New commands `enable probe' and `disable probe'.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1604 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1605 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1606
1607 @smallexample
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1609 main
1610 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1611 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1612 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1613 @end smallexample
1614
1615 @noindent
1616 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1617
1618 @table @code
1619 @kindex set max-completions
1620 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1621 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1622 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1623 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1624 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1625 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1626 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1627 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1628 completion slow.
1629 @kindex show max-completions
1630 @item show max-completions
1631 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1632 during completion.
1633 @end table
1634
1635 @cindex quotes in commands
1636 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1637 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1638 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1639 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1640 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1641 @value{GDBN} commands.
1642
1643 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1644 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1645 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1646 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1647 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1648 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1649 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1650 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1651 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1652 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1653 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1654
1655 @smallexample
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1657 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1658 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1659 @end smallexample
1660
1661 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1662 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1663 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1664 place:
1665
1666 @smallexample
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1668 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1669 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1670 @end smallexample
1671
1672 @noindent
1673 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1674 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1675 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1676
1677 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1678 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1679 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1680 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1681
1682 @cindex completion of structure field names
1683 @cindex structure field name completion
1684 @cindex completion of union field names
1685 @cindex union field name completion
1686 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1687 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1688 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1689 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1690 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1691 left-hand-side:
1692
1693 @smallexample
1694 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1695 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1696 to_data to_isatty to_write
1697 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1698 to_flush to_read
1699 @end smallexample
1700
1701 @noindent
1702 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1703 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1704 follows:
1705
1706 @smallexample
1707 struct ui_file
1708 @{
1709 int *magic;
1710 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1711 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1712 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1713 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1714 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1715 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1716 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1717 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1718 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1719 void *to_data;
1720 @}
1721 @end smallexample
1722
1723
1724 @node Help
1725 @section Getting Help
1726 @cindex online documentation
1727 @kindex help
1728
1729 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1730 using the command @code{help}.
1731
1732 @table @code
1733 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1734 @item help
1735 @itemx h
1736 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1737 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help
1741 List of classes of commands:
1742
1743 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1744 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1745 data -- Examining data
1746 files -- Specifying and examining files
1747 internals -- Maintenance commands
1748 obscure -- Obscure features
1749 running -- Running the program
1750 stack -- Examining the stack
1751 status -- Status inquiries
1752 support -- Support facilities
1753 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1754 stopping the program
1755 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1756
1757 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1758 commands in that class.
1759 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1760 documentation.
1761 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1762 (@value{GDBP})
1763 @end smallexample
1764 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1765
1766 @item help @var{class}
1767 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1768 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1769 help display for the class @code{status}:
1770
1771 @smallexample
1772 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1773 Status inquiries.
1774
1775 List of commands:
1776
1777 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1778 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1779 info -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the program being debugged
1781 show -- Generic command for showing things
1782 about the debugger
1783
1784 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1785 documentation.
1786 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1787 (@value{GDBP})
1788 @end smallexample
1789
1790 @item help @var{command}
1791 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1792 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1793
1794 @kindex apropos
1795 @item apropos @var{args}
1796 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1797 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1798 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 apropos alias
1802 @end smallexample
1803
1804 @noindent
1805 results in:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 @c @group
1809 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1810 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1811 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1813 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1814 @c @end group
1815 @end smallexample
1816
1817 @kindex complete
1818 @item complete @var{args}
1819 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1820 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1821 command you want completed. For example:
1822
1823 @smallexample
1824 complete i
1825 @end smallexample
1826
1827 @noindent results in:
1828
1829 @smallexample
1830 @group
1831 if
1832 ignore
1833 info
1834 inspect
1835 @end group
1836 @end smallexample
1837
1838 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1839 @end table
1840
1841 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1842 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1843 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1844 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1845 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1846 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1847 Index}.
1848
1849 @c @group
1850 @table @code
1851 @kindex info
1852 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1853 @item info
1854 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1855 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1856 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1857 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1858 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1859 @w{@code{help info}}.
1860
1861 @kindex set
1862 @item set
1863 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1864 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1865 @code{set prompt $}.
1866
1867 @kindex show
1868 @item show
1869 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1870 @value{GDBN} itself.
1871 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1872 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1873 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1874 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1875
1876 @kindex info set
1877 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1878 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1879 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1880 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1881 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1882 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1883 @end table
1884 @c @end group
1885
1886 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1887 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex show version
1891 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1892 @item show version
1893 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1894 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1895 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1896 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1897 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1898 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1899 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1900 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1901 @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show copying
1904 @kindex info copying
1905 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1906 @item show copying
1907 @itemx info copying
1908 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1909
1910 @kindex show warranty
1911 @kindex info warranty
1912 @item show warranty
1913 @itemx info warranty
1914 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1915 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1916
1917 @kindex show configuration
1918 @item show configuration
1919 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1920 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1921 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1922 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1923 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1924 your report.
1925
1926 @end table
1927
1928 @node Running
1929 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1930
1931 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1932 debugging information when you compile it.
1933
1934 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1935 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1936 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1937 kill a child process.
1938
1939 @menu
1940 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1941 * Starting:: Starting your program
1942 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1943 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1944
1945 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1946 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1947 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1948 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1949
1950 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1951 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1952 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1953 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1954 @end menu
1955
1956 @node Compilation
1957 @section Compiling for Debugging
1958
1959 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1960 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1961 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1962 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1963 and addresses in the executable code.
1964
1965 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1966 the compiler.
1967
1968 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1969 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1970 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1971 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1972 executables containing debugging information.
1973
1974 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1975 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1976 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1977 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1978 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1979
1980 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1981 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1982 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1983
1984 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1985 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1986 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1987 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1988 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1989 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1990
1991 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1992 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1993 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1994
1995 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1996 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1997 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1998 format in @value{GDBN}.
1999
2000 @need 2000
2001 @node Starting
2002 @section Starting your Program
2003 @cindex starting
2004 @cindex running
2005
2006 @table @code
2007 @kindex run
2008 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2009 @item run
2010 @itemx r
2011 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2012 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2013 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2014 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2015 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2016
2017 @end table
2018
2019 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2020 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2021 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2022 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2023 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2024 message like this one:
2025
2026 @smallexample
2027 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2028 Try "help target" or "continue".
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 @noindent
2032 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2033 first (@pxref{load}).
2034
2035 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2036 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2037 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2038 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2039 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2040 divided into four categories:
2041
2042 @table @asis
2043 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2044 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2045 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2046 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2047 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2048 the arguments.
2049 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2050 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2051 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2052 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2053 below for details).
2054
2055 @item The @emph{environment.}
2056 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2057 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2058 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2059 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2060
2061 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2062 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2063 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2064 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2065
2066 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2067 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2068 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2069 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2070 set a different device for your program.
2071 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2072
2073 @cindex pipes
2074 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2075 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2076 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2077 wrong program.
2078 @end table
2079
2080 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2081 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2082 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2083 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2084 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2085
2086 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2087 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2088 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2089 your current breakpoints.
2090
2091 @table @code
2092 @kindex start
2093 @item start
2094 @cindex run to main procedure
2095 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2096 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2097 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2098 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2099 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2100 procedure, depending on the language used.
2101
2102 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2103 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2104 the @samp{run} command.
2105
2106 @cindex elaboration phase
2107 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2108 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2109 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2110 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2111 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2112 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2113 will remain to halt execution.
2114
2115 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2116 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2117 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2118 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2119 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2120
2121 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2122 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2123 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2124 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2125 elaboration code before running your program.
2126
2127 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2128 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2129 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2130 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2131 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2132 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2133 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2134 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2135 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2136 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2137 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2138 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2139
2140 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2141 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2142 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2143 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2144
2145 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2146 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2147 environment:
2148
2149 @smallexample
2150 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2151 (@value{GDBP}) run
2152 @end smallexample
2153
2154 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2155 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2156
2157 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2158 @item set startup-with-shell
2159 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2160 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2161 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2162 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2163 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2164 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2165 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2166 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2167 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2168 startup failures such as:
2169
2170 @smallexample
2171 (@value{GDBP}) run
2172 Starting program: ./a.out
2173 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2174 @end smallexample
2175
2176 @noindent
2177 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2178 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2179 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2180 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2181 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2182 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2183
2184 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2185 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2186 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2187 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2188 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2189 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2190
2191 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2192 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2193 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2194 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2195 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2196 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2197
2198 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2199 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2200 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2201
2202 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2203 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2204
2205 @smallexample
2206 (@value{GDBP}) run
2207 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2208 @end smallexample
2209
2210 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2211 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2212
2213 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2214 @code{target native} command. For example,
2215
2216 @smallexample
2217 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2218 (@value{GDBP}) run
2219 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2220 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2227 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2228 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2229 disconnect.
2230
2231 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2232 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2233 proc}, @code{info os}.
2234
2235 @kindex set disable-randomization
2236 @item set disable-randomization
2237 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2238 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2239 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2240 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2241 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2242
2243 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2244 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2245
2246 @smallexample
2247 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2248 @end smallexample
2249
2250 @item set disable-randomization off
2251 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2252 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2253 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2254 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2255 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2256 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2257
2258 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2259 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2260 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2261 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2262 a code at its expected addresses.
2263
2264 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2265 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2266 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2267 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2268 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2269 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2270 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2271 a randomly chosen address.
2272
2273 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2274 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2275 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2276 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2277 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2278
2279 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2280 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2281
2282 @item show disable-randomization
2283 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2284 the virtual address space of the started program.
2285
2286 @end table
2287
2288 @node Arguments
2289 @section Your Program's Arguments
2290
2291 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2292 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2293 @code{run} command.
2294 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2295 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2296 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2297 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2298 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2299
2300 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2301 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2302 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2303 the program, not by the shell.
2304
2305 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2306 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2307
2308 @table @code
2309 @kindex set args
2310 @item set args
2311 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2312 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2313 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2314 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2315 it again without arguments.
2316
2317 @kindex show args
2318 @item show args
2319 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2320 @end table
2321
2322 @node Environment
2323 @section Your Program's Environment
2324
2325 @cindex environment (of your program)
2326 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2327 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2328 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2329 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2330 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2331 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2332 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2333
2334 @table @code
2335 @kindex path
2336 @item path @var{directory}
2337 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2338 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2339 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2340 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2341 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2342 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2343 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2344
2345 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2346 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2347 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2348 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2349 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2350 @var{directory} to the search path.
2351 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2352 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2353
2354 @kindex show paths
2355 @item show paths
2356 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2357 environment variable).
2358
2359 @kindex show environment
2360 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2361 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2362 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2363 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2364 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2365
2366 @kindex set environment
2367 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2368 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2369 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2370 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2371 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2372 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2373 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2374 null value.
2375 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2376 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2377
2378 For example, this command:
2379
2380 @smallexample
2381 set env USER = foo
2382 @end smallexample
2383
2384 @noindent
2385 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2386 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2387 are not actually required.)
2388
2389 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2390 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2391 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2392 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2393 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2394
2395 @kindex unset environment
2396 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2397 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2398 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2399 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2400 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2401 @end table
2402
2403 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2404 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2405 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2406 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2407 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2408 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2409 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2410 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2411 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2412 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2413
2414 @node Working Directory
2415 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2416
2417 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2418 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2419 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2420 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2421 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2422 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2423
2424 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2425 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2426 Specify Files}.
2427
2428 @table @code
2429 @kindex cd
2430 @cindex change working directory
2431 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2432 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2433 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2434
2435 @kindex pwd
2436 @item pwd
2437 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2438 @end table
2439
2440 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2441 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2442 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2443 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2444 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2445 current working directory of the debuggee.
2446
2447 @node Input/Output
2448 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2449
2450 @cindex redirection
2451 @cindex i/o
2452 @cindex terminal
2453 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2454 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2455 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2456 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2457 running your program.
2458
2459 @table @code
2460 @kindex info terminal
2461 @item info terminal
2462 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2463 program is using.
2464 @end table
2465
2466 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2467 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2468
2469 @smallexample
2470 run > outfile
2471 @end smallexample
2472
2473 @noindent
2474 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2475
2476 @kindex tty
2477 @cindex controlling terminal
2478 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2479 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2480 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2481 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2482 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2483
2484 @smallexample
2485 tty /dev/ttyb
2486 @end smallexample
2487
2488 @noindent
2489 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2490 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2491 that as their controlling terminal.
2492
2493 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2494 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2495 terminal.
2496
2497 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2498 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2499 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2500 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2501
2502 @cindex inferior tty
2503 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2504 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2505 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2506 program.
2507
2508 @table @code
2509 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2510 @kindex set inferior-tty
2511 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2512
2513 @item show inferior-tty
2514 @kindex show inferior-tty
2515 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2516 @end table
2517
2518 @node Attach
2519 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2520 @kindex attach
2521 @cindex attach
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @item attach @var{process-id}
2525 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2526 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2527 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2528 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2529 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2530
2531 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2536 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2537 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2538 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2539
2540 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2541 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2542 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2543 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2544 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2545 Specify Files}.
2546
2547 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2548 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2549 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2550 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2551 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2552 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2553 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2554
2555 @table @code
2556 @kindex detach
2557 @item detach
2558 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2559 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2560 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2561 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2562 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2563 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2564 executing the command.
2565 @end table
2566
2567 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2568 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2569 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2570 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2571 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2572 Messages}).
2573
2574 @node Kill Process
2575 @section Killing the Child Process
2576
2577 @table @code
2578 @kindex kill
2579 @item kill
2580 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2581 @end table
2582
2583 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2584 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2585 is running.
2586
2587 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2588 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2589 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2590 outside the debugger.
2591
2592 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2593 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2594 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2595 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2596 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2597 breakpoint settings).
2598
2599 @node Inferiors and Programs
2600 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2601
2602 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2603 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2604 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2605 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2606 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2607 from multiple executables.
2608
2609 @cindex inferior
2610 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2611 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2612 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2613 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2614 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2615 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2616 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2617 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2618 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2619 threads running in it.
2620
2621 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2622 inferiors}}:
2623
2624 @table @code
2625 @kindex info inferiors
2626 @item info inferiors
2627 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2628
2629 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2630
2631 @enumerate
2632 @item
2633 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2634
2635 @item
2636 the target system's inferior identifier
2637
2638 @item
2639 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2640
2641 @end enumerate
2642
2643 @noindent
2644 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2645 indicates the current inferior.
2646
2647 For example,
2648 @end table
2649 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2650
2651 @smallexample
2652 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2653 Num Description Executable
2654 2 process 2307 hello
2655 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2656 @end smallexample
2657
2658 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2659
2660 @table @code
2661 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2662 @item inferior @var{infno}
2663 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2664 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2665 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2666 @end table
2667
2668
2669 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2670 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2671 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2672 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2673 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2674 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2675
2676 @table @code
2677 @kindex add-inferior
2678 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2679 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2680 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2681 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2682 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2683 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2684
2685 @kindex clone-inferior
2686 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2687 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2688 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2689 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2690 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2691
2692 @smallexample
2693 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2694 Num Description Executable
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2697 Added inferior 2.
2698 1 inferiors added.
2699 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2700 Num Description Executable
2701 2 <null> helloworld
2702 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2703 @end smallexample
2704
2705 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2706
2707 @kindex remove-inferiors
2708 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2709 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2710 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2711 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2712
2713 @end table
2714
2715 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2716 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2717 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2718 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2719
2720 @table @code
2721 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2724 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2725 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2726 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727
2728 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2730 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2731 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2732 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2733 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2737 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2738 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2739 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2740
2741
2742 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2743 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2744
2745 @table @code
2746 @kindex set print inferior-events
2747 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2748 @item set print inferior-events
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2750 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2751 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2752 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2753 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2754 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2755
2756 @kindex show print inferior-events
2757 @item show print inferior-events
2758 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2759 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2760 @end table
2761
2762 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2763 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2764 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2765
2766
2767 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2768 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2769 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2770 info program-spaces}} command.
2771
2772 @table @code
2773 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2774 @item maint info program-spaces
2775 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2776 @value{GDBN}.
2777
2778 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2779
2780 @enumerate
2781 @item
2782 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2783
2784 @item
2785 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2786 the @code{file} command.
2787
2788 @end enumerate
2789
2790 @noindent
2791 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2792 indicates the current program space.
2793
2794 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2795 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2796 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2797
2798 @smallexample
2799 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2800 Id Executable
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 * 1 hello
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2807 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2808 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2809 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2810 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2811
2812 @smallexample
2813 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2814 Id Executable
2815 * 1 vfork-test
2816 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2817 @end smallexample
2818
2819 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2820 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2821 @end table
2822
2823 @node Threads
2824 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2825
2826 @cindex threads of execution
2827 @cindex multiple threads
2828 @cindex switching threads
2829 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2830 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2831 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2832 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2833 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2834 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2835 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2836
2837 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2838 programs:
2839
2840 @itemize @bullet
2841 @item automatic notification of new threads
2842 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2843 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2844 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2845 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2846 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2847 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2848 messages on thread start and exit.
2849 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2850 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2851 isn't compatible with the program.
2852 @end itemize
2853
2854 @quotation
2855 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2856 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2857 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2858 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2859 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2860 like this:
2861
2862 @smallexample
2863 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2864 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2865 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2866 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2867 @end smallexample
2868 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2869 @c doesn't support threads"?
2870 @end quotation
2871
2872 @cindex focus of debugging
2873 @cindex current thread
2874 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2875 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2876 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2877 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2878 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2879
2880 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2881 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2882 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2883 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2884 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2885 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2886 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2887 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2888 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2889 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2890
2891 @smallexample
2892 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2893 @end smallexample
2894
2895 @noindent
2896 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2897 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2898 further qualifier.
2899
2900 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2901 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2902 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2903 @c program?
2904 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2905 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2906 @c threads ab initio?
2907
2908 @cindex thread number
2909 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2910 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2911 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2912
2913 @table @code
2914 @kindex info threads
2915 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2916 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2917 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2918 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2919 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2920
2921 @enumerate
2922 @item
2923 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2924
2925 @item
2926 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2927
2928 @item
2929 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2930 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2931 program itself.
2932
2933 @item
2934 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 @noindent
2938 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2939 indicates the current thread.
2940
2941 For example,
2942 @end table
2943 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2944
2945 @smallexample
2946 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2947 Id Target Id Frame
2948 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2949 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2950 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2951 at threadtest.c:68
2952 @end smallexample
2953
2954 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2955 Solaris-specific command:
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @item maint info sol-threads
2959 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2960 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2961 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2962 @end table
2963
2964 @table @code
2965 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2966 @item thread @var{threadno}
2967 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2968 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2969 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2970 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2971 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2972
2973 @smallexample
2974 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2975 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2976 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2977 8 printf ("hello\n");
2978 @end smallexample
2979
2980 @noindent
2981 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2982 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2983 threads.
2984
2985 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2986 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2987 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2988 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2989 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2990 information on convenience variables.
2991
2992 @kindex thread apply
2993 @cindex apply command to several threads
2994 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2995 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2996 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2997 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2998 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2999 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
3000 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
3001 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3002 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3003 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3004
3005
3006 @kindex thread name
3007 @cindex name a thread
3008 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3009 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3010 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3011 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3012
3013 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3014 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3015 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3016 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3017 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3018
3019 @kindex thread find
3020 @cindex search for a thread
3021 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3022 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3023 matches the supplied regular expression.
3024
3025 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3026 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3027 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3028 is the LWP id.
3029
3030 @smallexample
3031 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3032 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3033 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3034 Id Target Id Frame
3035 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3036 @end smallexample
3037
3038 @kindex set print thread-events
3039 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3040 @item set print thread-events
3041 @itemx set print thread-events on
3042 @itemx set print thread-events off
3043 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3044 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3045 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3046 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3047 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3048
3049 @kindex show print thread-events
3050 @item show print thread-events
3051 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3052 have started and exited.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3056 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3057 programs with multiple threads.
3058
3059 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3060 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3061
3062 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3063 @table @code
3064 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3065 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3066 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3067 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3068 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3069 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3070 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3071 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3072 macro.
3073
3074 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3075 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3076 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3077 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3078 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3079 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3080
3081 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3082 refers to the default system directories that are
3083 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3084 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3085 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3086
3087 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3088 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3089 was loaded in the inferior process.
3090
3091 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3092 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3093 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3094 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3095 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3096 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3097 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3098
3099 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3100 only on some platforms.
3101
3102 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3103 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3104 Display current libthread_db search path.
3105
3106 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3107 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3108 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3109 @item set debug libthread-db
3110 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3111 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3112 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3113 @end table
3114
3115 @node Forks
3116 @section Debugging Forks
3117
3118 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3119 @cindex multiple processes
3120 @cindex processes, multiple
3121 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3122 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3123 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3124 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3125 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3126 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3127 will cause it to terminate.
3128
3129 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3130 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3131 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3132 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3133 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3134 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3135 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3136 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3137 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3138 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3139
3140 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3141 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3142 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3143 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3144
3145 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3146 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3147
3148 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3149 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3153 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3154 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3155 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3156 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3157
3158 @table @code
3159 @item parent
3160 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3161 unimpeded. This is the default.
3162
3163 @item child
3164 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3165 unimpeded.
3166
3167 @end table
3168
3169 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3170 @item show follow-fork-mode
3171 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3172 @end table
3173
3174 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3175 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3176 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3177
3178 @table @code
3179 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3180 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3181 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3182 retain debugger control over them both.
3183
3184 @table @code
3185 @item on
3186 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3187 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3188 independently. This is the default.
3189
3190 @item off
3191 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3192 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3193 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3194 is held suspended.
3195
3196 @end table
3197
3198 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3199 @item show detach-on-fork
3200 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3201 @end table
3202
3203 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3204 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3205 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3206 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3207 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3208 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3209
3210 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3211 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3212 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3213 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3214 and Programs}.
3215
3216 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3217 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3218 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3219 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3220 the child process's @code{main}.
3221
3222 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3223 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3224
3225 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3226 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3227 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3228 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3229 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3230 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3231 command.
3232
3233 @table @code
3234 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3235 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3236
3237 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3238 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3239
3240 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3241
3242 @table @code
3243 @item new
3244 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3245 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3246 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3247 original inferior.
3248
3249 For example:
3250
3251 @smallexample
3252 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3253 (gdb) info inferior
3254 Id Description Executable
3255 * 1 <null> prog1
3256 (@value{GDBP}) run
3257 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3258 Program exited normally.
3259 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3260 Id Description Executable
3261 * 2 <null> prog2
3262 1 <null> prog1
3263 @end smallexample
3264
3265 @item same
3266 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3267 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3268 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3269 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3270 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3271
3272 For example:
3273
3274 @smallexample
3275 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3276 Id Description Executable
3277 * 1 <null> prog1
3278 (@value{GDBP}) run
3279 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3280 Program exited normally.
3281 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3282 Id Description Executable
3283 * 1 <null> prog2
3284 @end smallexample
3285
3286 @end table
3287 @end table
3288
3289 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3290 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3291 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3292
3293 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3294 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3295
3296 @cindex checkpoint
3297 @cindex restart
3298 @cindex bookmark
3299 @cindex snapshot of a process
3300 @cindex rewind program state
3301
3302 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3303 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3304 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3305 later.
3306
3307 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3308 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3309 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3310 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3311 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3312
3313 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3314 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3315 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3316 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3317 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3318 start again from there.
3319
3320 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3321 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3322
3323 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3324
3325 @table @code
3326 @kindex checkpoint
3327 @item checkpoint
3328 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3329 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3330 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3331
3332 @kindex info checkpoints
3333 @item info checkpoints
3334 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3335 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3336 listed:
3337
3338 @table @code
3339 @item Checkpoint ID
3340 @item Process ID
3341 @item Code Address
3342 @item Source line, or label
3343 @end table
3344
3345 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3346 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3347 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3348 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3349 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3350 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3351 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3352
3353 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3354 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3355 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3356 the debugger.
3357
3358 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3359 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3360 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3361
3362 @end table
3363
3364 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3365 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3366 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3367 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3368 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3369 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3370 previously read data can be read again.
3371
3372 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3373 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3374 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3375 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3376 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3377 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3378
3379 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3380 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3381 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3382 different execution path this time.
3383
3384 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3385 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3386 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3387 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3388 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3389 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3390 potentially pose a problem.
3391
3392 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3393
3394 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3395 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3396 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3397 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3398 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3399 next.
3400
3401 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3402 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3403 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3404 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3405 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3406
3407 @node Stopping
3408 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3409
3410 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3411 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3412 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3413
3414 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3415 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3416 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3417 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3418 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3419 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3420 explicitly request this information at any time.
3421
3422 @table @code
3423 @kindex info program
3424 @item info program
3425 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3426 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3427 @end table
3428
3429 @menu
3430 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3431 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3432 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3433 Skipping over functions and files
3434 * Signals:: Signals
3435 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3436 @end menu
3437
3438 @node Breakpoints
3439 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3440
3441 @cindex breakpoints
3442 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3443 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3444 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3445 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3446 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3447 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3448 program.
3449
3450 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3451 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3452 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3453 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3454 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3455 call).
3456
3457 @cindex watchpoints
3458 @cindex data breakpoints
3459 @cindex memory tracing
3460 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3461 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3462 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3463 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3464 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3465 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3466 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3467 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3468 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3469 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3470 same commands.
3471
3472 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3473 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3474 Automatic Display}.
3475
3476 @cindex catchpoints
3477 @cindex breakpoint on events
3478 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3479 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3480 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3481 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3482 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3483 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3484 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3485
3486 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3487 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3488 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3489 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3490 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3491 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3492 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3493 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3494 enable it again.
3495
3496 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3497 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3498 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3499 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3500 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3501 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3502 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3503
3504 @menu
3505 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3506 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3507 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3508 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3509 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3510 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3511 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3512 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3513 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3514 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3515 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3516 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3517 @end menu
3518
3519 @node Set Breaks
3520 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3521
3522 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3523 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3524 @c
3525 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3526
3527 @kindex break
3528 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3529 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3530 @cindex latest breakpoint
3531 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3532 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3533 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3534 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3535 convenience variables.
3536
3537 @table @code
3538 @item break @var{location}
3539 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3540 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3541 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3542 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3543 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3544
3545 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3546 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3547 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3548 that situation.
3549
3550 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3551 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3552 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3553
3554 @item break
3555 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3556 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3557 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3558 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3559 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3560 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3561 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3562 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3563 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3564 inside loops.
3565
3566 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3567 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3568 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3569 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3570 existed when your program stopped.
3571
3572 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3573 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3574 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3575 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3576 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3577 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3578 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3579
3580 @kindex tbreak
3581 @item tbreak @var{args}
3582 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3583 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3584 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3585 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3586
3587 @kindex hbreak
3588 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3589 @item hbreak @var{args}
3590 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3591 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3592 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3593 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3594 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3595 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3596 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3597 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3598 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3599 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3600 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3601 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3602 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3603 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3604 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3605 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3606 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3607 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3608
3609 @kindex thbreak
3610 @item thbreak @var{args}
3611 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3612 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3613 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3614 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3615 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3616 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3617 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3618 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3619
3620 @kindex rbreak
3621 @cindex regular expression
3622 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3623 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3624 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3625 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3626 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3627 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3628 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3629 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3630 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3631
3632 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3633 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3634 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3635 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3636 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3637 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3638
3639 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3640 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3641 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3642 classes.
3643
3644 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3645 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3646 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3647
3648 @smallexample
3649 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3650 @end smallexample
3651
3652 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3653 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3654 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3655 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3656 every function in a given file:
3657
3658 @smallexample
3659 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3660 @end smallexample
3661
3662 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3663 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3664
3665 @kindex info breakpoints
3666 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3667 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3668 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3669 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3670 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3671 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3672 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3673
3674 @table @emph
3675 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3676 @item Type
3677 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3678 @item Disposition
3679 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3680 @item Enabled or Disabled
3681 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3682 that are not enabled.
3683 @item Address
3684 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3685 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3686 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3687 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3688 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3689 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3690 @item What
3691 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3692 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3693 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3694 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3695 @end table
3696
3697 @noindent
3698 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3699 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3700 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3701 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3702 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3703 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3704
3705 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3706 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3707 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3708 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3709
3710 @noindent
3711 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3712 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3713 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3714 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3715 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3716
3717 @noindent
3718 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3719 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3720 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3721 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3722 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3723 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3724
3725 @noindent
3726 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3727 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3728
3729 @end table
3730
3731 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3732 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3733 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3734 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3735
3736 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3737 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3738 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3739 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3740
3741 @itemize @bullet
3742 @item
3743 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3744
3745 @item
3746 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3747 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3748
3749 @item
3750 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3751 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3752
3753 @item
3754 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3755 several places where that function is inlined.
3756 @end itemize
3757
3758 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3759 the relevant locations.
3760
3761 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3762 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3763 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3764 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3765 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3766 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3767 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3768
3769 For example:
3770
3771 @smallexample
3772 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3773 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3774 stop only if i==1
3775 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3776 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3777 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3778 @end smallexample
3779
3780 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3781 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3782 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3783 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3784 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3785 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3786 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3787 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3788 that belong to that breakpoint.
3789
3790 @cindex pending breakpoints
3791 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3792 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3793 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3794 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3795 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3796 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3797 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3798 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3799 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3800 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3801 is not yet resolved.
3802
3803 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3804 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3805 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3806 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3807 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3808 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3809
3810 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3811 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3812 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3813 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3814
3815 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3816 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3817 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3818
3819 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3820 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3821 address specification to an address:
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3824 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3828 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3829
3830 @item set breakpoint pending on
3831 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3832 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3833
3834 @item set breakpoint pending off
3835 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3836 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3837 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3838
3839 @item show breakpoint pending
3840 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3841 @end table
3842
3843 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3844 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3845 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3846
3847 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3848 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3849 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3850 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3851 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3852 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3853 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3854 breakpoints.
3855
3856 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3857
3858 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3859 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3860 @table @code
3861 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3862 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3863 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3864 breakpoint must be used.
3865
3866 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3867 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3868 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3869 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3870 @end table
3871
3872 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3873 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3874 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3875 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3876 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3877 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3878 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3879 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3880 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3881
3882 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3883 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3884 @table @code
3885 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3886 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3887 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3888 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3889
3890 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3891 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3892 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3893 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3894 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3895 @end table
3896
3897 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3898 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3899 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3900
3901 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3902 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3903
3904 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3905
3906 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3907 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3908 @table @code
3909 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3910 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3911 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3912 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3913 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3914
3915 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3916 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3917 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3918 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3919 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3920 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3921 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3922 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3923 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3924 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3925 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3926 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3927 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3928
3929 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3930 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3931 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3932 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3933 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3934 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3935 @end table
3936
3937
3938 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3939 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3940 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3941 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3942 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3943 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3944 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3945 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3946
3947
3948 @node Set Watchpoints
3949 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3950
3951 @cindex setting watchpoints
3952 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3953 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3954 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3955 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3956 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3957
3958 @itemize @bullet
3959 @item
3960 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3961
3962 @item
3963 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3964 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3965 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3966
3967 @item
3968 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3969 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3970 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3971 @end itemize
3972
3973 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3974 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3975 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3976 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3977 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3978 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3979 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3980 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3981 the expression changes.
3982
3983 @cindex software watchpoints
3984 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3985 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3986 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3987 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3988 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3989 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3990 culprit.)
3991
3992 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3993 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3994 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3995
3996 @table @code
3997 @kindex watch
3998 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3999 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4000 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4001 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4002 to watch the value of a single variable:
4003
4004 @smallexample
4005 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4006 @end smallexample
4007
4008 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4009 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4010 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4011 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4012 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4013 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4014
4015 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4016 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4017 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4018 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4019 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4020 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4021 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4022 error.
4023
4024 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4025 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4026 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4027 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4028 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4029 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4030 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4031 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4032 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4033 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4034 Examples:
4035
4036 @smallexample
4037 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4038 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4039 @end smallexample
4040
4041 @kindex rwatch
4042 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4043 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4044 by the program.
4045
4046 @kindex awatch
4047 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4048 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4049 or written into by the program.
4050
4051 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4052 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4053 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4054 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4055 @end table
4056
4057 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4058 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4059 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4060 a never-changing value:
4061
4062 @smallexample
4063 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4064 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4065 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4066 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4067 @end smallexample
4068
4069 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4070 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4071 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4072 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4073 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4074 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4075
4076 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4077 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4078 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4079 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4080 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4081 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4082 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4083 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4084
4085 @table @code
4086 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4087 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4088 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4089
4090 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4091 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4092 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4093 @end table
4094
4095 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4096 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4097 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4098
4099 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4100
4101 @smallexample
4102 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 @noindent
4106 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4107
4108 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4109 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4110 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4111 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4112 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4113 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4114 will print a message like this:
4115
4116 @smallexample
4117 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4118 @end smallexample
4119
4120 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4121 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4122 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4123 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4124 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4125 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4126 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4127 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4128
4129 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4130 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4131 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4132 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4133 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4134 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4135
4136 @smallexample
4137 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4138 @end smallexample
4139
4140 @noindent
4141 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4142
4143 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4144 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4145 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4146 expression with separately allocated resources.
4147
4148 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4149 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4150 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4151
4152 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4153 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4154 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4155 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4156 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4157 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4158 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4159 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4160 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4161
4162 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4163 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4164 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4165 watched expression from every thread.
4166
4167 @quotation
4168 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4169 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4170 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4171 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4172 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4173 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4174 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4175 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4176 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4177 @end quotation
4178
4179 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4180
4181 @node Set Catchpoints
4182 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4183 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4184 @cindex exception handlers
4185 @cindex event handling
4186
4187 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4188 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4189 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4190
4191 @table @code
4192 @kindex catch
4193 @item catch @var{event}
4194 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4195
4196 @table @code
4197 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4198 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4199 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4200 @kindex catch throw
4201 @kindex catch rethrow
4202 @kindex catch catch
4203 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4204 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4205
4206 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4207 regular expression will be caught.
4208
4209 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4210 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4211 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4212 exception being thrown.
4213
4214 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4215 @value{GDBN}:
4216
4217 @itemize @bullet
4218 @item
4219 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4220 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4221 supported.
4222
4223 @item
4224 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4225 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4226 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4227 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4228 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4229 built.
4230
4231 @item
4232 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4233 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4234
4235 @item
4236 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4237 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4238 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4239 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4240
4241 @item
4242 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4243 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4244 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4245 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4246 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4247 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4248 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4249 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4250 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4251
4252 @item
4253 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4254
4255 @item
4256 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4257 @end itemize
4258
4259 @item exception
4260 @kindex catch exception
4261 @cindex Ada exception catching
4262 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4263 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4264 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4265 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4266 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4267
4268 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4269 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4270 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4271 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4272 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4273 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4274 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4275 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4276
4277 @item exception unhandled
4278 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4279 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4280
4281 @item assert
4282 @kindex catch assert
4283 A failed Ada assertion.
4284
4285 @item exec
4286 @kindex catch exec
4287 @cindex break on fork/exec
4288 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4289 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4290
4291 @item syscall
4292 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4293 @kindex catch syscall
4294 @cindex break on a system call.
4295 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4296 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4297 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4298 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4299 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4300 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4301 will be caught.
4302
4303 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4304 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4305 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4306 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4307
4308 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4309 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4310 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4311 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4312
4313 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4314 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4315 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4316 available choices.
4317
4318 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4319 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4320 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4321 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4322 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4323 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4324 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4325 behind the OS upgrades).
4326
4327 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4328 arguments to it:
4329
4330 @smallexample
4331 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4332 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4333 (@value{GDBP}) r
4334 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4335
4336 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4337 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4338 (@value{GDBP}) c
4339 Continuing.
4340
4341 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4342 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4343 (@value{GDBP})
4344 @end smallexample
4345
4346 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4347
4348 @smallexample
4349 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4350 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4351 (@value{GDBP}) r
4352 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4353
4354 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4355 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4356 (@value{GDBP}) c
4357 Continuing.
4358
4359 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4360 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4361 (@value{GDBP})
4362 @end smallexample
4363
4364 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4365 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4366 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4367
4368 @smallexample
4369 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4370 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4371 (@value{GDBP}) r
4372 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4373
4374 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4375 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4376 (@value{GDBP}) c
4377 Continuing.
4378
4379 Program exited normally.
4380 (@value{GDBP})
4381 @end smallexample
4382
4383 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4384 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4385 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4386 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4390 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4391 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4392 (@value{GDBP})
4393 @end smallexample
4394
4395 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4396 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4397 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4398 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4399 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4400 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4401
4402 @smallexample
4403 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4404 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4405 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4406 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4407 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4408 (@value{GDBP})
4409 @end smallexample
4410
4411 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4412
4413 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4414 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4418 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4419 @end smallexample
4420
4421 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4422
4423 @item fork
4424 @kindex catch fork
4425 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4426 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4427
4428 @item vfork
4429 @kindex catch vfork
4430 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4431 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4432
4433 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4434 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4435 @kindex catch load
4436 @kindex catch unload
4437 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4438 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4439 matches one of the affected libraries.
4440
4441 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4442 @kindex catch signal
4443 The delivery of a signal.
4444
4445 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4446 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4447 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4448
4449 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4450 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4451 signal names.
4452
4453 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4454 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4455 will be caught.
4456
4457 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4458 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4459 catchpoint.
4460
4461 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4462 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4463 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4464 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4465 commands.
4466
4467 @end table
4468
4469 @item tcatch @var{event}
4470 @kindex tcatch
4471 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4472 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4473
4474 @end table
4475
4476 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4477
4478
4479 @node Delete Breaks
4480 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4481
4482 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4483 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4484 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4485 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4486 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4487 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4488
4489 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4490 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4491 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4492 their breakpoint numbers.
4493
4494 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4495 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4496 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4497
4498 @table @code
4499 @kindex clear
4500 @item clear
4501 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4502 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4503 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4504 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4505
4506 @item clear @var{location}
4507 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4508 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4509 most useful ones are listed below:
4510
4511 @table @code
4512 @item clear @var{function}
4513 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4514 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4515
4516 @item clear @var{linenum}
4517 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4518 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4519 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4520 @end table
4521
4522 @cindex delete breakpoints
4523 @kindex delete
4524 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4525 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4526 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4527 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4528 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4529 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4530 @end table
4531
4532 @node Disabling
4533 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4534
4535 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4536 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4537 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4538 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4539 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4540
4541 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4542 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4543 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4544 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4545 do not know which numbers to use.
4546
4547 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4548 affects all of its locations.
4549
4550 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4551 different states of enablement:
4552
4553 @itemize @bullet
4554 @item
4555 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4556 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4557 @item
4558 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4559 @item
4560 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4561 disabled.
4562 @item
4563 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4564 N times, then becomes disabled.
4565 @item
4566 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4567 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4568 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4569 @end itemize
4570
4571 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4572 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4573
4574 @table @code
4575 @kindex disable
4576 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4577 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4578 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4579 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4580 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4581 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4582 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4583
4584 @kindex enable
4585 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4586 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4587 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4588
4589 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4590 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4591 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4592
4593 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4594 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4595 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4596 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4597 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4598 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4599 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4600
4601 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4602 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4603 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4604 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4605 @end table
4606
4607 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4608 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4609 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4610 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4611 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4612 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4613 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4614 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4615 Stepping}.)
4616
4617 @node Conditions
4618 @subsection Break Conditions
4619 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4620 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4621
4622 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4623 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4624 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4625 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4626 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4627 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4628 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4629 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4630
4631 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4632 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4633 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4634 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4635 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4636
4637 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4638 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4639 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4640 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4641 one.
4642
4643 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4644 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4645 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4646 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4647 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4648 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4649 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4650 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4651 conditions for the
4652 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4653 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4654
4655 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4656 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4657 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4658 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4659 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4660 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4661
4662 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4663 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4664 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4665 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4666 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4667
4668 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4669 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4670 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4671 with the @code{condition} command.
4672
4673 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4674 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4675 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4676 catchpoint.
4677
4678 @table @code
4679 @kindex condition
4680 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4681 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4682 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4683 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4684 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4685 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4686 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4687 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4688 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4689 prints an error message:
4690
4691 @smallexample
4692 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4693 @end smallexample
4694
4695 @noindent
4696 @value{GDBN} does
4697 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4698 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4699 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4700
4701 @item condition @var{bnum}
4702 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4703 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4704 @end table
4705
4706 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4707 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4708 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4709 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4710 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4711 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4712 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4713 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4714 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4715 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4716 your program reaches it.
4717
4718 @table @code
4719 @kindex ignore
4720 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4721 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4722 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4723 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4724 takes no action.
4725
4726 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4727 a count of zero.
4728
4729 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4730 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4731 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4732 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4733
4734 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4735 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4736 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4737
4738 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4739 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4740 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4741 Variables}.
4742 @end table
4743
4744 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4745
4746
4747 @node Break Commands
4748 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4749
4750 @cindex breakpoint commands
4751 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4752 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4753 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4754 enable other breakpoints.
4755
4756 @table @code
4757 @kindex commands
4758 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4759 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4760 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4761 @itemx end
4762 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4763 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4764 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4765
4766 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4767 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4768
4769 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4770 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4771 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4772 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4773 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4774 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4775 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4776 Expressions}).
4777 @end table
4778
4779 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4780 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4781
4782 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4783 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4784 that resumes execution.
4785
4786 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4787 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4788 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4789 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4790 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4791
4792 @kindex silent
4793 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4794 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4795 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4796 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4797 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4798 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4799
4800 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4801 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4802 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4803
4804 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4805 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4806
4807 @smallexample
4808 break foo if x>0
4809 commands
4810 silent
4811 printf "x is %d\n",x
4812 cont
4813 end
4814 @end smallexample
4815
4816 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4817 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4818 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4819 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4820 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4821 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4822 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4823
4824 @smallexample
4825 break 403
4826 commands
4827 silent
4828 set x = y + 4
4829 cont
4830 end
4831 @end smallexample
4832
4833 @node Dynamic Printf
4834 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4835
4836 @cindex dynamic printf
4837 @cindex dprintf
4838 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4839 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4840 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4841 having to recompile it.
4842
4843 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4844 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4845 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4846 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4847 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4848 redirects to files and so forth.
4849
4850 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4851 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4852 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4853 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4854 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4855 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4856 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4857
4858 @table @code
4859 @kindex dprintf
4860 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4861 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4862 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4863 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4864
4865 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4866 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4867 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4868 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4869 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4870 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4871
4872 @item gdb
4873 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4874 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4875
4876 @item call
4877 @kindex dprintf-style call
4878 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4879 @code{printf}).
4880
4881 @item agent
4882 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4883 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4884 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4885 support running commands on the target.
4886
4887 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4888 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4889 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4890 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4891 command.
4892
4893 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4894 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4895 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4896 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4897 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4898 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4899
4900 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4901 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4902 you could do the following:
4903
4904 @example
4905 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4906 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4907 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4908 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4909 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4910 (gdb) info break
4911 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4912 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4913 continue
4914 (gdb)
4915 @end example
4916
4917 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4918 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4919 the variable settings.
4920
4921 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4922 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4923 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4924 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4925 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4926 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4927
4928 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4929 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4930 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4931
4932 @end table
4933
4934 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4935 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4936 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4937 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4938 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4939 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4940
4941 @node Save Breakpoints
4942 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4943
4944 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4945 breakpoints}} command.
4946
4947 @table @code
4948 @kindex save breakpoints
4949 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4950 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4951 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4952 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4953 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4954 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4955 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4956 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4957 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4958 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4959 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4960 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4961 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4962 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4963 that can no longer be recreated.
4964 @end table
4965
4966 @node Static Probe Points
4967 @subsection Static Probe Points
4968
4969 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4970 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4971 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4972 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4973 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4974 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4975 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4976
4977 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4978 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4979 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4980 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4981 in your applications.
4982
4983 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4984 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4985 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4986 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4987 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4988 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4989 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4990 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4991
4992 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4993 probes}, with optional arguments:
4994
4995 @table @code
4996 @kindex info probes
4997 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4998 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4999 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5000 probes from all providers are listed.
5001
5002 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5003 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5004 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5005
5006 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5007 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5008 given, all object files are considered.
5009
5010 @item info probes all
5011 List the available static probes, from all types.
5012 @end table
5013
5014 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5015 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5016 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5017 handled. @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5018
5019 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5020 commands, with optional arguments:
5021
5022 @table @code
5023 @kindex enable probes
5024 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5025 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5026 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5027 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5028
5029 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5030 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5031 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5032
5033 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5034 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5035 given, all object files are considered.
5036
5037 @kindex disable probes
5038 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5039 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5040 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5041 @end table
5042
5043 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5044 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5045 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5046 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5047 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5048 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
5049 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
5050 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5051 at the current probe point.
5052
5053 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5054 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5055 an error message.
5056
5057
5058 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5059 @node Error in Breakpoints
5060 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5061
5062 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5063 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5064
5065 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5066 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5067 @smallexample
5068 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5069 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5070 @end smallexample
5071
5072 @noindent
5073 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5074 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5075 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5076
5077 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5078 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5079
5080 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5081 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5082 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5083
5084 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5085 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5086 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5087 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5088
5089 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5090 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5091 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5092 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5093 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5094 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5095 first in the bundle.
5096
5097 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5098 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5099 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5100 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5101 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5102 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5103 is hit.
5104
5105 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5106 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5107
5108 @smallexample
5109 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5110 @end smallexample
5111
5112 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5113 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5114 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5115 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5116 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5117 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5118 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5119 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5120
5121 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5122 adjusted breakpoints:
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5126 to 0x00010410.
5127 @end smallexample
5128
5129 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5130 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5131 frequently than expected.
5132
5133 @node Continuing and Stepping
5134 @section Continuing and Stepping
5135
5136 @cindex stepping
5137 @cindex continuing
5138 @cindex resuming execution
5139 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5140 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5141 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5142 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5143 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5144 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5145 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5146 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5147 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5148 handlers}).)
5149
5150 @table @code
5151 @kindex continue
5152 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5153 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5154 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5155 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5156 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5157 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5158 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5159 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5160 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5161 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5162
5163 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5164 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5165 @code{continue} is ignored.
5166
5167 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5168 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5169 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5170 @code{continue}.
5171 @end table
5172
5173 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5174 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5175 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5176 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5177
5178 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5179 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5180 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5181 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5182 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5183 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5184
5185 @table @code
5186 @kindex step
5187 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5188 @item step
5189 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5190 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5191 abbreviated @code{s}.
5192
5193 @quotation
5194 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5195 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5196 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5197 @c distinction here.
5198 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5199 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5200 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5201 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5202 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5203 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5204 below.
5205 @end quotation
5206
5207 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5208 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5209 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5210 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5211 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5212 called within the line.
5213
5214 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5215 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5216 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5217 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5218 was any debugging information about the routine.
5219
5220 @item step @var{count}
5221 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5222 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5223 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5224
5225 @kindex next
5226 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5227 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5228 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5229 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5230 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5231 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5232 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5233 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5234
5235 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5236
5237
5238 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5239 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5240 @c
5241 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5242 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5243 @c function are executed without stopping.
5244
5245 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5246 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5247 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5248
5249 @kindex set step-mode
5250 @item set step-mode
5251 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5252 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5253 @itemx set step-mode on
5254 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5255 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5256 information rather than stepping over it.
5257
5258 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5259 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5260 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5261
5262 @item set step-mode off
5263 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5264 debug information. This is the default.
5265
5266 @item show step-mode
5267 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5268 source line debug information.
5269
5270 @kindex finish
5271 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5272 @item finish
5273 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5274 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5275 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5276
5277 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5278 ,Returning from a Function}).
5279
5280 @kindex until
5281 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5282 @cindex run until specified location
5283 @item until
5284 @itemx u
5285 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5286 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5287 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5288 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5289 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5290 than the address of the jump.
5291
5292 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5293 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5294 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5295 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5296 through the next iteration.
5297
5298 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5299 stack frame.
5300
5301 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5302 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5303 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5304 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5305 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5306
5307 @smallexample
5308 (@value{GDBP}) f
5309 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5310 206 expand_input();
5311 (@value{GDBP}) until
5312 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5313 @end smallexample
5314
5315 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5316 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5317 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5318 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5319 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5320 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5321 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5322
5323 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5324 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5325 argument.
5326
5327 @item until @var{location}
5328 @itemx u @var{location}
5329 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5330 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5331 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5332 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5333 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5334 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5335 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5336 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5337 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5338 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5339 invocations have returned.
5340
5341 @smallexample
5342 94 int factorial (int value)
5343 95 @{
5344 96 if (value > 1) @{
5345 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5346 98 @}
5347 99 return (value);
5348 100 @}
5349 @end smallexample
5350
5351
5352 @kindex advance @var{location}
5353 @item advance @var{location}
5354 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5355 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5356 @ref{Specify Location}.
5357 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5358 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5359 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5360 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5361
5362
5363 @kindex stepi
5364 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5365 @item stepi
5366 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5367 @itemx si
5368 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5369
5370 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5371 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5372 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5373 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5374
5375 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5376
5377 @need 750
5378 @kindex nexti
5379 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5380 @item nexti
5381 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5382 @itemx ni
5383 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5384 proceed until the function returns.
5385
5386 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5387
5388 @end table
5389
5390 @anchor{range stepping}
5391 @cindex range stepping
5392 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5393 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5394 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5395 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5396 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5397 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5398 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5399 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5400 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5401 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5402 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5403 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5404 if necessary:
5405
5406 @table @code
5407 @kindex set range-stepping
5408 @kindex show range-stepping
5409 @item set range-stepping
5410 @itemx show range-stepping
5411 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5412
5413 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5414 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5415 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5416 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5417 default is @code{on}.
5418
5419 @end table
5420
5421 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5422 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5423 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5424
5425 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5426 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5427 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5428
5429 For example, consider the following C function:
5430
5431 @smallexample
5432 101 int func()
5433 102 @{
5434 103 foo(boring());
5435 104 bar(boring());
5436 105 @}
5437 @end smallexample
5438
5439 @noindent
5440 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5441 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5442 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5443 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5444
5445 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5446 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5447 is called from many places.
5448
5449 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5450 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5451 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5452 @code{foo}.
5453
5454 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5455 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5456
5457 @table @code
5458 @kindex skip function
5459 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5460 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5461 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5462 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5463 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5464
5465 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5466 will be skipped.
5467
5468 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5469 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5470
5471 @kindex skip file
5472 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5473 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5474 will be skipped over when stepping.
5475
5476 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5477 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5478 @end table
5479
5480 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5481 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5482
5483 @table @code
5484 @kindex info skip
5485 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5486 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5487 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5488 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5489
5490 @table @emph
5491 @item Identifier
5492 A number identifying this skip.
5493 @item Type
5494 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5495 @item Enabled or Disabled
5496 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5497 @item Address
5498 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5499 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5500 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5501 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5502 address here.
5503 @item What
5504 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5505 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5506 where it is defined.
5507 @end table
5508
5509 @kindex skip delete
5510 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5511 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5512 skips.
5513
5514 @kindex skip enable
5515 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5516 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5517 skips.
5518
5519 @kindex skip disable
5520 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5521 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5522 skips.
5523
5524 @end table
5525
5526 @node Signals
5527 @section Signals
5528 @cindex signals
5529
5530 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5531 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5532 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5533 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5534 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5535 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5536 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5537 requested an alarm).
5538
5539 @cindex fatal signals
5540 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5541 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5542 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5543 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5544 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5545 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5546
5547 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5548 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5549 signal.
5550
5551 @cindex handling signals
5552 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5553 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5554 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5555 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5556 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5557
5558 @table @code
5559 @kindex info signals
5560 @kindex info handle
5561 @item info signals
5562 @itemx info handle
5563 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5564 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5565 the defined types of signals.
5566
5567 @item info signals @var{sig}
5568 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5569
5570 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5571
5572 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5573 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5574 for details about this command.
5575
5576 @kindex handle
5577 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5578 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5579 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5580 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5581 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5582 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5583 say what change to make.
5584 @end table
5585
5586 @c @group
5587 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5588 Their full names are:
5589
5590 @table @code
5591 @item nostop
5592 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5593 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5594
5595 @item stop
5596 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5597 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5598
5599 @item print
5600 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5601
5602 @item noprint
5603 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5604 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5605
5606 @item pass
5607 @itemx noignore
5608 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5609 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5610 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5611
5612 @item nopass
5613 @itemx ignore
5614 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5615 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5616 @end table
5617 @c @end group
5618
5619 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5620 program until you
5621 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5622 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5623 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5624 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5625 program sees that signal when you continue.
5626
5627 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5628 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5629 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5630 erroneous signals.
5631
5632 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5633 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5634 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5635 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5636 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5637 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5638 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5639 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5640 Program a Signal}.
5641
5642 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5643 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5644
5645 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5646 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5647 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5648 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5649 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5650 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5651 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5652 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5653 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5654 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5655 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5656 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5657 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5658
5659 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5660
5661 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5662 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5663 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5664 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5665
5666 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5667 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5668 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5669 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5670
5671 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5672 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5673
5674 @smallexample
5675 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5676 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5677 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5678 (@value{GDBP}) c
5679 Continuing.
5680
5681 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5682 main () sigusr1.c:28
5683 28 p = 0;
5684 (@value{GDBP}) si
5685 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5686 9 @{
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5690 program to receive the signal first:
5691
5692 @smallexample
5693 (@value{GDBP}) n
5694 28 p = 0;
5695 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5696 (@value{GDBP}) si
5697 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5698 9 @{
5699 (@value{GDBP})
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 @cindex extra signal information
5703 @anchor{extra signal information}
5704
5705 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5706 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5707 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5708 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5709 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5710 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5711 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5712 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5713 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5714 system header.
5715
5716 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5717 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5718
5719 @smallexample
5720 @group
5721 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5722 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5723 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5724 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5725 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5726 type = struct @{
5727 int si_signo;
5728 int si_errno;
5729 int si_code;
5730 union @{
5731 int _pad[28];
5732 struct @{...@} _kill;
5733 struct @{...@} _timer;
5734 struct @{...@} _rt;
5735 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5736 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5737 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5738 @} _sifields;
5739 @}
5740 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5741 type = struct @{
5742 void *si_addr;
5743 @}
5744 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5745 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5746 @end group
5747 @end smallexample
5748
5749 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5750
5751 @node Thread Stops
5752 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5753
5754 @cindex stopped threads
5755 @cindex threads, stopped
5756
5757 @cindex continuing threads
5758 @cindex threads, continuing
5759
5760 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5761 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5762 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5763 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5764 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5765 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5766 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5767 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5768 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5769
5770 @menu
5771 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5772 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5773 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5774 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5775 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5776 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5777 @end menu
5778
5779 @node All-Stop Mode
5780 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5781
5782 @cindex all-stop mode
5783
5784 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5785 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5786 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5787 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5788 underfoot.
5789
5790 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5791 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5792 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5793
5794 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5795 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5796 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5797 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5798 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5799 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5800 stops.
5801
5802 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5803 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5804 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5805 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5806
5807 @cindex automatic thread selection
5808 @cindex switching threads automatically
5809 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5810 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5811 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5812 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5813 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5814 thread.
5815
5816 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5817 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5818
5819 @table @code
5820 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5821 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5822 @cindex lock scheduler
5823 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5824 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5825 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5826 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5827 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5828 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5829 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5830 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5831 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5832 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5833 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5834 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5835
5836 @item show scheduler-locking
5837 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5838 @end table
5839
5840 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5841 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5842 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5843 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5844 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5845 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5846 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5847 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5848 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5849 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5850 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5851 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5852 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5853 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5854
5855 @table @code
5856 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5857 @item set schedule-multiple
5858 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5859 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5860 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5861 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5862 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5863 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5864
5865 @item show schedule-multiple
5866 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5867 multiple processes.
5868 @end table
5869
5870 @node Non-Stop Mode
5871 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5872
5873 @cindex non-stop mode
5874
5875 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5876 @c with more details.
5877
5878 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5879 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5880 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5881 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5882 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5883 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5884
5885 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5886 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5887 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5888 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5889 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5890 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5891 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5892 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5893 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5894 independently and simultaneously.
5895
5896 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5897 or attach to your program:
5898
5899 @smallexample
5900 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5901 set pagination off
5902
5903 # Finally, turn it on!
5904 set non-stop on
5905 @end smallexample
5906
5907 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5908
5909 @table @code
5910 @kindex set non-stop
5911 @item set non-stop on
5912 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5913 @item set non-stop off
5914 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5915 @kindex show non-stop
5916 @item show non-stop
5917 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5918 @end table
5919
5920 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5921 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5922 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5923 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5924 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5925 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5926 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5927 default.
5928
5929 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5930 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5931 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5932
5933 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5934 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5935 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5936 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5937 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5938
5939 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5940 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5941 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5942 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5943 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5944
5945 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5946
5947 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5948 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5949 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5950 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5951 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5952 previously current thread.
5953
5954 @node Background Execution
5955 @subsection Background Execution
5956
5957 @cindex foreground execution
5958 @cindex background execution
5959 @cindex asynchronous execution
5960 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5961
5962 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5963 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5964 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5965 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5966 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5967 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5968
5969 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5970 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5971
5972 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5973 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5974 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5975 are:
5976
5977 @table @code
5978 @kindex run&
5979 @item run
5980 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5981
5982 @item attach
5983 @kindex attach&
5984 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5985
5986 @item step
5987 @kindex step&
5988 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5989
5990 @item stepi
5991 @kindex stepi&
5992 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5993
5994 @item next
5995 @kindex next&
5996 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5997
5998 @item nexti
5999 @kindex nexti&
6000 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6001
6002 @item continue
6003 @kindex continue&
6004 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6005
6006 @item finish
6007 @kindex finish&
6008 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6009
6010 @item until
6011 @kindex until&
6012 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6013
6014 @end table
6015
6016 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6017 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6018 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6019 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6020 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6021 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6022
6023 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6024 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6025
6026 @table @code
6027 @kindex interrupt
6028 @item interrupt
6029 @itemx interrupt -a
6030
6031 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6032 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6033 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6034 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6035 @end table
6036
6037 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6038 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6039
6040 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6041 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6042 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6043
6044 @table @code
6045 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6046 @cindex thread breakpoints
6047 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6048 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6049 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6050 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6051 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6052 specify some source line.
6053
6054 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6055 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6056 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6057 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6058 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6059
6060 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6061 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6062 program.
6063
6064 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6065 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6066 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6067
6068 @smallexample
6069 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6070 @end smallexample
6071
6072 @end table
6073
6074 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6075 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6076 thread list. For example:
6077
6078 @smallexample
6079 (@value{GDBP}) c
6080 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6081 @end smallexample
6082
6083 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6084 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6085 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6086 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6087 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6088 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6089 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6090 command.
6091
6092 @node Interrupted System Calls
6093 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6094
6095 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6096 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6097 @cindex premature return from system calls
6098 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6099 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6100 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6101 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6102 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6103 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6104 stop execution.
6105
6106 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6107 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6108 style anyways.
6109
6110 For example, do not write code like this:
6111
6112 @smallexample
6113 sleep (10);
6114 @end smallexample
6115
6116 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6117 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6118
6119 Instead, write this:
6120
6121 @smallexample
6122 int unslept = 10;
6123 while (unslept > 0)
6124 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6125 @end smallexample
6126
6127 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6128 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6129 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6130 @value{GDBN}.
6131
6132 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6133 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6134 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6135 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6136
6137 @node Observer Mode
6138 @subsection Observer Mode
6139
6140 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6141 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6142 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6143 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6144 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6145
6146 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6147 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6148 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6149 mode.
6150
6151 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6152 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6153 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6154 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6155 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6156
6157 @table @code
6158
6159 @kindex observer
6160 @item set observer on
6161 @itemx set observer off
6162 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6163 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6164 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6165 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6166
6167 @item show observer
6168 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6169
6170 @kindex may-write-registers
6171 @item set may-write-registers on
6172 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6173 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6174 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6175 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6176
6177 @item show may-write-registers
6178 Show the current permission to write registers.
6179
6180 @kindex may-write-memory
6181 @item set may-write-memory on
6182 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6183 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6184 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6185 defaults to @code{on}.
6186
6187 @item show may-write-memory
6188 Show the current permission to write memory.
6189
6190 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6191 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6192 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6193 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6194 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6195 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6196
6197 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6198 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6199
6200 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6201 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6202 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6203 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6204 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6205 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6206 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6207
6208 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6209 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6210
6211 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6212 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6213 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6214 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6215 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6216 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6217 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6218
6219 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6220 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6221
6222 @kindex may-interrupt
6223 @item set may-interrupt on
6224 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6225 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6226 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6227 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6228 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6229
6230 @item show may-interrupt
6231 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6232
6233 @end table
6234
6235 @node Reverse Execution
6236 @chapter Running programs backward
6237 @cindex reverse execution
6238 @cindex running programs backward
6239
6240 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6241 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6242 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6243 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6244
6245 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6246 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6247 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6248 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6249 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6250 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6251
6252 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6253 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6254 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6255 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6256 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6257 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6258 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6259 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6260 prior values@footnote{
6261 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6262 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6263 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6264
6265 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6266 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6267 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6268 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6269 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6270 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6271 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6272 }.
6273
6274 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6275 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6276
6277 @table @code
6278 @kindex reverse-continue
6279 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6280 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6281 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6282 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6283 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6284 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6285 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6286
6287 @kindex reverse-step
6288 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6289 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6290 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6291 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6292
6293 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6294 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6295 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6296 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6297 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6298 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6299
6300 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6301 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6302
6303 @kindex reverse-stepi
6304 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6305 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6306 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6307 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6308 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6309 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6310 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6311
6312 @kindex reverse-next
6313 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6314 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6315 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6316 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6317 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6318 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6319 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6320 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6321 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6322 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6323
6324 @kindex reverse-nexti
6325 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6326 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6327 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6328 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6329 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6330 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6331 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6332 frame) is reached.
6333
6334 @kindex reverse-finish
6335 @item reverse-finish
6336 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6337 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6338 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6339 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6340
6341 @kindex set exec-direction
6342 @item set exec-direction
6343 Set the direction of target execution.
6344 @item set exec-direction reverse
6345 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6346 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6347 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6348 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6349 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6350 @item set exec-direction forward
6351 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6352 This is the default.
6353 @end table
6354
6355
6356 @node Process Record and Replay
6357 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6358 @cindex process record and replay
6359 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6360
6361 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6362 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6363 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6364
6365 @cindex replay mode
6366 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6367 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6368 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6369 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6370 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6371 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6372 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6373 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6374 execution log.
6375
6376 @cindex record mode
6377 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6378 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6379 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6380 for future replay.
6381
6382 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6383 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6384 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6385 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6386 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6387 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6388
6389 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6390 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6391 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6392 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6393
6394 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6395 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6396
6397 @table @code
6398 @kindex target record
6399 @kindex target record-full
6400 @kindex target record-btrace
6401 @kindex record
6402 @kindex record full
6403 @kindex record btrace
6404 @kindex record btrace bts
6405 @kindex record bts
6406 @kindex rec
6407 @kindex rec full
6408 @kindex rec btrace
6409 @kindex rec btrace bts
6410 @kindex rec bts
6411 @item record @var{method}
6412 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6413 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6414 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6415 recording methods are available:
6416
6417 @table @code
6418 @item full
6419 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6420 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6421 execution.
6422
6423 @item btrace @var{format}
6424 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6425 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6426 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6427 reverse execution.
6428
6429 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6430 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6431 formats are available:
6432
6433 @table @code
6434 @item bts
6435 @cindex branch trace store
6436 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6437 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6438 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6439 @end table
6440
6441 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6442 @end table
6443
6444 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6445 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6446 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6447 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6448
6449 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6450 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6451
6452 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6453 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6454 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6455 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6456 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6457
6458 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6459 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6460 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6461 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6462 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6463 does not support these two modes.
6464
6465 @kindex record stop
6466 @kindex rec s
6467 @item record stop
6468 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6469 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6470 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6471
6472 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6473 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6474 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6475 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6476 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6477
6478 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6479 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6480 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6481 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6482 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6483
6484 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6485 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6486
6487 @kindex record goto
6488 @item record goto
6489 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6490 ways to specify the location to go to:
6491
6492 @table @code
6493 @item record goto begin
6494 @itemx record goto start
6495 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6496
6497 @item record goto end
6498 Go to the end of the execution log.
6499
6500 @item record goto @var{n}
6501 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6502 @end table
6503
6504 @kindex record save
6505 @item record save @var{filename}
6506 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6507 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6508 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6509
6510 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6511
6512 @kindex record restore
6513 @item record restore @var{filename}
6514 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6515 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6516
6517 @kindex set record full
6518 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6519 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6520 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6521 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6522
6523 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6524 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6525 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6526 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6527 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6528 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6529 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6530 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6531
6532 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6533 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6534 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6535
6536 @kindex show record full
6537 @item show record full insn-number-max
6538 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6539 recording method.
6540
6541 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6542 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6543 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6544 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6545 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6546 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6547 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6548 oldest one to be deleted.
6549
6550 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6551 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6552
6553 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6554 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6555
6556 @item set record full memory-query
6557 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6558 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6559 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6560 case.
6561
6562 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6563 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6564 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6565 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6566 results.
6567
6568 @item show record full memory-query
6569 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6570
6571 @kindex set record btrace
6572 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6573 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6574 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6575 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6576 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6577 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6578 You can use the following command for that:
6579
6580 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6581 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6582 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6583 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6584 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6585 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6586 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6587 position.
6588
6589 @kindex show record btrace
6590 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6591 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6592
6593 @kindex set record btrace bts
6594 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6595 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6596 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6597 format. Default is 64KB.
6598
6599 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6600 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6601 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6602 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6603 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6604 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6605 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6606
6607 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6608 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6609
6610 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6611 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6612
6613 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6614 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6615 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6616
6617 @kindex info record
6618 @item info record
6619 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6620 method:
6621
6622 @table @code
6623 @item full
6624 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6625 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6626
6627 @itemize @bullet
6628 @item
6629 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6630 @item
6631 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6632 @item
6633 Highest recorded instruction number.
6634 @item
6635 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6636 @item
6637 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6638 @item
6639 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6640 @end itemize
6641
6642 @item btrace
6643 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6644
6645 @itemize @bullet
6646 @item
6647 Recording format.
6648 @item
6649 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6650 @item
6651 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6652 instructions.
6653 @item
6654 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6655 @end itemize
6656
6657 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6658 @itemize @bullet
6659 @item
6660 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6661 @end itemize
6662 @end table
6663
6664 @kindex record delete
6665 @kindex rec del
6666 @item record delete
6667 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6668 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6669 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6670 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6671
6672 @kindex record instruction-history
6673 @kindex rec instruction-history
6674 @item record instruction-history
6675 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6676 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6677 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6678 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6679 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6680
6681 @table @code
6682 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6683 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6684 @var{insn}.
6685
6686 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6687 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6688 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6689 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6690 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6691 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6692
6693 @item record instruction-history
6694 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6695
6696 @item record instruction-history -
6697 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6698
6699 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6700 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6701 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6702 number @var{end} is included.
6703 @end table
6704
6705 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6706
6707 @kindex set record
6708 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6709 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6710 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6711 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6712 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6713
6714 @kindex show record
6715 @item show record instruction-history-size
6716 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6717 instruction-history} command.
6718
6719 @kindex record function-call-history
6720 @kindex rec function-call-history
6721 @item record function-call-history
6722 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6723 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6724 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6725 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6726 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6727 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6728 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6729 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6730 given together.
6731
6732 @smallexample
6733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6734 1 void foo (void)
6735 2 @{
6736 3 @}
6737 4
6738 5 void bar (void)
6739 6 @{
6740 7 ...
6741 8 foo ();
6742 9 ...
6743 10 @}
6744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6745 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6746 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6747 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6748 @end smallexample
6749
6750 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6751 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6752 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6753 to print:
6754
6755 @table @code
6756 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6757 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6758
6759 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6760 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6761 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6762 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6763 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6764
6765 @item record function-call-history
6766 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6767
6768 @item record function-call-history -
6769 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6770
6771 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6772 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6773 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6774 @end table
6775
6776 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6777
6778 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6779 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6780 Define how many lines to print in the
6781 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6782 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6783
6784 @item show record function-call-history-size
6785 Show how many lines to print in the
6786 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6787 @end table
6788
6789
6790 @node Stack
6791 @chapter Examining the Stack
6792
6793 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6794 stopped and how it got there.
6795
6796 @cindex call stack
6797 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6798 is generated.
6799 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6800 the arguments of the call,
6801 and the local variables of the function being called.
6802 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6803 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6804 stack}.
6805
6806 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6807 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6808
6809 @cindex selected frame
6810 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6811 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6812 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6813 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6814 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6815 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6816
6817 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6818 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6819 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6820
6821 @menu
6822 * Frames:: Stack frames
6823 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6824 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6825 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6826 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6827
6828 @end menu
6829
6830 @node Frames
6831 @section Stack Frames
6832
6833 @cindex frame, definition
6834 @cindex stack frame
6835 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6836 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6837 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6838 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6839 which the function is executing.
6840
6841 @cindex initial frame
6842 @cindex outermost frame
6843 @cindex innermost frame
6844 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6845 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6846 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6847 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6848 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6849 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6850 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6851 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6852
6853 @cindex frame pointer
6854 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6855 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6856 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6857 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6858 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6859 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6860
6861 @cindex frame number
6862 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6863 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6864 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6865 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6866 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6867
6868 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6869 @c underflow problems.
6870 @cindex frameless execution
6871 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6872 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6873 @smallexample
6874 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6875 @end smallexample
6876 generates functions without a frame.)
6877 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6878 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6879 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6880 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6881 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6882 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6883 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6884
6885 @table @code
6886 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6887 @cindex current stack frame
6888 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6889 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6890 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6891 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6892 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6893
6894 @kindex select-frame
6895 @cindex selecting frame silently
6896 @item select-frame
6897 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6898 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6899 @code{frame}.
6900 @end table
6901
6902 @node Backtrace
6903 @section Backtraces
6904
6905 @cindex traceback
6906 @cindex call stack traces
6907 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6908 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6909 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6910 stack.
6911
6912 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6913 @table @code
6914 @kindex backtrace
6915 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6916 @item backtrace
6917 @itemx bt
6918 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6919 frames in the stack.
6920
6921 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6922 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6923
6924 @item backtrace @var{n}
6925 @itemx bt @var{n}
6926 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6927
6928 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6929 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6930 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6931
6932 @item backtrace full
6933 @itemx bt full
6934 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6935 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6936 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6937 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6938
6939 @item backtrace no-filters
6940 @itemx bt no-filters
6941 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6942 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6943 @itemx bt no-filters full
6944 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6945 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6946 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6947 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6948 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6949 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6950 support.
6951 @end table
6952
6953 @kindex where
6954 @kindex info stack
6955 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6956 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6957
6958 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6959 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6960 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6961 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6962 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6963 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6964 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6965 multi-threaded program.
6966
6967 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6968 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6969 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6970 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6971 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6972 line number.
6973
6974 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6975 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6976
6977 @smallexample
6978 @group
6979 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6980 at builtin.c:993
6981 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6982 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6983 at macro.c:71
6984 (More stack frames follow...)
6985 @end group
6986 @end smallexample
6987
6988 @noindent
6989 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6990 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6991 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6992
6993 @noindent
6994 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6995 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6996 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6997 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6998 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6999
7000 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7001 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7002 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7003 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7004 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7005 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7006 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7007 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7008 such a backtrace might look like:
7009
7010 @smallexample
7011 @group
7012 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7013 at builtin.c:993
7014 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7015 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7016 at macro.c:71
7017 (More stack frames follow...)
7018 @end group
7019 @end smallexample
7020
7021 @noindent
7022 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7023 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7024
7025 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7026 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7027 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7028
7029 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7030 @cindex program entry point
7031 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7032 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7033 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7034 @code{main}@footnote{
7035 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7036 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7037 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7038 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7039 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7040 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7041
7042 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7043 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7044
7045 @table @code
7046 @item set backtrace past-main
7047 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7048 @kindex set backtrace
7049 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7050
7051 @item set backtrace past-main off
7052 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7053 default.
7054
7055 @item show backtrace past-main
7056 @kindex show backtrace
7057 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7058
7059 @item set backtrace past-entry
7060 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7061 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7062 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7063 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7064
7065 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7066 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7067 application. This is the default.
7068
7069 @item show backtrace past-entry
7070 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7071
7072 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7073 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7074 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7075 @cindex backtrace limit
7076 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7077 or zero means unlimited levels.
7078
7079 @item show backtrace limit
7080 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7081 @end table
7082
7083 You can control how file names are displayed.
7084
7085 @table @code
7086 @item set filename-display
7087 @itemx set filename-display relative
7088 @cindex filename-display
7089 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7090
7091 @item set filename-display basename
7092 Display only basename of a filename.
7093
7094 @item set filename-display absolute
7095 Display an absolute filename.
7096
7097 @item show filename-display
7098 Show the current way to display filenames.
7099 @end table
7100
7101 @node Frame Filter Management
7102 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7103 @cindex managing frame filters
7104
7105 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7106 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7107
7108 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7109 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7110
7111 @table @code
7112 @kindex info frame-filter
7113 @item info frame-filter
7114 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7115 their name, priority and enabled status.
7116
7117 @kindex disable frame-filter
7118 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7119 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7120 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7121 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7122 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7123 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7124 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7125 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7126 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7127 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7128 may be enabled again later.
7129
7130 @kindex enable frame-filter
7131 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7132 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7133 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7134 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7135 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7136 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7137 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7138 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7139 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7140
7141 Example:
7142
7143 @smallexample
7144 (gdb) info frame-filter
7145
7146 global frame-filters:
7147 Priority Enabled Name
7148 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7149 100 Yes Reverse
7150
7151 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7152 Priority Enabled Name
7153 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7154
7155 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7156 Priority Enabled Name
7157 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7158
7159 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7160 (gdb) info frame-filter
7161
7162 global frame-filters:
7163 Priority Enabled Name
7164 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7165 100 Yes Reverse
7166
7167 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7168 Priority Enabled Name
7169 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7170
7171 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7172 Priority Enabled Name
7173 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7174
7175 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7176 (gdb) info frame-filter
7177
7178 global frame-filters:
7179 Priority Enabled Name
7180 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7181 100 Yes Reverse
7182
7183 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7184 Priority Enabled Name
7185 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7186
7187 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7188 Priority Enabled Name
7189 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7190 @end smallexample
7191
7192 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7193 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7194 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7195 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7196 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7197 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7198 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7199
7200 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7201 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7202 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7203 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7204 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7205 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7206 dictionary resides.
7207
7208 Example:
7209
7210 @smallexample
7211 (gdb) info frame-filter
7212
7213 global frame-filters:
7214 Priority Enabled Name
7215 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7216 100 Yes Reverse
7217
7218 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7219 Priority Enabled Name
7220 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7221
7222 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7223 Priority Enabled Name
7224 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7225
7226 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7227 (gdb) info frame-filter
7228
7229 global frame-filters:
7230 Priority Enabled Name
7231 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7232 50 Yes Reverse
7233
7234 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7235 Priority Enabled Name
7236 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7237
7238 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7239 Priority Enabled Name
7240 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7241 @end smallexample
7242 @end table
7243
7244 @node Selection
7245 @section Selecting a Frame
7246
7247 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7248 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7249 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7250 of the stack frame just selected.
7251
7252 @table @code
7253 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7254 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7255 @item frame @var{n}
7256 @itemx f @var{n}
7257 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7258 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7259 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7260 @code{main}.
7261
7262 @item frame @var{addr}
7263 @itemx f @var{addr}
7264 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7265 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7266 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7267 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7268 switches between them.
7269
7270 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7271 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7272
7273 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7274 pointer and a program counter.
7275
7276 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7277 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7278
7279 @kindex up
7280 @item up @var{n}
7281 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7282 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7283 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7284
7285 @kindex down
7286 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7287 @item down @var{n}
7288 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7289 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7290 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7291 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7292 @end table
7293
7294 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7295 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7296 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7297 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7298
7299 @need 1000
7300 For example:
7301
7302 @smallexample
7303 @group
7304 (@value{GDBP}) up
7305 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7306 at env.c:10
7307 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7308 @end group
7309 @end smallexample
7310
7311 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7312 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7313 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7314 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7315 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7316 for details.
7317
7318 @table @code
7319 @kindex down-silently
7320 @kindex up-silently
7321 @item up-silently @var{n}
7322 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7323 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7324 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7325 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7326 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7327 distracting.
7328 @end table
7329
7330 @node Frame Info
7331 @section Information About a Frame
7332
7333 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7334 stack frame.
7335
7336 @table @code
7337 @item frame
7338 @itemx f
7339 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7340 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7341 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7342 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7343 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7344
7345 @kindex info frame
7346 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7347 @item info frame
7348 @itemx info f
7349 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7350 including:
7351
7352 @itemize @bullet
7353 @item
7354 the address of the frame
7355 @item
7356 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7357 @item
7358 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7359 @item
7360 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7361 @item
7362 the address of the frame's arguments
7363 @item
7364 the address of the frame's local variables
7365 @item
7366 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7367 @item
7368 which registers were saved in the frame
7369 @end itemize
7370
7371 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7372 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7373 the usual conventions.
7374
7375 @item info frame @var{addr}
7376 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7377 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7378 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7379 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7380 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7381 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7382
7383 @kindex info args
7384 @item info args
7385 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7386
7387 @item info locals
7388 @kindex info locals
7389 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7390 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7391 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7392
7393 @end table
7394
7395
7396 @node Source
7397 @chapter Examining Source Files
7398
7399 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7400 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7401 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7402 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7403 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7404 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7405 source files by explicit command.
7406
7407 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7408 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7409 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7410
7411 @menu
7412 * List:: Printing source lines
7413 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7414 * Edit:: Editing source files
7415 * Search:: Searching source files
7416 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7417 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7418 @end menu
7419
7420 @node List
7421 @section Printing Source Lines
7422
7423 @kindex list
7424 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7425 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7426 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7427 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7428 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7429
7430 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7431
7432 @table @code
7433 @item list @var{linenum}
7434 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7435 current source file.
7436
7437 @item list @var{function}
7438 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7439 @var{function}.
7440
7441 @item list
7442 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7443 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7444 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7445 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7446 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7447
7448 @item list -
7449 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7450 @end table
7451
7452 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7453 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7454 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @kindex set listsize
7458 @item set listsize @var{count}
7459 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7460 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7461 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7462 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7463
7464 @kindex show listsize
7465 @item show listsize
7466 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7467 @end table
7468
7469 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7470 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7471 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7472 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7473 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7474
7475 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7476 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7477 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7478 to specify some source line.
7479
7480 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7481
7482 @table @code
7483 @item list @var{linespec}
7484 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7485
7486 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7487 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7488 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7489 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7490 the same source file as the first linespec.
7491
7492 @item list ,@var{last}
7493 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7494
7495 @item list @var{first},
7496 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7497
7498 @item list +
7499 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7500
7501 @item list -
7502 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7503
7504 @item list
7505 As described in the preceding table.
7506 @end table
7507
7508 @node Specify Location
7509 @section Specifying a Location
7510 @cindex specifying location
7511 @cindex linespec
7512
7513 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7514 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7515 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7516 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7517
7518 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7519 @value{GDBN} understands:
7520
7521 @table @code
7522 @item @var{linenum}
7523 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7524
7525 @item -@var{offset}
7526 @itemx +@var{offset}
7527 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7528 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7529 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7530 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7531 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7532 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7533 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7534 linespec.
7535
7536 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7537 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7538 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7539 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7540 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7541 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7542 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7543
7544 @item @var{function}
7545 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7546 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7547
7548 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7549 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7550
7551 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7552 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7553 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7554 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7555 functions in different source files.
7556
7557 @item @var{label}
7558 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7559 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7560 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7561 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7562 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7563
7564 @item *@var{address}
7565 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7566 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7567 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7568 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7569 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7570 source files.
7571
7572 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7573 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7574 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7575 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7576 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7577 of @var{address}:
7578
7579 @table @code
7580 @item @var{expression}
7581 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7582
7583 @item @var{funcaddr}
7584 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7585 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7586 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7587 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7588 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7589 (although the Pascal form also works).
7590
7591 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7592 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7593
7594 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7595 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7596 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7597 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7598 functions with identical names in different source files.
7599 @end table
7600
7601 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7602 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7603 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7604 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7605 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7606 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7607
7608 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7609 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7610 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7611 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7612 each one of those probes.
7613
7614 @end table
7615
7616
7617 @node Edit
7618 @section Editing Source Files
7619 @cindex editing source files
7620
7621 @kindex edit
7622 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7623 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7624 The editing program of your choice
7625 is invoked with the current line set to
7626 the active line in the program.
7627 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7628 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7629
7630 @table @code
7631 @item edit @var{location}
7632 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7633 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7634 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7635 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7636 command most commonly used:
7637
7638 @table @code
7639 @item edit @var{number}
7640 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7641
7642 @item edit @var{function}
7643 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7644 @end table
7645
7646 @end table
7647
7648 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7649 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7650 @footnote{
7651 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7652 following command-line syntax:
7653 @smallexample
7654 ex +@var{number} file
7655 @end smallexample
7656 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7657 the file where to start editing.}.
7658 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7659 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7660 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7661 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7662 @smallexample
7663 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7664 export EDITOR
7665 gdb @dots{}
7666 @end smallexample
7667 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7668 @smallexample
7669 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7670 gdb @dots{}
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @node Search
7674 @section Searching Source Files
7675 @cindex searching source files
7676
7677 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7678 regular expression.
7679
7680 @table @code
7681 @kindex search
7682 @kindex forward-search
7683 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7684 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7685 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7686 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7687 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7688 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7689 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7690 @code{fo}.
7691
7692 @kindex reverse-search
7693 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7694 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7695 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7696 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7697 this command as @code{rev}.
7698 @end table
7699
7700 @node Source Path
7701 @section Specifying Source Directories
7702
7703 @cindex source path
7704 @cindex directories for source files
7705 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7706 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7707 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7708 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7709 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7710 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7711 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7712
7713 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7714 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7715 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7716 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7717 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7718 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7719 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7720 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7721 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7722 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7723 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7724
7725 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7726 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7727 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7728 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7729 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7730 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7731
7732 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7733 source files.
7734
7735 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7736 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7737 each line is in the file.
7738
7739 @kindex directory
7740 @kindex dir
7741 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7742 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7743 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7744
7745 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7746 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7747
7748 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7749 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7750 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7751 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7752 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7753 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7754 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7755 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7756 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7757 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7758 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7759 name to look up the sources.
7760
7761 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7762 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7763 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7764 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7765 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7766 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7767 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7768 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7769
7770 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7771 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7772 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7773 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7774 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7775 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7776 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7777
7778 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7779 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7780 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7781 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7782 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7783 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7784 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7785 command.
7786
7787 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7788 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7789 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7790 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7791 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7792 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7793 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7794
7795 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7796 @cindex default source path substitution
7797 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7798 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7799 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7800 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7801 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7802 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7803 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7804 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7805 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7806 together.
7807
7808 @table @code
7809 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7810 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7811 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7812 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7813 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7814 part of absolute file names) or
7815 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7816 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7817
7818 @kindex cdir
7819 @kindex cwd
7820 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7821 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7822 @cindex compilation directory
7823 @cindex current directory
7824 @cindex working directory
7825 @cindex directory, current
7826 @cindex directory, compilation
7827 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7828 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7829 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7830 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7831 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7832 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7833
7834 @item directory
7835 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7836
7837 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7838 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7839
7840 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7841 @kindex set directories
7842 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7843 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7844
7845 @item show directories
7846 @kindex show directories
7847 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7848
7849 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7850 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7851 @kindex set substitute-path
7852 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7853 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7854 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7855
7856 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7857 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7858
7859 @smallexample
7860 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7861 @end smallexample
7862
7863 @noindent
7864 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7865 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7866 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7867
7868 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7869 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7870 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7871 the substitution.
7872
7873 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7874
7875 @smallexample
7876 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7877 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7878 @end smallexample
7879
7880 @noindent
7881 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7882 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7883 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7884 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7885
7886
7887 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7888 @kindex unset substitute-path
7889 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7890 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7891 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7892
7893 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7894
7895 @item show substitute-path [path]
7896 @kindex show substitute-path
7897 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7898 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7899
7900 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7901 rules.
7902
7903 @end table
7904
7905 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7906 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7907 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7908
7909 @enumerate
7910 @item
7911 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7912
7913 @item
7914 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7915 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7916 directories in one command.
7917 @end enumerate
7918
7919 @node Machine Code
7920 @section Source and Machine Code
7921 @cindex source line and its code address
7922
7923 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7924 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7925 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7926 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7927 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7928 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7929 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7930 well as hex.
7931
7932 @table @code
7933 @kindex info line
7934 @item info line @var{linespec}
7935 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7936 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7937 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7938 @end table
7939
7940 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7941 the object code for the first line of function
7942 @code{m4_changequote}:
7943
7944 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7945 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7946 @smallexample
7947 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7948 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7949 @end smallexample
7950
7951 @noindent
7952 @cindex code address and its source line
7953 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7954 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7955 @smallexample
7956 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7957 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7958 @end smallexample
7959
7960 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7961 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7962 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7963 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7964 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7965 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7966 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7967 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7968 Variables}).
7969
7970 @table @code
7971 @kindex disassemble
7972 @cindex assembly instructions
7973 @cindex instructions, assembly
7974 @cindex machine instructions
7975 @cindex listing machine instructions
7976 @item disassemble
7977 @itemx disassemble /m
7978 @itemx disassemble /r
7979 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7980 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7981 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7982 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7983 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7984 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7985 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7986 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7987 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7988 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7989
7990 @table @code
7991 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7992 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7993 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7994 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7995 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7996 @end table
7997
7998 @noindent
7999 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8000 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8001
8002 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8003 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8004
8005 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8006 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8007 @end table
8008
8009 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8010 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8014 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8015 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8016 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8017 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8018 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8019 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8020 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8021 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8022 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8023 End of assembler dump.
8024 @end smallexample
8025
8026 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
8027 program is stopped just after function prologue:
8028
8029 @smallexample
8030 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8031 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8032 5 @{
8033 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8034 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8035 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8036 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8037 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8038
8039 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8040 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8041 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8042
8043 7 return 0;
8044 8 @}
8045 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8046 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8047 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8048
8049 End of assembler dump.
8050 @end smallexample
8051
8052 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8053
8054 @smallexample
8055 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8056 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8057 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8058 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8059 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8060 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8061 End of assembler dump.
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8065 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8066 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8067 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8068
8069 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8070 mnemonics or other syntax.
8071
8072 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8073 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8074 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8075 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8076 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8077
8078 @table @code
8079 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8080 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8081 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8082 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8083 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8084 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8085
8086 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8087 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8088 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8089 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8090
8091 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8092 @item show disassembly-flavor
8093 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8094 @end table
8095
8096 @table @code
8097 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8098 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8099 @item set disassemble-next-line
8100 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8101 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8102 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8103 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8104 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8105 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8106 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8107 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8108 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8109 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8110 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8111 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8112 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8113 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8114 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8115 instruction.
8116 @end table
8117
8118
8119 @node Data
8120 @chapter Examining Data
8121
8122 @cindex printing data
8123 @cindex examining data
8124 @kindex print
8125 @kindex inspect
8126 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8127 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8128 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8129 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8130 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8131 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8132
8133 @table @code
8134 @item print @var{expr}
8135 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8136 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8137 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8138 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8139 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8140 Formats}.
8141
8142 @item print
8143 @itemx print /@var{f}
8144 @cindex reprint the last value
8145 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8146 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8147 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8148 @end table
8149
8150 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8151 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8152 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8153
8154 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8155 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8156 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8157 Table}.
8158
8159 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8160 @kindex explore
8161 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8162 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8163 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8164 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8165 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8166 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8167 embedded in the higher level data types.
8168
8169 @table @code
8170 @item explore @var{arg}
8171 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8172 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8173 @end table
8174
8175 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8176 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8177 C program as
8178
8179 @smallexample
8180 struct SimpleStruct
8181 @{
8182 int i;
8183 double d;
8184 @};
8185
8186 struct ComplexStruct
8187 @{
8188 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8189 int arr[10];
8190 @};
8191 @end smallexample
8192
8193 @noindent
8194 followed by variable declarations as
8195
8196 @smallexample
8197 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8198 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8199 @end smallexample
8200
8201 @noindent
8202 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8203 @code{explore} command as follows.
8204
8205 @smallexample
8206 (gdb) explore cs
8207 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8208 the following fields:
8209
8210 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8211 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8212
8213 Enter the field number of choice:
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8218 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8219 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8220 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8221 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8222 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8223 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8224 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8225
8226 @smallexample
8227 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8228 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8229 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8230 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8231
8232 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8233 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8234
8235 Press enter to return to parent value:
8236 @end smallexample
8237
8238 @noindent
8239 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8240 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8241 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8242 to explore.
8243
8244 @smallexample
8245 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8246 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8247
8248 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8249
8250 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8251
8252 Press enter to return to parent value:
8253 @end smallexample
8254
8255 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8256 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8257 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8258 level data structure).
8259
8260 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8261 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8262 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8263 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8264 same example as above, your can explore the type
8265 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8266 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8267
8268 @smallexample
8269 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8270 @end smallexample
8271
8272 @noindent
8273 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8274 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8275 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8276 example.
8277
8278 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8279 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8280 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8281 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8282 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8283
8284 @table @code
8285 @item explore value @var{expr}
8286 @cindex explore value
8287 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8288 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8289 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8290 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8291 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8292
8293 @item explore type @var{arg}
8294 @cindex explore type
8295 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8296 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8297 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8298 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8299 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8300 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8301 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8302 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8303 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8304 @end table
8305
8306 @menu
8307 * Expressions:: Expressions
8308 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8309 * Variables:: Program variables
8310 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8311 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8312 * Memory:: Examining memory
8313 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8314 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8315 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8316 * Value History:: Value history
8317 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8318 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8319 * Registers:: Registers
8320 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8321 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8322 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8323 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8324 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8325 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8326 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8327 character set than GDB does
8328 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8329 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8330 @end menu
8331
8332 @node Expressions
8333 @section Expressions
8334
8335 @cindex expressions
8336 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8337 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8338 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8339 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8340 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8341 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8342 @ref{Compilation}.
8343
8344 @cindex arrays in expressions
8345 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8346 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8347 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8348 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8349 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8350 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8351
8352 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8353 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8354 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8355 languages.
8356
8357 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8358 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8359
8360 @cindex casts, in expressions
8361 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8362 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8363 at that address in memory.
8364 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8365
8366 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8367 to programming languages:
8368
8369 @table @code
8370 @item @@
8371 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8372 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8373
8374 @item ::
8375 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8376 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8377
8378 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8379 @cindex type casting memory
8380 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8381 @cindex casts, to view memory
8382 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8383 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8384 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8385 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8386 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8387 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8388 @end table
8389
8390 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8391 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8392 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8393
8394 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8395 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8396 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8397 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8398 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8399 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8400 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8401
8402 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8403 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8404 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8405 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8406 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8407 as well.
8408
8409 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8410 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8411 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8412 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8413 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8414 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8415 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8416 choices.
8417
8418 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8419 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8420 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8421
8422 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8423 @smallexample
8424 @group
8425 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8426 [0] cancel
8427 [1] all
8428 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8429 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8430 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8431 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8432 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8433 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8434 > 2 4 6
8435 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8436 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8437 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8438 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8439 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8440 breakpoints.
8441 (@value{GDBP})
8442 @end group
8443 @end smallexample
8444
8445 @table @code
8446 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8447 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8448 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8449
8450 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8451 is ambiguous.
8452
8453 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8454 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8455 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8456 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8457 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8458 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8459 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8460 in the use of the menu.
8461
8462 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8463 when an ambiguity is detected.
8464
8465 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8466 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8467
8468 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8469 @item show multiple-symbols
8470 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8471 @end table
8472
8473 @node Variables
8474 @section Program Variables
8475
8476 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8477 in your program.
8478
8479 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8480 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8481
8482 @itemize @bullet
8483 @item
8484 global (or file-static)
8485 @end itemize
8486
8487 @noindent or
8488
8489 @itemize @bullet
8490 @item
8491 visible according to the scope rules of the
8492 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8493 @end itemize
8494
8495 @noindent This means that in the function
8496
8497 @smallexample
8498 foo (a)
8499 int a;
8500 @{
8501 bar (a);
8502 @{
8503 int b = test ();
8504 bar (b);
8505 @}
8506 @}
8507 @end smallexample
8508
8509 @noindent
8510 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8511 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8512 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8513 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8514
8515 @cindex variable name conflict
8516 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8517 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8518 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8519 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8520 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8521 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8522 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8523
8524 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8525 @ifnotinfo
8526 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8527 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8528 @end ifnotinfo
8529 @smallexample
8530 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8531 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8532 @end smallexample
8533
8534 @noindent
8535 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8536 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8537 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8538 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8539
8540 @smallexample
8541 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8542 @end smallexample
8543
8544 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8545 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8546 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8547 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8548 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8549
8550 @smallexample
8551 void
8552 foo (int a)
8553 @{
8554 if (a < 10)
8555 bar (a);
8556 else
8557 process (a); /* Stop here */
8558 @}
8559
8560 int
8561 bar (int a)
8562 @{
8563 foo (a + 5);
8564 @}
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 @noindent
8568 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8569 here is what you might see
8570 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8571
8572 @smallexample
8573 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8574 $1 = 10
8575 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8576 $2 = 5
8577 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8578 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8579 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8580 $3 = 5
8581 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8582 $4 = 0
8583 @end smallexample
8584
8585 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8586 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8587 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8588 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8589 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8590
8591 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8592 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8593 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8594 @code{some_global}.
8595
8596 @smallexample
8597 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8598 $1 = 23
8599 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8600 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8601 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8602 $2 = 27
8603 @end smallexample
8604
8605 @cindex wrong values
8606 @cindex variable values, wrong
8607 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8608 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8609 @quotation
8610 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8611 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8612 scope, and just before exit.
8613 @end quotation
8614 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8615 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8616 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8617 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8618 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8619 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8620 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8621 variable definitions may be gone.
8622
8623 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8624 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8625 when compiling.
8626
8627 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8628 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8629 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8630 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8631 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8632 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8633 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8634
8635 @smallexample
8636 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8637 @end smallexample
8638
8639 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8640 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8641 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8642 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8643 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8644
8645 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8646 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8647 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8648 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8649
8650 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8651 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8652 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8653 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8654 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8655
8656 @smallexample
8657 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8658 29 i++;
8659 (gdb) next
8660 30 e (i);
8661 (gdb) print i
8662 $1 = 31
8663 (gdb) print i@@entry
8664 $2 = 30
8665 @end smallexample
8666
8667 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8668 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8669 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8670 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8671 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8672 For program code
8673
8674 @smallexample
8675 char var0[] = "A";
8676 signed char var1[] = "A";
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 You get during debugging
8680 @smallexample
8681 (gdb) print var0
8682 $1 = "A"
8683 (gdb) print var1
8684 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8685 @end smallexample
8686
8687 @node Arrays
8688 @section Artificial Arrays
8689
8690 @cindex artificial array
8691 @cindex arrays
8692 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8693 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8694 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8695 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8696 program.
8697
8698 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8699 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8700 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8701 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8702 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8703 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8704 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8705 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8706 example. If a program says
8707
8708 @smallexample
8709 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8710 @end smallexample
8711
8712 @noindent
8713 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8714
8715 @smallexample
8716 p *array@@len
8717 @end smallexample
8718
8719 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8720 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8721 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8722 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8723 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8724
8725 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8726 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8727 The value need not be in memory:
8728 @smallexample
8729 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8730 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8731 @end smallexample
8732
8733 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8734 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8735 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8736 @smallexample
8737 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8738 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8739 @end smallexample
8740
8741 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8742 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8743 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8744 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8745 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8746 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8747 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8748 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8749 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8750 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8751
8752 @smallexample
8753 set $i = 0
8754 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8755 @key{RET}
8756 @key{RET}
8757 @dots{}
8758 @end smallexample
8759
8760 @node Output Formats
8761 @section Output Formats
8762
8763 @cindex formatted output
8764 @cindex output formats
8765 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8766 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8767 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8768 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8769 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8770
8771 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8772 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8773 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8774 letters supported are:
8775
8776 @table @code
8777 @item x
8778 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8779 hexadecimal.
8780
8781 @item d
8782 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8783
8784 @item u
8785 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8786
8787 @item o
8788 Print as integer in octal.
8789
8790 @item t
8791 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8792 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8793 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8794 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8795
8796 @item a
8797 @cindex unknown address, locating
8798 @cindex locate address
8799 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8800 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8801 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8802
8803 @smallexample
8804 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8805 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8806 @end smallexample
8807
8808 @noindent
8809 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8810 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8811
8812 @item c
8813 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8814 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8815 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8816 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8817
8818 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8819 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8820 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8821 data.
8822
8823 @item f
8824 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8825 using typical floating point syntax.
8826
8827 @item s
8828 @cindex printing strings
8829 @cindex printing byte arrays
8830 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8831 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8832 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8833 natural types.
8834
8835 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8836 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8837 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8838 array.
8839
8840 @item z
8841 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8842 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8843 to the size of the integer type.
8844
8845 @item r
8846 @cindex raw printing
8847 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8848 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8849 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8850 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8851 pretty-printer which might exist.
8852 @end table
8853
8854 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8855
8856 @smallexample
8857 p/x $pc
8858 @end smallexample
8859
8860 @noindent
8861 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8862 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8863
8864 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8865 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8866 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8867
8868 @node Memory
8869 @section Examining Memory
8870
8871 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8872 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8873
8874 @cindex examining memory
8875 @table @code
8876 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8877 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8878 @itemx x @var{addr}
8879 @itemx x
8880 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8881 @end table
8882
8883 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8884 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8885 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8886 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8887 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8888
8889 @table @r
8890 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8891 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8892 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8893 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8894 @c 4.1.2.
8895
8896 @item @var{f}, the display format
8897 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8898 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8899 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8900 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8901 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8902
8903 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8904 The unit size is any of
8905
8906 @table @code
8907 @item b
8908 Bytes.
8909 @item h
8910 Halfwords (two bytes).
8911 @item w
8912 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8913 @item g
8914 Giant words (eight bytes).
8915 @end table
8916
8917 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8918 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8919 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8920 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8921 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8922 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8923 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8924 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8925 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8926 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8927 be altered.
8928
8929 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8930 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8931 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8932 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8933 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8934 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8935 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8936 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8937 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8938 a value from memory).
8939 @end table
8940
8941 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8942 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8943 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8944 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8945 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8946
8947 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8948 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8949 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8950 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8951 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8952
8953 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8954 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8955 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8956 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8957 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8958 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8959 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8960 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8961 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8962
8963 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8964 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8965 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8966 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8967 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8968 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8969 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8970
8971 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8972 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8973
8974 @smallexample
8975 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8976 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8977 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8978 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8979 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8980 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8981 @end smallexample
8982
8983 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8984 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8985 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8986 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8987 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8988 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8989 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8990 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8991 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8992
8993 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8994 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8995 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8996
8997 @cindex remote memory comparison
8998 @cindex target memory comparison
8999 @cindex verify remote memory image
9000 @cindex verify target memory image
9001 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9002 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9003 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9004 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9005 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9006 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9007
9008 @table @code
9009 @kindex compare-sections
9010 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9011 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9012 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9013 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9014 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9015 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9016
9017 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9018 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9019 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9020 @end table
9021
9022 @node Auto Display
9023 @section Automatic Display
9024 @cindex automatic display
9025 @cindex display of expressions
9026
9027 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9028 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9029 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9030 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9031 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9032 The automatic display looks like this:
9033
9034 @smallexample
9035 2: foo = 38
9036 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9037 @end smallexample
9038
9039 @noindent
9040 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9041 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9042 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9043 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9044 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9045 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9046
9047 @table @code
9048 @kindex display
9049 @item display @var{expr}
9050 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9051 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9052
9053 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9054
9055 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9056 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9057 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9058 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9059 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9060
9061 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9062 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9063 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9064 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9065 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9066 @end table
9067
9068 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9069 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9070 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @kindex delete display
9074 @kindex undisplay
9075 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9076 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9077 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9078 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9079 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9080 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9081 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9082
9083 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9084 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9085
9086 @kindex disable display
9087 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9088 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9089 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9090 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9091 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9092 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9093 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9094 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9095
9096 @kindex enable display
9097 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9098 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9099 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9100 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9101 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9102 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9103 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9104
9105 @item display
9106 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9107 done when your program stops.
9108
9109 @kindex info display
9110 @item info display
9111 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9112 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9113 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9114 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9115 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9116 @end table
9117
9118 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9119 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9120 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9121 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9122 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9123 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9124 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9125 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9126 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9127 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9128 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9129
9130 @node Print Settings
9131 @section Print Settings
9132
9133 @cindex format options
9134 @cindex print settings
9135 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9136 and symbols are printed.
9137
9138 @noindent
9139 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9140
9141 @table @code
9142 @kindex set print
9143 @item set print address
9144 @itemx set print address on
9145 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9146 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9147 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9148 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9149 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9150 @code{set print address on}:
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 @group
9154 (@value{GDBP}) f
9155 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9156 at input.c:530
9157 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9158 @end group
9159 @end smallexample
9160
9161 @item set print address off
9162 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9163 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9164
9165 @smallexample
9166 @group
9167 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9168 (@value{GDBP}) f
9169 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9170 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9171 @end group
9172 @end smallexample
9173
9174 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9175 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9176 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9177 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9178
9179 @kindex show print
9180 @item show print address
9181 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9182 @end table
9183
9184 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9185 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9186 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9187 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9188 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9189 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9190 it prints a symbolic address:
9191
9192 @table @code
9193 @item set print symbol-filename on
9194 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9195 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9196 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9197 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9198
9199 @item set print symbol-filename off
9200 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9201 default.
9202
9203 @item show print symbol-filename
9204 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9205 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9206 @end table
9207
9208 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9209 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9210 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9211
9212 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9213 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9214
9215 @table @code
9216 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9217 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9218 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9219 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9220 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9221 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9222 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9223 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9224
9225 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9226 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9227 symbolic address.
9228 @end table
9229
9230 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9231 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9232 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9233 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9234 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9235 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9236 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9237 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9238
9239 @smallexample
9240 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9241 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9242 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9243 @end smallexample
9244
9245 @quotation
9246 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9247 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9248 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9249 @end quotation
9250
9251 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9252 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9253
9254 @table @code
9255 @item set print symbol on
9256 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9257 one exists.
9258
9259 @item set print symbol off
9260 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9261 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9262 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9263
9264 @item show print symbol
9265 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9266 address.
9267 @end table
9268
9269 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9270
9271 @table @code
9272 @item set print array
9273 @itemx set print array on
9274 @cindex pretty print arrays
9275 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9276 but uses more space. The default is off.
9277
9278 @item set print array off
9279 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9280
9281 @item show print array
9282 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9283 arrays.
9284
9285 @cindex print array indexes
9286 @item set print array-indexes
9287 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9288 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9289 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9290 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9291
9292 @item set print array-indexes off
9293 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9294
9295 @item show print array-indexes
9296 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9297 arrays.
9298
9299 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9300 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9301 @cindex number of array elements to print
9302 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9303 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9304 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9305 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9306 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9307 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9308 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9309 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9310
9311 @item show print elements
9312 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9313 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9314
9315 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9316 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9317 @cindex printing frame argument values
9318 @cindex print all frame argument values
9319 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9320 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9321 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9322 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9323 values are:
9324
9325 @table @code
9326 @item all
9327 The values of all arguments are printed.
9328
9329 @item scalars
9330 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9331 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9332 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9333 only scalar arguments are shown:
9334
9335 @smallexample
9336 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9337 at frame-args.c:23
9338 @end smallexample
9339
9340 @item none
9341 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9342 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9343
9344 @smallexample
9345 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9346 at frame-args.c:23
9347 @end smallexample
9348 @end table
9349
9350 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9351 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9352 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9353 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9354 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9355 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9356 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9357 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9358 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9359 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9360
9361 @item show print frame-arguments
9362 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9363
9364 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9365 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9366
9367 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9368 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9369 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9370 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9371 This is the default.
9372
9373 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9374 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9375
9376 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9377 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9378 @kindex set print entry-values
9379 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9380 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9381 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9382 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9383 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9384
9385 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9386 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9387 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9388 @code{no} setting.
9389
9390 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9391 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9392 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9393 this information.
9394
9395 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9396
9397 @table @code
9398 @item no
9399 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9400 point.
9401 @smallexample
9402 #0 equal (val=5)
9403 #0 different (val=6)
9404 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9405 #0 born (val=10)
9406 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9407 @end smallexample
9408
9409 @item only
9410 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9411 values are never printed.
9412 @smallexample
9413 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9414 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9415 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9416 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9417 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9418 @end smallexample
9419
9420 @item preferred
9421 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9422 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9423 value for such parameter.
9424 @smallexample
9425 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9426 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9427 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9428 #0 born (val=10)
9429 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9430 @end smallexample
9431
9432 @item if-needed
9433 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9434 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9435 parameter.
9436 @smallexample
9437 #0 equal (val=5)
9438 #0 different (val=6)
9439 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9440 #0 born (val=10)
9441 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 @item both
9445 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9446 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9447 optimizations.
9448 @smallexample
9449 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9450 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9451 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9452 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9453 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9454 @end smallexample
9455
9456 @item compact
9457 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9458 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9459 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9460 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9461 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9462 @smallexample
9463 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9464 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9465 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9466 #0 born (val=10)
9467 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9468 @end smallexample
9469
9470 @item default
9471 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9472 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9473 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9474 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9475 @smallexample
9476 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9477 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9478 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9479 #0 born (val=10)
9480 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9481 @end smallexample
9482 @end table
9483
9484 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9485 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9486
9487 @item show print entry-values
9488 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9489 entry.
9490
9491 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9492 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9493 @cindex repeated array elements
9494 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9495 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9496 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9497 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9498 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9499 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9500 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9501 is 10.
9502
9503 @item show print repeats
9504 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9505 elements.
9506
9507 @item set print null-stop
9508 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9509 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9510 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9511 contain only short strings.
9512 The default is off.
9513
9514 @item show print null-stop
9515 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9516 @sc{null} character.
9517
9518 @item set print pretty on
9519 @cindex print structures in indented form
9520 @cindex indentation in structure display
9521 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9522 per line, like this:
9523
9524 @smallexample
9525 @group
9526 $1 = @{
9527 next = 0x0,
9528 flags = @{
9529 sweet = 1,
9530 sour = 1
9531 @},
9532 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9533 @}
9534 @end group
9535 @end smallexample
9536
9537 @item set print pretty off
9538 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9539
9540 @smallexample
9541 @group
9542 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9543 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9544 @end group
9545 @end smallexample
9546
9547 @noindent
9548 This is the default format.
9549
9550 @item show print pretty
9551 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9552
9553 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9554 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9555 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9556 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9557 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9558 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9559 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9560 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9561
9562 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9563 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9564 international character sets, and is the default.
9565
9566 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9567 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9568
9569 @item set print union on
9570 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9571 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9572 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9573
9574 @item set print union off
9575 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9576 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9577 instead.
9578
9579 @item show print union
9580 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9581 structures and other unions.
9582
9583 For example, given the declarations
9584
9585 @smallexample
9586 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9587 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9588 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9589 Bug_forms;
9590
9591 struct thing @{
9592 Species it;
9593 union @{
9594 Tree_forms tree;
9595 Bug_forms bug;
9596 @} form;
9597 @};
9598
9599 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9600 @end smallexample
9601
9602 @noindent
9603 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9604
9605 @smallexample
9606 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9607 @end smallexample
9608
9609 @noindent
9610 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9614 @end smallexample
9615
9616 @noindent
9617 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9618 and in Pascal.
9619 @end table
9620
9621 @need 1000
9622 @noindent
9623 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9624
9625 @table @code
9626 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9627 @item set print demangle
9628 @itemx set print demangle on
9629 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9630 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9631 linkage. The default is on.
9632
9633 @item show print demangle
9634 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9635
9636 @item set print asm-demangle
9637 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9638 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9639 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9640 The default is off.
9641
9642 @item show print asm-demangle
9643 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9644 or demangled form.
9645
9646 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9647 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9648 @kindex set demangle-style
9649 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9650 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9651 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9652
9653 @table @code
9654 @item auto
9655 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9656 This is the default.
9657
9658 @item gnu
9659 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9660
9661 @item hp
9662 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9663
9664 @item lucid
9665 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9666
9667 @item arm
9668 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9669 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9670 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9671 require further enhancement to permit that.
9672
9673 @end table
9674 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9675
9676 @item show demangle-style
9677 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9678
9679 @item set print object
9680 @itemx set print object on
9681 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9682 @cindex display derived types
9683 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9684 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9685 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9686 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9687 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9688 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9689 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9690
9691 @item set print object off
9692 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9693 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9694
9695 @item show print object
9696 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9697
9698 @item set print static-members
9699 @itemx set print static-members on
9700 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9701 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9702
9703 @item set print static-members off
9704 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9705
9706 @item show print static-members
9707 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9708
9709 @item set print pascal_static-members
9710 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9711 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9712 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9713 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9714
9715 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9716 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9717
9718 @item show print pascal_static-members
9719 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9720
9721 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9722 @item set print vtbl
9723 @itemx set print vtbl on
9724 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9725 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9726 @cindex VTBL display
9727 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9728 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9729 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9730
9731 @item set print vtbl off
9732 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9733
9734 @item show print vtbl
9735 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9736 @end table
9737
9738 @node Pretty Printing
9739 @section Pretty Printing
9740
9741 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9742 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9743 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9744
9745 @menu
9746 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9747 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9748 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9749 @end menu
9750
9751 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9752 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9753
9754 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9755 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9756 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9757
9758 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9759 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9760 pretty-printers with their names.
9761 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9762 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9763 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9764 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9765
9766 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9767 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9768 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9769 do anything special.
9770
9771 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9772
9773 @itemize @bullet
9774 @item
9775 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9776 all inferiors.
9777
9778 @item
9779 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9780 when debugging that program.
9781 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9782
9783 @item
9784 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9785 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9786 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9787 @end itemize
9788
9789 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9790 pretty-printers are selected,
9791
9792 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9793 for new types.
9794
9795 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9796 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9797
9798 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9799
9800 @smallexample
9801 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9802 $1 = @{
9803 static npos = 4294967295,
9804 _M_dataplus = @{
9805 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9806 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9807 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9808 @},
9809 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9810 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9811 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9812 @}
9813 @}
9814 @end smallexample
9815
9816 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9817
9818 @smallexample
9819 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9820 $2 = "abcd"
9821 @end smallexample
9822
9823 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9824 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9825 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9826
9827 @table @code
9828 @kindex info pretty-printer
9829 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9830 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9831 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9832
9833 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9834 whose pretty-printers to list.
9835 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9836 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9837 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9838 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9839 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9840
9841 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9842 to list.
9843
9844 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9845 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9846 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9847 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9848
9849 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9850 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9851 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9852 @end table
9853
9854 Example:
9855
9856 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9857 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9858 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9859 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9860
9861 @smallexample
9862 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9863 library1.so:
9864 foo
9865 library2.so:
9866 bar
9867 bar1
9868 bar2
9869 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9870 library2.so:
9871 bar
9872 bar1
9873 bar2
9874 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9875 1 printer disabled
9876 2 of 3 printers enabled
9877 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9878 library1.so:
9879 foo [disabled]
9880 library2.so:
9881 bar
9882 bar1
9883 bar2
9884 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9885 1 printer disabled
9886 1 of 3 printers enabled
9887 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9888 library1.so:
9889 foo [disabled]
9890 library2.so:
9891 bar
9892 bar1 [disabled]
9893 bar2
9894 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9895 1 printer disabled
9896 0 of 3 printers enabled
9897 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9898 library1.so:
9899 foo [disabled]
9900 library2.so:
9901 bar [disabled]
9902 bar1 [disabled]
9903 bar2
9904 @end smallexample
9905
9906 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9907 as can each individual subprinter.
9908
9909 @node Value History
9910 @section Value History
9911
9912 @cindex value history
9913 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9914 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9915 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9916 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9917 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9918 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9919 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9920 symbol table.
9921
9922 @cindex @code{$}
9923 @cindex @code{$$}
9924 @cindex history number
9925 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9926 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9927 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9928 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9929 history number.
9930
9931 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9932 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9933 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9934 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9935 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9936 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9937 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9938
9939 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9940 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9941
9942 @smallexample
9943 p *$
9944 @end smallexample
9945
9946 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9947 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9948
9949 @smallexample
9950 p *$.next
9951 @end smallexample
9952
9953 @noindent
9954 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9955 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9956
9957 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9958 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9959
9960 @smallexample
9961 print x
9962 set x=5
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9967 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9968
9969 @table @code
9970 @kindex show values
9971 @item show values
9972 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9973 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9974 values} does not change the history.
9975
9976 @item show values @var{n}
9977 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9978
9979 @item show values +
9980 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9981 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9982 @end table
9983
9984 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9985 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9986
9987 @node Convenience Vars
9988 @section Convenience Variables
9989
9990 @cindex convenience variables
9991 @cindex user-defined variables
9992 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9993 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9994 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9995 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9996 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9997
9998 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9999 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10000 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10001 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10002 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10003
10004 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10005 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10006 For example:
10007
10008 @smallexample
10009 set $foo = *object_ptr
10010 @end smallexample
10011
10012 @noindent
10013 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10014 @code{object_ptr}.
10015
10016 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10017 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10018 value with another assignment at any time.
10019
10020 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10021 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10022 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10023 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10024
10025 @table @code
10026 @kindex show convenience
10027 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10028 @item show convenience
10029 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10030 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10031 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10032
10033 @kindex init-if-undefined
10034 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10035 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10036 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10037 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10038 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10039 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10040 override default values used in a command script.
10041
10042 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10043 any side-effects do not occur.
10044 @end table
10045
10046 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10047 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10048 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10049
10050 @smallexample
10051 set $i = 0
10052 print bar[$i++]->contents
10053 @end smallexample
10054
10055 @noindent
10056 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10057
10058 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10059 values likely to be useful.
10060
10061 @table @code
10062 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10063 @item $_
10064 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10065 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10066 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10067 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10068 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10069 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10070 to the type of @code{$__}.
10071
10072 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10073 @item $__
10074 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10075 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10076 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10077
10078 @item $_exitcode
10079 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10080 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10081 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10082 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10083
10084 @item $_exitsignal
10085 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10086 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10087 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10088 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10089
10090 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10091 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10092 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10093 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10094 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10095
10096 @smallexample
10097 #include <signal.h>
10098
10099 int
10100 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10101 @{
10102 raise (SIGALRM);
10103 return 0;
10104 @}
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10108 or signalled would be:
10109
10110 @smallexample
10111 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10112 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10113 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10114 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10115 >echo The program has exited\n
10116 >else
10117 >echo The program has signalled\n
10118 >end
10119 >end
10120 (@value{GDBP}) run
10121 Starting program:
10122
10123 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10124 The program no longer exists.
10125 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10126 The program has signalled
10127 @end smallexample
10128
10129 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10130 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10131 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10132 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10133
10134 @smallexample
10135 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10136 The program has exited
10137 @end smallexample
10138
10139 @item $_exception
10140 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10141 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10142
10143 @item $_probe_argc
10144 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10145 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10146
10147 @item $_sdata
10148 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10149 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10150 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10151 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10152 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10153
10154 @item $_siginfo
10155 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10156 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10157 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10158 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10159 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10160
10161 @item $_tlb
10162 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10163 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10164 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10165 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10166 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10167 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10168
10169 @end table
10170
10171 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10172 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10173 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10174
10175 @node Convenience Funs
10176 @section Convenience Functions
10177
10178 @cindex convenience functions
10179 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10180 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10181 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10182 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10183 @value{GDBN}.
10184
10185 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10186 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10187
10188 @table @code
10189
10190 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10191 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10192 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10193 returns zero.
10194
10195 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10196 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10197 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10198 it is @code{void}:
10199
10200 @smallexample
10201 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10202 $1 = void
10203 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10204 $2 = 1
10205 (@value{GDBP}) run
10206 Starting program: ./a.out
10207 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10208 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10209 $3 = 0
10210 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10211 $4 = 0
10212 @end smallexample
10213
10214 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10215 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10216 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10217 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10218 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10219 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10220 anymore.
10221
10222 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10223 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10224
10225 @smallexample
10226 void
10227 foo (void)
10228 @{
10229 @}
10230 @end smallexample
10231
10232 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10233
10234 @smallexample
10235 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10236 $1 = void
10237 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10238 $2 = 1
10239 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10240 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10241 $3 = void
10242 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10243 $4 = 1
10244 @end smallexample
10245
10246 @end table
10247
10248 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10249 @code{Python} support.
10250
10251 @table @code
10252
10253 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10254 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10255 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10256 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10257 Otherwise it returns zero.
10258
10259 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10260 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10261 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10262 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10263 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10264 regular expression support.
10265
10266 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10267 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10268 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10269 Otherwise it returns zero.
10270
10271 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10272 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10273 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10274
10275 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10276 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10277 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10278 Otherwise it returns zero.
10279
10280 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10281 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10282 The default is 1.
10283
10284 Example:
10285
10286 @smallexample
10287 (gdb) backtrace
10288 #0 bottom_func ()
10289 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10290 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10291 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10292 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10293 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10294 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10295 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10296 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10297 $1 = 1
10298 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10299 $1 = 1
10300 @end smallexample
10301
10302 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10303 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10304 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10305 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10306
10307 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10308 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10309 The default is 1.
10310
10311 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10312 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10313 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10314 Otherwise it returns zero.
10315
10316 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10317 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10318 The default is 1.
10319
10320 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10321 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10322 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10323 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10324
10325 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10326 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10327 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10328 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10329
10330 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10331 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10332 The default is 1.
10333
10334 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10335 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10336 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10337 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10338
10339 @end table
10340
10341 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10342 convenience functions.
10343
10344 @table @code
10345 @item help function
10346 @kindex help function
10347 @cindex show all convenience functions
10348 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10349 @end table
10350
10351 @node Registers
10352 @section Registers
10353
10354 @cindex registers
10355 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10356 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10357 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10358 your machine.
10359
10360 @table @code
10361 @kindex info registers
10362 @item info registers
10363 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10364 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10365
10366 @kindex info all-registers
10367 @cindex floating point registers
10368 @item info all-registers
10369 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10370 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10371
10372 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10373 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10374 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10375 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10376 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10377 @end table
10378
10379 @anchor{standard registers}
10380 @cindex stack pointer register
10381 @cindex program counter register
10382 @cindex process status register
10383 @cindex frame pointer register
10384 @cindex standard registers
10385 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10386 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10387 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10388 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10389 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10390 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10391 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10392 you could print the program counter in hex with
10393
10394 @smallexample
10395 p/x $pc
10396 @end smallexample
10397
10398 @noindent
10399 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10400
10401 @smallexample
10402 x/i $pc
10403 @end smallexample
10404
10405 @noindent
10406 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10407 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10408 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10409 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10410 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10411 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10412 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10413
10414 @smallexample
10415 set $sp += 4
10416 @end smallexample
10417
10418 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10419 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10420 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10421 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10422 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10423 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10424 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10425
10426 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10427 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10428 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10429 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10430 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10431 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10432 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10433
10434 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10435 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10436 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10437 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10438 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10439 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10440 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10441 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10442 prints the data in both formats.
10443
10444 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10445 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10446 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10447 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10448 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10449 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10450 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10451
10452 @smallexample
10453 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10454 $1 = @{
10455 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10456 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10457 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10458 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10459 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10460 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10461 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10462 @}
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 @noindent
10466 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10467 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10468 value to a @code{struct} member:
10469
10470 @smallexample
10471 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10472 @end smallexample
10473
10474 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10475 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10476 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10477 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10478 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10479 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10480
10481 @cindex caller-saved registers
10482 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10483 @cindex volatile registers
10484 @cindex <not saved> values
10485 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10486 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10487 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10488 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10489 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10490 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10491 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10492 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10493 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10494 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10495 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10496 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10497 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10498 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10499 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10500 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10501 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10502 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10503 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10504 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10505 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10506 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10507 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10508
10509 @node Floating Point Hardware
10510 @section Floating Point Hardware
10511 @cindex floating point
10512
10513 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10514 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10515
10516 @table @code
10517 @kindex info float
10518 @item info float
10519 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10520 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10521 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10522 the ARM and x86 machines.
10523 @end table
10524
10525 @node Vector Unit
10526 @section Vector Unit
10527 @cindex vector unit
10528
10529 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10530 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10531
10532 @table @code
10533 @kindex info vector
10534 @item info vector
10535 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10536 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10537 @end table
10538
10539 @node OS Information
10540 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10541 @cindex OS information
10542
10543 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10544 you debug your program.
10545
10546 @cindex auxiliary vector
10547 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10548 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10549 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10550 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10551 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10552 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10553 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10554 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10555 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10556 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10557 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10558 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10559
10560 @table @code
10561 @kindex info auxv
10562 @item info auxv
10563 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10564 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10565 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10566 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10567 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10568 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10569 an unrecognized tag.
10570 @end table
10571
10572 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10573 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10574 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10575 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10576 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10577 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10578 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10579
10580 @table @code
10581 @kindex info os
10582 @item info os @var{infotype}
10583
10584 Display OS information of the requested type.
10585
10586 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10587
10588 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10589 @table @code
10590 @kindex info os processes
10591 @item processes
10592 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10593 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10594 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10595 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10596 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10597 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10598
10599 @kindex info os procgroups
10600 @item procgroups
10601 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10602 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10603 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10604 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10605 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10606 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10607 and the process group leader is listed first.
10608
10609 @kindex info os threads
10610 @item threads
10611 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10612 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10613 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10614 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10615 process is not listed.
10616
10617 @kindex info os files
10618 @item files
10619 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10620 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10621 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10622 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10623
10624 @kindex info os sockets
10625 @item sockets
10626 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10627 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10628 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10629 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10630 connection.
10631
10632 @kindex info os shm
10633 @item shm
10634 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10635 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10636 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10637 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10638 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10639 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10640 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10641
10642 @kindex info os semaphores
10643 @item semaphores
10644 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10645 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10646 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10647 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10648 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10649
10650 @kindex info os msg
10651 @item msg
10652 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10653 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10654 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10655 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10656 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10657 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10658 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10659 the message queue was last changed.
10660
10661 @kindex info os modules
10662 @item modules
10663 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10664 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10665 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10666 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10667 in memory.
10668 @end table
10669
10670 @item info os
10671 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10672 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10673 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10674 types, this command will report an error.
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @node Memory Region Attributes
10678 @section Memory Region Attributes
10679 @cindex memory region attributes
10680
10681 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10682 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10683 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10684 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10685 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10686 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10687 user can override the fetched regions.
10688
10689 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10690 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10691 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10692 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10693 all memory.
10694
10695 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10696 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10697
10698 @table @code
10699 @kindex mem
10700 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10701 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10702 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10703 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10704 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10705 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10706
10707 @item mem auto
10708 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10709 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10710
10711 @kindex delete mem
10712 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10713 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10714 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10715
10716 @kindex disable mem
10717 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10718 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10719 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10720 It may be enabled again later.
10721
10722 @kindex enable mem
10723 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10724 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10725
10726 @kindex info mem
10727 @item info mem
10728 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10729 for each region:
10730
10731 @table @emph
10732 @item Memory Region Number
10733 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10734 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10735 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10736
10737 @item Lo Address
10738 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10739
10740 @item Hi Address
10741 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10742
10743 @item Attributes
10744 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10745 @end table
10746 @end table
10747
10748
10749 @subsection Attributes
10750
10751 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10752 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10753 write accesses to a memory region.
10754
10755 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10756 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10757 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10758
10759 @table @code
10760 @item ro
10761 Memory is read only.
10762 @item wo
10763 Memory is write only.
10764 @item rw
10765 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10766 @end table
10767
10768 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10769 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10770 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10771 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10772 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10773
10774 @table @code
10775 @item 8
10776 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10777 @item 16
10778 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10779 @item 32
10780 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10781 @item 64
10782 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10783 @end table
10784
10785 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10786 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10787 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10788 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10789 @c
10790 @c @table @code
10791 @c @item hwbreak
10792 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10793 @c @item swbreak (default)
10794 @c @end table
10795
10796 @subsubsection Data Cache
10797 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10798 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10799 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10800 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10801 registers.
10802
10803 @table @code
10804 @item cache
10805 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10806 @item nocache
10807 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10808 @end table
10809
10810 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10811 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10812 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10813 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10814 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10815
10816 @table @code
10817 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10818 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10819 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10820 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10821 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10822 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10823 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10824 The default value is @code{on}.
10825 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10826 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10827 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10828 @end table
10829
10830
10831 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10832 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10833 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10834 @c
10835 @c @table @code
10836 @c @item verify
10837 @c @item noverify (default)
10838 @c @end table
10839
10840 @node Dump/Restore Files
10841 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10842 @cindex dump/restore files
10843 @cindex append data to a file
10844 @cindex dump data to a file
10845 @cindex restore data from a file
10846
10847 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10848 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10849 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10850 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10851 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10852 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10853 files.
10854
10855 @table @code
10856
10857 @kindex dump
10858 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10859 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10860 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10861 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10862
10863 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10864 @table @code
10865 @item binary
10866 Raw binary form.
10867 @item ihex
10868 Intel hex format.
10869 @item srec
10870 Motorola S-record format.
10871 @item tekhex
10872 Tektronix Hex format.
10873 @end table
10874
10875 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10876 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10877 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10878 form.
10879
10880 @kindex append
10881 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10882 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10883 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10884 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10885 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10886
10887 @kindex restore
10888 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10889 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10890 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10891 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10892 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10893
10894 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10895 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10896 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10897 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10898 from that location.
10899
10900 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10901 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10902 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10903 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10904
10905 @end table
10906
10907 @node Core File Generation
10908 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10909 @cindex dump core from inferior
10910
10911 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10912 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10913 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10914 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10915 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10916 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10917 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10918
10919 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10920 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10921 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10922
10923 @table @code
10924 @kindex gcore
10925 @kindex generate-core-file
10926 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10927 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10928 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10929 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10930 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10931 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10932
10933 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10934 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10935 @end table
10936
10937 @node Character Sets
10938 @section Character Sets
10939 @cindex character sets
10940 @cindex charset
10941 @cindex translating between character sets
10942 @cindex host character set
10943 @cindex target character set
10944
10945 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10946 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10947 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10948 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10949 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10950 @dfn{target character set}.
10951
10952 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10953 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10954 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10955 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10956 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10957 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10958 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10959 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10960 character and string literals in expressions.
10961
10962 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10963 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10964 target-charset} command, described below.
10965
10966 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10967 support:
10968
10969 @table @code
10970 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10971 @kindex set target-charset
10972 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10973 list of supported target character sets, type
10974 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10975
10976 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10977 @kindex set host-charset
10978 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10979
10980 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10981 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10982 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10983 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10984 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10985
10986 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10987 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10988 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10989
10990 @item set charset @var{charset}
10991 @kindex set charset
10992 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10993 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10994 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10995 for both host and target.
10996
10997 @item show charset
10998 @kindex show charset
10999 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11000
11001 @item show host-charset
11002 @kindex show host-charset
11003 Show the name of the current host character set.
11004
11005 @item show target-charset
11006 @kindex show target-charset
11007 Show the name of the current target character set.
11008
11009 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11010 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11011 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11012 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11013 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11014 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11015
11016 @item show target-wide-charset
11017 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11018 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11019 @end table
11020
11021 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11022 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11023 @file{charset-test.c}:
11024
11025 @smallexample
11026 #include <stdio.h>
11027
11028 char ascii_hello[]
11029 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11030 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11031 char ibm1047_hello[]
11032 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11033 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11034
11035 main ()
11036 @{
11037 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11038 @}
11039 @end smallexample
11040
11041 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11042 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11043 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11044
11045 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11046
11047 @smallexample
11048 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11049 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11050 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11051 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11052 @dots{}
11053 (@value{GDBP})
11054 @end smallexample
11055
11056 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11057 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11058 strings:
11059
11060 @smallexample
11061 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11062 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11063 (@value{GDBP})
11064 @end smallexample
11065
11066 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11067 initial character set:
11068 @smallexample
11069 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11070 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11071 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11072 (@value{GDBP})
11073 @end smallexample
11074
11075 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11076 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11077 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11078 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11079 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11080
11081 @smallexample
11082 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11083 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11084 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11085 $2 = 72 'H'
11086 (@value{GDBP})
11087 @end smallexample
11088
11089 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11090 literals you use in expressions:
11091
11092 @smallexample
11093 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11094 $3 = 43 '+'
11095 (@value{GDBP})
11096 @end smallexample
11097
11098 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11099 character.
11100
11101 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11102 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11103 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11104
11105 @smallexample
11106 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11107 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11108 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11109 $5 = 200 '\310'
11110 (@value{GDBP})
11111 @end smallexample
11112
11113 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11114 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11115
11116 @smallexample
11117 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11118 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11119 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11120 @end smallexample
11121
11122 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11123 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11124 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11125 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11126 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11127
11128 @smallexample
11129 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11130 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11131 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11132 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11133 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11134 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11135 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11136 $7 = 72 '\110'
11137 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11138 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11140 $9 = 200 'H'
11141 (@value{GDBP})
11142 @end smallexample
11143
11144 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11145 string literals you use in expressions:
11146
11147 @smallexample
11148 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11149 $10 = 78 '+'
11150 (@value{GDBP})
11151 @end smallexample
11152
11153 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11154 character.
11155
11156 @node Caching Target Data
11157 @section Caching Data of Targets
11158 @cindex caching data of targets
11159
11160 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11161 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11162 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11163 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11164 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11165 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11166 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11167 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11168 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11169 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11170 is executing.
11171 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11172 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11173 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11174 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11175 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11176 in the code segment.
11177 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11178 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11179
11180 @table @code
11181 @kindex set remotecache
11182 @item set remotecache on
11183 @itemx set remotecache off
11184 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11185 with old scripts.
11186
11187 @kindex show remotecache
11188 @item show remotecache
11189 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11190
11191 @kindex set stack-cache
11192 @item set stack-cache on
11193 @itemx set stack-cache off
11194 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11195 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11196
11197 @kindex show stack-cache
11198 @item show stack-cache
11199 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11200
11201 @kindex set code-cache
11202 @item set code-cache on
11203 @itemx set code-cache off
11204 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11205 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11206 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11207
11208 @kindex show code-cache
11209 @item show code-cache
11210 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11211 accesses.
11212
11213 @kindex info dcache
11214 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11215 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11216 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11217 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11218 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11219 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11220
11221 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11222 printed in hex.
11223
11224 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11225 @cindex dcache size
11226 @kindex set dcache size
11227 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11228
11229 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11230 @cindex dcache line-size
11231 @kindex set dcache line-size
11232 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11233 Must be a power of 2.
11234
11235 @item show dcache size
11236 @kindex show dcache size
11237 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11238
11239 @item show dcache line-size
11240 @kindex show dcache line-size
11241 Show default size of dcache lines.
11242
11243 @end table
11244
11245 @node Searching Memory
11246 @section Search Memory
11247 @cindex searching memory
11248
11249 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11250 @code{find} command.
11251
11252 @table @code
11253 @kindex find
11254 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11255 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11256 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11257 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11258 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11259 @end table
11260
11261 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11262 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11263
11264 @table @r
11265 @item @var{s}, search query size
11266 The size of each search query value.
11267
11268 @table @code
11269 @item b
11270 bytes
11271 @item h
11272 halfwords (two bytes)
11273 @item w
11274 words (four bytes)
11275 @item g
11276 giant words (eight bytes)
11277 @end table
11278
11279 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11280 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11281 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11282
11283 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11284 value's type in the current language.
11285 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11286 pattern as a mixture of types.
11287 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11288 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11289 which is typically four bytes.
11290
11291 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11292 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11293 @end table
11294
11295 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11296 (@code{"}).
11297 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11298 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11299
11300 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11301 number of matches found.
11302
11303 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11304 @samp{$_}.
11305 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11306
11307 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11308
11309 @smallexample
11310 void
11311 hello ()
11312 @{
11313 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11314 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11315 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11316 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11317 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11318 @}
11319 @end smallexample
11320
11321 @noindent
11322 you get during debugging:
11323
11324 @smallexample
11325 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11326 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11327 1 pattern found
11328 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11329 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11330 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11331 2 patterns found
11332 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11333 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11334 1 pattern found
11335 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11336 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11337 1 pattern found
11338 (gdb) print $numfound
11339 $1 = 1
11340 (gdb) print $_
11341 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11342 @end smallexample
11343
11344 @node Optimized Code
11345 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11346 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11347 @cindex debugging optimized code
11348
11349 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11350 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11351 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11352 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11353 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11354 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11355 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11356
11357 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11358 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11359 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11360 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11361
11362 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11363 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11364 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11365 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11366 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11367 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11368
11369 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11370 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11371 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11372 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11373 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11374
11375 @menu
11376 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11377 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11378 @end menu
11379
11380 @node Inline Functions
11381 @section Inline Functions
11382 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11383
11384 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11385 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11386 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11387 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11388 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11389 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11390 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11391 @code{info frame} command.
11392
11393 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11394 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11395 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11396 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11397 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11398 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11399 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11400 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11401 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11402 local variables in the caller.
11403
11404 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11405 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11406 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11407 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11408 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11409 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11410 instructions are executed.
11411
11412 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11413 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11414 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11415 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11416
11417 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11418 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11419
11420 @itemize @bullet
11421 @item
11422 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11423 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11424 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11425 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11426 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11427 or inside the inlined function instead.
11428
11429 @item
11430 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11431 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11432 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11433 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11434
11435 @end itemize
11436
11437 @node Tail Call Frames
11438 @section Tail Call Frames
11439 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11440
11441 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11442 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11443 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11444 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11445 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11446
11447 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11448 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11449 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11450 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11451 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11452 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11453 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11454
11455 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11456 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11457 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11458 this information.
11459
11460 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11461 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11462
11463 @smallexample
11464 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11465 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11466 (gdb) info frame
11467 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11468 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11469 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11470 source language c++.
11471 Arglist at unknown address.
11472 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11473 @end smallexample
11474
11475 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11476 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11477 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11478 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11479 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11480 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11481
11482 @table @code
11483 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11484 @item set debug entry-values
11485 @kindex set debug entry-values
11486 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11487 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11488 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11489 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11490 result.
11491
11492 @item show debug entry-values
11493 @kindex show debug entry-values
11494 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11495 values at function entry and tail calls.
11496 @end table
11497
11498 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11499 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11500 reference by variable @code{x}):
11501
11502 @smallexample
11503 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11504 void (*x) (void) = c;
11505 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11506 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11507 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11508
11509 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11510 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11511 a () at t.c:3
11512 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11513 (gdb) bt
11514 #0 a () at t.c:3
11515 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11516 @end smallexample
11517
11518 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11519
11520 @smallexample
11521 int i;
11522 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11523 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11524 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11525 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11526 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11527 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11528 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11529 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11530
11531 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11532 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11533 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11534 (gdb) bt
11535 #0 f () at t.c:2
11536 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11537 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11538 @end smallexample
11539
11540 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11541 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11542
11543 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11544 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11545 @set ARROW @click{}
11546 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11547 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11548 @end ifset
11549 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11550 @set ARROW ->
11551 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11552 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11553 @end ifclear
11554
11555 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11556 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11557 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11558
11559 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11560 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11561 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11562 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11563 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11564 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11565
11566 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11567 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11568 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11569 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11570 omitted.
11571
11572 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11573 entry may fail:
11574
11575 @smallexample
11576 int v;
11577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11578 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11580 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11581 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11582 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11583
11584 (gdb) bt
11585 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11586 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11587 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11588 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11589 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11590 @end smallexample
11591
11592 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11593 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11594 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11595 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11596 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11597
11598 @node Macros
11599 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11600
11601 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11602 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11603 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11604 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11605 where it was defined.
11606
11607 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11608 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11609 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11610 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11611
11612 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11613 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11614 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11615 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11616 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11617 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11618 see @ref{List}.
11619
11620 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11621 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11622 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11623
11624 @table @code
11625
11626 @kindex macro expand
11627 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11628 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11629 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11630 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11631 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11632 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11633 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11634 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11635 it can be any string of tokens.
11636
11637 @kindex macro exp1
11638 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11639 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11640 @cindex expand macro once
11641 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11642 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11643 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11644 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11645 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11646 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11647 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11648 can be any string of tokens.
11649
11650 @kindex info macro
11651 @cindex macro definition, showing
11652 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11653 @cindex macros, from debug info
11654 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11655 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11656 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11657 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11658 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11659 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11660
11661 @kindex info macros
11662 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11663 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11664 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11665 command-line where those definitions were established.
11666
11667 @kindex macro define
11668 @cindex user-defined macros
11669 @cindex defining macros interactively
11670 @cindex macros, user-defined
11671 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11672 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11673 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11674 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11675 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11676 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11677 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11678 @var{arglist}.
11679
11680 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11681 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11682 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11683 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11684 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11685
11686 @kindex macro undef
11687 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11688 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11689 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11690 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11691 in the program being debugged.
11692
11693 @kindex macro list
11694 @item macro list
11695 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11696 @end table
11697
11698 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11699 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11700 show our source files:
11701
11702 @smallexample
11703 $ cat sample.c
11704 #include <stdio.h>
11705 #include "sample.h"
11706
11707 #define M 42
11708 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11709
11710 main ()
11711 @{
11712 #define N 28
11713 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11714 #undef N
11715 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11716 #define N 1729
11717 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11718 @}
11719 $ cat sample.h
11720 #define Q <
11721 $
11722 @end smallexample
11723
11724 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11725 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11726 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11727 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11728 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11729 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11730 information.
11731
11732 @smallexample
11733 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11734 $
11735 @end smallexample
11736
11737 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11738
11739 @smallexample
11740 $ gdb -nw sample
11741 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11742 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11743 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11744 (@value{GDBP})
11745 @end smallexample
11746
11747 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11748 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11749 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11750
11751 @smallexample
11752 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11753 3
11754 4 #define M 42
11755 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11756 6
11757 7 main ()
11758 8 @{
11759 9 #define N 28
11760 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11761 11 #undef N
11762 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11763 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11764 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11765 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11766 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11767 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11768 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11769 #define Q <
11770 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11771 expands to: (42 + 1)
11772 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11773 expands to: once (M + 1)
11774 (@value{GDBP})
11775 @end smallexample
11776
11777 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11778 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11779 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11780 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11781
11782 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11783 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11784
11785 @smallexample
11786 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11787 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11788 (@value{GDBP}) run
11789 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11790
11791 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11792 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11793 (@value{GDBP})
11794 @end smallexample
11795
11796 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11797
11798 @smallexample
11799 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11800 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11801 #define N 28
11802 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11803 expands to: 28 < 42
11804 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11805 $1 = 1
11806 (@value{GDBP})
11807 @end smallexample
11808
11809 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11810 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11811 thereof) in force at each point:
11812
11813 @smallexample
11814 (@value{GDBP}) next
11815 Hello, world!
11816 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11817 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11818 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11819 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11820 (@value{GDBP}) next
11821 We're so creative.
11822 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11823 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11824 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11825 #define N 1729
11826 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11827 expands to: 1729 < 42
11828 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11829 $2 = 0
11830 (@value{GDBP})
11831 @end smallexample
11832
11833 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11834 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11835 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11836 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11837
11838 @smallexample
11839 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11840 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11841 -D__STDC__=1
11842 (@value{GDBP})
11843 @end smallexample
11844
11845
11846 @node Tracepoints
11847 @chapter Tracepoints
11848 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11849 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11850
11851 @cindex tracepoints
11852 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11853 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11854 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11855 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11856 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11857 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11858 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11859
11860 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11861 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11862 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11863 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11864 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11865 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11866 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11867 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11868 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11869 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11870 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11871
11872 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11873 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11874 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11875 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11876 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11877 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11878 Packets}.
11879
11880 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11881 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11882 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11883
11884 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11885
11886 @menu
11887 * Set Tracepoints::
11888 * Analyze Collected Data::
11889 * Tracepoint Variables::
11890 * Trace Files::
11891 @end menu
11892
11893 @node Set Tracepoints
11894 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11895
11896 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11897 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11898 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11899 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11900 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11901 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11902 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11903
11904 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11905 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11906 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11907 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11908 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11909 tracepoint was hit.
11910
11911 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11912 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11913 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11914 either.
11915
11916 @cindex fast tracepoints
11917 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11918 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11919 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11920
11921 @cindex static tracepoints
11922 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11923 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11924 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11925 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11926 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11927 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11928 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11929 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11930 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11931 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11932 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11933 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11934 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11935 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11936 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11937 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11938 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11939 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11940 static tracepoint marker.
11941
11942 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11943 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11944
11945 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11946 conditions and actions.
11947
11948 @menu
11949 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11950 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11951 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11952 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11953 * Trace State Variables::
11954 * Tracepoint Actions::
11955 * Listing Tracepoints::
11956 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11957 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11958 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11959 @end menu
11960
11961 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11962 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11963
11964 @table @code
11965 @cindex set tracepoint
11966 @kindex trace
11967 @item trace @var{location}
11968 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11969 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11970 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11971 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11972 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11973 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11974 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11975 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11976 in tracing}).
11977 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11978 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11979 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11980 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11981 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11982 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11983 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11984 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11985 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11986 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11987 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11988 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11989
11990 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11991
11992 @smallexample
11993 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11994
11995 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11996
11997 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11998
11999 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12000
12001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12002 @end smallexample
12003
12004 @noindent
12005 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12006
12007 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12008 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12009 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12010 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12011 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12012 information on tracepoint conditions.
12013
12014 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12015 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12016 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12017 @kindex ftrace
12018 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12019 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12020 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12021 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12022 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12023 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12024 message.
12025
12026 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12027 @code{trace}.
12028
12029 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12030 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12031 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12032 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12033 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12034 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12035 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12036 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12037
12038 @example
12039 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12040 @end example
12041
12042 @noindent
12043 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12044 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12045
12046 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12047 @cindex set static tracepoint
12048 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12049 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12050 @kindex strace
12051 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12052 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12053 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12054 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12055 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12056
12057 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12058 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12059 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12060 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12061 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12062 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12063 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12064 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12065 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12066 tracing engine:
12067
12068 @smallexample
12069 main ()
12070 @{
12071 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12072 @}
12073 @end smallexample
12074
12075 @noindent
12076 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12077 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12078
12079 @smallexample
12080 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12081 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12082 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12083 Data: "str %s"
12084 [etc...]
12085 @end smallexample
12086
12087 @noindent
12088 so you may probe the marker above with:
12089
12090 @smallexample
12091 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12092 @end smallexample
12093
12094 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12095 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12096 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12097 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12098 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12099 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12100 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12101 the @samp{Data:} field.
12102
12103 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12104 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12105 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12106
12107 @vindex $tpnum
12108 @cindex last tracepoint number
12109 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12110 @cindex tracepoint number
12111 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12112 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12113
12114 @kindex delete tracepoint
12115 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12116 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12117 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12118 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12119 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12120
12121 Examples:
12122
12123 @smallexample
12124 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12125
12126 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12127 @end smallexample
12128
12129 @noindent
12130 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12131 @end table
12132
12133 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12134 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12135
12136 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12137
12138 @table @code
12139 @kindex disable tracepoint
12140 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12141 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12142 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12143 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12144 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12145 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12146 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12147 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12148 next trace experiment.
12149
12150 @kindex enable tracepoint
12151 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12152 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12153 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12154 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12155 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12156 next time a trace experiment is run.
12157 @end table
12158
12159 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12160 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12161
12162 @table @code
12163 @kindex passcount
12164 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12165 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12166 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12167 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12168 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12169 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12170 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12171 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12172 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12173 user.
12174
12175 Examples:
12176
12177 @smallexample
12178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12179 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12180
12181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12182 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12183 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12184 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12185 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12186 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12187 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12189 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12190 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12191 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12192 @end smallexample
12193 @end table
12194
12195 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12196 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12197 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12198 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12199
12200 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12201 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12202 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12203 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12204 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12205 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12206 is true.
12207
12208 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12209 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12210 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12211 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12212 just as with breakpoints.
12213
12214 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12215 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12216 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12217 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12218 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12219 accesses, and so forth.
12220
12221 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12222 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12223 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12224 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12225 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12226 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12227 search through.
12228
12229 @smallexample
12230 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12231 @end smallexample
12232
12233 @node Trace State Variables
12234 @subsection Trace State Variables
12235 @cindex trace state variables
12236
12237 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12238 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12239 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12240 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12241 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12242 integers.
12243
12244 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12245 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12246 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12247 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12248
12249 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12250 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12251 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12252 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12253 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12254 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12255 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12256 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12257 variable with the same name.
12258
12259 @table @code
12260
12261 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12262 @kindex tvariable
12263 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12264 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12265 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12266 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12267 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12268 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12269 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12270 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12271 value. The default initial value is 0.
12272
12273 @item info tvariables
12274 @kindex info tvariables
12275 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12276 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12277 currently running.
12278
12279 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12280 @kindex delete tvariable
12281 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12282 are specified.
12283
12284 @end table
12285
12286 @node Tracepoint Actions
12287 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12288
12289 @table @code
12290 @kindex actions
12291 @cindex tracepoint actions
12292 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12293 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12294 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12295 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12296 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12297 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12298 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12299 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12300 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12301 @code{while-stepping}.
12302
12303 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12304 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12305 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12306
12307 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12308 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12309 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12310
12311 @smallexample
12312 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12313
12314 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12315
12316 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12317 @end smallexample
12318
12319 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12320 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12321 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12322 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12323 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12324 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12325 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12326 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12327
12328 @smallexample
12329 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12330 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12331 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12332 > collect bar,baz
12333 > collect $regs
12334 > while-stepping 12
12335 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12336 > end
12337 end
12338 @end smallexample
12339
12340 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12341 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12342 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12343 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12344 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12345 special arguments are supported:
12346
12347 @table @code
12348 @item $regs
12349 Collect all registers.
12350
12351 @item $args
12352 Collect all function arguments.
12353
12354 @item $locals
12355 Collect all local variables.
12356
12357 @item $_ret
12358 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12359 of a backtrace.
12360
12361 @item $_probe_argc
12362 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12363 tracepoint is located.
12364 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12365
12366 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12367 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12368 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12369 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12370
12371 @item $_sdata
12372 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12373 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12374 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12375 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12376 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12377 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12378 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12379 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12380 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12381
12382 @smallexample
12383 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12384 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12385 @end smallexample
12386
12387 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12388 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12389 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12390 @value{GDBN}.
12391 @end table
12392
12393 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12394 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12395 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12396
12397 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12398 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12399 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12400 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12401 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12402 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12403 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12404 @samp{mystr}.
12405
12406 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12407 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12408
12409 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12410 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12411 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12412 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12413 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12414 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12415 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12416 action were used.
12417
12418 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12419 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12420 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12421 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12422 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12423 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12424
12425 @smallexample
12426 > while-stepping 12
12427 > collect $regs, myglobal
12428 > end
12429 >
12430 @end smallexample
12431
12432 @noindent
12433 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12434 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12435 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12436 @code{stepping}.
12437
12438 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12439 @kindex set default-collect
12440 @cindex default collection action
12441 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12442 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12443 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12444 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12445 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12446 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12447
12448 @item show default-collect
12449 @kindex show default-collect
12450 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12451 tracepoint hit.
12452
12453 @end table
12454
12455 @node Listing Tracepoints
12456 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12457
12458 @table @code
12459 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12460 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12461 @cindex information about tracepoints
12462 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12463 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12464 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12465 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12466 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12467 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12468
12469 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12470 tracing:
12471
12472 @itemize @bullet
12473 @item
12474 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12475
12476 @item
12477 the state about installed on target of each location
12478 @end itemize
12479
12480 @smallexample
12481 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12482 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12483 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12484 while-stepping 20
12485 collect globfoo, $regs
12486 end
12487 collect globfoo2
12488 end
12489 pass count 1200
12490 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12491 collect $eip
12492 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12493 installed on target
12494 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12495 installed on target
12496 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12497 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12498 not installed on target
12499 (@value{GDBP})
12500 @end smallexample
12501
12502 @noindent
12503 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12504 @end table
12505
12506 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12507 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12508
12509 @table @code
12510 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12511 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12512 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12513 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12514 program.
12515
12516 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12517
12518 @table @emph
12519 @item Count
12520 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12521 stable identifier.
12522 @item ID
12523 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12524 @item Enabled or Disabled
12525 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12526 that are not enabled.
12527 @item Address
12528 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12529 @item What
12530 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12531 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12532 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12533 will be left blank.
12534 @end table
12535
12536 @noindent
12537 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12538
12539 @table @emph
12540 @item Data
12541 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12542 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12543 marker call.
12544 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12545 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12546 @end table
12547
12548 @smallexample
12549 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12550 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12551 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12552 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12553 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12554 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12555 Data: str %s
12556 (@value{GDBP})
12557 @end smallexample
12558 @end table
12559
12560 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12561 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12562
12563 @table @code
12564 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12565 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12566 @cindex collected data discarded
12567 @item tstart
12568 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12569 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12570 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12571 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12572 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12573 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12574 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12575 information, and so forth.
12576
12577 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12578 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12579 @item tstop
12580 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12581 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12582 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12583 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12584 needs to be stopped quickly.
12585
12586 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12587 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12588 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12589
12590 @kindex tstatus
12591 @cindex status of trace data collection
12592 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12593 @item tstatus
12594 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12595 collection.
12596 @end table
12597
12598 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12599
12600 @smallexample
12601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12603 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12604 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12605 > while-stepping 11
12606 > collect $regs
12607 > end
12608 > end
12609 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12610 [time passes @dots{}]
12611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12612 @end smallexample
12613
12614 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12615 @cindex disconnected tracing
12616 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12617 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12618 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12619 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12620 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12621 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12622 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12623 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12624
12625 @table @code
12626 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12627 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12628 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12629 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12630 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12631 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12632 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12633 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12634
12635 @item show disconnected-tracing
12636 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12637 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12638
12639 @end table
12640
12641 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12642 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12643 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12644 it will continue after reconnection.
12645
12646 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12647 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12648 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12649 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12650 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12651 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12652 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12653 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12654 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12655 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12656
12657 @cindex circular trace buffer
12658 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12659 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12660 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12661 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12662 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12663 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12664 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12665 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12666 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12667 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12668 the next run.
12669
12670 @table @code
12671 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12672 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12673 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12674 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12675 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12676 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12677 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12678
12679 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12680 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12681 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12682 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12683 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12684 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12685
12686 @end table
12687
12688 @table @code
12689 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12690 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12691 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12692 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12693 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12694 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12695 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12696 likes. This is also the default.
12697
12698 @item show trace-buffer-size
12699 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12700 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12701 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12702 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12703 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12704 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12705 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12706 @end table
12707
12708 @table @code
12709 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12710 @kindex set trace-user
12711
12712 @item show trace-user
12713 @kindex show trace-user
12714
12715 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12716 @kindex set trace-notes
12717 Set the trace run's notes.
12718
12719 @item show trace-notes
12720 @kindex show trace-notes
12721 Show the trace run's notes.
12722
12723 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12724 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12725 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12726 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12727 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12728
12729 @item show trace-stop-notes
12730 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12731 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12732
12733 @end table
12734
12735 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12736 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12737
12738 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12739 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12740 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12741 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12742 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12743 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12744 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12745 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12746 mentioned here.
12747
12748 @itemize @bullet
12749
12750 @item
12751 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12752 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12753 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12754 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12755 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12756 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12757 cannot be collected either.
12758
12759 @item
12760 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12761 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12762 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12763 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12764 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12765 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12766 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12767 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12768 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12769 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12770
12771 @item
12772 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12773 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12774 in a misleading way.
12775
12776 @item
12777 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12778 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12779 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12780 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12781 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12782 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12783 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12784 by @code{ptr}.
12785
12786 @item
12787 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12788 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12789 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12790 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12791 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12792 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12793 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12794 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12795 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12796 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12797 invalid address.
12798
12799 @item
12800 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12801 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12802 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12803 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12804 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12805 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12806 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12807 it to zero.
12808
12809 @end itemize
12810
12811 @node Analyze Collected Data
12812 @section Using the Collected Data
12813
12814 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12815 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12816 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12817 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12818 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12819 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12820 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12821 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12822 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12823 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12824 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12825 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12826 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12827 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12828 the buffer will fail.
12829
12830 @menu
12831 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12832 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12833 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12834 @end menu
12835
12836 @node tfind
12837 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12838
12839 @kindex tfind
12840 @cindex select trace snapshot
12841 @cindex find trace snapshot
12842 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12843 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12844 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12845 snapshot is selected.
12846
12847 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12848
12849 @table @code
12850 @item tfind start
12851 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12852 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12853
12854 @item tfind none
12855 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12856
12857 @item tfind end
12858 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12859
12860 @item tfind
12861 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12862
12863 @item tfind -
12864 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12865 retracing earlier steps.
12866
12867 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12868 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12869 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12870 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12871 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12872
12873 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12874 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12875 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12876 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12877 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12878
12879 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12880 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12881 addresses (exclusive).
12882
12883 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12884 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12885 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12886
12887 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12888 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12889 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12890 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12891 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12892 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12893 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12894 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12895 @end table
12896
12897 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12898 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12899 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12900 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12901 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12902 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12903 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12904 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12905 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12906 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12907 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12908 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12909 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12910 tracepoint as the current one.
12911
12912 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12913 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12914 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12915 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12916 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12917
12918 @smallexample
12919 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12920 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12921 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12922 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12923 > tfind
12924 > end
12925
12926 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12927 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12928 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12929 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12930 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12931 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12932 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12933 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12934 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12935 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12936 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12937 @end smallexample
12938
12939 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12940 the buffer:
12941
12942 @smallexample
12943 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12944 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12945 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12946 > tfind line
12947 > end
12948
12949 Frame 0, X = 1
12950 Frame 7, X = 2
12951 Frame 13, X = 255
12952 @end smallexample
12953
12954 @node tdump
12955 @subsection @code{tdump}
12956 @kindex tdump
12957 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12958 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12959
12960 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12961 the current trace snapshot.
12962
12963 @smallexample
12964 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12965 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12966 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12967 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12968 > end
12969
12970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12971
12972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12973 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12974 at gdb_test.c:444
12975 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12976
12977 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12978 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12979 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12980 d1 0x18 24
12981 d2 0x80 128
12982 d3 0x33 51
12983 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12984 d5 0x22 34
12985 d6 0xe0 224
12986 d7 0x380035 3670069
12987 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12988 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12989 a2 0x100 256
12990 a3 0x322000 3284992
12991 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12992 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12993 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12994 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12995 ps 0x0 0
12996 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12997 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12998 fpstatus 0x0 0
12999 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13000 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13001 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13002 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13003 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13004 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13005 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13006 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13007 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13008
13009 (@value{GDBP})
13010 @end smallexample
13011
13012 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13013 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13014 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13015 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13016
13017 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13018 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13019 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13020 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13021 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13022 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13023 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13024 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13025 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13026 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13027
13028 @node save tracepoints
13029 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13030 @kindex save tracepoints
13031 @kindex save-tracepoints
13032 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13033
13034 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13035 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13036 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13037 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13038 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13039 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13040
13041 @node Tracepoint Variables
13042 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13043 @cindex tracepoint variables
13044 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13045
13046 @table @code
13047 @vindex $trace_frame
13048 @item (int) $trace_frame
13049 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13050 snapshot is selected.
13051
13052 @vindex $tracepoint
13053 @item (int) $tracepoint
13054 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13055
13056 @vindex $trace_line
13057 @item (int) $trace_line
13058 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13059
13060 @vindex $trace_file
13061 @item (char []) $trace_file
13062 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13063
13064 @vindex $trace_func
13065 @item (char []) $trace_func
13066 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13067 @end table
13068
13069 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13070 use @code{output} instead.
13071
13072 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13073 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13074 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13075 which are managed by the target.
13076
13077 @smallexample
13078 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13079
13080 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13081 > output $trace_file
13082 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13083 > tfind
13084 > end
13085 @end smallexample
13086
13087 @node Trace Files
13088 @section Using Trace Files
13089 @cindex trace files
13090
13091 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13092 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13093 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13094 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13095 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13096
13097 @table @code
13098
13099 @kindex tsave
13100 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13101 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13102 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13103 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13104 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13105 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13106 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13107 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13108 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13109 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13110 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13111 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13112 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13113 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13114 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13115
13116 @kindex target tfile
13117 @kindex tfile
13118 @kindex target ctf
13119 @kindex ctf
13120 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13121 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13122 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13123 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13124 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13125 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13126 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13127 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13128 the host.
13129
13130 @smallexample
13131 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13132 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13133 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13134 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13135 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13136 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13137 i = 0
13138 a = 0
13139 b = 1 '\001'
13140 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13141 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13142 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13143 $1 = 1
13144 @end smallexample
13145
13146 @end table
13147
13148 @node Overlays
13149 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13150 @cindex overlays
13151
13152 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13153 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13154 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13155 use overlays.
13156
13157 @menu
13158 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13159 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13160 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13161 mapped by asking the inferior.
13162 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13163 @end menu
13164
13165 @node How Overlays Work
13166 @section How Overlays Work
13167 @cindex mapped overlays
13168 @cindex unmapped overlays
13169 @cindex load address, overlay's
13170 @cindex mapped address
13171 @cindex overlay area
13172
13173 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13174 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13175 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13176 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13177 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13178
13179 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13180 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13181 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13182 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13183 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13184 largest overlay as well.
13185
13186 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13187 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13188 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13189 there.
13190
13191 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13192 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13193 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13194
13195 @smallexample
13196 @group
13197 Data Instruction Larger
13198 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13199 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13200 | | | | | |
13201 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13202 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13203 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13204 | and heap | | | | | |
13205 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13206 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13207 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13208 | | | | | |
13209 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13210 address | | | | | |
13211 | overlay | <-' | | |
13212 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13213 | | <---. | | load address
13214 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13215 | | | |
13216 +-----------+ | |
13217 +-----------+
13218 | |
13219 +-----------+
13220
13221 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13222 @end group
13223 @end smallexample
13224
13225 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13226 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13227 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13228 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13229 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13230 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13231 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13232 program and the overlay area.
13233
13234 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13235 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13236 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13237 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13238 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13239 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13240 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13241
13242 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13243 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13244 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13245
13246 @itemize @bullet
13247
13248 @item
13249 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13250 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13251 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13252 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13253
13254 @item
13255 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13256 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13257 your program's performance.
13258
13259 @item
13260 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13261 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13262 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13263 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13264 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13265 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13266 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13267
13268 @item
13269 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13270 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13271 instruction and data spaces.
13272
13273 @end itemize
13274
13275 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13276 improved in many ways:
13277
13278 @itemize @bullet
13279
13280 @item
13281 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13282 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13283 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13284 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13285 area in the usual way.
13286
13287 @item
13288 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13289 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13290
13291 @item
13292 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13293 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13294 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13295 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13296 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13297 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13298 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13299
13300 @end itemize
13301
13302
13303 @node Overlay Commands
13304 @section Overlay Commands
13305
13306 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13307 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13308 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13309 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13310 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13311 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13312
13313 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13314 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13315
13316 @table @code
13317 @item overlay off
13318 @kindex overlay
13319 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13320 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13321 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13322 overlay support is disabled.
13323
13324 @item overlay manual
13325 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13326 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13327 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13328 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13329 commands described below.
13330
13331 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13332 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13333 @cindex map an overlay
13334 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13335 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13336 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13337 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13338 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13339 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13340
13341 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13342 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13343 @cindex unmap an overlay
13344 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13345 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13346 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13347 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13348
13349 @item overlay auto
13350 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13351 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13352 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13353 Overlay Debugging}.
13354
13355 @item overlay load-target
13356 @itemx overlay load
13357 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13358 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13359 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13360 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13361 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13362 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13363
13364 @item overlay list-overlays
13365 @itemx overlay list
13366 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13367 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13368 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13369
13370 @end table
13371
13372 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13373 of the function the address falls in:
13374
13375 @smallexample
13376 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13377 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13378 @end smallexample
13379 @noindent
13380 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13381 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13382 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13383 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13384
13385 @smallexample
13386 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13387 No sections are mapped.
13388 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13389 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13390 @end smallexample
13391 @noindent
13392 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13393 name normally:
13394
13395 @smallexample
13396 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13397 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13398 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13399 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13400 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13401 @end smallexample
13402
13403 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13404 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13405 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13406 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13407 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13408
13409 @itemize @bullet
13410 @item
13411 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13412 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13413 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13414 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13415 @item
13416 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13417 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13418 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13419 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13420 breakpoints properly.
13421 @end itemize
13422
13423
13424 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13425 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13426 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13427
13428 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13429 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13430 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13431 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13432 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13433 current state of the overlays.
13434
13435 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13436 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13437
13438 @table @asis
13439
13440 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13441 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13442
13443 @smallexample
13444 struct
13445 @{
13446 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13447 unsigned long vma;
13448
13449 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13450 unsigned long size;
13451
13452 /* The overlay's load address. */
13453 unsigned long lma;
13454
13455 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13456 zero otherwise. */
13457 unsigned long mapped;
13458 @}
13459 @end smallexample
13460
13461 @item @code{_novlys}:
13462 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13463 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13464
13465 @end table
13466
13467 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13468 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13469 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13470 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13471 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13472 currently mapped.
13473
13474 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13475 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13476 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13477 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13478 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13479 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13480 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13481 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13482 are not being executed.
13483
13484 @node Overlay Sample Program
13485 @section Overlay Sample Program
13486 @cindex overlay example program
13487
13488 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13489 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13490 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13491 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13492 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13493 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13494 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13495
13496 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13497 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13498 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13499 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13500
13501 @table @file
13502 @item overlays.c
13503 The main program file.
13504 @item ovlymgr.c
13505 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13506 @item foo.c
13507 @itemx bar.c
13508 @itemx baz.c
13509 @itemx grbx.c
13510 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13511 @item d10v.ld
13512 @itemx m32r.ld
13513 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13514 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13515 @end table
13516
13517 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13518 cross-compiler like this:
13519
13520 @smallexample
13521 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13522 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13523 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13524 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13525 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13526 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13527 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13528 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13529 @end smallexample
13530
13531 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13532 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13533 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13534
13535
13536 @node Languages
13537 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13538 @cindex languages
13539
13540 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13541 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13542 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13543 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13544 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13545 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13546
13547 @cindex working language
13548 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13549 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13550 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13551 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13552 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13553 language}.
13554
13555 @menu
13556 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13557 * Show:: Displaying the language
13558 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13559 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13560 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13561 @end menu
13562
13563 @node Setting
13564 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13565
13566 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13567 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13568 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13569 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13570 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13571 are printed, etc.
13572
13573 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13574 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13575 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13576 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13577 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13578 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13579 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13580 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13581 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13582 Displaying the Language}.
13583
13584 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13585 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13586 another language. In that case, make the
13587 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13588 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13589 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13590
13591 @menu
13592 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13593 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13594 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13595 @end menu
13596
13597 @node Filenames
13598 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13599
13600 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13601 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13602
13603 @table @file
13604 @item .ada
13605 @itemx .ads
13606 @itemx .adb
13607 @itemx .a
13608 Ada source file.
13609
13610 @item .c
13611 C source file
13612
13613 @item .C
13614 @itemx .cc
13615 @itemx .cp
13616 @itemx .cpp
13617 @itemx .cxx
13618 @itemx .c++
13619 C@t{++} source file
13620
13621 @item .d
13622 D source file
13623
13624 @item .m
13625 Objective-C source file
13626
13627 @item .f
13628 @itemx .F
13629 Fortran source file
13630
13631 @item .mod
13632 Modula-2 source file
13633
13634 @item .s
13635 @itemx .S
13636 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13637 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13638 @end table
13639
13640 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13641 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13642
13643 @node Manually
13644 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13645
13646 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13647 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13648 your program.
13649
13650 @kindex set language
13651 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13652 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13653 a language, such as
13654 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13655 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13656
13657 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13658 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13659 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13660 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13661 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13662 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13663 command such as:
13664
13665 @smallexample
13666 print a = b + c
13667 @end smallexample
13668
13669 @noindent
13670 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13671 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13672 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13673 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13674
13675 @node Automatically
13676 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13677
13678 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13679 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13680 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13681 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13682 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13683 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13684 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13685 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13686 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13687
13688 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13689 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13690 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13691 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13692 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13693
13694 @node Show
13695 @section Displaying the Language
13696
13697 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13698 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13699
13700 @table @code
13701 @item show language
13702 @anchor{show language}
13703 @kindex show language
13704 Display the current working language. This is the
13705 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13706 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13707
13708 @item info frame
13709 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13710 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13711 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13712 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13713 information listed here.
13714
13715 @item info source
13716 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13717 Display the source language of this source file.
13718 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13719 information listed here.
13720 @end table
13721
13722 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13723 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13724 with a language explicitly:
13725
13726 @table @code
13727 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13728 @kindex set extension-language
13729 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13730 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13731
13732 @item info extensions
13733 @kindex info extensions
13734 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13735 @end table
13736
13737 @node Checks
13738 @section Type and Range Checking
13739
13740 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13741 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13742 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13743 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13744 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13745 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13746 errors when your program is running.
13747
13748 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13749 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13750 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13751 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13752
13753 @menu
13754 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13755 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13756 @end menu
13757
13758 @cindex type checking
13759 @cindex checks, type
13760 @node Type Checking
13761 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13762
13763 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13764 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13765 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13766 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13767
13768 @smallexample
13769 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13770
13771 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13772 $1 = 2
13773 @exdent but
13774 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13775 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13776 @end smallexample
13777
13778 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13779 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13780
13781 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13782 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13783 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13784 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13785 expressions like the second example above.
13786
13787 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13788 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13789 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13790 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13791 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13792 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13793
13794 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13795
13796 @kindex set check type
13797 @kindex show check type
13798 @table @code
13799 @item set check type on
13800 @itemx set check type off
13801 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13802 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13803 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13804
13805 @item show check type
13806 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13807 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13808 @end table
13809
13810 @cindex range checking
13811 @cindex checks, range
13812 @node Range Checking
13813 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13814
13815 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13816 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13817 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13818 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13819 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13820
13821 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13822 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13823 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13824 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13825
13826 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13827 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13828 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13829 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13830 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13831 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13832
13833 @smallexample
13834 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13835 @end smallexample
13836
13837 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13838 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13839 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13840
13841 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13842
13843 @kindex set check range
13844 @kindex show check range
13845 @table @code
13846 @item set check range auto
13847 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13848 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13849 each language.
13850
13851 @item set check range on
13852 @itemx set check range off
13853 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13854 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13855 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13856 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13857
13858 @item set check range warn
13859 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13860 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13861 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13862 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13863 systems).
13864
13865 @item show range
13866 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13867 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13868 @end table
13869
13870 @node Supported Languages
13871 @section Supported Languages
13872
13873 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13874 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13875 @c This is false ...
13876 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13877 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13878 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13879 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13880 language.
13881
13882 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13883 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13884 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13885 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13886 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13887 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13888 language reference or tutorial.
13889
13890 @menu
13891 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13892 * D:: D
13893 * Go:: Go
13894 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13895 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13896 * Fortran:: Fortran
13897 * Pascal:: Pascal
13898 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13899 * Ada:: Ada
13900 @end menu
13901
13902 @node C
13903 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13904
13905 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13906 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13907
13908 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13909 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13910 together.
13911
13912 @cindex C@t{++}
13913 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13914 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13915 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13916 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13917 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13918 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13919 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13920
13921 @menu
13922 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13923 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13924 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13925 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13926 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13927 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13928 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13929 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13930 @end menu
13931
13932 @node C Operators
13933 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13934
13935 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13936
13937 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13938 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13939 often defined on groups of types.
13940
13941 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13942
13943 @itemize @bullet
13944
13945 @item
13946 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13947 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13948
13949 @item
13950 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13951 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13952
13953 @item
13954 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13955
13956 @item
13957 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13958
13959 @end itemize
13960
13961 @noindent
13962 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13963 in order of increasing precedence:
13964
13965 @table @code
13966 @item ,
13967 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13968 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13969 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13970
13971 @item =
13972 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13973 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13974
13975 @item @var{op}=
13976 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13977 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13978 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13979 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13980 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13981
13982 @item ?:
13983 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13984 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13985 should be of an integral type.
13986
13987 @item ||
13988 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13989
13990 @item &&
13991 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13992
13993 @item |
13994 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13995
13996 @item ^
13997 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13998
13999 @item &
14000 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14001
14002 @item ==@r{, }!=
14003 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14004 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14005
14006 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14007 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14008 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14009 and non-zero for true.
14010
14011 @item <<@r{, }>>
14012 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14013
14014 @item @@
14015 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14016
14017 @item +@r{, }-
14018 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14019 pointer types.
14020
14021 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14022 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14023 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14024 integral types.
14025
14026 @item ++@r{, }--
14027 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14028 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14029 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14030 operation takes place.
14031
14032 @item *
14033 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14034 @code{++}.
14035
14036 @item &
14037 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14038
14039 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14040 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14041 to examine the address
14042 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14043 stored.
14044
14045 @item -
14046 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14047 precedence as @code{++}.
14048
14049 @item !
14050 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14051 @code{++}.
14052
14053 @item ~
14054 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14055 @code{++}.
14056
14057
14058 @item .@r{, }->
14059 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14060 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14061 pointer based on the stored type information.
14062 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14063
14064 @item .*@r{, }->*
14065 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14066
14067 @item []
14068 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14069 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14070
14071 @item ()
14072 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14073
14074 @item ::
14075 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14076 and @code{class} types.
14077
14078 @item ::
14079 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14080 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14081 above.
14082 @end table
14083
14084 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14085 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14086 predefined meaning.
14087
14088 @node C Constants
14089 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14090
14091 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14092
14093 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14094 following ways:
14095
14096 @itemize @bullet
14097 @item
14098 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14099 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14100 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14101 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14102 @code{long} value.
14103
14104 @item
14105 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14106 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14107 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14108 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14109 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14110 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14111 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14112 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14113 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14114 constant.
14115
14116 @item
14117 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14118 integral equivalents.
14119
14120 @item
14121 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14122 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14123 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14124 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14125 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14126 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14127 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14128 @samp{\n} for newline.
14129
14130 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14131 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14132 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14133 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14134
14135 @item
14136 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14137 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14138 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14139 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14140 characters.
14141
14142 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14143 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14144 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14145
14146 @item
14147 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14148 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14149
14150 @item
14151 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14152 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14153 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14154 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14155 @end itemize
14156
14157 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14158 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14159
14160 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14161 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14162
14163 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14164 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14165 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14166 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14167 @quotation
14168 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14169 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14170 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14171 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14172 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14173 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14174 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14175 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14176 @end quotation
14177
14178 @enumerate
14179
14180 @cindex member functions
14181 @item
14182 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14183
14184 @smallexample
14185 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14186 @end smallexample
14187
14188 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14189 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14190 @item
14191 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14192 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14193 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14194 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14195 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14196
14197 @cindex call overloaded functions
14198 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14199 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14200 @item
14201 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14202 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14203 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14204 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14205 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14206 default arguments.
14207
14208 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14209 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14210 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14211 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14212 number of function arguments.
14213
14214 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14215 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14216 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14217
14218 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14219 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14220 @smallexample
14221 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14222 @end smallexample
14223
14224 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14225 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14226
14227 @cindex reference declarations
14228 @item
14229 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14230 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14231 dereferenced.
14232
14233 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14234 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14235 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14236 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14237 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14238
14239 @item
14240 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14241 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14242 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14243 necessary, for example in an expression like
14244 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14245 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14246 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14247
14248 @item
14249 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14250 specification.
14251 @end enumerate
14252
14253 @node C Defaults
14254 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14255
14256 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14257
14258 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14259 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14260 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14261 selects the working language.
14262
14263 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14264 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14265 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14266 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14267 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14268 for further details.
14269
14270 @node C Checks
14271 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14272
14273 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14274
14275 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14276 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14277 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14278 constants to pointers.
14279
14280 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14281 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14282 that is not itself an array.
14283
14284 @node Debugging C
14285 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14286
14287 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14288 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14289 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14290 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14291
14292 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14293 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14294 ,Expressions}.
14295
14296 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14297 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14298
14299 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14300
14301 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14302 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14303
14304 @table @code
14305 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14306 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14307 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14308 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14309 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14310 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14311
14312 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14313 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14314 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14315 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14316 classes.
14317 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14318
14319 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14320 @item catch throw
14321 @itemx catch rethrow
14322 @itemx catch catch
14323 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14324 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14325
14326 @cindex inheritance
14327 @item ptype @var{typename}
14328 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14329 @var{typename}.
14330 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14331
14332 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14333 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14334 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14335 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14336 multiple inheritance is in use.
14337
14338 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14339 @item demangle @var{name}
14340 Demangle @var{name}.
14341 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14342
14343 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14344 @item set print demangle
14345 @itemx show print demangle
14346 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14347 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14348 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14349 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14350 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14351
14352 @item set print object
14353 @itemx show print object
14354 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14355 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14356
14357 @item set print vtbl
14358 @itemx show print vtbl
14359 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14360 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14361 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14362 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14363
14364 @kindex set overload-resolution
14365 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14366 @item set overload-resolution on
14367 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14368 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14369 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14370 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14371 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14372 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14373
14374 @item set overload-resolution off
14375 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14376 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14377 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14378 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14379 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14380 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14381 argument types.
14382
14383 @kindex show overload-resolution
14384 @item show overload-resolution
14385 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14386
14387 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14388 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14389 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14390 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14391 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14392 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14393 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14394 @end table
14395
14396 @node Decimal Floating Point
14397 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14398 @cindex decimal floating point format
14399
14400 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14401 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14402 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14403 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14404
14405 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14406 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14407 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14408 configured target.
14409
14410 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14411 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14412 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14413
14414 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14415 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14416 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14417
14418 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14419 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14420 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14421
14422 @node D
14423 @subsection D
14424
14425 @cindex D
14426 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14427 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14428 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14429
14430 @node Go
14431 @subsection Go
14432
14433 @cindex Go (programming language)
14434 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14435 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14436
14437 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14438
14439 @table @code
14440 @cindex current Go package
14441 @item The current Go package
14442 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14443 specifying global variables and functions.
14444
14445 For example, given the program:
14446
14447 @example
14448 package main
14449 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14450 func main () @{
14451 // ...
14452 @}
14453 @end example
14454
14455 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14456
14457 @example
14458 (gdb) p myglob
14459 (gdb) p main.myglob
14460 @end example
14461
14462 @cindex builtin Go types
14463 @item Builtin Go types
14464 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14465 as a string.
14466
14467 @cindex builtin Go functions
14468 @item Builtin Go functions
14469 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14470 function and handles it internally.
14471
14472 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14473 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14474 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14475 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14476 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14477 @end table
14478
14479 @node Objective-C
14480 @subsection Objective-C
14481
14482 @cindex Objective-C
14483 This section provides information about some commands and command
14484 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14485 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14486 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14487
14488 @menu
14489 * Method Names in Commands::
14490 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14491 @end menu
14492
14493 @node Method Names in Commands
14494 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14495
14496 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14497 names as line specifications:
14498
14499 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14500 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14501 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14502 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14503 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14504 @itemize
14505 @item @code{clear}
14506 @item @code{break}
14507 @item @code{info line}
14508 @item @code{jump}
14509 @item @code{list}
14510 @end itemize
14511
14512 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14513
14514 @smallexample
14515 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14516 @end smallexample
14517
14518 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14519 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14520 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14521 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14522 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14523 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14524 debugged, enter:
14525
14526 @smallexample
14527 break -[Fruit create]
14528 @end smallexample
14529
14530 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14531 enter:
14532
14533 @smallexample
14534 list +[NSText initialize]
14535 @end smallexample
14536
14537 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14538 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14539 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14540 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14541
14542 @smallexample
14543 break create
14544 @end smallexample
14545
14546 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14547 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14548 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14549 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14550 none apply.
14551
14552 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14553 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14554
14555 @smallexample
14556 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14557 @end smallexample
14558
14559 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14560 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14561 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14562 @kindex print-object
14563 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14564
14565 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14566
14567 @smallexample
14568 print -[@var{object} hash]
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14572 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14573 @noindent
14574 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14575 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14576 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14577 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14578 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14579 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14580
14581 @node OpenCL C
14582 @subsection OpenCL C
14583
14584 @cindex OpenCL C
14585 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14586
14587 @menu
14588 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14589 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14590 * OpenCL C Operators::
14591 @end menu
14592
14593 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14594 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14595
14596 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14597 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14598 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14599 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14600 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14601
14602 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14603 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14604
14605 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14606 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14607 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14608 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14609
14610 @node OpenCL C Operators
14611 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14612
14613 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14614 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14615 vector data types.
14616
14617 @node Fortran
14618 @subsection Fortran
14619 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14620
14621 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14622 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14623
14624 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14625 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14626 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14627 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14628 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14629 underscore.
14630
14631 @menu
14632 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14633 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14634 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14635 @end menu
14636
14637 @node Fortran Operators
14638 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14639
14640 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14641
14642 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14643 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14644 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14645
14646 @table @code
14647 @item **
14648 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14649 of the second one.
14650
14651 @item :
14652 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14653 represent a section of array.
14654
14655 @item %
14656 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14657 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14658 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14659 union type.
14660 @end table
14661
14662 @node Fortran Defaults
14663 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14664
14665 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14666
14667 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14668 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14669 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14670 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14671
14672 @node Special Fortran Commands
14673 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14674
14675 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14676
14677 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14678 such as displaying common blocks.
14679
14680 @table @code
14681 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14682 @kindex info common
14683 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14684 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14685 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14686 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14687 printed.
14688 @end table
14689
14690 @node Pascal
14691 @subsection Pascal
14692
14693 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14694 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14695 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14696 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14697 syntax.
14698
14699 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14700 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14701 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14702
14703 @node Modula-2
14704 @subsection Modula-2
14705
14706 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14707
14708 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14709 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14710 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14711 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14712 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14713 table.
14714
14715 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14716 @menu
14717 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14718 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14719 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14720 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14721 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14722 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14723 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14724 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14725 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14726 @end menu
14727
14728 @node M2 Operators
14729 @subsubsection Operators
14730 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14731
14732 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14733 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14734 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14735 following definitions hold:
14736
14737 @itemize @bullet
14738
14739 @item
14740 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14741 their subranges.
14742
14743 @item
14744 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14745
14746 @item
14747 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14748
14749 @item
14750 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14751 @var{type}}.
14752
14753 @item
14754 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14755
14756 @item
14757 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14758
14759 @item
14760 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14761 @end itemize
14762
14763 @noindent
14764 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14765 increasing precedence:
14766
14767 @table @code
14768 @item ,
14769 Function argument or array index separator.
14770
14771 @item :=
14772 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14773 @var{value}.
14774
14775 @item <@r{, }>
14776 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14777 types.
14778
14779 @item <=@r{, }>=
14780 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14781 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14782 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14783
14784 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14785 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14786 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14787 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14788 comment character.
14789
14790 @item IN
14791 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14792 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14793
14794 @item OR
14795 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14796
14797 @item AND@r{, }&
14798 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14799
14800 @item @@
14801 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14802
14803 @item +@r{, }-
14804 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14805 and difference on set types.
14806
14807 @item *
14808 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14809 on set types.
14810
14811 @item /
14812 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14813 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14814
14815 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14816 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14817 precedence as @code{*}.
14818
14819 @item -
14820 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14821
14822 @item ^
14823 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14824
14825 @item NOT
14826 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14827 @code{^}.
14828
14829 @item .
14830 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14831 precedence as @code{^}.
14832
14833 @item []
14834 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14835
14836 @item ()
14837 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14838 as @code{^}.
14839
14840 @item ::@r{, }.
14841 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14842 @end table
14843
14844 @quotation
14845 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14846 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14847 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14848 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14849 @end quotation
14850
14851
14852 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14853 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14854 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14855
14856 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14857 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14858
14859 @table @var
14860
14861 @item a
14862 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14863
14864 @item c
14865 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14866
14867 @item i
14868 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14869
14870 @item m
14871 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14872 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14873 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14874
14875 @item n
14876 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14877
14878 @item r
14879 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14880
14881 @item t
14882 represents a type.
14883
14884 @item v
14885 represents a variable.
14886
14887 @item x
14888 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14889 explanation of the function for details.
14890 @end table
14891
14892 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14893
14894 @table @code
14895 @item ABS(@var{n})
14896 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14897
14898 @item CAP(@var{c})
14899 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14900 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14901
14902 @item CHR(@var{i})
14903 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14904
14905 @item DEC(@var{v})
14906 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14907
14908 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14909 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14910 new value.
14911
14912 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14913 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14914 set.
14915
14916 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14917 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14918
14919 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14920 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14921
14922 @item INC(@var{v})
14923 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14924
14925 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14926 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14927 new value.
14928
14929 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14930 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14931 there. Returns the new set.
14932
14933 @item MAX(@var{t})
14934 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14935
14936 @item MIN(@var{t})
14937 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14938
14939 @item ODD(@var{i})
14940 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14941
14942 @item ORD(@var{x})
14943 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14944 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14945 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14946 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14947
14948 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14949 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14950 variable or a type.
14951
14952 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14953 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14954
14955 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14956 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14957 variable or a type.
14958
14959 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14960 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14961 @end table
14962
14963 @quotation
14964 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14965 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14966 an error.
14967 @end quotation
14968
14969 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14970 @node M2 Constants
14971 @subsubsection Constants
14972
14973 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14974 ways:
14975
14976 @itemize @bullet
14977
14978 @item
14979 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14980 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14981 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14982 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14983
14984 @item
14985 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14986 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14987 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14988 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14989 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14990 digits.
14991
14992 @item
14993 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14994 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14995 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14996 followed by a @samp{C}.
14997
14998 @item
14999 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15000 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15001 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15002 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15003 sequences.
15004
15005 @item
15006 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15007
15008 @item
15009 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15010 @code{FALSE}.
15011
15012 @item
15013 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15014
15015 @item
15016 Set constants are not yet supported.
15017 @end itemize
15018
15019 @node M2 Types
15020 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15021 @cindex Modula-2 types
15022
15023 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15024 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15025 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15026 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15027 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15028 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15029
15030 The first example contains the following section of code:
15031
15032 @smallexample
15033 VAR
15034 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15035 r: [20..40] ;
15036 @end smallexample
15037
15038 @noindent
15039 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15040 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15041
15042 @smallexample
15043 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15044 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15045 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15046 SET OF CHAR
15047 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15048 21
15049 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15050 [20..40]
15051 @end smallexample
15052
15053 @noindent
15054 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15055
15056 @smallexample
15057 VAR
15058 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15059 @end smallexample
15060
15061 @noindent
15062 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15063
15064 @smallexample
15065 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15066 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15067 @end smallexample
15068
15069 @noindent
15070 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15071 expressions using the debugger.
15072
15073 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15074 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15075
15076 @smallexample
15077 VAR
15078 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15079 @end smallexample
15080
15081 @smallexample
15082 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15083 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15084 @end smallexample
15085
15086 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15087 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15088 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15089 above.
15090
15091 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15092
15093 @smallexample
15094 TYPE
15095 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15096 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15097 VAR
15098 s: t ;
15099 BEGIN
15100 s := blue ;
15101 @end smallexample
15102
15103 @noindent
15104 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15105 and value of a variable.
15106
15107 @smallexample
15108 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15109 $1 = blue
15110 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15111 type = [blue..yellow]
15112 @end smallexample
15113
15114 @noindent
15115 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15116 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15117 their @code{C} counterparts.
15118
15119 @smallexample
15120 VAR
15121 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15122 BEGIN
15123 s[1] := 1 ;
15124 @end smallexample
15125
15126 @smallexample
15127 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15128 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15129 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15130 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15131 @end smallexample
15132
15133 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15134 pointer types as shown in this example:
15135
15136 @smallexample
15137 VAR
15138 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15139 BEGIN
15140 NEW(s) ;
15141 s^[1] := 1 ;
15142 @end smallexample
15143
15144 @noindent
15145 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15146
15147 @smallexample
15148 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15149 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15150 @end smallexample
15151
15152 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15153 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15154 types:
15155
15156 @smallexample
15157 TYPE
15158 foo = RECORD
15159 f1: CARDINAL ;
15160 f2: CHAR ;
15161 f3: myarray ;
15162 END ;
15163
15164 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15165 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15166 VAR
15167 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15168 @end smallexample
15169
15170 @noindent
15171 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15172 below.
15173
15174 @smallexample
15175 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15176 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15177 f1 : CARDINAL;
15178 f2 : CHAR;
15179 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15180 END
15181 @end smallexample
15182
15183 @node M2 Defaults
15184 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15185 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15186
15187 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15188 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15189 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15190 selected the working language.
15191
15192 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15193 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15194 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15195 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15196
15197 @node Deviations
15198 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15199 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15200
15201 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15202 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15203
15204 @itemize @bullet
15205 @item
15206 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15207 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15208 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15209 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15210 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15211 returned a pointer.)
15212
15213 @item
15214 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15215 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15216 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15217 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15218
15219 @item
15220 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15221 argument.
15222
15223 @item
15224 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15225 @end itemize
15226
15227 @node M2 Checks
15228 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15229 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15230
15231 @quotation
15232 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15233 range checking.
15234 @end quotation
15235 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15236
15237 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15238
15239 @itemize @bullet
15240 @item
15241 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15242 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15243
15244 @item
15245 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15246 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15247 @end itemize
15248
15249 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15250 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15251
15252 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15253 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15254
15255 @node M2 Scope
15256 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15257 @cindex scope
15258 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15259 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15260 @ifinfo
15261 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15262 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15263 @end ifinfo
15264 @ifnotinfo
15265 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15266 @end ifnotinfo
15267
15268 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15269 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15270 similar syntax:
15271
15272 @smallexample
15273
15274 @var{module} . @var{id}
15275 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15276 @end smallexample
15277
15278 @noindent
15279 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15280 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15281 identifier within your program, except another module.
15282
15283 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15284 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15285 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15286 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15287
15288 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15289 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15290 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15291 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15292 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15293 @var{module}.
15294
15295 @node GDB/M2
15296 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15297
15298 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15299 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15300 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15301 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15302 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15303 analogue in Modula-2.
15304
15305 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15306 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15307 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15308 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15309 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15310 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15311
15312 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15313 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15314 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15315
15316 @node Ada
15317 @subsection Ada
15318 @cindex Ada
15319
15320 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15321 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15322 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15323 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15324 to be difficult.
15325
15326
15327 @cindex expressions in Ada
15328 @menu
15329 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15330 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15331 in @value{GDBN}.
15332 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15333 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15334 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15335 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15336 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15337 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15338 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15339 Profile
15340 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15341 @end menu
15342
15343 @node Ada Mode Intro
15344 @subsubsection Introduction
15345 @cindex Ada mode, general
15346
15347 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15348 syntax, with some extensions.
15349 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15350
15351 @itemize @bullet
15352 @item
15353 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15354 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15355 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15356 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15357
15358 @item
15359 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15360 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15361
15362 @item
15363 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15364 @end itemize
15365
15366 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15367 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15368 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15369 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15370 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15371
15372 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15373 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15374 was translated from an Ada source file.
15375
15376 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15377 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15378 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15379 middle (to allow based literals).
15380
15381 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15382 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15383 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15384 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15385 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15386 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15387
15388 @node Omissions from Ada
15389 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15390 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15391
15392 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15393
15394 @itemize @bullet
15395 @item
15396 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15397
15398 @itemize @minus
15399 @item
15400 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15401 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15402
15403 @item
15404 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15405
15406 @item
15407 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15408
15409 @item
15410 @t{'Tag}.
15411
15412 @item
15413 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15414 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15415
15416 @item
15417 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15418 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15419
15420 @item
15421 @t{'Address}.
15422 @end itemize
15423
15424 @item
15425 The names in
15426 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15427 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15428 not currently available.
15429
15430 @item
15431 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15432 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15433 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15434 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15435 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15436 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15437 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15438 indeterminate values.
15439
15440 @item
15441 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15442 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15443 are not implemented.
15444
15445 @item
15446 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15447 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15448 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15449 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15450 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15451
15452 @smallexample
15453 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15454 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15455 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15456 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15457 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15458 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15459 @end smallexample
15460
15461 Changing a
15462 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15463 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15464 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15465 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15466 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15467 declared to have a type such as:
15468
15469 @smallexample
15470 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15471 Id : Integer;
15472 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15473 end record;
15474 @end smallexample
15475
15476 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15477 assignments:
15478
15479 @smallexample
15480 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15481 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15482 @end smallexample
15483
15484 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15485 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15486 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15487 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15488 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15489 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15490 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15491 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15492
15493 @item
15494 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15495
15496 @item
15497 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15498 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15499 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15500 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15501 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15502 the proper resolution.
15503
15504 @item
15505 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15506
15507 @item
15508 Entry calls are not implemented.
15509
15510 @item
15511 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15512 formats are not supported.
15513
15514 @item
15515 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15516
15517 @item
15518 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15519 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15520 context.
15521 Should your program
15522 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15523 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15524 @end itemize
15525
15526 @node Additions to Ada
15527 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15528 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15529
15530 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15531 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15532
15533 @itemize @bullet
15534 @item
15535 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15536 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15537 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15538 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15539 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15540 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15541 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15542 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15543
15544 @item
15545 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15546 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15547 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15548
15549 @item
15550 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15551 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15552
15553 @item
15554 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15555 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15556 @end itemize
15557
15558 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15559 additions specific to Ada:
15560
15561 @itemize @bullet
15562 @item
15563 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15564 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15565
15566 @smallexample
15567 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15568 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15569 @end smallexample
15570
15571 @item
15572 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15573 the value of its right-hand operand.
15574 This allows, for example,
15575 complex conditional breaks:
15576
15577 @smallexample
15578 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15579 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15580 @end smallexample
15581
15582 @item
15583 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15584 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15585 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15586 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15587 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15588 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15589 in strings. For example,
15590 @smallexample
15591 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15592 @end smallexample
15593 @noindent
15594 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15595 after each period.
15596
15597 @item
15598 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15599 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15600 to write
15601
15602 @smallexample
15603 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15604 @end smallexample
15605
15606 @item
15607 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15608 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15609 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15610 of 3 might print as
15611
15612 @smallexample
15613 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15614 @end smallexample
15615
15616 @noindent
15617 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15618 clause.
15619
15620 @item
15621 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15622 multi-character subsequence of
15623 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15624 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15625 in place of @t{a'length}.
15626
15627 @item
15628 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15629 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15630 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15631 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15632 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15633 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15634 For example,
15635 @smallexample
15636 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15637 @end smallexample
15638
15639 @item
15640 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15641 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15642 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15643 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15644 object.
15645
15646 @end itemize
15647
15648 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15649 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15650
15651 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15652 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15653 before reaching the main procedure.
15654 As defined in the Ada Reference
15655 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15656 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15657 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15658 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15659
15660 @node Ada Exceptions
15661 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15662
15663 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15664
15665 @table @code
15666 @kindex info exceptions
15667 @item info exceptions
15668 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15669 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15670 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15671 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15672 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15673 @end table
15674
15675 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15676 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15677 argument.
15678
15679 @smallexample
15680 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15681 All defined Ada exceptions:
15682 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15683 program_error: 0x613d20
15684 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15685 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15686 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15687 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15688 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15689 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15690 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15691 @end smallexample
15692
15693 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15694 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15695
15696 @node Ada Tasks
15697 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15698 @cindex Ada, tasking
15699
15700 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15701 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15702
15703 @table @code
15704 @kindex info tasks
15705 @item info tasks
15706 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15707
15708
15709 @smallexample
15710 @iftex
15711 @leftskip=0.5cm
15712 @end iftex
15713 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15714 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15715 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15716 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15717 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15718 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15719
15720 @end smallexample
15721
15722 @noindent
15723 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15724 task currently being inspected.
15725
15726 @table @asis
15727 @item ID
15728 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15729
15730 @item TID
15731 The Ada task ID.
15732
15733 @item P-ID
15734 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15735
15736 @item Pri
15737 The base priority of the task.
15738
15739 @item State
15740 Current state of the task.
15741
15742 @table @code
15743 @item Unactivated
15744 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15745 executing.
15746
15747 @item Runnable
15748 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15749 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15750
15751 @item Terminated
15752 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15753 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15754 terminated themselves.
15755
15756 @item Child Activation Wait
15757 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15758
15759 @item Accept Statement
15760 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15761
15762 @item Waiting on entry call
15763 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15764
15765 @item Async Select Wait
15766 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15767 select statement.
15768
15769 @item Delay Sleep
15770 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15771 alternative open.
15772
15773 @item Child Termination Wait
15774 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15775 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15776 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15777
15778 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15779 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15780 finish terminating.
15781
15782 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15783 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15784 @end table
15785
15786 @item Name
15787 Name of the task in the program.
15788
15789 @end table
15790
15791 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15792 @item info task @var{taskno}
15793 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15794 the following example:
15795 @smallexample
15796 @iftex
15797 @leftskip=0.5cm
15798 @end iftex
15799 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15800 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15801 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15802 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15803 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15804 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15805 Name: task_1
15806 Thread: 0x807f378
15807 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15808 Base Priority: 15
15809 State: Runnable
15810 @end smallexample
15811
15812 @item task
15813 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15814 @cindex current Ada task ID
15815 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15816
15817 @smallexample
15818 @iftex
15819 @leftskip=0.5cm
15820 @end iftex
15821 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15822 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15823 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15824 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15825 (@value{GDBP}) task
15826 [Current task is 2]
15827 @end smallexample
15828
15829 @item task @var{taskno}
15830 @cindex Ada task switching
15831 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15832 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15833 from the current task to the given task.
15834
15835 @smallexample
15836 @iftex
15837 @leftskip=0.5cm
15838 @end iftex
15839 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15840 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15841 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15842 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15843 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15844 [Switching to task 1]
15845 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15846 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15847 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15848 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15849 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15850 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15851 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15852 @end smallexample
15853
15854 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15855 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15856 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15857 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15858 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15859 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15860 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15861 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15862 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15863
15864 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15865 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15866 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15867 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15868 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15869
15870 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15871 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15872 program.
15873
15874 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15875 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15876 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15877
15878 For example,
15879
15880 @smallexample
15881 @iftex
15882 @leftskip=0.5cm
15883 @end iftex
15884 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15885 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15886 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15887 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15888 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15889 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15890 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15891 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15892 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15893 Continuing.
15894 task # 1 running
15895 task # 2 running
15896
15897 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15898 15 flush;
15899 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15900 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15901 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15902 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15903 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15904 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15905 @end smallexample
15906 @end table
15907
15908 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15909 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15910 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15911
15912 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15913 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15914 the platform being used.
15915 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15916 switching is not supported.
15917
15918 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15919 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15920 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15921 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15922 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15923 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15924
15925 @node Ravenscar Profile
15926 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15927 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15928
15929 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15930 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15931 requirements.
15932
15933 @table @code
15934 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15935 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15936 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15937 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15938 Profile. This is the default.
15939
15940 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15941 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15942 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15943 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15944 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15945 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15946 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15947
15948 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15949 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15950 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15951 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15952
15953 @end table
15954
15955 @node Ada Glitches
15956 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15957 @cindex Ada, problems
15958
15959 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15960 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15961 @value{GDBN},
15962 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15963 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15964
15965 @itemize @bullet
15966 @item
15967 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15968 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15969
15970 @item
15971 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15972 argument lists are treated as positional).
15973
15974 @item
15975 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15976
15977 @item
15978 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15979 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15980 the host machine.
15981
15982 @item
15983 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15984 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15985 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15986 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15987 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15988 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15989 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15990 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15991 you can usually resolve the confusion
15992 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15993 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15994 @end itemize
15995
15996 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15997 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15998 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15999 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16000 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16001 enabled.
16002
16003 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16004 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16005 @table @code
16006
16007 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16008 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16009 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16010 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16011 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16012 This is the default.
16013
16014 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16015 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16016 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16017 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16018 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16019 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16020 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16021
16022 @end table
16023
16024 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16025 @cindex GNAT encoding
16026 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16027 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16028 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16029 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16030 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16031 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16032
16033 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16034 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16035 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16036 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16037 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16038 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16039 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16040 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16041
16042 @table @code
16043
16044 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16045 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16046 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16047 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16048
16049 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16050 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16051 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16052
16053 @end table
16054
16055 @node Unsupported Languages
16056 @section Unsupported Languages
16057
16058 @cindex unsupported languages
16059 @cindex minimal language
16060 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16061 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16062 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16063 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16064 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16065 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16066
16067 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16068 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16069 language.
16070
16071 @node Symbols
16072 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16073
16074 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16075 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16076 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16077 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16078 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16079 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16080 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16081
16082 @cindex symbol names
16083 @cindex names of symbols
16084 @cindex quoting names
16085 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16086 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16087 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16088 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16089 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16090 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16091 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16092 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16093
16094 @smallexample
16095 p 'foo.c'::x
16096 @end smallexample
16097
16098 @noindent
16099 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16100
16101 @table @code
16102 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16103 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16104 @kindex set case-sensitive
16105 @item set case-sensitive on
16106 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16107 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16108 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16109 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16110 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16111 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16112 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16113 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16114 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16115 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16116 case-insensitive matches.
16117
16118 @kindex show case-sensitive
16119 @item show case-sensitive
16120 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16121 lookups.
16122
16123 @kindex set print type methods
16124 @item set print type methods
16125 @itemx set print type methods on
16126 @itemx set print type methods off
16127 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16128 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16129 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16130 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16131 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16132 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16133
16134 @kindex show print type methods
16135 @item show print type methods
16136 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16137 classes.
16138
16139 @kindex set print type typedefs
16140 @item set print type typedefs
16141 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16142 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16143
16144 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16145 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16146 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16147 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16148 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16149 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16150 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16151 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16152 types.
16153
16154 @kindex show print type typedefs
16155 @item show print type typedefs
16156 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16157 printing classes.
16158
16159 @kindex info address
16160 @cindex address of a symbol
16161 @item info address @var{symbol}
16162 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16163 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16164 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16165 is always stored.
16166
16167 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16168 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16169 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16170
16171 @kindex info symbol
16172 @cindex symbol from address
16173 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16174 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16175 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16176 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16177 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16178
16179 @smallexample
16180 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16181 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16182 @end smallexample
16183
16184 @noindent
16185 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16186 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16187
16188 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16189 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16190
16191 @smallexample
16192 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16193 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16194 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16195 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16196 @end smallexample
16197
16198 @kindex demangle
16199 @cindex demangle
16200 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16201 Demangle @var{name}.
16202 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16203 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16204
16205 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16206 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16207
16208 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16209 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16210
16211 @kindex whatis
16212 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16213 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16214 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16215 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16216
16217 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16218 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16219 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16220
16221 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16222 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16223 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16224 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16225 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16226 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16227 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16228 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16229 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16230
16231 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16232 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16233 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16234 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16235 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16236 unroll it.
16237
16238 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16239 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16240 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16241
16242 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16243 Available flags are:
16244
16245 @table @code
16246 @item r
16247 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16248 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16249 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16250
16251 @item m
16252 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16253
16254 @item M
16255 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16256 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16257
16258 @item t
16259 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16260 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16261 names are substituted when printing other types.
16262
16263 @item T
16264 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16265 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16266 @end table
16267
16268 @kindex ptype
16269 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16270 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16271 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16272 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16273
16274 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16275 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16276 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16277 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16278 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16279 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16280 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16281 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16282
16283 For example, for this variable declaration:
16284
16285 @smallexample
16286 typedef double real_t;
16287 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16288 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16289 complex_t var;
16290 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16291 @end smallexample
16292
16293 @noindent
16294 the two commands give this output:
16295
16296 @smallexample
16297 @group
16298 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16299 type = complex_t
16300 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16301 type = struct complex @{
16302 real_t real;
16303 double imag;
16304 @}
16305 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16306 type = struct complex
16307 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16308 type = struct complex
16309 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16310 type = struct complex @{
16311 real_t real;
16312 double imag;
16313 @}
16314 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16315 type = real_t *
16316 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16317 type = double *
16318 @end group
16319 @end smallexample
16320
16321 @noindent
16322 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16323 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16324
16325 @cindex incomplete type
16326 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16327 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16328 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16329 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16330 given these declarations:
16331
16332 @smallexample
16333 struct foo;
16334 struct foo *fooptr;
16335 @end smallexample
16336
16337 @noindent
16338 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16339
16340 @smallexample
16341 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16342 $1 = <incomplete type>
16343 @end smallexample
16344
16345 @noindent
16346 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16347 completely specified.
16348
16349 @kindex info types
16350 @item info types @var{regexp}
16351 @itemx info types
16352 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16353 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16354 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16355 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16356 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16357 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16358 name is @code{value}.
16359
16360 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16361 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16362 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16363
16364 @kindex info type-printers
16365 @item info type-printers
16366 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16367 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16368 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16369 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16370 type printers.
16371
16372 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16373
16374 @kindex enable type-printer
16375 @kindex disable type-printer
16376 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16377 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16378 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16379
16380 @kindex info scope
16381 @cindex local variables
16382 @item info scope @var{location}
16383 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16384 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16385 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16386 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16387 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16388
16389 @smallexample
16390 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16391 Scope for command_line_handler:
16392 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16393 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16394 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16395 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16396 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16397 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16398 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16399 @end smallexample
16400
16401 @noindent
16402 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16403 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16404 collect}.
16405
16406 @kindex info source
16407 @item info source
16408 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16409 the function containing the current point of execution:
16410 @itemize @bullet
16411 @item
16412 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16413 @item
16414 the directory it was compiled in,
16415 @item
16416 its length, in lines,
16417 @item
16418 which programming language it is written in,
16419 @item
16420 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16421 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16422 @item
16423 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16424 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16425 @item
16426 whether the debugging information includes information about
16427 preprocessor macros.
16428 @end itemize
16429
16430
16431 @kindex info sources
16432 @item info sources
16433 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16434 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16435 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16436
16437 @kindex info functions
16438 @item info functions
16439 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16440
16441 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16442 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16443 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16444 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16445 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16446 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16447 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16448 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16449
16450 @kindex info variables
16451 @item info variables
16452 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16453 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16454
16455 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16456 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16457 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16458 @var{regexp}.
16459
16460 @kindex info classes
16461 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16462 @item info classes
16463 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16464 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16465 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16466 expression.
16467
16468 @kindex info selectors
16469 @item info selectors
16470 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16471 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16472 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16473 expression.
16474
16475 @ignore
16476 This was never implemented.
16477 @kindex info methods
16478 @item info methods
16479 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16480 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16481 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16482 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16483 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16484 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16485 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16486 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16487 @end ignore
16488
16489 @cindex opaque data types
16490 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16491 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16492 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16493 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16494 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16495 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16496 another source file. The default is on.
16497
16498 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16499 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16500
16501 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16502 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16503 is printed as follows:
16504 @smallexample
16505 @{<no data fields>@}
16506 @end smallexample
16507
16508 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16509 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16510 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16511
16512 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16513 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16514 @item set print symbol-loading
16515 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16516 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16517 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16518 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16519 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16520 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16521 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16522 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16523 can be annoying.
16524 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16525 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16526 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16527 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16528
16529 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16530 @item show print symbol-loading
16531 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16532 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16533
16534 @kindex maint print symbols
16535 @cindex symbol dump
16536 @kindex maint print psymbols
16537 @cindex partial symbol dump
16538 @kindex maint print msymbols
16539 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16540 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16541 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16542 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16543 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16544 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16545 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16546 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16547 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16548 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16549 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16550 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16551 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16552 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16553 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16554 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16555 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16556 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16557
16558 @kindex maint info symtabs
16559 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16560 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16561 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16562 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16563 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16564 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16565 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16566
16567 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16568 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16569 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16570 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16571 structure in more detail. For example:
16572
16573 @smallexample
16574 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16575 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16576 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16577 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16578 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16579 readin no
16580 fullname (null)
16581 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16582 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16583 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16584 dependencies (none)
16585 @}
16586 @}
16587 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16588 (@value{GDBP})
16589 @end smallexample
16590 @noindent
16591 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16592 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16593 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16594 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16595 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16596
16597 @smallexample
16598 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16599 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16600 line 1574.
16601 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16602 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16603 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16604 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16605 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16606 dirname (null)
16607 fullname (null)
16608 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16609 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16610 debugformat DWARF 2
16611 @}
16612 @}
16613 (@value{GDBP})
16614 @end smallexample
16615
16616 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16617 @cindex symbol cache size
16618 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16619 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16620 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16621 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16622 with different sizes.
16623
16624 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16625 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16626 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16627
16628 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16629 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16630 @item maint print symbol-cache
16631 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16632 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16633
16634 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16635 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16636 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16637 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16638 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16639
16640 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16641 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16642 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16643 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16644 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16645 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16646
16647 @end table
16648
16649 @node Altering
16650 @chapter Altering Execution
16651
16652 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16653 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16654 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16655 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16656 program.
16657
16658 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16659 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16660 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16661
16662 @menu
16663 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16664 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16665 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16666 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16667 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16668 * Patching:: Patching your program
16669 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16670 @end menu
16671
16672 @node Assignment
16673 @section Assignment to Variables
16674
16675 @cindex assignment
16676 @cindex setting variables
16677 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16678 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16679
16680 @smallexample
16681 print x=4
16682 @end smallexample
16683
16684 @noindent
16685 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16686 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16687 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16688 information on operators in supported languages.
16689
16690 @kindex set variable
16691 @cindex variables, setting
16692 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16693 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16694 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16695 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16696 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16697
16698 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16699 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16700 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16701 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16702 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16703 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16704 command @code{set width}:
16705
16706 @smallexample
16707 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16708 type = double
16709 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16710 $4 = 13
16711 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16712 Invalid syntax in expression.
16713 @end smallexample
16714
16715 @noindent
16716 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16717 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16718
16719 @smallexample
16720 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16721 @end smallexample
16722
16723 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16724 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16725 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16726 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16727 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16728 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16729
16730 @smallexample
16731 @group
16732 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16733 type = double
16734 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16735 $1 = 1
16736 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16737 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16738 $2 = 1
16739 (@value{GDBP}) r
16740 The program being debugged has been started already.
16741 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16742 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16743 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16744 Invalid bfd target.
16745 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16746 The current BFD target is "=4".
16747 @end group
16748 @end smallexample
16749
16750 @noindent
16751 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16752 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16753 @code{g}, use
16754
16755 @smallexample
16756 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16757 @end smallexample
16758
16759 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16760 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16761 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16762 same length or shorter.
16763 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16764 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16765
16766 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16767 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16768 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16769 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16770 and representation in memory), and
16771
16772 @smallexample
16773 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16774 @end smallexample
16775
16776 @noindent
16777 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16778
16779 @node Jumping
16780 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16781
16782 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16783 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16784 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16785
16786 @table @code
16787 @kindex jump
16788 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16789 @item jump @var{linespec}
16790 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16791 @itemx jump @var{location}
16792 @itemx j @var{location}
16793 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16794 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16795 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16796 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16797 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16798 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16799
16800 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16801 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16802 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16803 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16804 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16805 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16806 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16807 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16808 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16809 @end table
16810
16811 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16812 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16813 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16814 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16815 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16816 example,
16817
16818 @smallexample
16819 set $pc = 0x485
16820 @end smallexample
16821
16822 @noindent
16823 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16824 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16825 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16826
16827 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16828 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16829 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16830 detail.
16831
16832 @c @group
16833 @node Signaling
16834 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16835 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16836
16837 @table @code
16838 @kindex signal
16839 @item signal @var{signal}
16840 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16841 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16842 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16843 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16844
16845 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16846 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16847 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16848 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16849 signal.
16850
16851 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16852 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16853 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16854 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16855 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16856 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16857 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16858 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16859
16860 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16861 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16862 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16863 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16864 passes the signal directly to your program.
16865
16866 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16867 after executing the command.
16868
16869 @kindex queue-signal
16870 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16871 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16872 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16873 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16874 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16875 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16876 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16877 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16878 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16879
16880 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16881 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16882 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16883 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16884 @code{continue} command.
16885
16886 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16887 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16888 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16889 (@pxref{Signals}).
16890 @end table
16891 @c @end group
16892
16893 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16894 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16895
16896 @node Returning
16897 @section Returning from a Function
16898
16899 @table @code
16900 @cindex returning from a function
16901 @kindex return
16902 @item return
16903 @itemx return @var{expression}
16904 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16905 command. If you give an
16906 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16907 value.
16908 @end table
16909
16910 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16911 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16912 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16913 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16914
16915 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16916 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16917 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16918 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16919 of functions.
16920
16921 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16922 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16923 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16924 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16925 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16926
16927 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16928 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16929 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16930 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16931 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16932 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16933 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16934 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16935 assignment into the right register(s).
16936
16937 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16938 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16939 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16940 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16941 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16942 into a @code{long long int}:
16943
16944 @smallexample
16945 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16946 29 return 31;
16947 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16948 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16949 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16950 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16951 (@value{GDBP})
16952 @end smallexample
16953
16954 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16955 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16956 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16957 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16958 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16959 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16960 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16961 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16962
16963 @smallexample
16964 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16965 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16966 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16967 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16968 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16969 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16970 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16971 (@value{GDBP})
16972 @end smallexample
16973
16974 @node Calling
16975 @section Calling Program Functions
16976
16977 @table @code
16978 @cindex calling functions
16979 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16980 @item print @var{expr}
16981 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16982 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16983 debugged.
16984
16985 @kindex call
16986 @item call @var{expr}
16987 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16988 returned values.
16989
16990 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16991 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16992 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16993 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16994 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16995 value history.
16996 @end table
16997
16998 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16999 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17000 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17001 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17002
17003 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17004 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17005 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17006 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17007 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17008 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17009 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17010 in that case is controlled by the
17011 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17012
17013 @table @code
17014 @item set unwindonsignal
17015 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17016 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17017 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17018 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17019 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17020 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17021 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17022 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17023 received.
17024
17025 @item show unwindonsignal
17026 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17027 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17028 @value{GDBN}.
17029
17030 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17031 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17032 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17033 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17034 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17035 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17036 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17037 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17038 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17039 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17040
17041 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17042 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17043 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17044 @value{GDBN}.
17045
17046 @end table
17047
17048 @cindex weak alias functions
17049 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17050 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17051 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17052 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17053 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17054 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17055 function instead.
17056
17057 @node Patching
17058 @section Patching Programs
17059
17060 @cindex patching binaries
17061 @cindex writing into executables
17062 @cindex writing into corefiles
17063
17064 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17065 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17066 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17067 patching your program's binary.
17068
17069 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17070 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17071 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17072 repairs.
17073
17074 @table @code
17075 @kindex set write
17076 @item set write on
17077 @itemx set write off
17078 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17079 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17080 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17081
17082 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17083 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17084 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17085
17086 @item show write
17087 @kindex show write
17088 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17089 as well as reading.
17090 @end table
17091
17092 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17093 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17094 @cindex injecting code
17095 @cindex writing into executables
17096 @cindex compiling code
17097
17098 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17099 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17100 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17101 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17102
17103 @table @code
17104 @kindex compile code
17105 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17106 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17107 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17108 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17109 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17110 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17111 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17112 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17113 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17114 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17115 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17116 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17117
17118 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17119 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17120 E.g.:
17121
17122 @smallexample
17123 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17124 @end smallexample
17125
17126 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17127 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17128 from actual source code. E.g.:
17129
17130 @smallexample
17131 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17132 @end smallexample
17133
17134 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17135 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17136 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17137 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17138 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17139 editor.
17140
17141 @smallexample
17142 compile code
17143 >printf ("hello\n");
17144 >printf ("world\n");
17145 >end
17146 @end smallexample
17147
17148 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17149 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17150 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17151 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17152 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17153 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17154 inferior symbols otherwise.
17155
17156 @kindex compile file
17157 @item compile file @var{filename}
17158 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17159 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17160
17161 @smallexample
17162 compile file /home/user/example.c
17163 @end smallexample
17164 @end table
17165
17166 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17167
17168 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17169 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17170 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17171
17172 @table @asis
17173 @item C code examples and caveats
17174 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17175 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17176 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17177 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17178 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17179
17180 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17181 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17182 much like any other normal debugging session.
17183
17184 @smallexample
17185 void function1 (void)
17186 @{
17187 int i = 42;
17188 printf ("function 1\n");
17189 @}
17190
17191 void function2 (void)
17192 @{
17193 int j = 12;
17194 function1 ();
17195 @}
17196
17197 int main(void)
17198 @{
17199 int k = 6;
17200 int *p;
17201 function2 ();
17202 return 0;
17203 @}
17204 @end smallexample
17205
17206 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17207 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17208 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17209
17210 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17211 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17212 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17213 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17214 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17215
17216 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17217 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17218 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17219 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17220 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17221 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17222 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17223 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17224 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17225 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17226
17227 @smallexample
17228 compile code k = 3;
17229 @end smallexample
17230
17231 @noindent
17232 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17233 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17234 @code{compile} command changes it.
17235
17236 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17237 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17238 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17239 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17240 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17241
17242 @smallexample
17243 compile code j = 3;
17244 @end smallexample
17245
17246 @noindent
17247 will result in a compilation error message.
17248
17249 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17250 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17251 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17252
17253 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17254 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17255 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17256 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17257
17258 @smallexample
17259 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17260 @end smallexample
17261
17262 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17263 command has completed:
17264
17265 @smallexample
17266 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17267 @end smallexample
17268
17269 @noindent
17270 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17271 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17272 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17273 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17274 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17275
17276 @smallexample
17277 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17278 @end smallexample
17279
17280 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17281 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17282 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17283 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17284 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17285 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17286 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17287 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17288
17289 @smallexample
17290 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17291 @end smallexample
17292
17293 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17294 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17295 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17296 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17297 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17298 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17299 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17300
17301 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17302 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17303 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17304 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17305 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17306 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17307
17308 @smallexample
17309 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17310 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17311 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17312 Compilation failed.
17313 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17314 42
17315 @end smallexample
17316
17317 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17318 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17319 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17320 will print to the console.
17321 @end table
17322
17323 @node GDB Files
17324 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17325
17326 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17327 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17328 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17329 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17330
17331 @menu
17332 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17333 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17334 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17335 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17336 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17337 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17338 @end menu
17339
17340 @node Files
17341 @section Commands to Specify Files
17342
17343 @cindex symbol table
17344 @cindex core dump file
17345
17346 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17347 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17348 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17349 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17350
17351 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17352 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17353 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17354 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17355 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17356 new files are useful.
17357
17358 @table @code
17359 @cindex executable file
17360 @kindex file
17361 @item file @var{filename}
17362 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17363 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17364 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17365 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17366 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17367 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17368 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17369 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17370
17371 @cindex unlinked object files
17372 @cindex patching object files
17373 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17374 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17375 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17376 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17377 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17378 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17379 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17380 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17381
17382 @item file
17383 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17384 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17385
17386 @kindex exec-file
17387 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17388 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17389 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17390 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17391 discard information on the executable file.
17392
17393 @kindex symbol-file
17394 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17395 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17396 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17397 table and program to run from the same file.
17398
17399 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17400 program's symbol table.
17401
17402 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17403 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17404 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17405 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17406 @value{GDBN}.
17407
17408 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17409 executing it once.
17410
17411 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17412 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17413 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17414 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17415 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17416 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17417 optimized code.
17418
17419 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17420 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17421 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17422 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17423 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17424
17425 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17426 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17427 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17428 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17429 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17430 Warnings and Messages}.)
17431
17432 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17433 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17434 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17435 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17436 in stabs format.
17437
17438 @kindex readnow
17439 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17440 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17441 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17442 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17443 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17444 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17445 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17446 entire symbol table available.
17447
17448 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17449 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17450 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17451 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17452 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17453 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17454 @c files.
17455
17456 @kindex core-file
17457 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17458 @itemx core
17459 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17460 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17461 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17462 executable file itself for other parts.
17463
17464 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17465 to be used.
17466
17467 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17468 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17469 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17470 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17471 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17472
17473 @kindex add-symbol-file
17474 @cindex dynamic linking
17475 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17476 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17477 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17478 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17479 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17480 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17481 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17482 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17483 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17484 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17485 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17486 @var{address} as an expression.
17487
17488 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17489 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17490 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17491 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17492
17493 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17494
17495 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17496 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17497 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17498 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17499 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17500 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17501 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17502 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17503 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17504
17505 @itemize @bullet
17506 @item
17507 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17508 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17509 @item
17510 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17511 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17512 @item
17513 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17514 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17515 @end itemize
17516
17517 @noindent
17518 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17519 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17520 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17521 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17522 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17523 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17524 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17525 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17526 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17527 way.
17528
17529 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17530
17531 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17532 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17533 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17534 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17535 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17536 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17537
17538 @smallexample
17539 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17540 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17541 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17542 (y or n) y
17543 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17544 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17545 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17546 (gdb)
17547 @end smallexample
17548
17549
17550 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17551
17552 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17553 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17554 @cindex load symbols from memory
17555 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17556 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17557 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17558 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17559 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17560 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17561 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17562 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17563 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17564
17565 @kindex section
17566 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17567 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17568 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17569 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17570 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17571 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17572 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17573 their addresses.
17574
17575 @kindex info files
17576 @kindex info target
17577 @item info files
17578 @itemx info target
17579 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17580 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17581 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17582 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17583 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17584 current ones.
17585
17586 @kindex maint info sections
17587 @item maint info sections
17588 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17589 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17590 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17591 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17592 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17593 may be arbitrarily combined):
17594
17595 @table @code
17596 @item ALLOBJ
17597 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17598 @item @var{sections}
17599 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17600 @item @var{section-flags}
17601 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17602 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17603 @table @code
17604 @item ALLOC
17605 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17606 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17607 @item LOAD
17608 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17609 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17610 @item RELOC
17611 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17612 @item READONLY
17613 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17614 @item CODE
17615 Section contains executable code only.
17616 @item DATA
17617 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17618 @item ROM
17619 Section will reside in ROM.
17620 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17621 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17622 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17623 Section is not empty.
17624 @item NEVER_LOAD
17625 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17626 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17627 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17628 COFF shared library information.
17629 @item IS_COMMON
17630 Section contains common symbols.
17631 @end table
17632 @end table
17633 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17634 @cindex read-only sections
17635 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17636 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17637 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17638 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17639 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17640 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17641 enhancement to debugging performance.
17642
17643 The default is off.
17644
17645 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17646 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17647 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17648 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17649
17650 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17651 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17652 @end table
17653
17654 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17655 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17656 name and remembers it that way.
17657
17658 @cindex shared libraries
17659 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17660 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17661 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17662
17663 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17664 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17665
17666 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17667 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17668 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17669 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17670 debugging a core file).
17671
17672 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17673 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17674
17675 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17676 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17677 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17678
17679 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17680 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17681 particularly large or there are many of them.
17682
17683 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17684 commands:
17685
17686 @table @code
17687 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17688 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17689 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17690 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17691 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17692 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17693 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17694 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17695
17696 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17697 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17698 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17699 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17700 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17701 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17702 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17703 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17704 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17705
17706 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17707 @item show auto-solib-add
17708 Display the current autoloading mode.
17709 @end table
17710
17711 @cindex load shared library
17712 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17713 command:
17714
17715 @table @code
17716 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17717 @kindex info share
17718 @item info share @var{regex}
17719 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17720 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17721 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17722 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17723
17724 @kindex sharedlibrary
17725 @kindex share
17726 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17727 @itemx share @var{regex}
17728 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17729 Unix regular expression.
17730 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17731 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17732 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17733 loaded.
17734
17735 @item nosharedlibrary
17736 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17737 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17738 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17739 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17740 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17741 discarded.
17742 @end table
17743
17744 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17745 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17746 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17747 Catchpoints}).
17748
17749 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17750 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17751 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17752 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17753
17754 @table @code
17755 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17756 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17757 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17758 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17759 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17760 shared library.
17761
17762 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17763 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17764 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17765 library events happen.
17766 @end table
17767
17768 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17769 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17770 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17771 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17772 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17773 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17774 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17775 not.
17776
17777 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17778 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17779 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17780 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17781 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17782
17783 @table @code
17784 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17785 @cindex system root, alternate
17786 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17787 @kindex set sysroot
17788 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17789 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17790 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17791 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17792 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17793 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17794 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17795 under @var{path}.
17796
17797 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17798 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17799 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17800 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17801 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17802 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17803 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17804 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17805 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17806
17807 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17808 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17809 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17810 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17811 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17812
17813 @smallexample
17814 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17815 @end smallexample
17816
17817 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17818 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17819 system:
17820
17821 @smallexample
17822 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17823 @end smallexample
17824
17825 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17826 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17827 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17828 colons:
17829
17830 @smallexample
17831 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17832 @end smallexample
17833
17834 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17835 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17836 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17837 @samp{z}):
17838
17839 @smallexample
17840 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17841 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17842 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17843 @end smallexample
17844
17845 @noindent
17846 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17847 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17848 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17849
17850 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17851 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17852
17853 @smallexample
17854 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17855 @end smallexample
17856
17857 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17858 if you don't want or need to.
17859
17860 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17861 sysroot}.
17862
17863 @cindex default system root
17864 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17865 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17866 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17867 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17868 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17869 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17870 location.
17871
17872 @kindex show sysroot
17873 @item show sysroot
17874 Display the current shared library prefix.
17875
17876 @kindex set solib-search-path
17877 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17878 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17879 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17880 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17881 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17882 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17883 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17884 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17885 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17886 of shared library symbols.
17887
17888 @kindex show solib-search-path
17889 @item show solib-search-path
17890 Display the current shared library search path.
17891
17892 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17893 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17894 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17895 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17896 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17897
17898 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17899 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17900 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17901 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17902 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17903 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17904 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17905 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17906 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17907 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17908 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17909 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17910 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17911 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17912 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17913 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17914 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17915 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17916 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17917 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17918 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17919 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17920
17921 @table @code
17922 @item unix
17923 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17924 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17925 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17926 the forward slash.
17927
17928 @item dos-based
17929 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17930 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17931 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17932 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17933 considered directory separators.
17934
17935 @item auto
17936 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17937 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17938 This is the default.
17939 @end table
17940 @end table
17941
17942 @cindex file name canonicalization
17943 @cindex base name differences
17944 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17945 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17946 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17947 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17948 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17949 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17950 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17951 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17952 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17953 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17954 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17955 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17956 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17957 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17958 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17959
17960 @table @code
17961 @item set basenames-may-differ
17962 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17963 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17964
17965 @item show basenames-may-differ
17966 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17967 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17968 @end table
17969
17970 @node Separate Debug Files
17971 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17972 @cindex separate debugging information files
17973 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17974 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17975 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17976 @cindex global debugging information directories
17977 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17978 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17979
17980 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17981 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17982 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17983 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17984 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17985 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17986 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17987
17988 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17989 file:
17990
17991 @itemize @bullet
17992 @item
17993 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17994 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17995 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17996 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17997 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17998 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17999 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18000 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18001
18002 @item
18003 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18004 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18005 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
18006 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18007 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18008 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18009 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18010 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18011 below.
18012 @end itemize
18013
18014 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18015 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18016
18017 @itemize @bullet
18018 @item
18019 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18020 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18021 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18022 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18023 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18024
18025 @item
18026 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18027 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18028 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18029 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18030 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18031 hex characters, not 10.)
18032 @end itemize
18033
18034 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18035 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18036 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18037 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18038 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18039 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18040
18041 @itemize @minus
18042 @item
18043 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18044 @item
18045 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18046 @item
18047 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18048 @item
18049 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18050 @end itemize
18051
18052 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18053 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18054 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18055 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18056 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18057
18058 @table @code
18059
18060 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18061 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18062 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18063 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18064 concatenating them by a path separator.
18065
18066 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18067 @item show debug-file-directory
18068 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18069 information files.
18070
18071 @end table
18072
18073 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18074 @cindex debug link sections
18075 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18076 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18077
18078 @itemize
18079 @item
18080 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18081 a zero byte,
18082 @item
18083 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18084 boundary within the section, and
18085 @item
18086 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18087 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18088 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18089 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18090 @end itemize
18091
18092 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18093 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18094 described above.
18095
18096 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18097 @cindex build ID sections
18098 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18099 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18100 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18101 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18102 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18103 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18104 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18105 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18106 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18107
18108 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18109 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18110 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18111 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18112 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18113 in an ordinary executable.
18114
18115 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18116 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18117 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18118 following commands:
18119
18120 @smallexample
18121 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18122 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18123 @end smallexample
18124
18125 @noindent
18126 These commands remove the debugging
18127 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18128 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18129 two files:
18130
18131 @itemize @bullet
18132 @item
18133 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18134 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18135
18136 @smallexample
18137 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18138 @end smallexample
18139
18140 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18141 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18142 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18143 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18144
18145 @item
18146 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18147 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18148 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18149 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18150 @end itemize
18151
18152 @noindent
18153
18154 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18155 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18156 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18157
18158 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18159 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18160 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18161 @c different ways!
18162 @ifhtml
18163 @display
18164 @html
18165 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18166 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18167 @end html
18168 @end display
18169 @end ifhtml
18170 @ifnothtml
18171 @display
18172 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18173 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18174 @end display
18175 @end ifnothtml
18176
18177 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18178 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18179 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18180 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18181 CRC.
18182
18183 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18184 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18185 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18186 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18187 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18188
18189 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18190 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18191 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18192 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18193 @code{0xffffffff}.
18194
18195 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18196 @smallexample
18197 unsigned long
18198 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18199 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18200 @{
18201 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18202 @{
18203 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18204 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18205 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18206 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18207 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18208 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18209 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18210 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18211 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18212 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18213 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18214 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18215 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18216 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18217 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18218 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18219 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18220 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18221 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18222 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18223 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18224 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18225 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18226 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18227 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18228 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18229 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18230 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18231 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18232 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18233 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18234 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18235 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18236 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18237 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18238 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18239 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18240 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18241 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18242 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18243 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18244 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18245 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18246 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18247 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18248 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18249 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18250 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18251 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18252 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18253 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18254 0x2d02ef8d
18255 @};
18256 unsigned char *end;
18257
18258 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18259 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18260 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18261 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18262 @}
18263 @end smallexample
18264
18265 @noindent
18266 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18267
18268 @node MiniDebugInfo
18269 @section Debugging information in a special section
18270 @cindex separate debug sections
18271 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18272
18273 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18274 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18275 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18276 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18277
18278 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18279 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18280 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18281 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18282 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18283 debugging information might be included in the section.
18284
18285 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18286 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18287 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18288
18289 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18290 standard utilities:
18291
18292 @smallexample
18293 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18294 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18295 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18296 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18297
18298 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18299 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18300 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18301 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18302 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18303 | sort > funcsyms
18304
18305 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18306 # table.
18307 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18308
18309 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18310 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18311
18312 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18313 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18314 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18315 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18316
18317 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18318 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18319
18320 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18321 # original binary.
18322 xz mini_debuginfo
18323 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18324 @end smallexample
18325
18326 @node Index Files
18327 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18328 @cindex index files
18329 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18330
18331 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18332 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18333 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18334 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18335 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18336 startup.
18337
18338 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18339 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18340 using @command{objcopy}.
18341
18342 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18343
18344 @table @code
18345 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18346 @kindex save gdb-index
18347 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18348 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18349 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18350 @var{directory}.
18351 @end table
18352
18353 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18354 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18355
18356 @smallexample
18357 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18358 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18359 @end smallexample
18360
18361 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18362 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18363 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18364 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18365 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18366 The default is @code{off}.
18367 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18368 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18369
18370 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18371 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18372
18373 @smallexample
18374 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18375 @end smallexample
18376
18377 Instead you must do, for example,
18378
18379 @smallexample
18380 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18381 @end smallexample
18382
18383 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18384 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18385 currently work for programs using Ada.
18386
18387 @node Symbol Errors
18388 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18389
18390 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18391 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18392 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18393 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18394 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18395 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18396 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18397 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18398 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18399 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18400 Messages}).
18401
18402 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18403
18404 @table @code
18405 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18406
18407 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18408 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18409 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18410 in its outer scope blocks.
18411
18412 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18413 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18414 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18415 function.
18416
18417 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18418
18419 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18420 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18421 do so.
18422
18423 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18424 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18425 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18426 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18427 Messages}.)
18428
18429 @item bad block start address patched
18430
18431 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18432 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18433 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18434
18435 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18436 starting on the previous source line.
18437
18438 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18439
18440 @cindex foo
18441 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18442 larger than the size of the string table.
18443
18444 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18445 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18446 with this name.
18447
18448 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18449
18450 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18451 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18452 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18453
18454 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18455 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18456 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18457 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18458 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18459 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18460
18461 @item stub type has NULL name
18462
18463 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18464
18465 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18466 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18467 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18468 it.
18469
18470 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18471
18472 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18473
18474 @end table
18475
18476 @node Data Files
18477 @section GDB Data Files
18478
18479 @cindex prefix for data files
18480 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18481 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18482
18483 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18484 is currently using.
18485
18486 @table @code
18487 @kindex set data-directory
18488 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18489 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18490 to @var{directory}.
18491
18492 @kindex show data-directory
18493 @item show data-directory
18494 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18495 @end table
18496
18497 @cindex default data directory
18498 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18499 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18500 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18501 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18502 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18503 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18504 location.
18505
18506 The data directory may also be specified with the
18507 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18508 @xref{Mode Options}.
18509
18510 @node Targets
18511 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18512
18513 @cindex debugging target
18514 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18515
18516 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18517 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18518 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18519 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18520 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18521 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18522 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18523 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18524
18525 @cindex target architecture
18526 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18527 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18528 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18529 command.
18530
18531 @table @code
18532 @kindex set architecture
18533 @kindex show architecture
18534 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18535 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18536 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18537 supported architectures.
18538
18539 @item show architecture
18540 Show the current target architecture.
18541
18542 @item set processor
18543 @itemx processor
18544 @kindex set processor
18545 @kindex show processor
18546 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18547 and @code{show architecture}.
18548 @end table
18549
18550 @menu
18551 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18552 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18553 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18554 @end menu
18555
18556 @node Active Targets
18557 @section Active Targets
18558
18559 @cindex stacking targets
18560 @cindex active targets
18561 @cindex multiple targets
18562
18563 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18564 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18565 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18566 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18567 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18568 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18569 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18570 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18571 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18572
18573 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18574 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18575 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18576 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18577
18578 @node Target Commands
18579 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18580
18581 @table @code
18582 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18583 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18584 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18585 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18586 protocol of the target machine.
18587
18588 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18589 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18590 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18591
18592 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18593 after executing the command.
18594
18595 @kindex help target
18596 @item help target
18597 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18598 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18599 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18600
18601 @item help target @var{name}
18602 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18603 select it.
18604
18605 @kindex set gnutarget
18606 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18607 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18608 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18609 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18610 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18611 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18612
18613 @quotation
18614 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18615 you must know the actual BFD name.
18616 @end quotation
18617
18618 @noindent
18619 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18620
18621 @kindex show gnutarget
18622 @item show gnutarget
18623 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18624 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18625 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18626 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18627 @end table
18628
18629 @cindex common targets
18630 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18631 configuration):
18632
18633 @table @code
18634 @kindex target
18635 @item target exec @var{program}
18636 @cindex executable file target
18637 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18638 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18639
18640 @item target core @var{filename}
18641 @cindex core dump file target
18642 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18643 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18644
18645 @item target remote @var{medium}
18646 @cindex remote target
18647 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18648 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18649 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18650
18651 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18652 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18653
18654 @smallexample
18655 target remote /dev/ttya
18656 @end smallexample
18657
18658 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18659 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18660 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18661 clobbered by the download.
18662
18663 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18664 @cindex built-in simulator target
18665 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18666 In general,
18667 @smallexample
18668 target sim
18669 load
18670 run
18671 @end smallexample
18672 @noindent
18673 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18674 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18675 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18676 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18677 Processors}.
18678
18679 @item target native
18680 @cindex native target
18681 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18682 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18683 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18684 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18685
18686 @end table
18687
18688 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18689 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18690
18691 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18692 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18693 various aspects of this process.
18694
18695 @table @code
18696
18697 @item set hash
18698 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18699 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18700 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18701 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18702 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18703 monitor.
18704
18705 @item show hash
18706 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18707 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18708
18709 @item set debug monitor
18710 @kindex set debug monitor
18711 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18712 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18713 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18714
18715 @item show debug monitor
18716 @kindex show debug monitor
18717 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18718 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18719 @end table
18720
18721 @table @code
18722
18723 @kindex load @var{filename}
18724 @item load @var{filename}
18725 @anchor{load}
18726 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18727 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18728 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18729 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18730 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18731 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18732
18733 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18734 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18735 target is @dots{}}''
18736
18737 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18738 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18739 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18740 specifies a fixed address.
18741 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18742
18743 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18744 load programs into flash memory.
18745
18746 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18747 @end table
18748
18749 @node Byte Order
18750 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18751
18752 @cindex choosing target byte order
18753 @cindex target byte order
18754
18755 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18756 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18757 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18758 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18759 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18760 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18761
18762 @table @code
18763 @kindex set endian
18764 @item set endian big
18765 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18766
18767 @item set endian little
18768 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18769
18770 @item set endian auto
18771 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18772 executable.
18773
18774 @item show endian
18775 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18776
18777 @end table
18778
18779 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18780 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18781 target system.
18782
18783
18784 @node Remote Debugging
18785 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18786 @cindex remote debugging
18787
18788 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18789 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18790 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18791 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18792 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18793
18794 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18795 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18796 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18797 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18798 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18799 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18800
18801 Other remote targets may be available in your
18802 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18803
18804 @menu
18805 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18806 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18807 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18808 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18809 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18810 @end menu
18811
18812 @node Connecting
18813 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18814
18815 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18816 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18817 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18818 program as the first argument.
18819
18820 @cindex @code{target remote}
18821 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18822 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18823 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18824 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18825 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18826 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18827
18828 @table @code
18829
18830 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18831 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18832 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18833 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18834
18835 @smallexample
18836 target remote /dev/ttyb
18837 @end smallexample
18838
18839 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18840 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18841 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18842 @code{target} command.
18843
18844 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18845 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18846 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18847 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18848 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18849 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18850 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18851 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18852 target.
18853
18854 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18855 @code{manyfarms}:
18856
18857 @smallexample
18858 target remote manyfarms:2828
18859 @end smallexample
18860
18861 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18862 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18863 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18864 port 1234 on your local machine:
18865
18866 @smallexample
18867 target remote :1234
18868 @end smallexample
18869 @noindent
18870
18871 Note that the colon is still required here.
18872
18873 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18874 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18875 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18876 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18877
18878 @smallexample
18879 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18880 @end smallexample
18881
18882 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18883 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18884 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18885 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18886
18887 @item target remote | @var{command}
18888 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18889 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18890 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18891 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18892 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18893 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18894 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18895 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18896
18897 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18898 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18899 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18900
18901 @end table
18902
18903 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18904 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18905 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18906 need to use @kbd{run}.
18907
18908 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18909 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18910 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18911 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18912 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18913 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18914 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18915
18916 @smallexample
18917 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18918 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18919 @end smallexample
18920
18921 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18922 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18923 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18924 goes back to waiting.
18925
18926 @table @code
18927 @kindex detach (remote)
18928 @item detach
18929 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18930 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18931 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18932 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18933 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18934
18935 @kindex disconnect
18936 @item disconnect
18937 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18938 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18939 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18940 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18941 another target.
18942
18943 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18944 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18945 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18946 @kindex monitor
18947 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18948 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18949 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18950 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18951 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18952 and implement.
18953 @end table
18954
18955 @node File Transfer
18956 @section Sending files to a remote system
18957 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18958 @cindex file transfer
18959 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18960
18961 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18962 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18963 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18964 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18965 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18966 the only way to upload or download files.
18967
18968 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18969
18970 @table @code
18971 @kindex remote put
18972 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18973 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18974 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18975
18976 @kindex remote get
18977 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18978 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18979 on the host system.
18980
18981 @kindex remote delete
18982 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18983 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18984
18985 @end table
18986
18987 @node Server
18988 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18989
18990 @kindex gdbserver
18991 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18992 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18993 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18994 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18995
18996 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18997 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18998 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18999 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19000 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19001 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19002 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19003 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19004 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19005 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19006 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19007 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19008 choice for debugging.
19009
19010 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19011 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19012 protocol.
19013
19014 @quotation
19015 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19016 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19017 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19018 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19019 @code{gdbserver}.
19020 @end quotation
19021
19022 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19023 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19024 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19025
19026 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19027 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19028 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19029 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19030 system does all the symbol handling.
19031
19032 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19033 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19034 syntax is:
19035
19036 @smallexample
19037 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19038 @end smallexample
19039
19040 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19041 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19042 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19043 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19044 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19045 @file{/dev/com1}:
19046
19047 @smallexample
19048 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19049 @end smallexample
19050
19051 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19052 with it.
19053
19054 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19055
19056 @smallexample
19057 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19058 @end smallexample
19059
19060 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19061 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19062 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19063 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19064 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19065 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19066 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19067 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19068 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19069 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19070 @code{target remote} command.
19071
19072 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19073 with ssh:
19074
19075 @smallexample
19076 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19077 @end smallexample
19078
19079 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19080 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19081 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19082 You could elide it if you want to.
19083
19084 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19085 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19086 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19087 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19088
19089 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19090 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19091 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19092
19093 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19094 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19095
19096 @smallexample
19097 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19098 @end smallexample
19099
19100 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19101 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19102
19103 @pindex pidof
19104 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19105 @code{pidof} utility:
19106
19107 @smallexample
19108 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19109 @end smallexample
19110
19111 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19112 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19113 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19114
19115 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19116 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19117 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19118
19119 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19120 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19121 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19122 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19123
19124 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19125 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19126 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19127 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19128 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19129 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19130 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19131 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19132 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19133
19134 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19135 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19136 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19137 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19138 the program you want to debug.
19139
19140 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19141 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19142 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19143 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19144 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19145 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19146
19147 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19148
19149 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19150
19151 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19152 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19153 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19154 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19155 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19156 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19157 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19158 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19159
19160 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19161 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19162 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19163
19164 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19165 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19166 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19167 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19168 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19169 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19170 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19171 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19172 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19173 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19174 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19175 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19176
19177 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19178 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19179
19180 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19181 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19182 status information about the debugging process.
19183 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19184 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19185 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19186 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19187
19188 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19189 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19190 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19191 Possible options are:
19192
19193 @table @code
19194 @item none
19195 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19196 @item all
19197 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19198 @item timestamps
19199 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19200 @end table
19201
19202 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19203 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19204
19205 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19206 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19207 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19208 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19209 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19210
19211 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19212 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19213 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19214 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19215
19216 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19217 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19218 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19219 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19220
19221 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19222 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19223 environment:
19224
19225 @smallexample
19226 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19227 @end smallexample
19228
19229 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19230
19231 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19232
19233 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19234 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19235 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19236 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19237
19238 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19239 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19240 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19241 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19242 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19243 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19244 programs.
19245
19246 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19247 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19248 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19249 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19250 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19251 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19252 already on the target.
19253
19254 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19255 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19256 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19257
19258 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19259 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19260 Here are the available commands.
19261
19262 @table @code
19263 @item monitor help
19264 List the available monitor commands.
19265
19266 @item monitor set debug 0
19267 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19268 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19269
19270 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19271 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19272 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19273 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19274
19275 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19276 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19277 Possible options are:
19278
19279 @table @code
19280 @item none
19281 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19282 @item all
19283 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19284 @item timestamps
19285 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19286 @end table
19287
19288 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19289 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19290
19291 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19292 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19293 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19294 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19295 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19296 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19297
19298 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19299 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19300
19301 @item monitor exit
19302 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19303 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19304 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19305 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19306 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19307
19308 @end table
19309
19310 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19311 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19312
19313 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19314 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19315
19316 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19317 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19318 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19319 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19320 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19321 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19322 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19323 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19324 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19325 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19326 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19327 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19328
19329 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19330
19331 @table @code
19332 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19333
19334 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19335 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19336 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19337
19338 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19339
19340 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19341 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19342 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19343 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19344 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19345 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19346
19347 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19348
19349 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19350 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19351 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19352 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19353 command for that. For example:
19354
19355 @smallexample
19356 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19357 @end smallexample
19358
19359 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19360 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19361 @end table
19362
19363 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19364 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19365 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19366 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19367 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19368 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19369 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19370 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19371 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19372 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19373
19374 @smallexample
19375 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19376 @end smallexample
19377
19378 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19379
19380 @smallexample
19381 $ gdb myprogram
19382 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19383 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19384 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19385 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19386 @end smallexample
19387
19388 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19389 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19390 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19391 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19392 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19393 tracing.
19394
19395 @node Remote Configuration
19396 @section Remote Configuration
19397
19398 @kindex set remote
19399 @kindex show remote
19400 This section documents the configuration options available when
19401 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19402 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19403 system-call-allowed}.
19404
19405 @table @code
19406 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19407 @cindex address size for remote targets
19408 @cindex bits in remote address
19409 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19410 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19411 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19412 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19413
19414 @item show remoteaddresssize
19415 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19416
19417 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19418 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19419 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19420 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19421 remote targets.
19422
19423 @item show serial baud
19424 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19425
19426 @item set remotebreak
19427 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19428 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19429 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19430 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19431 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19432 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19433 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19434 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19435
19436 @item show remotebreak
19437 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19438 interrupt the remote program.
19439
19440 @item set remoteflow on
19441 @itemx set remoteflow off
19442 @kindex set remoteflow
19443 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19444 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19445
19446 @item show remoteflow
19447 @kindex show remoteflow
19448 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19449
19450 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19451 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19452 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19453 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19454 @code{ascii}.
19455
19456 @item show remotelogbase
19457 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19458 protocol.
19459
19460 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19461 @cindex record serial communications on file
19462 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19463 default is not to record at all.
19464
19465 @item show remotelogfile.
19466 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19467 serial communications.
19468
19469 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19470 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19471 @cindex remote timeout
19472 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19473 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19474
19475 @item show remotetimeout
19476 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19477 responses.
19478
19479 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19480 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19481 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19482 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19483 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19484 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19485 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19486 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19487
19488 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19489 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19490 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19491 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19492 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19493 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19494 as unlimited.
19495
19496 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19497 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19498 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19499
19500 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19501 @itemx show remote exec-file
19502 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19503 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19504 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19505 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19506 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19507 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19508
19509 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19510 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19511 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19512 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19513 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19514 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19515 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19516 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19517 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19518 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19519
19520 @item show interrupt-sequence
19521 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19522 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19523 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19524 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19525
19526 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19527 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19528 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19529 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19530 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19531 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19532
19533 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19534 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19535 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19536
19537 @kindex set tcp
19538 @kindex show tcp
19539 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19540 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19541 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19542 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19543 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19544 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19545 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19546 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19547 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19548
19549 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19550 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19551
19552 @item show tcp auto-retry
19553 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19554
19555 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19556 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19557 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19558 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19559 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19560 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19561 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19562 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19563 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19564 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19565 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19566
19567 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19568 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19569 @end table
19570
19571 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19572 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19573 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19574 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19575 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19576 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19577 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19578 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19579 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19580
19581 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19582 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19583 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19584 @value{GDBN} developers.
19585
19586 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19587 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19588 are:
19589
19590 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19591 @item Command Name
19592 @tab Remote Packet
19593 @tab Related Features
19594
19595 @item @code{fetch-register}
19596 @tab @code{p}
19597 @tab @code{info registers}
19598
19599 @item @code{set-register}
19600 @tab @code{P}
19601 @tab @code{set}
19602
19603 @item @code{binary-download}
19604 @tab @code{X}
19605 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19606
19607 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19608 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19609 @tab @code{info auxv}
19610
19611 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19612 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19613 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19614
19615 @item @code{attach}
19616 @tab @code{vAttach}
19617 @tab @code{attach}
19618
19619 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19620 @tab @code{vCont}
19621 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19622
19623 @item @code{run}
19624 @tab @code{vRun}
19625 @tab @code{run}
19626
19627 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19628 @tab @code{Z0}
19629 @tab @code{break}
19630
19631 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19632 @tab @code{Z1}
19633 @tab @code{hbreak}
19634
19635 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19636 @tab @code{Z2}
19637 @tab @code{watch}
19638
19639 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19640 @tab @code{Z3}
19641 @tab @code{rwatch}
19642
19643 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19644 @tab @code{Z4}
19645 @tab @code{awatch}
19646
19647 @item @code{target-features}
19648 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19649 @tab @code{set architecture}
19650
19651 @item @code{library-info}
19652 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19653 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19654
19655 @item @code{memory-map}
19656 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19657 @tab @code{info mem}
19658
19659 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19660 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19661 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19662
19663 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19664 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19665 @tab @code{info spu}
19666
19667 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19668 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19669 @tab @code{info spu}
19670
19671 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19672 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19673 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19674
19675 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19676 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19677 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19678
19679 @item @code{threads}
19680 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19681 @tab @code{info threads}
19682
19683 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19684 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19685 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19686
19687 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19688 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19689 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19690
19691 @item @code{search-memory}
19692 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19693 @tab @code{find}
19694
19695 @item @code{supported-packets}
19696 @tab @code{qSupported}
19697 @tab Remote communications parameters
19698
19699 @item @code{pass-signals}
19700 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19701 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19702
19703 @item @code{program-signals}
19704 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19705 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19706
19707 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19708 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19709 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19710
19711 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19712 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19713 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19714
19715 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19716 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19717 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19718
19719 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19720 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19721 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19722
19723 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19724 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19725 @tab @code{remote delete}
19726
19727 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19728 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19729 @tab Host I/O
19730
19731 @item @code{noack-packet}
19732 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19733 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19734
19735 @item @code{osdata}
19736 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19737 @tab @code{info os}
19738
19739 @item @code{query-attached}
19740 @tab @code{qAttached}
19741 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19742
19743 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19744 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19745 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19746
19747 @item @code{trace-status}
19748 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19749 @tab @code{tstatus}
19750
19751 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19752 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19753 @tab Traceframe info
19754
19755 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19756 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19757 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19758
19759 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19760 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19761 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19762
19763 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19764 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19765 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19766 @end multitable
19767
19768 @node Remote Stub
19769 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19770
19771 @cindex debugging stub, example
19772 @cindex remote stub, example
19773 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19774 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19775 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19776 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19777 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19778 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19779 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19780 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19781
19782 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19783 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19784 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19785 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19786 program, you need:
19787
19788 @enumerate
19789 @item
19790 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19791 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19792 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19793
19794 @item
19795 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19796 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19797
19798 @item
19799 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19800 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19801 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19802 documentation.
19803 @end enumerate
19804
19805 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19806 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19807 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19808
19809 @table @emph
19810 @item On the host,
19811 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19812 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19813 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19814
19815 @item On the target,
19816 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19817 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19818 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19819
19820 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19821 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19822 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19823 @end table
19824
19825 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19826 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19827 @sc{sparc} boards.
19828
19829 @cindex remote serial stub list
19830 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19831
19832 @table @code
19833
19834 @item i386-stub.c
19835 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19836 @cindex Intel
19837 @cindex i386
19838 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19839
19840 @item m68k-stub.c
19841 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19842 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19843 @cindex m680x0
19844 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19845
19846 @item sh-stub.c
19847 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19848 @cindex Renesas
19849 @cindex SH
19850 For Renesas SH architectures.
19851
19852 @item sparc-stub.c
19853 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19854 @cindex Sparc
19855 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19856
19857 @item sparcl-stub.c
19858 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19859 @cindex Fujitsu
19860 @cindex SparcLite
19861 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19862
19863 @end table
19864
19865 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19866 recently added stubs.
19867
19868 @menu
19869 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19870 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19871 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19872 @end menu
19873
19874 @node Stub Contents
19875 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19876
19877 @cindex remote serial stub
19878 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19879 subroutines:
19880
19881 @table @code
19882 @item set_debug_traps
19883 @findex set_debug_traps
19884 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19885 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19886 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19887 program's startup code.
19888
19889 @item handle_exception
19890 @findex handle_exception
19891 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19892 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19893 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19894 run when a trap is triggered.
19895
19896 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19897 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19898 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19899 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19900 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19901 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19902 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19903 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19904 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19905 machine.
19906
19907 @item breakpoint
19908 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19909 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19910 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19911 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19912 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19913 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19914 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19915 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19916 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19917 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19918 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19919
19920 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19921 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19922 start of your debugging session.
19923 @end table
19924
19925 @node Bootstrapping
19926 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19927
19928 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19929 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19930 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19931 debugging target machine.
19932
19933 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19934 serial port.
19935
19936 @table @code
19937 @item int getDebugChar()
19938 @findex getDebugChar
19939 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19940 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19941 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19942
19943 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19944 @findex putDebugChar
19945 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19946 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19947 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19948 @end table
19949
19950 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19951 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19952 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19953 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19954 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19955 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19956 remote system to stop.
19957
19958 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19959 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19960 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19961 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19962
19963 Other routines you need to supply are:
19964
19965 @table @code
19966 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19967 @findex exceptionHandler
19968 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19969 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19970 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19971 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19972 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19973 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19974 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19975 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19976 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19977 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19978 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19979 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19980 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19981
19982 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19983 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19984 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19985 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19986 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19987
19988 @item void flush_i_cache()
19989 @findex flush_i_cache
19990 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19991 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19992 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19993
19994 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19995 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19996 @end table
19997
19998 @noindent
19999 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20000
20001 @table @code
20002 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20003 @findex memset
20004 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20005 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20006 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20007 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20008 @end table
20009
20010 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20011 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20012 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20013 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20014
20015
20016 @node Debug Session
20017 @subsection Putting it All Together
20018
20019 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20020 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20021 steps.
20022
20023 @enumerate
20024 @item
20025 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20026 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20027 @display
20028 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20029 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20030 @end display
20031
20032 @item
20033 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20034 procedure is called:
20035
20036 @smallexample
20037 set_debug_traps();
20038 breakpoint();
20039 @end smallexample
20040
20041 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20042 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20043 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20044 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20045 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20046 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20047 progress.
20048
20049 @item
20050 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20051 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20052
20053 @smallexample
20054 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20055 @end smallexample
20056
20057 @noindent
20058 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20059 function in your program, that function is called when
20060 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20061 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20062 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20063
20064 @item
20065 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20066 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20067
20068 @item
20069 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20070 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20071
20072 @item
20073 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20074 @c document that. FIXME.
20075 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20076 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20077
20078 @item
20079 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20080 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20081
20082 @end enumerate
20083
20084 @node Configurations
20085 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20086
20087 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20088 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20089 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20090
20091 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20092 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20093 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20094 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20095 are quite different from each other.
20096
20097 @menu
20098 * Native::
20099 * Embedded OS::
20100 * Embedded Processors::
20101 * Architectures::
20102 @end menu
20103
20104 @node Native
20105 @section Native
20106
20107 This section describes details specific to particular native
20108 configurations.
20109
20110 @menu
20111 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20112 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20113 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20114 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20115 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20116 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20117 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20118 @end menu
20119
20120 @node HP-UX
20121 @subsection HP-UX
20122
20123 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20124 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20125 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20126
20127
20128 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20129 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20130
20131 @cindex libkvm
20132 @cindex kernel memory image
20133 @cindex kernel crash dump
20134
20135 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20136 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20137 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20138 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20139 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20140 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20141 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20142 @code{kvm} target:
20143
20144 @smallexample
20145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20146 @end smallexample
20147
20148 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20149 argument:
20150
20151 @smallexample
20152 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20153 @end smallexample
20154
20155 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20156 available:
20157
20158 @table @code
20159 @kindex kvm
20160 @item kvm pcb
20161 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20162
20163 @item kvm proc
20164 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20165 modern FreeBSD systems.
20166 @end table
20167
20168 @node SVR4 Process Information
20169 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20170 @cindex /proc
20171 @cindex examine process image
20172 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20173
20174 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20175 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20176 process using file-system subroutines.
20177
20178 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20179 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20180 information about the process running your program, or about any
20181 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20182 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20183
20184 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20185 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20186
20187 @table @code
20188 @kindex info proc
20189 @cindex process ID
20190 @item info proc
20191 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20192 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20193 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20194 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20195 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20196 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20197 executable file's absolute file name.
20198
20199 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20200 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20201 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20202 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20203 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20204 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20205
20206 @item info proc cmdline
20207 @cindex info proc cmdline
20208 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20209 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20210
20211 @item info proc cwd
20212 @cindex info proc cwd
20213 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20214 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20215
20216 @item info proc exe
20217 @cindex info proc exe
20218 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20219 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20220
20221 @item info proc mappings
20222 @cindex memory address space mappings
20223 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20224 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20225 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20226 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20227 memory access rights to that range.
20228
20229 @item info proc stat
20230 @itemx info proc status
20231 @cindex process detailed status information
20232 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20233 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20234 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20235 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20236 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20237 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20238 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20239
20240 @item info proc all
20241 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20242 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20243
20244 @ignore
20245 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20246 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20247 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20248 @kindex info proc times
20249 @item info proc times
20250 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20251 its children.
20252
20253 @kindex info proc id
20254 @item info proc id
20255 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20256 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20257 @end ignore
20258
20259 @item set procfs-trace
20260 @kindex set procfs-trace
20261 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20262 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20263
20264 @item show procfs-trace
20265 @kindex show procfs-trace
20266 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20267
20268 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20269 @kindex set procfs-file
20270 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20271 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20272 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20273 standard output.
20274
20275 @item show procfs-file
20276 @kindex show procfs-file
20277 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20278
20279 @item proc-trace-entry
20280 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20281 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20282 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20283 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20284 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20285 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20286 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20287 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20288 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20289
20290 @item info pidlist
20291 @kindex info pidlist
20292 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20293 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20294 processes and all the threads within each process.
20295
20296 @item info meminfo
20297 @kindex info meminfo
20298 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20299 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20300 @end table
20301
20302 @node DJGPP Native
20303 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20304 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20305 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20306 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20307
20308 @cindex DPMI
20309 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20310 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20311 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20312 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20313
20314 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20315 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20316 subsection describes those commands.
20317
20318 @table @code
20319 @kindex info dos
20320 @item info dos
20321 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20322 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20323
20324 @kindex sysinfo
20325 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20326 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20327 @item info dos sysinfo
20328 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20329 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20330 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20331
20332 @cindex GDT
20333 @cindex LDT
20334 @cindex IDT
20335 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20336 @cindex descriptor tables display
20337 @item info dos gdt
20338 @itemx info dos ldt
20339 @itemx info dos idt
20340 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20341 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20342 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20343 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20344 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20345 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20346 rights.
20347
20348 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20349 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20350 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20351 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20352 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20353
20354 @cindex garbled pointers
20355 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20356 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20357 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20358 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20359 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20360 debugged program's data segment:
20361
20362 @smallexample
20363 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20364 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20365 @end smallexample
20366
20367 @noindent
20368 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20369 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20370
20371 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20372 @item info dos pde
20373 @itemx info dos pte
20374 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20375 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20376 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20377 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20378 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20379 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20380 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20381 that is currently in use.
20382
20383 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20384 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20385 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20386 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20387 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20388 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20389 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20390
20391 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20392 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20393 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20394 controller.
20395
20396 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20397
20398 @cindex physical address from linear address
20399 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20400 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20401 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20402 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20403 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20404 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20405 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20406
20407 @smallexample
20408 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20409 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20410 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20411 @end smallexample
20412
20413 @noindent
20414 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20415 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20416 attributes of that page.
20417
20418 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20419 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20420 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20421 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20422 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20423 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20424
20425 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20426 transfer buffer:
20427
20428 @smallexample
20429 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20430 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20431 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20432 @end smallexample
20433
20434 @noindent
20435 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20436 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20437 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20438 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20439 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20440
20441 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20442 @end table
20443
20444 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20445 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20446 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20447 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20448
20449 @table @code
20450 @kindex set com1base
20451 @kindex set com1irq
20452 @kindex set com2base
20453 @kindex set com2irq
20454 @kindex set com3base
20455 @kindex set com3irq
20456 @kindex set com4base
20457 @kindex set com4irq
20458 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20459 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20460 port.
20461
20462 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20463 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20464 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20465
20466 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20467 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20468 other 3 COM ports.
20469
20470 @kindex show com1base
20471 @kindex show com1irq
20472 @kindex show com2base
20473 @kindex show com2irq
20474 @kindex show com3base
20475 @kindex show com3irq
20476 @kindex show com4base
20477 @kindex show com4irq
20478 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20479 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20480 lines used by the COM ports.
20481
20482 @item info serial
20483 @kindex info serial
20484 @cindex DOS serial port status
20485 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20486 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20487 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20488 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20489 @end table
20490
20491
20492 @node Cygwin Native
20493 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20494 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20495 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20496 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20497
20498 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20499 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20500
20501 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20502 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20503 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20504 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20505 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20506 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20507 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20508 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20509
20510 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20511 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20512 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20513
20514 @table @code
20515 @kindex info w32
20516 @item info w32
20517 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20518 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20519
20520 @item info w32 selector
20521 This command displays information returned by
20522 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20523 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20524 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20525 Without argument, this command displays information
20526 about the six segment registers.
20527
20528 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20529 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20530 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20531 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20532
20533 @kindex info dll
20534 @item info dll
20535 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20536
20537 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20538 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20539 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20540 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20541 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20542 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20543 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20544 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20545 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20546 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20547 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20548
20549 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20550 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20551 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20552 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20553
20554 @kindex set new-console
20555 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20556 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20557 be started in a new console on next start.
20558 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20559 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20560
20561 @kindex show new-console
20562 @item show new-console
20563 Displays whether a new console is used
20564 when the debuggee is started.
20565
20566 @kindex set new-group
20567 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20568 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20569 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20570 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20571 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20572
20573 @kindex show new-group
20574 @item show new-group
20575 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20576
20577 @kindex set debugevents
20578 @item set debugevents
20579 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20580 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20581 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20582 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20583 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20584
20585 @kindex set debugexec
20586 @item set debugexec
20587 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20588 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20589
20590 @kindex set debugexceptions
20591 @item set debugexceptions
20592 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20593 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20594
20595 @kindex set debugmemory
20596 @item set debugmemory
20597 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20598 and writes by the debugger.
20599
20600 @kindex set shell
20601 @item set shell
20602 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20603 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20604
20605 @kindex show shell
20606 @item show shell
20607 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20608
20609 @end table
20610
20611 @menu
20612 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20613 @end menu
20614
20615 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20616 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20617 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20618 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20619
20620 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20621 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20622 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20623 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20624 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20625 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20626 ``minimal symbols''.
20627
20628 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20629 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20630 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20631 program run once to completion.
20632
20633 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20634
20635 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20636 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20637 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20638 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20639 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20640 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20641 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20642 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20643 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20644
20645 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20646 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20647 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20648 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20649 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20650 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20651
20652 @smallexample
20653 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20654 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20655
20656 Non-debugging symbols:
20657 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20658 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20659 @end smallexample
20660
20661 @smallexample
20662 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20663 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20664
20665 Non-debugging symbols:
20666 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20667 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20668 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20669 [etc...]
20670 @end smallexample
20671
20672 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20673
20674 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20675 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20676 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20677 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20678 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20679 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20680 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20681
20682 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20683 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20684 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20685 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20686 problem:
20687
20688 @smallexample
20689 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20690 $1 = 268572168
20691 @end smallexample
20692
20693 @smallexample
20694 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20695 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20696 @end smallexample
20697
20698 And two possible solutions:
20699
20700 @smallexample
20701 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20702 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20703 @end smallexample
20704
20705 @smallexample
20706 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20707 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20708 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20709 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20710 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20711 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20712 @end smallexample
20713
20714 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20715 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20716 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20717 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20718 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20719
20720 @smallexample
20721 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20722 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20723 @end smallexample
20724
20725 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20726 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20727 safe.
20728
20729 @node Hurd Native
20730 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20731 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20732
20733 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20734 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20735
20736 @table @code
20737 @item set signals
20738 @itemx set sigs
20739 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20740 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20741 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20742 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20743 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20744 @code{signals}.
20745
20746 @item show signals
20747 @itemx show sigs
20748 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20749 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20750 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20751
20752 @item set signal-thread
20753 @itemx set sigthread
20754 @kindex set signal-thread
20755 @kindex set sigthread
20756 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20757 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20758 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20759 signal-thread}.
20760
20761 @item show signal-thread
20762 @itemx show sigthread
20763 @kindex show signal-thread
20764 @kindex show sigthread
20765 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20766 delivered a signal.
20767
20768 @item set stopped
20769 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20770 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20771 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20772 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20773
20774 @item show stopped
20775 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20776 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20777 stopped.
20778
20779 @item set exceptions
20780 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20781 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20782 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20783 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20784 trapping on.
20785
20786 @item show exceptions
20787 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20788 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20789
20790 @item set task pause
20791 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20792 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20793 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20794 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20795 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20796 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20797 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20798 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20799 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20800
20801 @item show task pause
20802 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20803 Show the current state of task suspension.
20804
20805 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20806 @cindex task suspend count
20807 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20808 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20809 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20810
20811 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20812 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20813
20814 @item set task exception-port
20815 @itemx set task excp
20816 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20817 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20818 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20819 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20820
20821 @item set noninvasive
20822 @cindex noninvasive task options
20823 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20824 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20825 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20826 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20827
20828 @item info send-rights
20829 @itemx info receive-rights
20830 @itemx info port-rights
20831 @itemx info port-sets
20832 @itemx info dead-names
20833 @itemx info ports
20834 @itemx info psets
20835 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20836 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20837 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20838 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20839 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20840 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20841 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20842 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20843 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20844
20845 @item set thread pause
20846 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20847 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20848 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20849 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20850 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20851 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20852 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20853 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20854 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20855 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20856 only the current thread.
20857
20858 @item show thread pause
20859 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20860 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20861
20862 @item set thread run
20863 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20864
20865 @item show thread run
20866 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20867
20868 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20869 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20870 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20871 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20872 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20873 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20874 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20875
20876 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20877 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20878 detaching.
20879
20880 @item set thread exception-port
20881 @itemx set thread excp
20882 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20883 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20884 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20885
20886 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20887 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20888 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20889 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20890
20891 @item set thread default
20892 @itemx show thread default
20893 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20894 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20895 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20896 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20897 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20898 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20899 the non-default commands.
20900 @end table
20901
20902 @node Darwin
20903 @subsection Darwin
20904 @cindex Darwin
20905
20906 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20907
20908 @table @code
20909 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20910 @kindex set debug darwin
20911 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20912 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20913
20914 @item show debug darwin
20915 @kindex show debug darwin
20916 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20917
20918 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20919 @kindex set debug mach-o
20920 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20921 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20922 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20923 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20924 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20925 usage.
20926
20927 @item show debug mach-o
20928 @kindex show debug mach-o
20929 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20930
20931 @item set mach-exceptions on
20932 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20933 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20934 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20935 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20936 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20937 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20938
20939 @item show mach-exceptions
20940 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20941 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20942 @end table
20943
20944
20945 @node Embedded OS
20946 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20947
20948 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20949 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20950 architectures.
20951
20952 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20953 various real-time operating systems.
20954
20955 @node Embedded Processors
20956 @section Embedded Processors
20957
20958 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20959 configurations.
20960
20961 @cindex send command to simulator
20962 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20963 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20964
20965 @table @code
20966 @item sim @var{command}
20967 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20968 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20969 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20970 acceptable commands.
20971 @end table
20972
20973
20974 @menu
20975 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20976 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20977 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20978 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20979 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20980 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20981 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20982 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20983 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20984 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20985 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20986 * CRIS:: CRIS
20987 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20988 @end menu
20989
20990 @node ARM
20991 @subsection ARM
20992 @cindex ARM RDI
20993
20994 @table @code
20995 @kindex target rdi
20996 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20997 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20998 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20999 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21000
21001 @kindex target rdp
21002 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21003 ARM Demon monitor.
21004
21005 @end table
21006
21007 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21008
21009 @table @code
21010 @item set arm disassembler
21011 @kindex set arm
21012 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21013 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21014
21015 @item show arm disassembler
21016 @kindex show arm
21017 Show the current disassembly style.
21018
21019 @item set arm apcs32
21020 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21021 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21022
21023 @item show arm apcs32
21024 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21025
21026 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21027 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21028 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21029
21030 @table @code
21031 @item auto
21032 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21033 @item softfpa
21034 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21035 processors.
21036 @item fpa
21037 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21038 @item softvfp
21039 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21040 @item vfp
21041 VFP co-processor.
21042 @end table
21043
21044 @item show arm fpu
21045 Show the current type of the FPU.
21046
21047 @item set arm abi
21048 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21049
21050 @item show arm abi
21051 Show the currently used ABI.
21052
21053 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21054 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21055 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21056 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21057 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21058 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21059 register).
21060
21061 @item show arm fallback-mode
21062 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21063
21064 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21065 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21066 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21067 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21068 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21069
21070 @item show arm force-mode
21071 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21072
21073 @item set debug arm
21074 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21075 target support subsystem.
21076
21077 @item show debug arm
21078 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21079 @end table
21080
21081 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21082 using the RDI interface:
21083
21084 @table @code
21085 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21086 @kindex rdilogfile
21087 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21088 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21089 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21090 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21091 @file{rdi.log}.
21092
21093 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21094 @kindex rdilogenable
21095 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21096 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21097 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21098 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21099 are logged to a file.
21100
21101 @item set rdiromatzero
21102 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21103 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21104 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21105 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21106 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21107 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21108
21109 @item show rdiromatzero
21110 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21111 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21112
21113 @item set rdiheartbeat
21114 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21115 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21116 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21117 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21118 well as the Angel monitor.
21119
21120 @item show rdiheartbeat
21121 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21122 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21123 @end table
21124
21125 @table @code
21126 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21127 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21128
21129 @table @code
21130 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21131 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21132 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21133 The default value is @code{all}.
21134
21135 @table @code
21136 @item none
21137 @item demon
21138 @item angel
21139 @item redboot
21140 @item all
21141 @end table
21142 @end table
21143 @end table
21144
21145 @node M32R/D
21146 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21147
21148 @table @code
21149 @kindex target m32r
21150 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21151 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21152
21153 @kindex target m32rsdi
21154 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21155 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21156 @end table
21157
21158 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21159
21160 @table @code
21161 @item set download-path @var{path}
21162 @kindex set download-path
21163 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21164 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21165
21166 @item show download-path
21167 @kindex show download-path
21168 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21169
21170 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21171 @kindex set board-address
21172 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21173 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21174
21175 @item show board-address
21176 @kindex show board-address
21177 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21178
21179 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21180 @kindex set server-address
21181 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21182 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21183 host machine.
21184
21185 @item show server-address
21186 @kindex show server-address
21187 Display the IP address of the download server.
21188
21189 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21190 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21191 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21192 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21193 executable file is uploaded.
21194
21195 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21196 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21197 Test the @code{upload} command.
21198 @end table
21199
21200 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21201
21202 @table @code
21203 @item sdireset
21204 @kindex sdireset
21205 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21206 This command resets the SDI connection.
21207
21208 @item sdistatus
21209 @kindex sdistatus
21210 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21211
21212 @item debug_chaos
21213 @kindex debug_chaos
21214 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21215 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21216
21217 @item use_debug_dma
21218 @kindex use_debug_dma
21219 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21220
21221 @item use_mon_code
21222 @kindex use_mon_code
21223 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21224
21225 @item use_ib_break
21226 @kindex use_ib_break
21227 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21228
21229 @item use_dbt_break
21230 @kindex use_dbt_break
21231 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21232 @end table
21233
21234 @node M68K
21235 @subsection M68k
21236
21237 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21238 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21239
21240 @table @code
21241
21242 @kindex target dbug
21243 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21244 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21245
21246 @end table
21247
21248 @node MicroBlaze
21249 @subsection MicroBlaze
21250 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21251 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21252
21253 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21254 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21255 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21256 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21257 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21258 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21259 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21260 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21261 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21262 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21263 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21264
21265 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21266
21267 @table @code
21268 @item target remote :1234
21269 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21270 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21271
21272 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21273 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21274 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21275
21276 @item load
21277 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21278
21279 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21280 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21281
21282 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21283 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21284 @end table
21285
21286 @node MIPS Embedded
21287 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21288
21289 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21290 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21291 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21292 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21293
21294 @need 1000
21295 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21296
21297 @table @code
21298 @item target mips @var{port}
21299 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21300 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21301 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21302 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21303 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21304 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21305 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21306
21307 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21308 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21309 debugger:
21310
21311 @smallexample
21312 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21313 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21314 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21315 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21316 (@value{GDBP}) run
21317 @end smallexample
21318
21319 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21320 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21321 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21322 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21323 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21324
21325 @item target pmon @var{port}
21326 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21327 PMON ROM monitor.
21328
21329 @item target ddb @var{port}
21330 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21331 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21332
21333 @item target lsi @var{port}
21334 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21335 LSI variant of PMON.
21336
21337 @kindex target r3900
21338 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21339 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21340
21341 @kindex target array
21342 @item target array @var{dev}
21343 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21344
21345 @end table
21346
21347
21348 @noindent
21349 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21350
21351 @table @code
21352 @item set mipsfpu double
21353 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21354 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21355 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21356 @itemx show mipsfpu
21357 @kindex set mipsfpu
21358 @kindex show mipsfpu
21359 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21360 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21361 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21362 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21363 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21364 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21365 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21366 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21367 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21368 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21369 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21370 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21371 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21372
21373 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21374 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21375 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21376
21377 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21378 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21379
21380 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21381 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21382 @itemx show timeout
21383 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21384 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21385 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21386 @kindex set timeout
21387 @kindex show timeout
21388 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21389 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21390 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21391 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21392 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21393 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21394 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21395 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21396 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21397 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21398
21399 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21400 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21401 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21402 to run before stopping.
21403
21404 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21405 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21406 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21407 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21408 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21409 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21410
21411 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21412 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21413 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21414 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21415
21416 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21417 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21418 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21419 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21420 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21421 @table @asis
21422 @item pmon target
21423 @samp{PMON}
21424 @item ddb target
21425 @samp{NEC010}
21426 @item lsi target
21427 @samp{PMON>}
21428 @end table
21429
21430 @item show monitor-prompt
21431 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21432 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21433 remote monitor.
21434
21435 @item set monitor-warnings
21436 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21437 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21438 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21439 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21440 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21441
21442 @item show monitor-warnings
21443 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21444 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21445
21446 @item pmon @var{command}
21447 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21448 @cindex send PMON command
21449 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21450 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21451 @end table
21452
21453 @node PowerPC Embedded
21454 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21455
21456 @cindex DVC register
21457 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21458 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21459
21460 @smallexample
21461 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21462 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21463 @end smallexample
21464
21465 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21466 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21467 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21468 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21469 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21470 or newer.
21471
21472 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21473 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21474 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21475 watching variables of scalar types.
21476
21477 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21478 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21479
21480 @smallexample
21481 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21482 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21483 @end smallexample
21484
21485 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21486 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21487
21488 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21489 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21490 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21491 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21492 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21493 use the @code{break-range} command.
21494
21495 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21496
21497 @table @code
21498 @kindex break-range
21499 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21500 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21501 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21502 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21503 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21504 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21505 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21506 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21507 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21508
21509 @kindex set powerpc
21510 @item set powerpc soft-float
21511 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21512 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21513 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21514 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21515
21516 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21517 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21518 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21519 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21520 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21521 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21522 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21523 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21524
21525 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21526 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21527 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21528 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21529 address of its first byte.
21530
21531 @kindex target dink32
21532 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21533 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21534
21535 @kindex target ppcbug
21536 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21537 @kindex target ppcbug1
21538 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21539 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21540
21541 @kindex target sds
21542 @item target sds @var{dev}
21543 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21544 @end table
21545
21546 @cindex SDS protocol
21547 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21548 by @value{GDBN}:
21549
21550 @table @code
21551 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21552 @kindex set sdstimeout
21553 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21554 default is 2 seconds.
21555
21556 @item show sdstimeout
21557 @kindex show sdstimeout
21558 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21559
21560 @item sds @var{command}
21561 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21562 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21563 @end table
21564
21565
21566 @node PA
21567 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21568
21569 @table @code
21570
21571 @kindex target op50n
21572 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21573 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21574
21575 @kindex target w89k
21576 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21577 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21578
21579 @end table
21580
21581 @node Sparclet
21582 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21583
21584 @cindex Sparclet
21585
21586 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21587 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21588 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21589 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21590 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21591
21592 @table @code
21593 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21594 @kindex remotetimeout
21595 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21596 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21597 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21598 @end table
21599
21600 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21601 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21602 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21603 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21604 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21605
21606 @smallexample
21607 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21608 @end smallexample
21609
21610 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21611
21612 @smallexample
21613 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21614 @end smallexample
21615
21616 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21617 Once you have set
21618 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21619 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21620 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21621
21622 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21623
21624 @smallexample
21625 (gdbslet)
21626 @end smallexample
21627
21628 @menu
21629 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21630 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21631 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21632 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21633 @end menu
21634
21635 @node Sparclet File
21636 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21637
21638 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21639
21640 @smallexample
21641 (gdbslet) file prog
21642 @end smallexample
21643
21644 @need 1000
21645 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21646 @value{GDBN} locates
21647 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21648 path.
21649 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21650 files will be searched as well.
21651 @value{GDBN} locates
21652 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21653 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21654 If it fails
21655 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21656
21657 @smallexample
21658 prog: No such file or directory.
21659 @end smallexample
21660
21661 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21662 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21663 @code{target} command again.
21664
21665 @node Sparclet Connection
21666 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21667
21668 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21669 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21670
21671 @smallexample
21672 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21673 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21674 main () at ../prog.c:3
21675 @end smallexample
21676
21677 @need 750
21678 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21679
21680 @smallexample
21681 Connected to ttya.
21682 @end smallexample
21683
21684 @node Sparclet Download
21685 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21686
21687 @cindex download to Sparclet
21688 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21689 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21690 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21691 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21692 command.
21693 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21694 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21695 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21696 of each of the file's sections.
21697 For instance, if the program
21698 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21699 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21700
21701 @smallexample
21702 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21703 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21704 @end smallexample
21705
21706 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21707 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21708 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21709
21710 @node Sparclet Execution
21711 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21712
21713 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21714 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21715 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21716 manual for the list of commands.
21717
21718 @smallexample
21719 (gdbslet) b main
21720 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21721 (gdbslet) run
21722 Starting program: prog
21723 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21724 3 char *symarg = 0;
21725 (gdbslet) step
21726 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21727 (gdbslet)
21728 @end smallexample
21729
21730 @node Sparclite
21731 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21732
21733 @table @code
21734
21735 @kindex target sparclite
21736 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21737 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21738 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21739 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21740 remote protocol.
21741
21742 @end table
21743
21744 @node Z8000
21745 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21746
21747 @cindex Z8000
21748 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21749 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21750
21751 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21752 a Z8000 simulator.
21753
21754 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21755 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21756 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21757 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21758
21759 @table @code
21760 @item target sim @var{args}
21761 @kindex sim
21762 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21763 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21764 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21765 @end table
21766
21767 @noindent
21768 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21769 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21770 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21771 to run your program, and so on.
21772
21773 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21774 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21775 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21776
21777 @table @code
21778
21779 @item cycles
21780 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21781
21782 @item insts
21783 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21784
21785 @item time
21786 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21787
21788 @end table
21789
21790 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21791 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21792 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21793 simulated clock ticks.
21794
21795 @node AVR
21796 @subsection Atmel AVR
21797 @cindex AVR
21798
21799 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21800 following AVR-specific commands:
21801
21802 @table @code
21803 @item info io_registers
21804 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21805 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21806 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21807 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21808 @end table
21809
21810 @node CRIS
21811 @subsection CRIS
21812 @cindex CRIS
21813
21814 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21815 following CRIS-specific commands:
21816
21817 @table @code
21818 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21819 @cindex CRIS version
21820 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21821 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21822 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21823
21824 @item show cris-version
21825 Show the current CRIS version.
21826
21827 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21828 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21829 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21830 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21831 @code{R59}.
21832
21833 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21834 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21835
21836 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21837 @cindex CRIS mode
21838 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21839 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21840 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21841
21842 @item show cris-mode
21843 Show the current CRIS mode.
21844 @end table
21845
21846 @node Super-H
21847 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21848 @cindex Super-H
21849
21850 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21851 commands:
21852
21853 @table @code
21854 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21855 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21856 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21857 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21858 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21859 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21860 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21861 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21862 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21863 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21864 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21865 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21866
21867 @item show sh calling-convention
21868 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21869 Show the current calling convention setting.
21870
21871 @end table
21872
21873
21874 @node Architectures
21875 @section Architectures
21876
21877 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21878 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21879
21880 @menu
21881 * AArch64::
21882 * i386::
21883 * Alpha::
21884 * MIPS::
21885 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21886 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21887 * PowerPC::
21888 * Nios II::
21889 @end menu
21890
21891 @node AArch64
21892 @subsection AArch64
21893 @cindex AArch64 support
21894
21895 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21896 following special commands:
21897
21898 @table @code
21899 @item set debug aarch64
21900 @kindex set debug aarch64
21901 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21902 messages are to be displayed.
21903
21904 @item show debug aarch64
21905 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21906
21907 @end table
21908
21909 @node i386
21910 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21911
21912 @table @code
21913 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21914 @kindex set struct-convention
21915 @cindex struct return convention
21916 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21917 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21918 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21919 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21920 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21921 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21922 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21923 be returned in a register.
21924
21925 @item show struct-convention
21926 @kindex show struct-convention
21927 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21928 from functions.
21929 @end table
21930
21931 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21932 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21933
21934 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21935 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21936 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21937 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21938 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21939 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21940 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21941
21942 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21943 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21944 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21945 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21946 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21947 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21948
21949 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21950 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21951 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21952
21953 @smallexample
21954 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21955 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21956 @end smallexample
21957
21958 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21959 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21960 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21961 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21962 the pointer.
21963
21964 @node Alpha
21965 @subsection Alpha
21966
21967 See the following section.
21968
21969 @node MIPS
21970 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21971
21972 @cindex stack on Alpha
21973 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21974 @cindex Alpha stack
21975 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21976 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21977 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21978 find the beginning of a function.
21979
21980 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21981 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21982 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21983 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21984 commands:
21985
21986 @table @code
21987 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21988 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21989 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21990 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21991 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21992 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21993 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21994 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21995
21996 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21997 Display the current limit.
21998 @end table
21999
22000 @noindent
22001 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22002 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22003
22004 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22005 programs:
22006
22007 @table @code
22008 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22009 @kindex set mips abi
22010 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22011 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22012 values of @var{arg} are:
22013
22014 @table @samp
22015 @item auto
22016 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22017 default).
22018 @item o32
22019 @item o64
22020 @item n32
22021 @item n64
22022 @item eabi32
22023 @item eabi64
22024 @end table
22025
22026 @item show mips abi
22027 @kindex show mips abi
22028 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22029
22030 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22031 @kindex set mips compression
22032 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22033 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22034 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22035 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22036 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22037 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22038 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22039 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22040 provided by the executable.
22041
22042 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22043 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22044 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22045 identified as such.
22046
22047 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22048 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22049 implicitly from an executable.
22050
22051 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22052 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22053 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22054 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22055 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22056
22057 @item show mips compression
22058 @kindex show mips compression
22059 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22060 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22061
22062 @item set mipsfpu
22063 @itemx show mipsfpu
22064 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22065
22066 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22067 @kindex set mips mask-address
22068 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22069 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22070 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22071 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22072 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22073
22074 @item show mips mask-address
22075 @kindex show mips mask-address
22076 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22077 not.
22078
22079 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22080 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22081 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22082 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22083 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22084 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22085
22086 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22087 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22088 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22089
22090 @item set debug mips
22091 @kindex set debug mips
22092 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22093 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22094
22095 @item show debug mips
22096 @kindex show debug mips
22097 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22098 @end table
22099
22100
22101 @node HPPA
22102 @subsection HPPA
22103 @cindex HPPA support
22104
22105 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22106 following special commands:
22107
22108 @table @code
22109 @item set debug hppa
22110 @kindex set debug hppa
22111 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22112 messages are to be displayed.
22113
22114 @item show debug hppa
22115 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22116
22117 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22118 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22119 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22120 given @var{address}.
22121
22122 @end table
22123
22124
22125 @node SPU
22126 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22127 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22128 @cindex SPU
22129
22130 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22131 it provides the following special commands:
22132
22133 @table @code
22134 @item info spu event
22135 @kindex info spu
22136 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22137 and pending event status.
22138
22139 @item info spu signal
22140 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22141 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22142 notification channels.
22143
22144 @item info spu mailbox
22145 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22146 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22147 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22148
22149 @item info spu dma
22150 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22151 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22152 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22153
22154 @item info spu proxydma
22155 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22156 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22157 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22158
22159 @end table
22160
22161 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22162 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22163 special commands:
22164
22165 @table @code
22166 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22167 @kindex set spu
22168 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22169 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22170 function. The default is @code{off}.
22171
22172 @item show spu stop-on-load
22173 @kindex show spu
22174 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22175
22176 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22177 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22178 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22179 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22180 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22181 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22182
22183 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22184 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22185
22186 @end table
22187
22188 @node PowerPC
22189 @subsection PowerPC
22190 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22191
22192 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22193 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22194 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22195 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22196 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22197
22198 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22199 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22200 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22201
22202 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22203 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22204
22205 @node Nios II
22206 @subsection Nios II
22207 @cindex Nios II architecture
22208
22209 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22210 it provides the following special commands:
22211
22212 @table @code
22213
22214 @item set debug nios2
22215 @kindex set debug nios2
22216 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22217 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22218
22219 @item show debug nios2
22220 @kindex show debug nios2
22221 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22222 @end table
22223
22224 @node Controlling GDB
22225 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22226
22227 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22228 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22229 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22230 described here.
22231
22232 @menu
22233 * Prompt:: Prompt
22234 * Editing:: Command editing
22235 * Command History:: Command history
22236 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22237 * Numbers:: Numbers
22238 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22239 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22240 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22241 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22242 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22243 @end menu
22244
22245 @node Prompt
22246 @section Prompt
22247
22248 @cindex prompt
22249
22250 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22251 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22252 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22253 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22254 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22255 which one you are talking to.
22256
22257 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22258 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22259 or a prompt that does not.
22260
22261 @table @code
22262 @kindex set prompt
22263 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22264 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22265
22266 @kindex show prompt
22267 @item show prompt
22268 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22269 @end table
22270
22271 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22272 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22273 are:
22274
22275 @table @code
22276 @kindex set extended-prompt
22277 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22278 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22279 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22280 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22281 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22282 is displayed.
22283
22284 For example:
22285
22286 @smallexample
22287 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22288 @end smallexample
22289
22290 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22291 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22292
22293 @kindex show extended-prompt
22294 @item show extended-prompt
22295 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22296 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22297 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22298 @end table
22299
22300 @node Editing
22301 @section Command Editing
22302 @cindex readline
22303 @cindex command line editing
22304
22305 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22306 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22307 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22308 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22309 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22310 debugging sessions.
22311
22312 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22313 command @code{set}.
22314
22315 @table @code
22316 @kindex set editing
22317 @cindex editing
22318 @item set editing
22319 @itemx set editing on
22320 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22321
22322 @item set editing off
22323 Disable command line editing.
22324
22325 @kindex show editing
22326 @item show editing
22327 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22328 @end table
22329
22330 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22331 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22332 @end ifset
22333 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22334 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22335 @end ifclear
22336 for more details about the Readline
22337 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22338 encouraged to read that chapter.
22339
22340 @node Command History
22341 @section Command History
22342 @cindex command history
22343
22344 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22345 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22346 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22347 history facility.
22348
22349 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22350 package, to provide the history facility.
22351 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22352 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22353 @end ifset
22354 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22355 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22356 @end ifclear
22357 for the detailed description of the History library.
22358
22359 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22360 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22361 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22362 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22363 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22364 pressed on a line by itself.
22365
22366 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22367 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22368 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22369 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22370
22371 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22372 history.
22373
22374 @table @code
22375 @cindex history substitution
22376 @cindex history file
22377 @kindex set history filename
22378 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22379 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22380 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22381 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22382 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22383 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22384 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22385 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22386 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22387 is not set.
22388
22389 @cindex save command history
22390 @kindex set history save
22391 @item set history save
22392 @itemx set history save on
22393 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22394 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22395
22396 @item set history save off
22397 Stop recording command history in a file.
22398
22399 @cindex history size
22400 @kindex set history size
22401 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22402 @item set history size @var{size}
22403 @itemx set history size unlimited
22404 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22405 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22406 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22407 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22408 history list is unlimited.
22409 @end table
22410
22411 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22412 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22413 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22414 @end ifset
22415 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22416 @xref{Event Designators},
22417 @end ifclear
22418 for more details.
22419
22420 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22421 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22422 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22423 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22424 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22425 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22426 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22427 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22428
22429 The commands to control history expansion are:
22430
22431 @table @code
22432 @item set history expansion on
22433 @itemx set history expansion
22434 @kindex set history expansion
22435 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22436
22437 @item set history expansion off
22438 Disable history expansion.
22439
22440 @c @group
22441 @kindex show history
22442 @item show history
22443 @itemx show history filename
22444 @itemx show history save
22445 @itemx show history size
22446 @itemx show history expansion
22447 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22448 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22449 @c @end group
22450 @end table
22451
22452 @table @code
22453 @kindex show commands
22454 @cindex show last commands
22455 @cindex display command history
22456 @item show commands
22457 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22458
22459 @item show commands @var{n}
22460 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22461
22462 @item show commands +
22463 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22464 @end table
22465
22466 @node Screen Size
22467 @section Screen Size
22468 @cindex size of screen
22469 @cindex screen size
22470 @cindex pagination
22471 @cindex page size
22472 @cindex pauses in output
22473
22474 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22475 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22476 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22477 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22478 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22479 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22480 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22481 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22482
22483 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22484 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22485 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22486 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22487 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22488 width} commands:
22489
22490 @table @code
22491 @kindex set height
22492 @kindex set width
22493 @kindex show width
22494 @kindex show height
22495 @item set height @var{lpp}
22496 @itemx set height unlimited
22497 @itemx show height
22498 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22499 @itemx set width unlimited
22500 @itemx show width
22501 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22502 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22503 commands display the current settings.
22504
22505 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22506 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22507 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22508 buffer.
22509
22510 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22511 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22512
22513 @item set pagination on
22514 @itemx set pagination off
22515 @kindex set pagination
22516 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22517 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22518 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22519 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22520
22521 @item show pagination
22522 @kindex show pagination
22523 Show the current pagination mode.
22524 @end table
22525
22526 @node Numbers
22527 @section Numbers
22528 @cindex number representation
22529 @cindex entering numbers
22530
22531 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22532 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22533 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22534 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22535 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22536 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22537 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22538 both input and output with the commands described below.
22539
22540 @table @code
22541 @kindex set input-radix
22542 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22543 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22544 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22545 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22546 example, any of
22547
22548 @smallexample
22549 set input-radix 012
22550 set input-radix 10.
22551 set input-radix 0xa
22552 @end smallexample
22553
22554 @noindent
22555 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22556 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22557 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22558 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22559 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22560 change the radix.
22561
22562 @kindex set output-radix
22563 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22564 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22565 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22566 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22567
22568 @kindex show input-radix
22569 @item show input-radix
22570 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22571
22572 @kindex show output-radix
22573 @item show output-radix
22574 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22575
22576 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22577 @itemx show radix
22578 @kindex set radix
22579 @kindex show radix
22580 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22581 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22582 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22583 default value of 10.
22584
22585 @end table
22586
22587 @node ABI
22588 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22589
22590 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22591 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22592 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22593 current ABI.
22594
22595 @cindex OS ABI
22596 @kindex set osabi
22597 @kindex show osabi
22598 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22599
22600 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22601 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22602 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22603 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22604 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22605 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22606 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22607 platform provides.
22608
22609 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22610 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22611 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22612 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22613
22614 @table @code
22615 @item show osabi
22616 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22617
22618 @item set osabi
22619 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22620
22621 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22622 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22623 @end table
22624
22625 @cindex float promotion
22626
22627 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22628 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22629 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22630 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22631 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22632 @code{double} and then passed.
22633
22634 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22635 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22636 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22637
22638 @table @code
22639 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22640 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22641 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22642 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22643 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22644
22645 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22646 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22647 functions.
22648
22649 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22650 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22651 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22652 @end table
22653
22654 @kindex set cp-abi
22655 @kindex show cp-abi
22656 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22657 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22658 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22659 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22660 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22661 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22662 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22663 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22664 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22665 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22666 ``auto''.
22667
22668 @table @code
22669 @item show cp-abi
22670 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22671
22672 @item set cp-abi
22673 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22674
22675 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22676 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22677 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22678 @end table
22679
22680 @node Auto-loading
22681 @section Automatically loading associated files
22682 @cindex auto-loading
22683
22684 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22685 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22686 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22687 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22688 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22689 sources).
22690
22691 @menu
22692 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22693 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22694
22695 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22696 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22697 @end menu
22698
22699 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22700 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22701 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22702
22703 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22704 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22705 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22706
22707 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22708 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22709
22710 @table @code
22711 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22712 @kindex set auto-load off
22713 @item set auto-load off
22714 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22715 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22716 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22717 @smallexample
22718 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22719 @end smallexample
22720
22721 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22722 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22723 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22724 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22725 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22726 @code{set auto-load no}.
22727
22728 @anchor{show auto-load}
22729 @kindex show auto-load
22730 @item show auto-load
22731 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22732 or disabled.
22733
22734 @smallexample
22735 (gdb) show auto-load
22736 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22737 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22738 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22739 is on.
22740 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22741 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22742 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22743 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22744 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22745 @end smallexample
22746
22747 @anchor{info auto-load}
22748 @kindex info auto-load
22749 @item info auto-load
22750 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22751 not.
22752
22753 @smallexample
22754 (gdb) info auto-load
22755 gdb-scripts:
22756 Loaded Script
22757 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22758 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22759 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22760 loaded.
22761 python-scripts:
22762 Loaded Script
22763 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22764 @end smallexample
22765 @end table
22766
22767 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22768
22769 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22770 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22771 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22772 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22773 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22774 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22775 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22776 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22777 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22778 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22779 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22780 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22781 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22782 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22783 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22784 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22785 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22786 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22787 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22788 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22789 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22790 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22791 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22792 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22793 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22794 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22795 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22796 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22797 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22798 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22799 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22800 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22801 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22802 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22803 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22804 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22805 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22806 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22807 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22808 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22809 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22810 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22811 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22812 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22813 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22814 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22815 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22816 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22817 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22818 @end multitable
22819
22820 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22821 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22822 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22823
22824 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22825 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22826 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22827
22828 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22829 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22830
22831 @table @code
22832 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22833 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22834 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22835 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22836 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22837
22838 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22839 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22840 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22841 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22842 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22843
22844 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22845 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22846 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22847 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22848 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22849 @end table
22850
22851 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22852 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22853 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22854
22855 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22856
22857 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22858 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22859
22860 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22861 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22862 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22863 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22864 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22865 library.
22866
22867 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22868 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22869
22870 @table @code
22871 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22872 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22873 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22874 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22875
22876 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22877 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22878 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22879 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22880 enabled or disabled.
22881
22882 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22883 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22884 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22885 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22886 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22887 @end table
22888
22889 @node Auto-loading safe path
22890 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22891 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22892
22893 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22894 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22895 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22896 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22897 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22898
22899 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22900 get loaded:
22901
22902 @smallexample
22903 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22904 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22905 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22906 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22907 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22908 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22909 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22910 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22911 @end smallexample
22912
22913 @noindent
22914 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22915 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22916
22917 @smallexample
22918 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22919 @end smallexample
22920
22921 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22922
22923 @table @code
22924 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22925 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22926 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22927 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22928 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22929 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22930 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22931 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22932 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22933 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22934
22935 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22936 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22937 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22938
22939 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22940 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22941 @item show auto-load safe-path
22942 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22943 scripts.
22944
22945 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22946 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22947 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22948 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
22949 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
22950 by the host platform path separator in use.
22951 @end table
22952
22953 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22954 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22955 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22956 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22957 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22958
22959 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22960 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22961 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22962 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22963 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22964 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22965 init file in the current directory
22966 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22967
22968 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22969 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22970
22971 @table @asis
22972 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22973 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22974 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22975 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22976
22977 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22978 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22979 @value{GDBN} session.
22980
22981 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22982 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22983 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22984 from trusted sources.
22985
22986 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22987 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22988 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22989 trusted sources.
22990 @end table
22991
22992 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22993 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22994
22995 @table @asis
22996 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22997 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22998
22999 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23000 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23001 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23002 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23003 @end table
23004
23005 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23006 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23007 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23008 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23009 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23010 recommended to be entered.
23011
23012 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23013 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23014 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23015
23016 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23017 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23018 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23019 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23020 be printed.
23021
23022 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23023 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23024 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23025
23026 @smallexample
23027 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23028 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23029 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23030 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23031 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23032 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23033 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23034 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23035 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23036 @end smallexample
23037
23038 @table @code
23039 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23040 @kindex set debug auto-load
23041 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23042 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23043
23044 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23045 @kindex show debug auto-load
23046 @item show debug auto-load
23047 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23048 on or off.
23049 @end table
23050
23051 @node Messages/Warnings
23052 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23053
23054 @cindex verbose operation
23055 @cindex optional warnings
23056 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23057 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23058 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23059 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23060
23061 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23062 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23063 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23064
23065 @table @code
23066 @kindex set verbose
23067 @item set verbose on
23068 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23069
23070 @item set verbose off
23071 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23072
23073 @kindex show verbose
23074 @item show verbose
23075 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23076 @end table
23077
23078 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23079 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23080 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23081 Symbol Files}).
23082
23083 @table @code
23084
23085 @kindex set complaints
23086 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23087 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23088 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23089 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23090 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23091
23092 @kindex show complaints
23093 @item show complaints
23094 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23095
23096 @end table
23097
23098 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23099 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23100 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23101 you try to run a program which is already running:
23102
23103 @smallexample
23104 (@value{GDBP}) run
23105 The program being debugged has been started already.
23106 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23107 @end smallexample
23108
23109 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23110 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23111
23112 @table @code
23113
23114 @kindex set confirm
23115 @cindex flinching
23116 @cindex confirmation
23117 @cindex stupid questions
23118 @item set confirm off
23119 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23120 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23121 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23122
23123 @item set confirm on
23124 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23125
23126 @kindex show confirm
23127 @item show confirm
23128 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23129
23130 @end table
23131
23132 @cindex command tracing
23133 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23134 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23135 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23136 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23137
23138 @table @code
23139 @kindex set trace-commands
23140 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23141 @item set trace-commands on
23142 Enable command tracing.
23143 @item set trace-commands off
23144 Disable command tracing.
23145 @item show trace-commands
23146 Display the current state of command tracing.
23147 @end table
23148
23149 @node Debugging Output
23150 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23151 @cindex optional debugging messages
23152
23153 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23154 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23155 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23156 section documents those commands.
23157
23158 @table @code
23159 @kindex set exec-done-display
23160 @item set exec-done-display
23161 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23162 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23163 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23164 @kindex show exec-done-display
23165 @item show exec-done-display
23166 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23167 notification.
23168 @kindex set debug
23169 @cindex ARM AArch64
23170 @item set debug aarch64
23171 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23172 The default is off.
23173 @kindex show debug
23174 @item show debug aarch64
23175 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23176 ARM AArch64.
23177 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23178 @cindex architecture debugging info
23179 @item set debug arch
23180 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23181 @item show debug arch
23182 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23183 @item set debug aix-solib
23184 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23185 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23186 support module. The default is off.
23187 @item show debug aix-thread
23188 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23189 @item set debug aix-thread
23190 @cindex AIX threads
23191 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23192 module.
23193 @item show debug aix-thread
23194 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23195 @item set debug check-physname
23196 @cindex physname
23197 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23198 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23199 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23200 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23201 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23202 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23203 @item show debug check-physname
23204 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23205 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23206 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23207 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23208 exported symbols. The default is off.
23209 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23210 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23211 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23212 @item set debug dwarf2-die
23213 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
23214 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
23215 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23216 A value of zero turns off the display.
23217 @item show debug dwarf2-die
23218 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
23219 @item set debug dwarf2-read
23220 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
23221 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23222 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23223 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23224 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23225 @item show debug dwarf2-read
23226 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
23227 @item set debug displaced
23228 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23229 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23230 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23231 @item show debug displaced
23232 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23233 related to displaced stepping.
23234 @item set debug event
23235 @cindex event debugging info
23236 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23237 default is off.
23238 @item show debug event
23239 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23240 info.
23241 @item set debug expression
23242 @cindex expression debugging info
23243 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23244 expression parsing. The default is off.
23245 @item show debug expression
23246 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23247 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23248 @item set debug frame
23249 @cindex frame debugging info
23250 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23251 default is off.
23252 @item show debug frame
23253 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23254 info.
23255 @item set debug gnu-nat
23256 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23257 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23258 @item show debug gnu-nat
23259 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23260 @item set debug infrun
23261 @cindex inferior debugging info
23262 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23263 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23264 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23265 @item show debug infrun
23266 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23267 @item set debug jit
23268 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23269 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23270 @item show debug jit
23271 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23272 @item set debug lin-lwp
23273 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23274 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23275 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23276 @item show debug lin-lwp
23277 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23278 @item set debug mach-o
23279 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23280 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23281 processing. The default is off.
23282 @item show debug mach-o
23283 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23284 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23285 @item set debug notification
23286 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23287 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23288 The default is off.
23289 @item show debug notification
23290 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23291 @item set debug observer
23292 @cindex observer debugging info
23293 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23294 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23295 @item show debug observer
23296 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23297 @item set debug overload
23298 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23299 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23300 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23301 is off.
23302 @item show debug overload
23303 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23304 debugging info.
23305 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23306 @cindex debug expression parser
23307 @item set debug parser
23308 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23309 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23310 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23311 details. The default is off.
23312 @item show debug parser
23313 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23314 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23315 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23316 @cindex debug remote protocol
23317 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23318 @cindex display remote packets
23319 @item set debug remote
23320 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23321 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23322 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23323 @item show debug remote
23324 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23325 @item set debug serial
23326 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23327 default is off.
23328 @item show debug serial
23329 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23330 info.
23331 @item set debug solib-frv
23332 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23333 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23334 @item show debug solib-frv
23335 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23336 messages.
23337 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23338 @cindex symbol lookup
23339 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23340 The default is 0 (off).
23341 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23342 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23343 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23344 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23345 @item set debug symfile
23346 @cindex symbol file functions
23347 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23348 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23349 @item show debug symfile
23350 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23351 @item set debug symtab-create
23352 @cindex symbol table creation
23353 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23354 The default is 0 (off).
23355 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23356 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23357 @item show debug symtab-create
23358 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23359 @item set debug target
23360 @cindex target debugging info
23361 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23362 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23363 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23364 value of large memory transfers.
23365 @item show debug target
23366 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23367 info.
23368 @item set debug timestamp
23369 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23370 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23371 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23372 message.
23373 @item show debug timestamp
23374 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23375 debugging info.
23376 @item set debug varobj
23377 @cindex variable object debugging info
23378 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23379 info. The default is off.
23380 @item show debug varobj
23381 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23382 debugging info.
23383 @item set debug xml
23384 @cindex XML parser debugging
23385 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23386 @item show debug xml
23387 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23388 @end table
23389
23390 @node Other Misc Settings
23391 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23392 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23393
23394 @table @code
23395 @kindex set interactive-mode
23396 @item set interactive-mode
23397 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23398 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23399 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23400 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23401 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23402 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23403 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23404 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23405
23406 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23407 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23408 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23409 inside a cygwin window.
23410
23411 @kindex show interactive-mode
23412 @item show interactive-mode
23413 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23414 @end table
23415
23416 @node Extending GDB
23417 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23418 @cindex extending GDB
23419
23420 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23421 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23422 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23423 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23424 being debugged.
23425
23426 @menu
23427 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23428 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23429 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23430 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23431 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23432 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23433 @end menu
23434
23435 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23436 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23437 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23438 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23439 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23440 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23441
23442 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23443 setting:
23444
23445 @table @code
23446 @kindex set script-extension
23447 @kindex show script-extension
23448 @item set script-extension off
23449 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23450
23451 @item set script-extension soft
23452 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23453 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23454 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23455 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23456
23457 @item set script-extension strict
23458 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23459 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23460 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23461
23462 @item show script-extension
23463 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23464
23465 @end table
23466
23467 @node Sequences
23468 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23469
23470 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23471 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23472 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23473 files.
23474
23475 @menu
23476 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23477 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23478 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23479 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23480 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23481 @end menu
23482
23483 @node Define
23484 @subsection User-defined Commands
23485
23486 @cindex user-defined command
23487 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23488 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23489 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23490 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23491 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23492 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23493
23494 @smallexample
23495 define adder
23496 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23497 end
23498 @end smallexample
23499
23500 @noindent
23501 To execute the command use:
23502
23503 @smallexample
23504 adder 1 2 3
23505 @end smallexample
23506
23507 @noindent
23508 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23509 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23510 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23511 functions calls.
23512
23513 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23514 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23515 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23516 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23517
23518 @smallexample
23519 define adder
23520 if $argc == 2
23521 print $arg0 + $arg1
23522 end
23523 if $argc == 3
23524 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23525 end
23526 end
23527 @end smallexample
23528
23529 @table @code
23530
23531 @kindex define
23532 @item define @var{commandname}
23533 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23534 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23535 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23536 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23537 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23538 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23539
23540 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23541 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23542 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23543
23544 @kindex document
23545 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23546 @item document @var{commandname}
23547 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23548 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23549 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23550 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23551 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23552 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23553
23554 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23555 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23556 does not change the documentation.
23557
23558 @kindex dont-repeat
23559 @cindex don't repeat command
23560 @item dont-repeat
23561 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23562 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23563 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23564
23565 @kindex help user-defined
23566 @item help user-defined
23567 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23568 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23569 included (if any).
23570
23571 @kindex show user
23572 @item show user
23573 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23574 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23575 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23576 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23577 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23578
23579 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23580 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23581 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23582 @item show max-user-call-depth
23583 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23584 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23585 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23586 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23587 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23588 @end table
23589
23590 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23591 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23592
23593 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23594 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23595 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23596
23597 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23598 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23599 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23600 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23601
23602 @node Hooks
23603 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23604 @cindex command hooks
23605 @cindex hooks, for commands
23606 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23607
23608 @kindex hook
23609 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23610 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23611 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23612 before that command.
23613
23614 @cindex hooks, post-command
23615 @kindex hookpost
23616 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23617 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23618 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23619 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23620 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23621
23622 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23623 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23624
23625 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23626 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23627
23628 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23629 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23630 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23631 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23632 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23633
23634 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23635 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23636 you could define:
23637
23638 @smallexample
23639 define hook-stop
23640 handle SIGALRM nopass
23641 end
23642
23643 define hook-run
23644 handle SIGALRM pass
23645 end
23646
23647 define hook-continue
23648 handle SIGALRM pass
23649 end
23650 @end smallexample
23651
23652 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23653 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23654 you could define:
23655
23656 @smallexample
23657 define hook-echo
23658 echo <<<---
23659 end
23660
23661 define hookpost-echo
23662 echo --->>>\n
23663 end
23664
23665 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23666 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23667 (@value{GDBP})
23668
23669 @end smallexample
23670
23671 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23672 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23673 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23674 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23675 @c or not?
23676 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23677 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23678 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23679
23680 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23681 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23682 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23683
23684 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23685 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23686
23687 @node Command Files
23688 @subsection Command Files
23689
23690 @cindex command files
23691 @cindex scripting commands
23692 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23693 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23694 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23695 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23696 terminal.
23697
23698 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23699 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23700 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23701 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23702 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23703
23704 @table @code
23705 @kindex source
23706 @cindex execute commands from a file
23707 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23708 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23709 @end table
23710
23711 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23712 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23713 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23714 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23715 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23716
23717 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23718 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23719 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23720 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23721 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23722 is not relevant to scripts.
23723
23724 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23725 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23726 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23727 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23728 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23729 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23730 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23731 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23732 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23733 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23734 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23735 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23736 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23737 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23738
23739 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23740 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23741 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23742
23743 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23744 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23745 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23746 when called from command files.
23747
23748 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23749 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23750 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23751 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23752 the next command.
23753
23754 @smallexample
23755 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23756 @end smallexample
23757
23758 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23759 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23760 would be directed to @file{log}.
23761
23762 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23763 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23764 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23765 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23766 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23767 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23768 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23769 conditionally, etc.
23770
23771 @table @code
23772 @kindex if
23773 @kindex else
23774 @item if
23775 @itemx else
23776 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23777 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23778 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23779 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23780 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23781 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23782 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23783
23784 @kindex while
23785 @item while
23786 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23787 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23788 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23789 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23790 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23791 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23792
23793 @kindex loop_break
23794 @item loop_break
23795 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23796 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23797 line.
23798
23799 @kindex loop_continue
23800 @item loop_continue
23801 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23802 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23803 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23804 the controlling expression.
23805
23806 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23807 @item end
23808 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23809 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23810 @end table
23811
23812
23813 @node Output
23814 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23815
23816 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23817 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23818 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23819 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23820 want.
23821
23822 @table @code
23823 @kindex echo
23824 @item echo @var{text}
23825 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23826 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23827 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23828 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23829 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23830 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23831 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23832 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23833 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23834 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23835 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23836
23837 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23838 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23839
23840 @smallexample
23841 echo This is some text\n\
23842 which is continued\n\
23843 onto several lines.\n
23844 @end smallexample
23845
23846 produces the same output as
23847
23848 @smallexample
23849 echo This is some text\n
23850 echo which is continued\n
23851 echo onto several lines.\n
23852 @end smallexample
23853
23854 @kindex output
23855 @item output @var{expression}
23856 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23857 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23858 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23859 on expressions.
23860
23861 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23862 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23863 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23864 Formats}, for more information.
23865
23866 @kindex printf
23867 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23868 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23869 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23870 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23871 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23872 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23873 executing the code below:
23874
23875 @smallexample
23876 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23877 @end smallexample
23878
23879 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23880 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23881 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23882 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23883 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23884 printed.
23885
23886 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23887
23888 @smallexample
23889 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23890 @end smallexample
23891
23892 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23893 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23894 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23895
23896 @itemize @bullet
23897 @item
23898 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23899
23900 @item
23901 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23902 width.
23903
23904 @item
23905 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23906 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23907
23908 @item
23909 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23910 supported.
23911
23912 @item
23913 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23914
23915 @item
23916 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23917 @end itemize
23918
23919 @noindent
23920 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23921 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23922 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23923 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23924
23925 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23926 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23927 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23928 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23929 supported.
23930
23931 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23932 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23933 together with a floating point specifier.
23934 letters:
23935
23936 @itemize @bullet
23937 @item
23938 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23939
23940 @item
23941 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23942
23943 @item
23944 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23945 @end itemize
23946
23947 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23948 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23949 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23950
23951 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23952 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23953
23954 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23955 @smallexample
23956 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23957 @end smallexample
23958
23959 @kindex eval
23960 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23961 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23962 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23963
23964 @end table
23965
23966 @node Auto-loading sequences
23967 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23968 @cindex native script auto-loading
23969
23970 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23971 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23972 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23973 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23974
23975 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23976 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23977
23978 @table @code
23979 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23980 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23981 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23982 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23983
23984 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23985 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23986 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23987 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23988 disabled.
23989
23990 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23991 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23992 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23993 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23994 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23995 auto-loaded.
23996 @end table
23997
23998 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23999 matching names are printed.
24000
24001 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24002 @include python.texi
24003
24004 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24005 @include guile.texi
24006
24007 @node Auto-loading extensions
24008 @section Auto-loading extensions
24009 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24010
24011 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24012 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24013 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24014 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24015 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24016
24017 @menu
24018 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24019 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24020 * Which flavor to choose?::
24021 @end menu
24022
24023 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24024 debugging commands and features.
24025
24026 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24027 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24028 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24029 for more information.
24030 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24031 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24032
24033 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24034 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24035
24036 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24037 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24038 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24039 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24040 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24041
24042 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24043 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24044 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24045 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24046
24047 @table @code
24048 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24049 GDB's own command language
24050 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24051 Python
24052 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24053 Guile
24054 @end table
24055
24056 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24057 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24058 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24059 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24060 script in the specified extension language.
24061
24062 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24063 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24064
24065 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24066 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24067
24068 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24069 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24070 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24071 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24072 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24073 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24074
24075 @table @code
24076 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24077 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24078 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24079 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24080 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24081 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24082
24083 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24084 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24085
24086 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24087 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24088 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24089 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24090
24091 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24092 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24093 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24094 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24095 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24096 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24097 platform.
24098
24099 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24100 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24101 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24102
24103 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24104 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24105 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24106 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24107
24108 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24109 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24110 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24111 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24112 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24113 @end table
24114
24115 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24116 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24117 @var{objfile} is opened.
24118 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24119 is evaluated more than once.
24120
24121 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24122 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24123 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24124
24125 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24126 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24127 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24128 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24129 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24130 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24131 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24132
24133 The following entries are supported:
24134
24135 @table @code
24136 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24137 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24138 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24139 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24140 @end table
24141
24142 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24143
24144 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24145 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24146 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24147 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24148 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24149
24150 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24151 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24152
24153 @example
24154 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24155 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24156 asm("\
24157 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24158 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24159 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24160 .popsection \n\
24161 ");
24162 @end example
24163
24164 @noindent
24165 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24166 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24167
24168 @example
24169 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24170 @end example
24171
24172 The script name may include directories if desired.
24173
24174 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24175 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24176
24177 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24178 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24179 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24180 will remove duplicates.
24181
24182 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24183
24184 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24185 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24186 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24187 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24188 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24189 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24190 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24191 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24192 on its name.
24193
24194 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24195 testsuite.
24196
24197 @example
24198 #include "symcat.h"
24199 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24200 asm(
24201 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24202 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24203 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24204 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24205 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24206 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24207 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24208 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24209 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24210 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24211 ".byte 0\n"
24212 ".popsection\n"
24213 );
24214 @end example
24215
24216 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24217 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24218 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24219 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24220
24221 @node Which flavor to choose?
24222 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24223
24224 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24225 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24226
24227 @noindent
24228 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24229
24230 @itemize @bullet
24231 @item
24232 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24233
24234 @item
24235 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24236
24237 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24238 in the source search path.
24239 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24240 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24241
24242 @item
24243 Doesn't require source code additions.
24244 @end itemize
24245
24246 @noindent
24247 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24248
24249 @itemize @bullet
24250 @item
24251 Works with static linking.
24252
24253 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24254 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24255 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24256 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24257 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24258
24259 @item
24260 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24261
24262 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24263 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24264
24265 @item
24266 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24267
24268 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24269 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24270 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24271 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24272 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24273 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24274 @end itemize
24275
24276 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24277 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24278
24279 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24280 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24281 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24282
24283 @subsection Python comes first
24284
24285 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24286 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24287 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24288 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24289 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24290 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24291 pretty-printed form of a value).
24292 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24293 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24294 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24295
24296 @node Aliases
24297 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24298 @cindex aliases for commands
24299
24300 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24301 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24302 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24303 that involves less typing.
24304
24305 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24306 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24307 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24308
24309 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24310 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24311 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24312
24313 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24314
24315 @table @code
24316
24317 @kindex alias
24318 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24319
24320 @end table
24321
24322 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24323 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24324 underscores.
24325
24326 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24327 that is being aliased.
24328
24329 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24330 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24331 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24332
24333 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24334 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24335
24336 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24337 of a command so that there is less to type.
24338 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24339 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24340 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24341 The following will accomplish this.
24342
24343 @smallexample
24344 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24345 @end smallexample
24346
24347 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24348 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24349 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24350 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24351
24352 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24353 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24354 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24355 of a command.
24356
24357 @smallexample
24358 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24359 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24360 (gdb) set p elms 20
24361 (gdb) show p elms
24362 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24363 @end smallexample
24364
24365 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24366 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24367 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24368
24369 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24370 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24371
24372 @smallexample
24373 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24374 @end smallexample
24375
24376 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24377 alias for a more complex command.
24378 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24379
24380 @smallexample
24381 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24382 (gdb) spe 20
24383 @end smallexample
24384
24385 @node Interpreters
24386 @chapter Command Interpreters
24387 @cindex command interpreters
24388
24389 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24390 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24391 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24392
24393 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24394 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24395 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24396 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24397
24398 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24399 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24400 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24401 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24402
24403 @table @code
24404 @item console
24405 @cindex console interpreter
24406 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24407 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24408 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24409
24410 @item mi
24411 @cindex mi interpreter
24412 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24413 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24414 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24415 Interface}.
24416
24417 @item mi2
24418 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24419 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24420
24421 @item mi1
24422 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24423 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24424
24425 @end table
24426
24427 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24428 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24429 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24430 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24431 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24432 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24433 the IDE inoperable!
24434
24435 @kindex interpreter-exec
24436 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24437 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24438 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24439 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24440
24441 @smallexample
24442 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24443 @end smallexample
24444
24445 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24446 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24447
24448 @node TUI
24449 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24450 @cindex TUI
24451 @cindex Text User Interface
24452
24453 @menu
24454 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24455 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24456 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24457 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24458 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24459 @end menu
24460
24461 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24462 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24463 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24464 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24465 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24466 is available.
24467
24468 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24469 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24470 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24471 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24472 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24473
24474 @node TUI Overview
24475 @section TUI Overview
24476
24477 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24478
24479 @table @emph
24480 @item command
24481 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24482 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24483 managed using readline.
24484
24485 @item source
24486 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24487 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24488
24489 @item assembly
24490 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24491
24492 @item register
24493 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24494 when their values change.
24495 @end table
24496
24497 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24498 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24499 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24500 indicates the breakpoint type:
24501
24502 @table @code
24503 @item B
24504 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24505
24506 @item b
24507 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24508
24509 @item H
24510 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24511
24512 @item h
24513 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24514 @end table
24515
24516 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24517
24518 @table @code
24519 @item +
24520 Breakpoint is enabled.
24521
24522 @item -
24523 Breakpoint is disabled.
24524 @end table
24525
24526 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24527 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24528 changes.
24529
24530 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24531 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24532 layouts:
24533
24534 @itemize @bullet
24535 @item
24536 source only,
24537
24538 @item
24539 assembly only,
24540
24541 @item
24542 source and assembly,
24543
24544 @item
24545 source and registers, or
24546
24547 @item
24548 assembly and registers.
24549 @end itemize
24550
24551 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24552
24553 @table @emph
24554 @item target
24555 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24556 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24557
24558 @item process
24559 Gives the current process or thread number.
24560 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24561
24562 @item function
24563 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24564 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24565 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24566 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24567
24568 @item line
24569 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24570 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24571
24572 @item pc
24573 Indicates the current program counter address.
24574 @end table
24575
24576 @node TUI Keys
24577 @section TUI Key Bindings
24578 @cindex TUI key bindings
24579
24580 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24581 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24582 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24583 @end ifset
24584 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24585 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24586 @end ifclear
24587 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24588 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24589
24590 @table @kbd
24591 @kindex C-x C-a
24592 @item C-x C-a
24593 @kindex C-x a
24594 @itemx C-x a
24595 @kindex C-x A
24596 @itemx C-x A
24597 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24598 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24599 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24600 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24601 The screen is then refreshed.
24602
24603 @kindex C-x 1
24604 @item C-x 1
24605 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24606 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24607 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24608
24609 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24610
24611 @kindex C-x 2
24612 @item C-x 2
24613 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24614 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24615 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24616 previous layout and the new one.
24617
24618 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24619
24620 @kindex C-x o
24621 @item C-x o
24622 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24623 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24624 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24625
24626 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24627
24628 @kindex C-x s
24629 @item C-x s
24630 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24631 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24632 @end table
24633
24634 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24635
24636 @table @asis
24637 @kindex PgUp
24638 @item @key{PgUp}
24639 Scroll the active window one page up.
24640
24641 @kindex PgDn
24642 @item @key{PgDn}
24643 Scroll the active window one page down.
24644
24645 @kindex Up
24646 @item @key{Up}
24647 Scroll the active window one line up.
24648
24649 @kindex Down
24650 @item @key{Down}
24651 Scroll the active window one line down.
24652
24653 @kindex Left
24654 @item @key{Left}
24655 Scroll the active window one column left.
24656
24657 @kindex Right
24658 @item @key{Right}
24659 Scroll the active window one column right.
24660
24661 @kindex C-L
24662 @item @kbd{C-L}
24663 Refresh the screen.
24664 @end table
24665
24666 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24667 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24668 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24669 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24670 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24671
24672 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24673 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24674 @cindex TUI single key mode
24675
24676 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24677 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24678 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24679
24680 @table @kbd
24681 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24682 @item c
24683 continue
24684
24685 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24686 @item d
24687 down
24688
24689 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24690 @item f
24691 finish
24692
24693 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24694 @item n
24695 next
24696
24697 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24698 @item q
24699 exit the SingleKey mode.
24700
24701 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24702 @item r
24703 run
24704
24705 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24706 @item s
24707 step
24708
24709 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24710 @item u
24711 up
24712
24713 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24714 @item v
24715 info locals
24716
24717 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24718 @item w
24719 where
24720 @end table
24721
24722 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24723 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24724 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24725 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24726 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24727 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24728
24729
24730 @node TUI Commands
24731 @section TUI-specific Commands
24732 @cindex TUI commands
24733
24734 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24735 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24736 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24737 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24738
24739 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24740 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24741 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24742 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24743 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24744
24745 @table @code
24746 @item info win
24747 @kindex info win
24748 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24749
24750 @item layout next
24751 @kindex layout
24752 Display the next layout.
24753
24754 @item layout prev
24755 Display the previous layout.
24756
24757 @item layout src
24758 Display the source window only.
24759
24760 @item layout asm
24761 Display the assembly window only.
24762
24763 @item layout split
24764 Display the source and assembly window.
24765
24766 @item layout regs
24767 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24768
24769 @item focus next
24770 @kindex focus
24771 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24772
24773 @item focus prev
24774 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24775
24776 @item focus src
24777 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24778
24779 @item focus asm
24780 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24781
24782 @item focus regs
24783 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24784
24785 @item focus cmd
24786 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24787
24788 @item refresh
24789 @kindex refresh
24790 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24791
24792 @item tui reg float
24793 @kindex tui reg
24794 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24795
24796 @item tui reg general
24797 Show the general registers in the register window.
24798
24799 @item tui reg next
24800 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24801 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24802 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24803 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24804
24805 @item tui reg system
24806 Show the system registers in the register window.
24807
24808 @item update
24809 @kindex update
24810 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24811
24812 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24813 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24814 @kindex winheight
24815 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24816 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24817 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
24818 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
24819 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
24820
24821 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24822 @kindex tabset
24823 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
24824 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
24825 assembly windows.
24826 @end table
24827
24828 @node TUI Configuration
24829 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24830 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24831
24832 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24833
24834 @table @code
24835 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24836 @kindex set tui border-kind
24837 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24838 The possible values are the following:
24839 @table @code
24840 @item space
24841 Use a space character to draw the border.
24842
24843 @item ascii
24844 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24845
24846 @item acs
24847 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24848 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24849 @end table
24850
24851 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24852 @kindex set tui border-mode
24853 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24854 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24855 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24856 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24857 @table @code
24858 @item normal
24859 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24860
24861 @item standout
24862 Use standout mode.
24863
24864 @item reverse
24865 Use reverse video mode.
24866
24867 @item half
24868 Use half bright mode.
24869
24870 @item half-standout
24871 Use half bright and standout mode.
24872
24873 @item bold
24874 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24875
24876 @item bold-standout
24877 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24878 @end table
24879 @end table
24880
24881 @node Emacs
24882 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24883
24884 @cindex Emacs
24885 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24886 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24887 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24888 @value{GDBN}.
24889
24890 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24891 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24892 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24893 created Emacs buffer.
24894 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24895
24896 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24897 things:
24898
24899 @itemize @bullet
24900 @item
24901 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24902 the GUD buffer.
24903
24904 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24905 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24906
24907 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24908 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24909 in this way.
24910
24911 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24912 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24913 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24914 stop.
24915
24916 @item
24917 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24918
24919 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24920 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24921 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24922 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24923 and the source.
24924
24925 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24926 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24927 @end itemize
24928
24929 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24930 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24931 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24932 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24933
24934 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24935 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24936 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24937 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24938 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24939 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24940 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24941 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24942 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24943
24944 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24945 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24946 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24947 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24948
24949 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24950 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24951 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24952 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24953 one you want.
24954
24955 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24956 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24957
24958 @table @kbd
24959 @item C-h m
24960 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24961
24962 @item C-c C-s
24963 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24964 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24965
24966 @item C-c C-n
24967 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24968 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24969 to show the current file and location.
24970
24971 @item C-c C-i
24972 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24973 display window accordingly.
24974
24975 @item C-c C-f
24976 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24977 @code{finish} command.
24978
24979 @item C-c C-r
24980 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24981 command.
24982
24983 @item C-c <
24984 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24985 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24986 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24987
24988 @item C-c >
24989 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24990 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24991 @end table
24992
24993 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24994 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24995
24996 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24997 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24998 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24999 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25000 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25001 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25002 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25003
25004 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25005 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25006 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25007 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25008 frame.
25009
25010 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25011 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25012 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25013 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25014 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25015 to correspond properly with the code.
25016
25017 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25018 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25019 Emacs Manual}).
25020
25021 @node GDB/MI
25022 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25023
25024 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25025
25026 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25027 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25028 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25029 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25030 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25031 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25032
25033 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25034 in the form of a reference manual.
25035
25036 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25037 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25038 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25039
25040 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25041
25042 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25043 This chapter uses the following notation:
25044
25045 @itemize @bullet
25046 @item
25047 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25048
25049 @item
25050 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25051 it may or may not be given.
25052
25053 @item
25054 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25055 may repeat zero or more times.
25056
25057 @item
25058 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25059 may repeat one or more times.
25060
25061 @item
25062 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25063 @end itemize
25064
25065 @ignore
25066 @heading Dependencies
25067 @end ignore
25068
25069 @menu
25070 * GDB/MI General Design::
25071 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25072 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25073 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25074 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25075 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25076 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25077 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25078 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25079 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25080 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25081 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25082 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25083 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25084 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25085 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25086 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25087 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25088 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25089 @ignore
25090 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25091 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25092 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25093 @end ignore
25094 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25095 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25096 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25097 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25098 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25099 @end menu
25100
25101 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25102 @node GDB/MI General Design
25103 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25104 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25105
25106 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25107 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25108 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25109 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25110 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25111 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25112 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25113 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25114 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25115 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25116
25117 The important examples of notifications are:
25118 @itemize @bullet
25119
25120 @item
25121 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25122 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25123 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25124 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25125 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25126 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25127 command itself was successfully executed.
25128
25129 @item
25130 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25131 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25132 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25133 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25134 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25135 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25136
25137 @item
25138 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25139 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25140 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25141 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25142 orthogonal frontend design.
25143
25144 @end itemize
25145
25146 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25147 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25148 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25149 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25150 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25151 the user interface.
25152
25153
25154 @menu
25155 * Context management::
25156 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25157 * Thread groups::
25158 @end menu
25159
25160 @node Context management
25161 @subsection Context management
25162
25163 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25164
25165 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25166 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25167 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25168 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25169 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25170 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25171 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25172 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25173 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25174
25175 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25176 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25177 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25178 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25179 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25180 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25181 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25182 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25183 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25184 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25185 for thread and frame to operate on.
25186
25187 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25188 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25189 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25190 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25191 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25192 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25193 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25194 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25195 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25196 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25197
25198 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25199 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25200 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25201 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25202 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25203 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25204 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25205 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25206 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25207 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25208 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25209 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25210 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25211 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25212 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25213 @samp{--frame} options.
25214
25215 @subsubsection Language
25216
25217 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25218 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25219 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25220 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25221 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25222 For instance:
25223
25224 @smallexample
25225 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25226 ^done,value="4"
25227 (gdb)
25228 @end smallexample
25229
25230 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25231 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25232 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25233
25234 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25235 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25236
25237 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25238 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25239 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25240 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25241 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25242 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25243 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25244 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25245 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25246
25247 @table @code
25248 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25249 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25250 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25251
25252 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25253 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25254 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25255
25256 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25257 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25258 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25259 MI commands even while the target is running.
25260
25261 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25262 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25263 @end table
25264
25265 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25266 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25267 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25268 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25269 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25270 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25271
25272 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25273 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25274 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25275 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25276 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25277 are running.
25278
25279 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25280 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25281 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25282 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25283 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25284 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25285 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25286 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25287 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25288 @samp{--thread} option).
25289
25290 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25291 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25292 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25293 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25294
25295 @node Thread groups
25296 @subsection Thread groups
25297 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25298 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25299 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25300 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25301 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25302
25303 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25304 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25305 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25306 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25307 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25308 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25309 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25310 into processes.
25311
25312 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25313 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25314 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25315 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25316 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25317 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25318 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25319 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25320 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25321 the members of specific thread group.
25322
25323 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25324 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25325 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25326 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25327 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25328 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25329 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25330 after attaching to that thread group.
25331
25332 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25333 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25334 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25335 such thread groups.
25336
25337 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25338 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25339 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25340
25341 @menu
25342 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25343 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25344 @end menu
25345
25346 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25347 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25348
25349 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25350 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25351 @table @code
25352 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25353 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25354
25355 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25356 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25357 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25358
25359 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25360 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25361 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25362
25363 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25364 "any sequence of digits"
25365
25366 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25367 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25368
25369 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25370 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25371
25372 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25373 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25374
25375 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25376 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25377 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25378
25379 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25380 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25381
25382 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25383 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25384 @end table
25385
25386 @noindent
25387 Notes:
25388
25389 @itemize @bullet
25390 @item
25391 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25392 output is described below.
25393
25394 @item
25395 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25396 finishes.
25397
25398 @item
25399 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25400 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25401 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25402 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25403 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25404 @end itemize
25405
25406 Pragmatics:
25407
25408 @itemize @bullet
25409 @item
25410 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25411
25412 @item
25413 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25414 @end itemize
25415
25416 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25417 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25418
25419 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25420 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25421 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25422 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25423 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25424 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25425
25426 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25427 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25428 @var{token}.
25429
25430 @table @code
25431 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25432 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25433
25434 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25435 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25436
25437 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25438 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25439
25440 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25441 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25442
25443 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25444 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25445
25446 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25447 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25448
25449 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25450 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25451
25452 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25453 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25454
25455 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25456 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25457
25458 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25459 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25460 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25461
25462 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25463 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25464
25465 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25466 @code{ @var{string} }
25467
25468 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25469 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25470
25471 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25472 @code{@var{c-string}}
25473
25474 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25475 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25476
25477 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25478 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25479 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25480
25481 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25482 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25483
25484 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25485 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25486
25487 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25488 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25489
25490 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25491 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25492
25493 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25494 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25495
25496 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25497 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25498 @end table
25499
25500 @noindent
25501 Notes:
25502
25503 @itemize @bullet
25504 @item
25505 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25506
25507 @item
25508 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25509 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25510 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25511 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25512 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25513 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25514 prior command.
25515
25516 @item
25517 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25518 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25519 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25520 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25521
25522 @item
25523 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25524 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25525 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25526 @samp{*}.
25527
25528 @item
25529 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25530 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25531 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25532 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25533
25534 @item
25535 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25536 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25537 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25538 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25539
25540 @item
25541 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25542 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25543 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25544
25545 @item
25546 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25547 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25548 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25549 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25550
25551 @item
25552 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25553 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25554 @var{values}.
25555
25556
25557 @end itemize
25558
25559 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25560 details about the various output records.
25561
25562 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25563 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25564 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25565
25566 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25567 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25568
25569 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25570 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25571 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25572 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25573 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25574 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25575
25576 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25577 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25578 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25579
25580 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25581 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25582 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25583 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25584
25585 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25586 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25587
25588 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25589 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25590 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25591 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25592 might change.
25593
25594 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25595 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25596 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25597 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25598
25599 @itemize @bullet
25600 @item
25601 New MI commands may be added.
25602
25603 @item
25604 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25605
25606 @item
25607 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25608 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25609
25610 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25611 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25612
25613 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25614 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25615 @end itemize
25616
25617 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25618 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25619 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25620 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25621 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25622
25623 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25624 @c version?
25625
25626 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25627 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25628 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25629 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25630 @cindex mailing lists
25631
25632 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25633 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25634 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25635
25636 @menu
25637 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25638 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25639 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25640 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25641 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25642 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25643 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25644 @end menu
25645
25646 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25647 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25648
25649 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25650 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25651 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25652 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25653
25654 @table @code
25655 @findex ^done
25656 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25657 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25658 values.
25659
25660 @item "^running"
25661 @findex ^running
25662 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25663 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25664 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25665 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25666 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25667 which threads are resumed.
25668
25669 @item "^connected"
25670 @findex ^connected
25671 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25672
25673 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25674 @findex ^error
25675 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25676 the corresponding error message.
25677
25678 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25679 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25680 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25681
25682 @table @samp
25683 @item "undefined-command"
25684 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25685 @end table
25686
25687 @item "^exit"
25688 @findex ^exit
25689 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25690
25691 @end table
25692
25693 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25694 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25695
25696 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25697 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25698 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25699 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25700 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25701
25702 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25703 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25704 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25705 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25706 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25707
25708 @table @code
25709 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25710 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25711 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25712
25713 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25714 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25715 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25716 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25717
25718 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25719 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25720 internals.
25721 @end table
25722
25723 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25724 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25725
25726 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25727 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25728 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25729 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25730 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25731 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25732
25733 The following is the list of possible async records:
25734
25735 @table @code
25736
25737 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25738 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25739 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25740 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25741 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25742 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25743 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25744 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25745 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25746 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25747
25748 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25749 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25750 following values:
25751
25752 @table @code
25753 @item breakpoint-hit
25754 A breakpoint was reached.
25755 @item watchpoint-trigger
25756 A watchpoint was triggered.
25757 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25758 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25759 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25760 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25761 @item function-finished
25762 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25763 @item location-reached
25764 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25765 @item watchpoint-scope
25766 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25767 @item end-stepping-range
25768 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25769 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25770 @item exited-signalled
25771 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25772 @item exited
25773 The inferior exited.
25774 @item exited-normally
25775 The inferior exited normally.
25776 @item signal-received
25777 A signal was received by the inferior.
25778 @item solib-event
25779 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25780 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25781 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25782 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25783 @item fork
25784 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25785 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25786 @item vfork
25787 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25788 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25789 @item syscall-entry
25790 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25791 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25792 @item syscall-entry
25793 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25794 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25795 @item exec
25796 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25797 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25798 @end table
25799
25800 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25801 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25802 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25803 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25804 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25805 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25806 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25807 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25808 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25809 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25810 if such information is not available.
25811
25812 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25813 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25814 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25815 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25816 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25817 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25818 cannot be used in any way.
25819
25820 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25821 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25822 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25823 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25824 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25825 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25826
25827 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25828 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25829 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25830 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25831 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25832 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25833
25834 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25835 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25836 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25837 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25838 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25839
25840 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25841 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25842 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25843 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25844 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25845 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25846 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25847
25848 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25849 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25850 that thread.
25851
25852 @item =library-loaded,...
25853 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25854 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25855 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25856 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25857 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25858 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25859 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25860 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25861 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25862 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25863 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25864 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25865 thread groups.
25866
25867 @item =library-unloaded,...
25868 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25869 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25870 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25871 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25872 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25873 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25874 thread groups.
25875
25876 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25877 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25878 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25879 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25880 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25881
25882 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25883 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25884 initial value @var{initial}.
25885
25886 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25887 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25888 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25889 trace state variables are deleted.
25890
25891 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25892 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25893 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25894 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25895 value of trace state variable is known.
25896
25897 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25898 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25899 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25900 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25901 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25902 user.
25903
25904 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25905 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25906 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25907
25908 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25909 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25910
25911 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25912 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25913 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25914 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25915 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25916
25917 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25918 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25919 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25920 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25921 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25922 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25923
25924 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25925 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25926 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25927 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25928 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25929 executable code.
25930 @end table
25931
25932 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25933 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25934
25935 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25936 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25937 following fields:
25938
25939 @table @code
25940 @item number
25941 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25942 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25943 @samp{1.2}.
25944
25945 @item type
25946 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25947 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25948
25949 @item catch-type
25950 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25951 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25952
25953 @item disp
25954 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25955 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25956 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25957
25958 @item enabled
25959 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25960 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25961 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25962
25963 @item addr
25964 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25965 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25966 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25967 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25968 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25969
25970 @item func
25971 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25972 If not known, this field is not present.
25973
25974 @item filename
25975 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25976 If not known, this field is not present.
25977
25978 @item fullname
25979 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25980 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25981
25982 @item line
25983 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25984 If not known, this field is not present.
25985
25986 @item at
25987 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25988 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25989 by a symbol name.
25990
25991 @item pending
25992 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25993 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25994
25995 @item evaluated-by
25996 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25997 @samp{target}.
25998
25999 @item thread
26000 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26001 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26002
26003 @item task
26004 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26005 field will hold the task identifier.
26006
26007 @item cond
26008 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26009
26010 @item ignore
26011 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26012
26013 @item enable
26014 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26015
26016 @item traceframe-usage
26017 FIXME.
26018
26019 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26020 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26021
26022 @item mask
26023 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26024
26025 @item pass
26026 A tracepoint's pass count.
26027
26028 @item original-location
26029 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26030 This field is optional.
26031
26032 @item times
26033 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26034
26035 @item installed
26036 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26037 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26038 is not.
26039
26040 @item what
26041 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26042
26043 @end table
26044
26045 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26046 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26047
26048 @smallexample
26049 -> -break-insert main
26050 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26051 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26052 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26053 times="0"@}
26054 <- (gdb)
26055 @end smallexample
26056
26057 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26058 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26059
26060 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26061 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26062 fields:
26063
26064 @table @code
26065 @item level
26066 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26067 zero. This field is always present.
26068
26069 @item func
26070 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26071 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26072
26073 @item addr
26074 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26075
26076 @item file
26077 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26078 address. This field may be absent.
26079
26080 @item line
26081 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26082 may be absent.
26083
26084 @item from
26085 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26086 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26087
26088 @end table
26089
26090 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26091 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26092
26093 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26094 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26095
26096 @table @code
26097 @item id
26098 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26099 always present.
26100
26101 @item target-id
26102 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26103
26104 @item details
26105 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26106 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26107 frontend. This field is optional.
26108
26109 @item state
26110 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26111 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26112
26113 @item core
26114 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26115 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26116 @end table
26117
26118 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26119 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26120
26121 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26122 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26123 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26124 the @code{exception-name} field.
26125
26126 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26127 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26128 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26129 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26130
26131 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26132 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26133 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26134 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26135
26136 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26137 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26138
26139 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26140
26141 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26142 information of the breakpoint.
26143
26144 @smallexample
26145 -> -break-insert main
26146 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26147 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26148 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26149 times="0"@}
26150 <- (gdb)
26151 @end smallexample
26152
26153 @subheading Program Execution
26154
26155 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26156 reason that execution stopped.
26157
26158 @smallexample
26159 -> -exec-run
26160 <- ^running
26161 <- (gdb)
26162 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26163 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26164 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26165 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26166 <- (gdb)
26167 -> -exec-continue
26168 <- ^running
26169 <- (gdb)
26170 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26171 <- (gdb)
26172 @end smallexample
26173
26174 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26175
26176 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26177
26178 @smallexample
26179 -> (gdb)
26180 <- -gdb-exit
26181 <- ^exit
26182 @end smallexample
26183
26184 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26185 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26186 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26187 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26188 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26189 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26190
26191 @subheading A Bad Command
26192
26193 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26194
26195 @smallexample
26196 -> -rubbish
26197 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26198 <- (gdb)
26199 @end smallexample
26200
26201
26202 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26203 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26204 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26205
26206 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26207 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26208
26209 @subheading Motivation
26210
26211 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26212
26213 @subheading Introduction
26214
26215 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26216
26217 @subheading Commands
26218
26219 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26220
26221 @subsubheading Synopsis
26222
26223 @smallexample
26224 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26225 @end smallexample
26226
26227 @subsubheading Result
26228
26229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26230
26231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26232
26233 @subsubheading Example
26234
26235 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26236 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26237
26238
26239 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26240 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26241 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26242
26243 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26244 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26245 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26246 breakpoints.
26247
26248 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26249 @findex -break-after
26250
26251 @subsubheading Synopsis
26252
26253 @smallexample
26254 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26255 @end smallexample
26256
26257 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26258 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26259 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26260 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26261
26262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26263
26264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26265
26266 @subsubheading Example
26267
26268 @smallexample
26269 (gdb)
26270 -break-insert main
26271 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26272 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26273 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26274 times="0"@}
26275 (gdb)
26276 -break-after 1 3
26277 ~
26278 ^done
26279 (gdb)
26280 -break-list
26281 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26282 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26283 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26284 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26285 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26286 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26287 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26288 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26289 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26290 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26291 (gdb)
26292 @end smallexample
26293
26294 @ignore
26295 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26296 @findex -break-catch
26297 @end ignore
26298
26299 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26300 @findex -break-commands
26301
26302 @subsubheading Synopsis
26303
26304 @smallexample
26305 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26306 @end smallexample
26307
26308 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26309 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26310 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26311 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26312 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26313 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26314
26315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26316
26317 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26318
26319 @subsubheading Example
26320
26321 @smallexample
26322 (gdb)
26323 -break-insert main
26324 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26325 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26326 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26327 times="0"@}
26328 (gdb)
26329 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26330 ^done
26331 (gdb)
26332 @end smallexample
26333
26334 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26335 @findex -break-condition
26336
26337 @subsubheading Synopsis
26338
26339 @smallexample
26340 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26341 @end smallexample
26342
26343 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26344 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26345 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26346 command below).
26347
26348 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26349
26350 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26351
26352 @subsubheading Example
26353
26354 @smallexample
26355 (gdb)
26356 -break-condition 1 1
26357 ^done
26358 (gdb)
26359 -break-list
26360 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26361 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26362 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26363 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26364 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26365 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26366 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26367 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26368 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26369 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26370 (gdb)
26371 @end smallexample
26372
26373 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26374 @findex -break-delete
26375
26376 @subsubheading Synopsis
26377
26378 @smallexample
26379 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26380 @end smallexample
26381
26382 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26383 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26384
26385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26386
26387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26388
26389 @subsubheading Example
26390
26391 @smallexample
26392 (gdb)
26393 -break-delete 1
26394 ^done
26395 (gdb)
26396 -break-list
26397 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26398 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26399 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26400 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26401 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26402 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26403 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26404 body=[]@}
26405 (gdb)
26406 @end smallexample
26407
26408 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26409 @findex -break-disable
26410
26411 @subsubheading Synopsis
26412
26413 @smallexample
26414 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26415 @end smallexample
26416
26417 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26418 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26419
26420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26421
26422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26423
26424 @subsubheading Example
26425
26426 @smallexample
26427 (gdb)
26428 -break-disable 2
26429 ^done
26430 (gdb)
26431 -break-list
26432 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26433 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26434 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26435 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26436 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26437 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26438 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26439 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26440 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26441 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26442 (gdb)
26443 @end smallexample
26444
26445 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26446 @findex -break-enable
26447
26448 @subsubheading Synopsis
26449
26450 @smallexample
26451 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26452 @end smallexample
26453
26454 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26455
26456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26457
26458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26459
26460 @subsubheading Example
26461
26462 @smallexample
26463 (gdb)
26464 -break-enable 2
26465 ^done
26466 (gdb)
26467 -break-list
26468 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26469 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26470 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26471 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26472 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26473 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26474 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26475 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26476 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26477 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26478 (gdb)
26479 @end smallexample
26480
26481 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26482 @findex -break-info
26483
26484 @subsubheading Synopsis
26485
26486 @smallexample
26487 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26488 @end smallexample
26489
26490 @c REDUNDANT???
26491 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26492
26493 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26494 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26495 table.
26496
26497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26498
26499 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26500
26501 @subsubheading Example
26502 N.A.
26503
26504 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26505 @findex -break-insert
26506
26507 @subsubheading Synopsis
26508
26509 @smallexample
26510 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26511 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26512 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26513 @end smallexample
26514
26515 @noindent
26516 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26517
26518 @itemize @bullet
26519 @item function
26520 @c @item +offset
26521 @c @item -offset
26522 @c @item linenum
26523 @item filename:linenum
26524 @item filename:function
26525 @item *address
26526 @end itemize
26527
26528 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26529
26530 @table @samp
26531 @item -t
26532 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26533 @item -h
26534 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26535 @item -f
26536 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26537 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26538 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26539 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26540 cannot be parsed.
26541 @item -d
26542 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26543 @item -a
26544 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26545 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26546 @item -c @var{condition}
26547 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26548 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26549 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26550 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26551 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26552 @end table
26553
26554 @subsubheading Result
26555
26556 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26557 resulting breakpoint.
26558
26559 Note: this format is open to change.
26560 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26561
26562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26563
26564 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26565 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26566
26567 @subsubheading Example
26568
26569 @smallexample
26570 (gdb)
26571 -break-insert main
26572 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26573 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26574 times="0"@}
26575 (gdb)
26576 -break-insert -t foo
26577 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26578 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26579 times="0"@}
26580 (gdb)
26581 -break-list
26582 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26583 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26584 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26585 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26586 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26587 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26588 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26589 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26590 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26591 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26592 times="0"@},
26593 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26594 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26595 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26596 times="0"@}]@}
26597 (gdb)
26598 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26599 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26600 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26601 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26602 @c times="0"@}
26603 @c (gdb)
26604 @end smallexample
26605
26606 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26607 @findex -dprintf-insert
26608
26609 @subsubheading Synopsis
26610
26611 @smallexample
26612 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26613 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26614 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26615 [ @var{argument} ]
26616 @end smallexample
26617
26618 @noindent
26619 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26620
26621 @itemize @bullet
26622 @item @var{function}
26623 @c @item +offset
26624 @c @item -offset
26625 @c @item @var{linenum}
26626 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26627 @item @var{filename}:function
26628 @item *@var{address}
26629 @end itemize
26630
26631 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26632
26633 @table @samp
26634 @item -t
26635 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26636 @item -f
26637 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26638 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26639 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26640 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26641 cannot be parsed.
26642 @item -d
26643 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26644 @item -c @var{condition}
26645 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26646 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26647 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26648 to @var{ignore-count}.
26649 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26650 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26651 @end table
26652
26653 @subsubheading Result
26654
26655 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26656 resulting breakpoint.
26657
26658 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26659
26660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26661
26662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26663
26664 @subsubheading Example
26665
26666 @smallexample
26667 (gdb)
26668 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26669 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26670 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26671 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26672 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26673 original-location="foo"@}
26674 (gdb)
26675 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26676 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26677 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26678 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26679 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26680 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26681 (gdb)
26682 @end smallexample
26683
26684 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26685 @findex -break-list
26686
26687 @subsubheading Synopsis
26688
26689 @smallexample
26690 -break-list
26691 @end smallexample
26692
26693 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26694
26695 @table @samp
26696 @item Number
26697 number of the breakpoint
26698 @item Type
26699 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26700 @item Disposition
26701 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26702 or @samp{nokeep}
26703 @item Enabled
26704 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26705 @item Address
26706 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26707 @item What
26708 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26709 name, line number
26710 @item Thread-groups
26711 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26712 @item Times
26713 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26714 @end table
26715
26716 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26717 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26718
26719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26720
26721 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26722
26723 @subsubheading Example
26724
26725 @smallexample
26726 (gdb)
26727 -break-list
26728 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26729 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26730 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26731 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26732 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26733 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26734 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26735 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26736 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26737 times="0"@},
26738 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26739 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26740 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26741 (gdb)
26742 @end smallexample
26743
26744 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26745
26746 @smallexample
26747 (gdb)
26748 -break-list
26749 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26750 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26751 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26752 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26753 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26754 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26755 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26756 body=[]@}
26757 (gdb)
26758 @end smallexample
26759
26760 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26761 @findex -break-passcount
26762
26763 @subsubheading Synopsis
26764
26765 @smallexample
26766 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26767 @end smallexample
26768
26769 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26770 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26771 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26772 command @samp{passcount}.
26773
26774 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26775 @findex -break-watch
26776
26777 @subsubheading Synopsis
26778
26779 @smallexample
26780 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26781 @end smallexample
26782
26783 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26784 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26785 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26786 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26787 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26788 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26789 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26790 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26791
26792 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26793 breakpoints inserted.
26794
26795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26796
26797 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26798 @samp{rwatch}.
26799
26800 @subsubheading Example
26801
26802 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26803
26804 @smallexample
26805 (gdb)
26806 -break-watch x
26807 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26808 (gdb)
26809 -exec-continue
26810 ^running
26811 (gdb)
26812 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26813 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26814 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26815 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26816 (gdb)
26817 @end smallexample
26818
26819 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26820 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26821 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26822
26823 @smallexample
26824 (gdb)
26825 -break-watch C
26826 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26827 (gdb)
26828 -exec-continue
26829 ^running
26830 (gdb)
26831 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26832 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26833 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26834 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26835 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26836 (gdb)
26837 -exec-continue
26838 ^running
26839 (gdb)
26840 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26841 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26842 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26843 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26844 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26845 (gdb)
26846 @end smallexample
26847
26848 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26849 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26850 deleted.
26851
26852 @smallexample
26853 (gdb)
26854 -break-watch C
26855 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26856 (gdb)
26857 -break-list
26858 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26859 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26860 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26861 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26862 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26863 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26864 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26865 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26866 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26867 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26868 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26869 times="1"@},
26870 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26871 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26872 (gdb)
26873 -exec-continue
26874 ^running
26875 (gdb)
26876 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26877 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26878 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26879 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26880 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26881 (gdb)
26882 -break-list
26883 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26884 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26885 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26886 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26887 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26888 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26889 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26890 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26891 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26892 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26893 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26894 times="1"@},
26895 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26896 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26897 (gdb)
26898 -exec-continue
26899 ^running
26900 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26901 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26902 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26903 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26904 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26905 (gdb)
26906 -break-list
26907 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26908 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26909 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26910 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26911 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26912 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26913 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26914 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26915 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26916 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26917 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26918 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26919 (gdb)
26920 @end smallexample
26921
26922
26923 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26924 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26925 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26926
26927 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26928 catchpoints.
26929
26930 @menu
26931 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26932 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26933 @end menu
26934
26935 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26936 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26937
26938 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26939 @findex -catch-load
26940
26941 @subsubheading Synopsis
26942
26943 @smallexample
26944 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26945 @end smallexample
26946
26947 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26948 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26949 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26950 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26951 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26952
26953
26954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26955
26956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26957
26958 @subsubheading Example
26959
26960 @smallexample
26961 -catch-load -t foo.so
26962 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26963 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26964 (gdb)
26965 @end smallexample
26966
26967
26968 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26969 @findex -catch-unload
26970
26971 @subsubheading Synopsis
26972
26973 @smallexample
26974 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26975 @end smallexample
26976
26977 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26978 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26979 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26980 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26981 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26982
26983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26984
26985 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26986
26987 @subsubheading Example
26988
26989 @smallexample
26990 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26991 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26992 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26993 (gdb)
26994 @end smallexample
26995
26996 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26997 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26998
26999 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27000 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27001
27002 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27003 @findex -catch-assert
27004
27005 @subsubheading Synopsis
27006
27007 @smallexample
27008 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27009 @end smallexample
27010
27011 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27012
27013 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27014
27015 @table @samp
27016 @item -c @var{condition}
27017 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27018 @item -d
27019 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27020 @item -t
27021 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27022 @end table
27023
27024 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27025
27026 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27027
27028 @subsubheading Example
27029
27030 @smallexample
27031 -catch-assert
27032 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27033 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27034 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27035 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27036 (gdb)
27037 @end smallexample
27038
27039 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27040 @findex -catch-exception
27041
27042 @subsubheading Synopsis
27043
27044 @smallexample
27045 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27046 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27047 @end smallexample
27048
27049 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27050 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27051 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27052 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27053 catchpoints.
27054
27055 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27056
27057 @table @samp
27058 @item -c @var{condition}
27059 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27060 @item -d
27061 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27062 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27063 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27064 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27065 @item -t
27066 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27067 @item -u
27068 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27069 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27070 @end table
27071
27072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27073
27074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27075 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27076
27077 @subsubheading Example
27078
27079 @smallexample
27080 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27081 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27082 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27083 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27084 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27085 (gdb)
27086 @end smallexample
27087
27088 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27089 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27090 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27091
27092 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27093 @findex -exec-arguments
27094
27095
27096 @subsubheading Synopsis
27097
27098 @smallexample
27099 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27100 @end smallexample
27101
27102 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27103 @samp{-exec-run}.
27104
27105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27106
27107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27108
27109 @subsubheading Example
27110
27111 @smallexample
27112 (gdb)
27113 -exec-arguments -v word
27114 ^done
27115 (gdb)
27116 @end smallexample
27117
27118
27119 @ignore
27120 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27121 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27122
27123 @subsubheading Synopsis
27124
27125 @smallexample
27126 -exec-show-arguments
27127 @end smallexample
27128
27129 Print the arguments of the program.
27130
27131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27132
27133 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27134
27135 @subsubheading Example
27136 N.A.
27137 @end ignore
27138
27139
27140 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27141 @findex -environment-cd
27142
27143 @subsubheading Synopsis
27144
27145 @smallexample
27146 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27147 @end smallexample
27148
27149 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27150
27151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27152
27153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27154
27155 @subsubheading Example
27156
27157 @smallexample
27158 (gdb)
27159 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27160 ^done
27161 (gdb)
27162 @end smallexample
27163
27164
27165 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27166 @findex -environment-directory
27167
27168 @subsubheading Synopsis
27169
27170 @smallexample
27171 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27172 @end smallexample
27173
27174 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27175 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27176 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27177 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27178 occurs as normal.
27179 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27180 multiple directories in a single command
27181 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27182 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27183 If blanks are needed as
27184 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27185 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27186 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27187 character must not be used
27188 in any directory name.
27189 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27190
27191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27192
27193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27194
27195 @subsubheading Example
27196
27197 @smallexample
27198 (gdb)
27199 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27200 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27201 (gdb)
27202 -environment-directory ""
27203 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27204 (gdb)
27205 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27206 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27207 (gdb)
27208 -environment-directory -r
27209 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27210 (gdb)
27211 @end smallexample
27212
27213
27214 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27215 @findex -environment-path
27216
27217 @subsubheading Synopsis
27218
27219 @smallexample
27220 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27221 @end smallexample
27222
27223 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27224 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27225 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27226 supplied in addition to the
27227 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27228 occurs as normal.
27229 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27230 multiple directories in a single command
27231 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27232 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27233 If blanks are needed as
27234 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27235 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27236 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27237 character must not be used
27238 in any directory name.
27239 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27240
27241
27242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27243
27244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27245
27246 @subsubheading Example
27247
27248 @smallexample
27249 (gdb)
27250 -environment-path
27251 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27252 (gdb)
27253 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27254 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27255 (gdb)
27256 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27257 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27258 (gdb)
27259 @end smallexample
27260
27261
27262 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27263 @findex -environment-pwd
27264
27265 @subsubheading Synopsis
27266
27267 @smallexample
27268 -environment-pwd
27269 @end smallexample
27270
27271 Show the current working directory.
27272
27273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27274
27275 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27276
27277 @subsubheading Example
27278
27279 @smallexample
27280 (gdb)
27281 -environment-pwd
27282 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27283 (gdb)
27284 @end smallexample
27285
27286 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27287 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27288 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27289
27290
27291 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27292 @findex -thread-info
27293
27294 @subsubheading Synopsis
27295
27296 @smallexample
27297 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27298 @end smallexample
27299
27300 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27301 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27302 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27303 also reports the current thread.
27304
27305 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27306
27307 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27308 about all threads.
27309
27310 @subsubheading Result
27311
27312 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27313 defined for a given thread:
27314
27315 @table @samp
27316 @item current
27317 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27318
27319 @item id
27320 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27321
27322 @item target-id
27323 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27324
27325 @item details
27326 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27327 field is optional.
27328
27329 @item name
27330 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27331 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27332 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27333 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27334 field is omitted.
27335
27336 @item frame
27337 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27338
27339 @item state
27340 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27341 values:
27342
27343 @table @code
27344 @item stopped
27345 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27346 threads.
27347
27348 @item running
27349 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27350 threads.
27351
27352 @end table
27353
27354 @item core
27355 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27356 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27357
27358 @end table
27359
27360 @subsubheading Example
27361
27362 @smallexample
27363 -thread-info
27364 ^done,threads=[
27365 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27366 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27367 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27368 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27369 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27370 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27371 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27372 state="running"@}],
27373 current-thread-id="1"
27374 (gdb)
27375 @end smallexample
27376
27377 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27378 @findex -thread-list-ids
27379
27380 @subsubheading Synopsis
27381
27382 @smallexample
27383 -thread-list-ids
27384 @end smallexample
27385
27386 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27387 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27388
27389 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27390 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27391
27392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27393
27394 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27395
27396 @subsubheading Example
27397
27398 @smallexample
27399 (gdb)
27400 -thread-list-ids
27401 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27402 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27403 (gdb)
27404 @end smallexample
27405
27406
27407 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27408 @findex -thread-select
27409
27410 @subsubheading Synopsis
27411
27412 @smallexample
27413 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27414 @end smallexample
27415
27416 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27417 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27418
27419 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27420 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27421
27422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27423
27424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27425
27426 @subsubheading Example
27427
27428 @smallexample
27429 (gdb)
27430 -exec-next
27431 ^running
27432 (gdb)
27433 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27434 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27435 (gdb)
27436 -thread-list-ids
27437 ^done,
27438 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27439 number-of-threads="3"
27440 (gdb)
27441 -thread-select 3
27442 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27443 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27444 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27445 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27446 (gdb)
27447 @end smallexample
27448
27449 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27450 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27451 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27452
27453 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27454 @findex -ada-task-info
27455
27456 @subsubheading Synopsis
27457
27458 @smallexample
27459 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27460 @end smallexample
27461
27462 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27463 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27464
27465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27466
27467 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27468 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27469
27470 @subsubheading Result
27471
27472 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27473 defined for each Ada task:
27474
27475 @table @samp
27476 @item current
27477 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27478
27479 @item id
27480 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27481
27482 @item task-id
27483 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27484
27485 @item thread-id
27486 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27487
27488 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27489 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27490 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27491
27492 @item parent-id
27493 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27494 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27495
27496 @item priority
27497 The base priority of the task.
27498
27499 @item state
27500 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27501 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27502
27503 @item name
27504 The name of the task.
27505
27506 @end table
27507
27508 @subsubheading Example
27509
27510 @smallexample
27511 -ada-task-info
27512 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27513 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27514 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27515 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27516 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27517 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27518 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27519 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27520 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27521 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27522 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27523 (gdb)
27524 @end smallexample
27525
27526 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27527 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27528 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27529
27530 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27531 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27532 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27533 other cases.
27534
27535 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27536 @findex -exec-continue
27537
27538 @subsubheading Synopsis
27539
27540 @smallexample
27541 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27542 @end smallexample
27543
27544 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27545 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27546 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27547 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27548 @itemize @bullet
27549 @item
27550 breakpoints or watchpoints
27551 @item
27552 signals or exceptions
27553 @item
27554 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27555 @item
27556 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27557 @end itemize
27558 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27559 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27560 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27561 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27562 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27563 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27564
27565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27566
27567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27568
27569 @subsubheading Example
27570
27571 @smallexample
27572 -exec-continue
27573 ^running
27574 (gdb)
27575 @@Hello world
27576 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27577 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27578 line="13"@}
27579 (gdb)
27580 @end smallexample
27581
27582
27583 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27584 @findex -exec-finish
27585
27586 @subsubheading Synopsis
27587
27588 @smallexample
27589 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27590 @end smallexample
27591
27592 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27593 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27594 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27595 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27596 function was called.
27597
27598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27599
27600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27601
27602 @subsubheading Example
27603
27604 Function returning @code{void}.
27605
27606 @smallexample
27607 -exec-finish
27608 ^running
27609 (gdb)
27610 @@hello from foo
27611 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27612 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27613 (gdb)
27614 @end smallexample
27615
27616 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27617 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27618 value itself.
27619
27620 @smallexample
27621 -exec-finish
27622 ^running
27623 (gdb)
27624 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27625 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27626 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27627 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27628 (gdb)
27629 @end smallexample
27630
27631
27632 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27633 @findex -exec-interrupt
27634
27635 @subsubheading Synopsis
27636
27637 @smallexample
27638 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27639 @end smallexample
27640
27641 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27642 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27643 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27644 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27645 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27646
27647 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27648 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27649 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27650 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27651
27652 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27653 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27654 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27655 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27656
27657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27658
27659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27660
27661 @subsubheading Example
27662
27663 @smallexample
27664 (gdb)
27665 111-exec-continue
27666 111^running
27667
27668 (gdb)
27669 222-exec-interrupt
27670 222^done
27671 (gdb)
27672 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27673 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27674 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27675 (gdb)
27676
27677 (gdb)
27678 -exec-interrupt
27679 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27680 (gdb)
27681 @end smallexample
27682
27683 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27684 @findex -exec-jump
27685
27686 @subsubheading Synopsis
27687
27688 @smallexample
27689 -exec-jump @var{location}
27690 @end smallexample
27691
27692 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27693 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27694 different forms of @var{location}.
27695
27696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27697
27698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27699
27700 @subsubheading Example
27701
27702 @smallexample
27703 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27704 *running,thread-id="all"
27705 ^running
27706 @end smallexample
27707
27708
27709 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27710 @findex -exec-next
27711
27712 @subsubheading Synopsis
27713
27714 @smallexample
27715 -exec-next [--reverse]
27716 @end smallexample
27717
27718 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27719 of the next source line is reached.
27720
27721 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27722 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27723 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27724 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27725 source line where the function was called.
27726
27727
27728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27729
27730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27731
27732 @subsubheading Example
27733
27734 @smallexample
27735 -exec-next
27736 ^running
27737 (gdb)
27738 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27739 (gdb)
27740 @end smallexample
27741
27742
27743 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27744 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27745
27746 @subsubheading Synopsis
27747
27748 @smallexample
27749 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27750 @end smallexample
27751
27752 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27753 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27754 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27755 printed as well.
27756
27757 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27758 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27759 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27760 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27761 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27762
27763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27764
27765 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27766
27767 @subsubheading Example
27768
27769 @smallexample
27770 (gdb)
27771 -exec-next-instruction
27772 ^running
27773
27774 (gdb)
27775 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27776 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27777 (gdb)
27778 @end smallexample
27779
27780
27781 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27782 @findex -exec-return
27783
27784 @subsubheading Synopsis
27785
27786 @smallexample
27787 -exec-return
27788 @end smallexample
27789
27790 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27791 Displays the new current frame.
27792
27793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27794
27795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27796
27797 @subsubheading Example
27798
27799 @smallexample
27800 (gdb)
27801 200-break-insert callee4
27802 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27803 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27804 (gdb)
27805 000-exec-run
27806 000^running
27807 (gdb)
27808 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27809 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27810 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27811 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27812 (gdb)
27813 205-break-delete
27814 205^done
27815 (gdb)
27816 111-exec-return
27817 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27818 args=[@{name="strarg",
27819 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27820 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27821 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27822 (gdb)
27823 @end smallexample
27824
27825
27826 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27827 @findex -exec-run
27828
27829 @subsubheading Synopsis
27830
27831 @smallexample
27832 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27833 @end smallexample
27834
27835 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27836 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27837 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27838 the program has exited exceptionally.
27839
27840 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27841 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27842 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27843 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27844 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27845
27846 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27847 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27848 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27849 (@pxref{Starting}).
27850
27851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27852
27853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27854
27855 @subsubheading Examples
27856
27857 @smallexample
27858 (gdb)
27859 -break-insert main
27860 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27861 (gdb)
27862 -exec-run
27863 ^running
27864 (gdb)
27865 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27866 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27867 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27868 (gdb)
27869 @end smallexample
27870
27871 @noindent
27872 Program exited normally:
27873
27874 @smallexample
27875 (gdb)
27876 -exec-run
27877 ^running
27878 (gdb)
27879 x = 55
27880 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27881 (gdb)
27882 @end smallexample
27883
27884 @noindent
27885 Program exited exceptionally:
27886
27887 @smallexample
27888 (gdb)
27889 -exec-run
27890 ^running
27891 (gdb)
27892 x = 55
27893 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27894 (gdb)
27895 @end smallexample
27896
27897 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27898 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27899
27900 @smallexample
27901 (gdb)
27902 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27903 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27904 @end smallexample
27905
27906
27907 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27908
27909
27910 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27911 @findex -exec-step
27912
27913 @subsubheading Synopsis
27914
27915 @smallexample
27916 -exec-step [--reverse]
27917 @end smallexample
27918
27919 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27920 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27921 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27922 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27923 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27924 previously executed source line.
27925
27926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27927
27928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27929
27930 @subsubheading Example
27931
27932 Stepping into a function:
27933
27934 @smallexample
27935 -exec-step
27936 ^running
27937 (gdb)
27938 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27939 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27940 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27941 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27942 (gdb)
27943 @end smallexample
27944
27945 Regular stepping:
27946
27947 @smallexample
27948 -exec-step
27949 ^running
27950 (gdb)
27951 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27952 (gdb)
27953 @end smallexample
27954
27955
27956 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27957 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27958
27959 @subsubheading Synopsis
27960
27961 @smallexample
27962 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27963 @end smallexample
27964
27965 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27966 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27967 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27968 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27969 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27970 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27971 as well.
27972
27973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27974
27975 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27976
27977 @subsubheading Example
27978
27979 @smallexample
27980 (gdb)
27981 -exec-step-instruction
27982 ^running
27983
27984 (gdb)
27985 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27986 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27987 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27988 (gdb)
27989 -exec-step-instruction
27990 ^running
27991
27992 (gdb)
27993 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27994 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27996 (gdb)
27997 @end smallexample
27998
27999
28000 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28001 @findex -exec-until
28002
28003 @subsubheading Synopsis
28004
28005 @smallexample
28006 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28007 @end smallexample
28008
28009 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28010 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28011 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28012 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28013
28014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28015
28016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28017
28018 @subsubheading Example
28019
28020 @smallexample
28021 (gdb)
28022 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28023 ^running
28024 (gdb)
28025 x = 55
28026 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28027 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28028 (gdb)
28029 @end smallexample
28030
28031 @ignore
28032 @subheading -file-clear
28033 Is this going away????
28034 @end ignore
28035
28036 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28037 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28038 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28039
28040 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28041 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28042
28043 @smallexample
28044 -enable-frame-filters
28045 @end smallexample
28046
28047 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28048 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28049 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28050 request that this functionality be enabled.
28051
28052 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28053
28054 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28055 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28056
28057 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28058 @findex -stack-info-frame
28059
28060 @subsubheading Synopsis
28061
28062 @smallexample
28063 -stack-info-frame
28064 @end smallexample
28065
28066 Get info on the selected frame.
28067
28068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28069
28070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28071 (without arguments).
28072
28073 @subsubheading Example
28074
28075 @smallexample
28076 (gdb)
28077 -stack-info-frame
28078 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28079 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28080 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28081 (gdb)
28082 @end smallexample
28083
28084 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28085 @findex -stack-info-depth
28086
28087 @subsubheading Synopsis
28088
28089 @smallexample
28090 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28091 @end smallexample
28092
28093 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28094 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28095
28096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28097
28098 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28099
28100 @subsubheading Example
28101
28102 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28103
28104 @smallexample
28105 (gdb)
28106 -stack-info-depth
28107 ^done,depth="12"
28108 (gdb)
28109 -stack-info-depth 4
28110 ^done,depth="4"
28111 (gdb)
28112 -stack-info-depth 12
28113 ^done,depth="12"
28114 (gdb)
28115 -stack-info-depth 11
28116 ^done,depth="11"
28117 (gdb)
28118 -stack-info-depth 13
28119 ^done,depth="12"
28120 (gdb)
28121 @end smallexample
28122
28123 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28124 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28125 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28126
28127 @subsubheading Synopsis
28128
28129 @smallexample
28130 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28131 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28132 @end smallexample
28133
28134 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28135 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28136 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28137 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28138 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28139 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28140 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28141 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28142
28143 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28144 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28145 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28146 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28147 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28148 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28149
28150 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28151 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28152 are still displayed, however.
28153
28154 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28155 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28156
28157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28158
28159 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28160 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28161 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28162
28163 @subsubheading Example
28164
28165 @smallexample
28166 (gdb)
28167 -stack-list-frames
28168 ^done,
28169 stack=[
28170 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28171 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28172 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28173 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28174 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28175 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28176 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28177 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28178 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28179 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28180 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28181 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28182 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28183 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28184 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28185 (gdb)
28186 -stack-list-arguments 0
28187 ^done,
28188 stack-args=[
28189 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28190 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28191 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28192 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28193 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28194 (gdb)
28195 -stack-list-arguments 1
28196 ^done,
28197 stack-args=[
28198 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28199 frame=@{level="1",
28200 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28201 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28202 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28203 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28204 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28205 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28206 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28207 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28208 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28209 (gdb)
28210 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28211 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28212 (gdb)
28213 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28214 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28215 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28216 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28217 (gdb)
28218 @end smallexample
28219
28220 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28221
28222
28223 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28224 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28225 @findex -stack-list-frames
28226
28227 @subsubheading Synopsis
28228
28229 @smallexample
28230 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28231 @end smallexample
28232
28233 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28234 following info:
28235
28236 @table @samp
28237 @item @var{level}
28238 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28239 @item @var{addr}
28240 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28241 @item @var{func}
28242 Function name.
28243 @item @var{file}
28244 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28245 @item @var{fullname}
28246 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28247 @item @var{line}
28248 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28249 @item @var{from}
28250 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28251 if the frame's function is not known.
28252 @end table
28253
28254 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28255 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28256 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28257 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28258 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28259 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28260 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28261 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28262 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28263
28264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28265
28266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28267
28268 @subsubheading Example
28269
28270 Full stack backtrace:
28271
28272 @smallexample
28273 (gdb)
28274 -stack-list-frames
28275 ^done,stack=
28276 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28277 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28278 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28279 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28280 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28281 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28282 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28283 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28284 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28285 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28286 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28287 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28288 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28289 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28290 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28291 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28292 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28293 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28294 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28295 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28296 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28297 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28298 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28299 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28300 (gdb)
28301 @end smallexample
28302
28303 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28304
28305 @smallexample
28306 (gdb)
28307 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28308 ^done,stack=
28309 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28310 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28311 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28312 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28313 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28314 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28315 (gdb)
28316 @end smallexample
28317
28318 Show a single frame:
28319
28320 @smallexample
28321 (gdb)
28322 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28323 ^done,stack=
28324 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28325 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28326 (gdb)
28327 @end smallexample
28328
28329
28330 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28331 @findex -stack-list-locals
28332 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28333
28334 @subsubheading Synopsis
28335
28336 @smallexample
28337 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28338 @end smallexample
28339
28340 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28341 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28342 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28343 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28344 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28345 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28346 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28347 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28348 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28349 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28350
28351 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28352 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28353 variables are still displayed, however.
28354
28355 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28356 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28357
28358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28359
28360 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28361
28362 @subsubheading Example
28363
28364 @smallexample
28365 (gdb)
28366 -stack-list-locals 0
28367 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28368 (gdb)
28369 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28370 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28371 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28372 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28373 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28374 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28375 (gdb)
28376 @end smallexample
28377
28378 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28379 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28380 @findex -stack-list-variables
28381
28382 @subsubheading Synopsis
28383
28384 @smallexample
28385 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28386 @end smallexample
28387
28388 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28389 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28390 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28391 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28392 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28393 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28394 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28395
28396 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28397 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28398 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28399
28400 @subsubheading Example
28401
28402 @smallexample
28403 (gdb)
28404 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28405 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28406 (gdb)
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28411 @findex -stack-select-frame
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28420 the stack.
28421
28422 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28423 option to every command.
28424
28425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28426
28427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28428 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28429
28430 @subsubheading Example
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 (gdb)
28434 -stack-select-frame 2
28435 ^done
28436 (gdb)
28437 @end smallexample
28438
28439 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28440 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28441 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28442
28443 @ignore
28444
28445 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28446
28447 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28448 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28449 used by @code{Insight}.
28450
28451 The two main reasons for that are:
28452
28453 @enumerate 1
28454 @item
28455 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28456
28457 @item
28458 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28459 now).
28460 @end enumerate
28461
28462 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28463 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28464 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28465 hints about their use.
28466
28467 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28468 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28469 least, the following operations:
28470
28471 @itemize @bullet
28472 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28473 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28474 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28475 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28476 @end itemize
28477
28478 @end ignore
28479
28480 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28481
28482 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28483
28484 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28485 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28486 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28487 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28488 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28489 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28490 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28491 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28492 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28493 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28494 object, or to change display format.
28495
28496 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28497 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28498 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28499 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28500 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28501 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28502 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28503 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28504 child will be created.
28505
28506 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28507 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28508 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28509 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28510 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28511
28512 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28513 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28514 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28515 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28516 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28517 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28518 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28519 variables that frontend has created.
28520
28521 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28522 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28523 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28524 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28525 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28526 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28527 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28528 implicitly updated.
28529
28530 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28531 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28532 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28533 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28534 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28535 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28536 frame. Consider this example:
28537
28538 @smallexample
28539 void do_work(...)
28540 @{
28541 struct work_state state;
28542
28543 if (...)
28544 do_work(...);
28545 @}
28546 @end smallexample
28547
28548 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28549 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28550 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28551 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28552 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28553
28554 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28555 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28556 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28557 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28558 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28559 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28560
28561 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28562 access this functionality:
28563
28564 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28565 @item @strong{Operation}
28566 @tab @strong{Description}
28567
28568 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28569 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28570 @item @code{-var-create}
28571 @tab create a variable object
28572 @item @code{-var-delete}
28573 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28574 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28575 @tab set the display format of this variable
28576 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28577 @tab show the display format of this variable
28578 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28579 @tab tells how many children this object has
28580 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28581 @tab return a list of the object's children
28582 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28583 @tab show the type of this variable object
28584 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28585 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28586 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28587 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28588 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28589 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28590 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28591 @tab get the value of this variable
28592 @item @code{-var-assign}
28593 @tab set the value of this variable
28594 @item @code{-var-update}
28595 @tab update the variable and its children
28596 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28597 @tab set frozeness attribute
28598 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28599 @tab set range of children to display on update
28600 @end multitable
28601
28602 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28603 how it can be used.
28604
28605 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28606
28607 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28608 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28609
28610 @smallexample
28611 -enable-pretty-printing
28612 @end smallexample
28613
28614 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28615 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28616 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28617 request that this functionality be enabled.
28618
28619 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28620
28621 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28622 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28623
28624 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28625 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28626
28627 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28628 @findex -var-create
28629
28630 @subsubheading Synopsis
28631
28632 @smallexample
28633 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28634 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28635 @end smallexample
28636
28637 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28638 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28639 register.
28640
28641 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28642 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28643 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28644 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28645 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28646
28647 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28648 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28649 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28650 object must be created.
28651
28652 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28653 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28654
28655 @itemize @bullet
28656 @item
28657 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28658
28659 @item
28660 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28661
28662 @item
28663 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28664 @end itemize
28665
28666 @cindex dynamic varobj
28667 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28668 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28669 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28670 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28671 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28672 compatibility for existing clients.
28673
28674 @subsubheading Result
28675
28676 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28677 are:
28678
28679 @table @samp
28680 @item name
28681 The name of the varobj.
28682
28683 @item numchild
28684 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28685 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28686 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28687
28688 @item value
28689 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28690 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28691 will not be interesting.
28692
28693 @item type
28694 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28695 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28696 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28697 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28698 @emph{declared} one.
28699
28700 @item thread-id
28701 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28702 thread's identifier.
28703
28704 @item has_more
28705 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28706 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28707
28708 @item dynamic
28709 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28710 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28711 then this attribute will not be present.
28712
28713 @item displayhint
28714 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28715 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28716 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28717 @end table
28718
28719 Typical output will look like this:
28720
28721 @smallexample
28722 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28723 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28724 @end smallexample
28725
28726
28727 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28728 @findex -var-delete
28729
28730 @subsubheading Synopsis
28731
28732 @smallexample
28733 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28734 @end smallexample
28735
28736 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28737 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28738
28739 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28740
28741
28742 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28743 @findex -var-set-format
28744
28745 @subsubheading Synopsis
28746
28747 @smallexample
28748 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28749 @end smallexample
28750
28751 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28752 @var{format-spec}.
28753
28754 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28755 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28756
28757 @smallexample
28758 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28759 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28760 @end smallexample
28761
28762 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28763 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28764 for pointers, etc.).
28765
28766 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28767 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28768
28769 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28770 @findex -var-show-format
28771
28772 @subsubheading Synopsis
28773
28774 @smallexample
28775 -var-show-format @var{name}
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28779
28780 @smallexample
28781 @var{format} @expansion{}
28782 @var{format-spec}
28783 @end smallexample
28784
28785
28786 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28787 @findex -var-info-num-children
28788
28789 @subsubheading Synopsis
28790
28791 @smallexample
28792 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28793 @end smallexample
28794
28795 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28796
28797 @smallexample
28798 numchild=@var{n}
28799 @end smallexample
28800
28801 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28802 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28803 be available.
28804
28805
28806 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28807 @findex -var-list-children
28808
28809 @subsubheading Synopsis
28810
28811 @smallexample
28812 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28813 @end smallexample
28814 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28815
28816 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28817 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28818 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28819 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28820 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28821 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28822 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28823 and unions.
28824
28825 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28826 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28827 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28828 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28829 reported.
28830
28831 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28832 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28833 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28834 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28835 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28836 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28837 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28838 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28839 the visible items.
28840
28841 For each child the following results are returned:
28842
28843 @table @var
28844
28845 @item name
28846 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28847
28848 @item exp
28849 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28850 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28851
28852 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28853 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28854
28855 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28856 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28857 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28858 type and value are not present.
28859
28860 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28861 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28862 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28863
28864 @item numchild
28865 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28866 0.
28867
28868 @item type
28869 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28870 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28871 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28872 @emph{declared} one.
28873
28874 @item value
28875 If values were requested, this is the value.
28876
28877 @item thread-id
28878 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28879 Otherwise this result is not present.
28880
28881 @item frozen
28882 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28883
28884 @item displayhint
28885 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28886 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28887 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28888
28889 @item dynamic
28890 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28891 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28892 then this attribute will not be present.
28893
28894 @end table
28895
28896 The result may have its own attributes:
28897
28898 @table @samp
28899 @item displayhint
28900 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28901 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28902 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28903
28904 @item has_more
28905 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28906 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28907 @end table
28908
28909 @subsubheading Example
28910
28911 @smallexample
28912 (gdb)
28913 -var-list-children n
28914 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28915 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28916 (gdb)
28917 -var-list-children --all-values n
28918 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28919 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922
28923 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28924 @findex -var-info-type
28925
28926 @subsubheading Synopsis
28927
28928 @smallexample
28929 -var-info-type @var{name}
28930 @end smallexample
28931
28932 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28933 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28934 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28935
28936 @smallexample
28937 type=@var{typename}
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940
28941 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28942 @findex -var-info-expression
28943
28944 @subsubheading Synopsis
28945
28946 @smallexample
28947 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28948 @end smallexample
28949
28950 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28951 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28952 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28953
28954 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28955 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28956
28957 @smallexample
28958 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28959 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28960 @end smallexample
28961
28962 @noindent
28963 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28964 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28965
28966 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28967 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28968 is of limited use.
28969
28970 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28971 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28972
28973 @subsubheading Synopsis
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28977 @end smallexample
28978
28979 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28980 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28981 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28982 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28983 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28984 watchpoint from a variable object.
28985
28986 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28987 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28988
28989 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28990 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28991 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28992 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28993 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28994 @smallexample
28995 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28996 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28997 @end smallexample
28998
28999 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29000 @findex -var-show-attributes
29001
29002 @subsubheading Synopsis
29003
29004 @smallexample
29005 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29006 @end smallexample
29007
29008 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29009
29010 @smallexample
29011 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29012 @end smallexample
29013
29014 @noindent
29015 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29016
29017 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29018 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29019
29020 @subsubheading Synopsis
29021
29022 @smallexample
29023 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29024 @end smallexample
29025
29026 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29027 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29028 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29029 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29030 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29031 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29032 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29033
29034 @smallexample
29035 value=@var{value}
29036 @end smallexample
29037
29038 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29039 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29040
29041 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29042 @findex -var-assign
29043
29044 @subsubheading Synopsis
29045
29046 @smallexample
29047 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29048 @end smallexample
29049
29050 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29051 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29052 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29053 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29054
29055 @subsubheading Example
29056
29057 @smallexample
29058 (gdb)
29059 -var-assign var1 3
29060 ^done,value="3"
29061 (gdb)
29062 -var-update *
29063 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29064 (gdb)
29065 @end smallexample
29066
29067 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29068 @findex -var-update
29069
29070 @subsubheading Synopsis
29071
29072 @smallexample
29073 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29074 @end smallexample
29075
29076 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29077 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29078 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29079 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29080 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29081 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29082 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29083 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29084 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29085 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29086 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29087 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29088 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29089
29090 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29091 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29092 diagnostic.
29093
29094 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29095 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29096
29097 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29098 @samp{changelist}.
29099
29100 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29101
29102 @table @samp
29103 @item name
29104 The name of the varobj.
29105
29106 @item value
29107 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29108 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29109
29110 @item in_scope
29111 @anchor{-var-update}
29112 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29113
29114 @table @code
29115 @item "true"
29116 The variable object's current value is valid.
29117
29118 @item "false"
29119 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29120 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29121 scope.
29122
29123 @item "invalid"
29124 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29125 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29126 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29127 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29128 objects.
29129 @end table
29130
29131 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29132 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29133
29134 @item type_changed
29135 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29136 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29137 be @samp{false}.
29138
29139 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29140 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29141 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29142 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29143 unset.
29144
29145 @item new_type
29146 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29147 hold the new type.
29148
29149 @item new_num_children
29150 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29151 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29152
29153 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29154 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29155 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29156 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29157 children which may be available.
29158
29159 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29160 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29161 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29162 only happen at the end of the update range).
29163
29164 @item displayhint
29165 The display hint, if any.
29166
29167 @item has_more
29168 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29169 available outside the varobj's update range.
29170
29171 @item dynamic
29172 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29173 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29174 then this attribute will not be present.
29175
29176 @item new_children
29177 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29178 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29179 be listed in this attribute.
29180 @end table
29181
29182 @subsubheading Example
29183
29184 @smallexample
29185 (gdb)
29186 -var-assign var1 3
29187 ^done,value="3"
29188 (gdb)
29189 -var-update --all-values var1
29190 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29191 type_changed="false"@}]
29192 (gdb)
29193 @end smallexample
29194
29195 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29196 @findex -var-set-frozen
29197 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29198
29199 @subsubheading Synopsis
29200
29201 @smallexample
29202 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29203 @end smallexample
29204
29205 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29206 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29207 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29208 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29209 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29210 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29211 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29212 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29213 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29214 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29215 @code{-var-update} does.
29216
29217 @subsubheading Example
29218
29219 @smallexample
29220 (gdb)
29221 -var-set-frozen V 1
29222 ^done
29223 (gdb)
29224 @end smallexample
29225
29226 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29227 @findex -var-set-update-range
29228 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29229
29230 @subsubheading Synopsis
29231
29232 @smallexample
29233 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29237 @code{-var-update}.
29238
29239 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29240 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29241 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29242 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29243
29244 @subsubheading Example
29245
29246 @smallexample
29247 (gdb)
29248 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29249 ^done
29250 @end smallexample
29251
29252 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29253 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29254 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29255
29256 @subsubheading Synopsis
29257
29258 @smallexample
29259 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29260 @end smallexample
29261
29262 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29263
29264 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29265 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29266
29267 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29268 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29269 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29270 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29271 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29272 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29273 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29274
29275 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29276 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29277 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29278 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29279
29280 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29281 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29282 can be used to check this.
29283
29284 @subsubheading Example
29285
29286 Resetting the visualizer:
29287
29288 @smallexample
29289 (gdb)
29290 -var-set-visualizer V None
29291 ^done
29292 @end smallexample
29293
29294 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29295
29296 @smallexample
29297 (gdb)
29298 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29299 ^done
29300 @end smallexample
29301
29302 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29303 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29304
29305 @smallexample
29306 (gdb)
29307 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29308 ^done
29309 @end smallexample
29310
29311 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29312 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29313 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29314
29315 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29316 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29317 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29318 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29319
29320 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29321 @c @subheading -data-assign
29322 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29323 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29324 @c set variable
29325 @c @subsubheading Example
29326 @c N.A.
29327
29328 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29329 @findex -data-disassemble
29330
29331 @subsubheading Synopsis
29332
29333 @smallexample
29334 -data-disassemble
29335 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29336 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29337 -- @var{mode}
29338 @end smallexample
29339
29340 @noindent
29341 Where:
29342
29343 @table @samp
29344 @item @var{start-addr}
29345 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29346 @item @var{end-addr}
29347 is the end address
29348 @item @var{filename}
29349 is the name of the file to disassemble
29350 @item @var{linenum}
29351 is the line number to disassemble around
29352 @item @var{lines}
29353 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29354 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29355 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29356 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29357 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29358 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29359 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29360 are displayed.
29361 @item @var{mode}
29362 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29363 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29364 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29365 @end table
29366
29367 @subsubheading Result
29368
29369 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29370 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29371 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29372
29373 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29374 following fields:
29375
29376 @table @code
29377 @item address
29378 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29379
29380 @item func-name
29381 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29382
29383 @item offset
29384 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29385
29386 @item inst
29387 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29388
29389 @item opcodes
29390 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29391 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29392
29393 @end table
29394
29395 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29396 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29397
29398 @table @code
29399 @item line
29400 The line number within @samp{file}.
29401
29402 @item file
29403 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29404 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29405 used.
29406
29407 @item fullname
29408 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29409 using the source file search path
29410 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29411 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29412
29413 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29414 present in the debug information.
29415
29416 @item line_asm_insn
29417 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29418 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29419 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29420 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29421 @samp{opcodes}.
29422
29423 @end table
29424
29425 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29426 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29427 adjust its format.
29428
29429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29430
29431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29432
29433 @subsubheading Example
29434
29435 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29436
29437 @smallexample
29438 (gdb)
29439 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29440 ^done,
29441 asm_insns=[
29442 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29443 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29444 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29445 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29446 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29447 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29448 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29449 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29450 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29451 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29452 (gdb)
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29456 @code{main}.
29457
29458 @smallexample
29459 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29460 ^done,asm_insns=[
29461 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29462 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29463 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29464 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29465 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29466 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29467 [@dots{}]
29468 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29469 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29470 (gdb)
29471 @end smallexample
29472
29473 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29474
29475 @smallexample
29476 (gdb)
29477 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29478 ^done,asm_insns=[
29479 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29480 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29481 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29482 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29483 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29484 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29485 (gdb)
29486 @end smallexample
29487
29488 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29489
29490 @smallexample
29491 (gdb)
29492 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29493 ^done,asm_insns=[
29494 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29495 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29496 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29497 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29498 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29499 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29500 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29501 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29502 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29503 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29504 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29505 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29506 (gdb)
29507 @end smallexample
29508
29509
29510 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29511 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29512
29513 @subsubheading Synopsis
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29517 @end smallexample
29518
29519 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29520 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29521 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29522
29523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29524
29525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29526 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29527 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29528
29529 @subsubheading Example
29530
29531 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29532 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29533 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29534 output.
29535
29536 @smallexample
29537 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29538 211^done,value="1"
29539 (gdb)
29540 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29541 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29542 (gdb)
29543 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29544 411^done,value="4"
29545 (gdb)
29546 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29547 511^done,value="4"
29548 (gdb)
29549 @end smallexample
29550
29551
29552 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29553 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29554
29555 @subsubheading Synopsis
29556
29557 @smallexample
29558 -data-list-changed-registers
29559 @end smallexample
29560
29561 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29562
29563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29564
29565 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29566 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29567
29568 @subsubheading Example
29569
29570 On a PPC MBX board:
29571
29572 @smallexample
29573 (gdb)
29574 -exec-continue
29575 ^running
29576
29577 (gdb)
29578 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29579 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29580 line="5"@}
29581 (gdb)
29582 -data-list-changed-registers
29583 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29584 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29585 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29586 (gdb)
29587 @end smallexample
29588
29589
29590 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29591 @findex -data-list-register-names
29592
29593 @subsubheading Synopsis
29594
29595 @smallexample
29596 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29597 @end smallexample
29598
29599 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29600 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29601 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29602 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29603 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29604 include empty register names.
29605
29606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29607
29608 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29609 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29610 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29611
29612 @subsubheading Example
29613
29614 For the PPC MBX board:
29615 @smallexample
29616 (gdb)
29617 -data-list-register-names
29618 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29619 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29620 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29621 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29622 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29623 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29624 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29625 (gdb)
29626 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29627 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29628 (gdb)
29629 @end smallexample
29630
29631 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29632 @findex -data-list-register-values
29633
29634 @subsubheading Synopsis
29635
29636 @smallexample
29637 -data-list-register-values
29638 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29639 @end smallexample
29640
29641 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29642 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29643 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29644 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29645 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29646 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29647
29648 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29649
29650 @table @code
29651 @item x
29652 Hexadecimal
29653 @item o
29654 Octal
29655 @item t
29656 Binary
29657 @item d
29658 Decimal
29659 @item r
29660 Raw
29661 @item N
29662 Natural
29663 @end table
29664
29665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29666
29667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29668 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29669
29670 @subsubheading Example
29671
29672 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29673 don't appear in the actual output):
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 (gdb)
29677 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29678 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29679 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29680 (gdb)
29681 -data-list-register-values x
29682 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29683 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29684 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29685 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29686 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29687 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29688 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29689 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29690 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29691 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29692 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29693 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29694 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29695 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29696 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29697 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29698 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29699 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29700 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29701 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29702 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29703 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29704 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29705 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29706 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29707 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29708 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29709 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29710 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29711 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29712 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29713 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29714 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29715 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29716 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29717 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29718 (gdb)
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721
29722 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29723 @findex -data-read-memory
29724
29725 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29726
29727 @subsubheading Synopsis
29728
29729 @smallexample
29730 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29731 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29732 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29733 @end smallexample
29734
29735 @noindent
29736 where:
29737
29738 @table @samp
29739 @item @var{address}
29740 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29741 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29742 quoted using the C convention.
29743
29744 @item @var{word-format}
29745 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29746 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29747 ,Output Formats}).
29748
29749 @item @var{word-size}
29750 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29751
29752 @item @var{nr-rows}
29753 The number of rows in the output table.
29754
29755 @item @var{nr-cols}
29756 The number of columns in the output table.
29757
29758 @item @var{aschar}
29759 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29760 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29761 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29762 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29763
29764 @item @var{byte-offset}
29765 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29766 @end table
29767
29768 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29769 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29770 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29771 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29772 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29773 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29774 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29775 @samp{addr}.
29776
29777 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29778 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29779 @samp{prev-page}.
29780
29781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29782
29783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29784 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29785
29786 @subsubheading Example
29787
29788 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29789 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29790 word. Display each word in hex.
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 (gdb)
29794 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29795 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29796 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29797 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29798 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29799 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29800 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29801 (gdb)
29802 @end smallexample
29803
29804 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29805 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29806
29807 @smallexample
29808 (gdb)
29809 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29810 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29811 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29812 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29813 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29814 (gdb)
29815 @end smallexample
29816
29817 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29818 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29819 used as the non-printable character.
29820
29821 @smallexample
29822 (gdb)
29823 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29824 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29825 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29826 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29827 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29828 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29829 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29830 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29831 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29832 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29833 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29834 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29835 (gdb)
29836 @end smallexample
29837
29838 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29839 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29840
29841 @subsubheading Synopsis
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29845 @var{address} @var{count}
29846 @end smallexample
29847
29848 @noindent
29849 where:
29850
29851 @table @samp
29852 @item @var{address}
29853 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29854 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29855 quoted using the C convention.
29856
29857 @item @var{count}
29858 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29859
29860 @item @var{byte-offset}
29861 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29862 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29863 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29864 perform address arithmetics itself.
29865
29866 @end table
29867
29868 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29869 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29870 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29871 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29872 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29873 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29874
29875 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29876 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29877 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29878 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29879 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29880 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29881 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29882 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29883
29884 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29885 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29886 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29887 and has the following fields:
29888
29889 @table @code
29890 @item begin
29891 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29892
29893 @item end
29894 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29895
29896 @item offset
29897 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29898 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29899
29900 @item contents
29901 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29902
29903 @end table
29904
29905
29906
29907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29908
29909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29910
29911 @subsubheading Example
29912
29913 @smallexample
29914 (gdb)
29915 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29916 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29917 end="0xbffff15e",
29918 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29919 (gdb)
29920 @end smallexample
29921
29922
29923 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29924 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29925
29926 @subsubheading Synopsis
29927
29928 @smallexample
29929 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29930 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29931 @end smallexample
29932
29933 @noindent
29934 where:
29935
29936 @table @samp
29937 @item @var{address}
29938 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29939 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29940 quoted using the C convention.
29941
29942 @item @var{contents}
29943 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29944
29945 @item @var{count}
29946 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29947 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29948 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29949
29950 @end table
29951
29952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29953
29954 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29955
29956 @subsubheading Example
29957
29958 @smallexample
29959 (gdb)
29960 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29961 ^done
29962 (gdb)
29963 @end smallexample
29964
29965 @smallexample
29966 (gdb)
29967 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29968 ^done
29969 (gdb)
29970 @end smallexample
29971
29972 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29973 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29974 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29975
29976 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29977 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29978
29979 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29980 @findex -trace-find
29981
29982 @subsubheading Synopsis
29983
29984 @smallexample
29985 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29986 @end smallexample
29987
29988 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29989 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29990 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29991
29992 @table @samp
29993
29994 @item none
29995 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29996
29997 @item frame-number
29998 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29999 that index.
30000
30001 @item tracepoint-number
30002 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30003 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30004
30005 @item pc
30006 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30007 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30008 address.
30009
30010 @item pc-inside-range
30011 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30012 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30013 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30014
30015 @item pc-outside-range
30016 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30017 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30018 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30019
30020 @item line
30021 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30022 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30023 the specified location.
30024
30025 @end table
30026
30027 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30028 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30029
30030 @table @samp
30031 @item found
30032 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30033 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30034
30035 @item traceframe
30036 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30037 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30038
30039 @item tracepoint
30040 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30041 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30042
30043 @item frame
30044 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30045 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30046 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30047
30048 @end table
30049
30050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30051
30052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30053
30054 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30055 @findex -trace-define-variable
30056
30057 @subsubheading Synopsis
30058
30059 @smallexample
30060 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30061 @end smallexample
30062
30063 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30064 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30065 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30066 with the @samp{$} character.
30067
30068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30069
30070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30071
30072 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30073 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30074
30075 @subsubheading Synopsis
30076
30077 @smallexample
30078 -trace-frame-collected
30079 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30080 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30081 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30082 [--memory-contents]
30083 @end smallexample
30084
30085 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30086 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30087 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30088 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30089 See the output description table below for more details.
30090
30091 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30092 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30093 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30094 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30095 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30096
30097 For instance, if the actions were
30098 @smallexample
30099 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30100 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30101 @end smallexample
30102
30103 @noindent
30104 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30105 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30106 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30107 objects would be computed expressions.
30108
30109 An example output would be:
30110
30111 @smallexample
30112 (gdb)
30113 -trace-frame-collected
30114 ^done,
30115 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30116 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30117 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30118 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30119 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30120 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30121 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30122 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30123 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30124 ...
30125 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30126 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30127 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30128 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30129 (gdb)
30130 @end smallexample
30131
30132 Where:
30133
30134 @table @code
30135 @item explicit-variables
30136 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30137 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30138 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30139 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30140 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30141 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30142 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30143 arrays, structures and unions.
30144
30145 @item computed-expressions
30146 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30147 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30148 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30149 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30150
30151 @item registers
30152 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30153 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30154 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30155 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30156 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30157
30158 @item tvars
30159 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30160 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30161 current value are returned.
30162
30163 @item memory
30164 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30165 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30166 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30167
30168 @table @code
30169 @item address
30170 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30171
30172 @item length
30173 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30174
30175 @item contents
30176 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30177 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30178
30179 @end table
30180
30181 @end table
30182
30183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30184
30185 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30186
30187 @subsubheading Example
30188
30189 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30190 @findex -trace-list-variables
30191
30192 @subsubheading Synopsis
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 -trace-list-variables
30196 @end smallexample
30197
30198 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30199 table has the following fields:
30200
30201 @table @samp
30202 @item name
30203 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30204
30205 @item initial
30206 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30207 field is always present.
30208
30209 @item current
30210 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30211 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30212 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30213 presently running.
30214
30215 @end table
30216
30217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30218
30219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30220
30221 @subsubheading Example
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 (gdb)
30225 -trace-list-variables
30226 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30227 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30228 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30229 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30230 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30231 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30232 (gdb)
30233 @end smallexample
30234
30235 @subheading -trace-save
30236 @findex -trace-save
30237
30238 @subsubheading Synopsis
30239
30240 @smallexample
30241 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30242 @end smallexample
30243
30244 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30245 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30246 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30247 to perform the save.
30248
30249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30250
30251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30252
30253
30254 @subheading -trace-start
30255 @findex -trace-start
30256
30257 @subsubheading Synopsis
30258
30259 @smallexample
30260 -trace-start
30261 @end smallexample
30262
30263 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30264 have any fields.
30265
30266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30267
30268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30269
30270 @subheading -trace-status
30271 @findex -trace-status
30272
30273 @subsubheading Synopsis
30274
30275 @smallexample
30276 -trace-status
30277 @end smallexample
30278
30279 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30280 the following fields:
30281
30282 @table @samp
30283
30284 @item supported
30285 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30286 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30287 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30288 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30289 started. This field is always present.
30290
30291 @item running
30292 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30293 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30294 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30295
30296 @item stop-reason
30297 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30298 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30299 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30300 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30301 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30302 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30303 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30304 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30305 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30306
30307 @item stopping-tracepoint
30308 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30309 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30310 @samp{passcount}.
30311
30312 @item frames
30313 @itemx frames-created
30314 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30315 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30316 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30317 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30318
30319 @item buffer-size
30320 @itemx buffer-free
30321 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30322 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30323
30324 @item circular
30325 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30326 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30327 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30328 and may fill up.
30329
30330 @item disconnected
30331 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30332 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30333 that the trace run will stop.
30334
30335 @item trace-file
30336 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30337 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30338
30339 @end table
30340
30341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30342
30343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30344
30345 @subheading -trace-stop
30346 @findex -trace-stop
30347
30348 @subsubheading Synopsis
30349
30350 @smallexample
30351 -trace-stop
30352 @end smallexample
30353
30354 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30355 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30356 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30357
30358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30359
30360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30361
30362
30363 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30364 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30365 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30366
30367
30368 @ignore
30369 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30370 @findex -symbol-info-address
30371
30372 @subsubheading Synopsis
30373
30374 @smallexample
30375 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30376 @end smallexample
30377
30378 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30379
30380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30381
30382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30383
30384 @subsubheading Example
30385 N.A.
30386
30387
30388 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30389 @findex -symbol-info-file
30390
30391 @subsubheading Synopsis
30392
30393 @smallexample
30394 -symbol-info-file
30395 @end smallexample
30396
30397 Show the file for the symbol.
30398
30399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30400
30401 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30402 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30403
30404 @subsubheading Example
30405 N.A.
30406
30407
30408 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30409 @findex -symbol-info-function
30410
30411 @subsubheading Synopsis
30412
30413 @smallexample
30414 -symbol-info-function
30415 @end smallexample
30416
30417 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30418
30419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30420
30421 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30422
30423 @subsubheading Example
30424 N.A.
30425
30426
30427 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30428 @findex -symbol-info-line
30429
30430 @subsubheading Synopsis
30431
30432 @smallexample
30433 -symbol-info-line
30434 @end smallexample
30435
30436 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30437
30438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30439
30440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30441 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30442
30443 @subsubheading Example
30444 N.A.
30445
30446
30447 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30448 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30449
30450 @subsubheading Synopsis
30451
30452 @smallexample
30453 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30454 @end smallexample
30455
30456 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30457
30458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30459
30460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30461
30462 @subsubheading Example
30463 N.A.
30464
30465
30466 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30467 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30468
30469 @subsubheading Synopsis
30470
30471 @smallexample
30472 -symbol-list-functions
30473 @end smallexample
30474
30475 List the functions in the executable.
30476
30477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30478
30479 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30480 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30481
30482 @subsubheading Example
30483 N.A.
30484 @end ignore
30485
30486
30487 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30488 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30489
30490 @subsubheading Synopsis
30491
30492 @smallexample
30493 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30494 @end smallexample
30495
30496 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30497 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30498 ascending PC order.
30499
30500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30501
30502 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30503
30504 @subsubheading Example
30505 @smallexample
30506 (gdb)
30507 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30508 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30509 (gdb)
30510 @end smallexample
30511
30512
30513 @ignore
30514 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30515 @findex -symbol-list-types
30516
30517 @subsubheading Synopsis
30518
30519 @smallexample
30520 -symbol-list-types
30521 @end smallexample
30522
30523 List all the type names.
30524
30525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30526
30527 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30528 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30529
30530 @subsubheading Example
30531 N.A.
30532
30533
30534 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30535 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30536
30537 @subsubheading Synopsis
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 -symbol-list-variables
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543 List all the global and static variable names.
30544
30545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30546
30547 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30548
30549 @subsubheading Example
30550 N.A.
30551
30552
30553 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30554 @findex -symbol-locate
30555
30556 @subsubheading Synopsis
30557
30558 @smallexample
30559 -symbol-locate
30560 @end smallexample
30561
30562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30563
30564 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30565
30566 @subsubheading Example
30567 N.A.
30568
30569
30570 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30571 @findex -symbol-type
30572
30573 @subsubheading Synopsis
30574
30575 @smallexample
30576 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30577 @end smallexample
30578
30579 Show type of @var{variable}.
30580
30581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30582
30583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30584 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30585
30586 @subsubheading Example
30587 N.A.
30588 @end ignore
30589
30590
30591 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30592 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30593 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30594
30595 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30596 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30597
30598 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30599 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30600
30601 @subsubheading Synopsis
30602
30603 @smallexample
30604 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30605 @end smallexample
30606
30607 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30608 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30609 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30610 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30611 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30612 notification.
30613
30614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30615
30616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30617
30618 @subsubheading Example
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 (gdb)
30622 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30623 ^done
30624 (gdb)
30625 @end smallexample
30626
30627
30628 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30629 @findex -file-exec-file
30630
30631 @subsubheading Synopsis
30632
30633 @smallexample
30634 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30635 @end smallexample
30636
30637 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30638 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30639 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30640 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30641 notification.
30642
30643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30644
30645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30646
30647 @subsubheading Example
30648
30649 @smallexample
30650 (gdb)
30651 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30652 ^done
30653 (gdb)
30654 @end smallexample
30655
30656
30657 @ignore
30658 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30659 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30660
30661 @subsubheading Synopsis
30662
30663 @smallexample
30664 -file-list-exec-sections
30665 @end smallexample
30666
30667 List the sections of the current executable file.
30668
30669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30670
30671 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30672 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30673 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30674
30675 @subsubheading Example
30676 N.A.
30677 @end ignore
30678
30679
30680 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30681 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30682
30683 @subsubheading Synopsis
30684
30685 @smallexample
30686 -file-list-exec-source-file
30687 @end smallexample
30688
30689 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30690 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30691 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30692 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30693
30694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30695
30696 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30697
30698 @subsubheading Example
30699
30700 @smallexample
30701 (gdb)
30702 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30703 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30704 (gdb)
30705 @end smallexample
30706
30707
30708 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30709 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30710
30711 @subsubheading Synopsis
30712
30713 @smallexample
30714 -file-list-exec-source-files
30715 @end smallexample
30716
30717 List the source files for the current executable.
30718
30719 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30720 name) of a source file.
30721
30722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30723
30724 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30725 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30726
30727 @subsubheading Example
30728 @smallexample
30729 (gdb)
30730 -file-list-exec-source-files
30731 ^done,files=[
30732 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30733 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30734 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30735 (gdb)
30736 @end smallexample
30737
30738 @ignore
30739 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30740 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30741
30742 @subsubheading Synopsis
30743
30744 @smallexample
30745 -file-list-shared-libraries
30746 @end smallexample
30747
30748 List the shared libraries in the program.
30749
30750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30751
30752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30753
30754 @subsubheading Example
30755 N.A.
30756
30757
30758 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30759 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30760
30761 @subsubheading Synopsis
30762
30763 @smallexample
30764 -file-list-symbol-files
30765 @end smallexample
30766
30767 List symbol files.
30768
30769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30770
30771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30772
30773 @subsubheading Example
30774 N.A.
30775 @end ignore
30776
30777
30778 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30779 @findex -file-symbol-file
30780
30781 @subsubheading Synopsis
30782
30783 @smallexample
30784 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30785 @end smallexample
30786
30787 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30788 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30789 produced, except for a completion notification.
30790
30791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30792
30793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30794
30795 @subsubheading Example
30796
30797 @smallexample
30798 (gdb)
30799 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30800 ^done
30801 (gdb)
30802 @end smallexample
30803
30804 @ignore
30805 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30806 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30807 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30808
30809 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30810
30811 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30812
30813 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30814
30815 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30816
30817 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30818
30819 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30820
30821 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30822
30823 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30824
30825 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30826 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30827 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30828
30829 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30830
30831 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30832
30833 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30834
30835 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30836 @end ignore
30837
30838
30839 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30840 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30841 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30842
30843
30844 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30845 @findex -target-attach
30846
30847 @subsubheading Synopsis
30848
30849 @smallexample
30850 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30851 @end smallexample
30852
30853 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30854 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30855 group, the id previously returned by
30856 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30857
30858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30859
30860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30861
30862 @subsubheading Example
30863 @smallexample
30864 (gdb)
30865 -target-attach 34
30866 =thread-created,id="1"
30867 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30868 ^done
30869 (gdb)
30870 @end smallexample
30871
30872 @ignore
30873 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30874 @findex -target-compare-sections
30875
30876 @subsubheading Synopsis
30877
30878 @smallexample
30879 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30880 @end smallexample
30881
30882 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30883 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30884
30885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30886
30887 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30888
30889 @subsubheading Example
30890 N.A.
30891 @end ignore
30892
30893
30894 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30895 @findex -target-detach
30896
30897 @subsubheading Synopsis
30898
30899 @smallexample
30900 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30901 @end smallexample
30902
30903 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30904 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30905 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30906
30907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30908
30909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30910
30911 @subsubheading Example
30912
30913 @smallexample
30914 (gdb)
30915 -target-detach
30916 ^done
30917 (gdb)
30918 @end smallexample
30919
30920
30921 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30922 @findex -target-disconnect
30923
30924 @subsubheading Synopsis
30925
30926 @smallexample
30927 -target-disconnect
30928 @end smallexample
30929
30930 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30931 generally not resumed.
30932
30933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30934
30935 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30936
30937 @subsubheading Example
30938
30939 @smallexample
30940 (gdb)
30941 -target-disconnect
30942 ^done
30943 (gdb)
30944 @end smallexample
30945
30946
30947 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30948 @findex -target-download
30949
30950 @subsubheading Synopsis
30951
30952 @smallexample
30953 -target-download
30954 @end smallexample
30955
30956 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30957 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30958
30959 @table @samp
30960 @item section
30961 The name of the section.
30962 @item section-sent
30963 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30964 @item section-size
30965 The size of the section.
30966 @item total-sent
30967 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30968 @item total-size
30969 The size of the overall executable to download.
30970 @end table
30971
30972 @noindent
30973 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30974 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30975
30976 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30977 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30978
30979 @table @samp
30980 @item section
30981 The name of the section.
30982 @item section-size
30983 The size of the section.
30984 @item total-size
30985 The size of the overall executable to download.
30986 @end table
30987
30988 @noindent
30989 At the end, a summary is printed.
30990
30991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30992
30993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30994
30995 @subsubheading Example
30996
30997 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30998 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30999
31000 @smallexample
31001 (gdb)
31002 -target-download
31003 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31004 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31005 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31006 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31007 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31008 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31009 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31010 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31011 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31012 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31013 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31014 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31015 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31016 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31017 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31018 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31019 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31020 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31021 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31022 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31023 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31024 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31025 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31026 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31027 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31028 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31029 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31030 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31031 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31032 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31033 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31034 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31035 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31036 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31037 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31038 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31039 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31040 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31041 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31042 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31043 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31044 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31045 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31046 write-rate="429"
31047 (gdb)
31048 @end smallexample
31049
31050
31051 @ignore
31052 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31053 @findex -target-exec-status
31054
31055 @subsubheading Synopsis
31056
31057 @smallexample
31058 -target-exec-status
31059 @end smallexample
31060
31061 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31062 not, for instance).
31063
31064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31065
31066 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31067
31068 @subsubheading Example
31069 N.A.
31070
31071
31072 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31073 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31074
31075 @subsubheading Synopsis
31076
31077 @smallexample
31078 -target-list-available-targets
31079 @end smallexample
31080
31081 List the possible targets to connect to.
31082
31083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31084
31085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31086
31087 @subsubheading Example
31088 N.A.
31089
31090
31091 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31092 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31093
31094 @subsubheading Synopsis
31095
31096 @smallexample
31097 -target-list-current-targets
31098 @end smallexample
31099
31100 Describe the current target.
31101
31102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31103
31104 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31105 other things).
31106
31107 @subsubheading Example
31108 N.A.
31109
31110
31111 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31112 @findex -target-list-parameters
31113
31114 @subsubheading Synopsis
31115
31116 @smallexample
31117 -target-list-parameters
31118 @end smallexample
31119
31120 @c ????
31121 @end ignore
31122
31123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31124
31125 No equivalent.
31126
31127 @subsubheading Example
31128 N.A.
31129
31130
31131 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31132 @findex -target-select
31133
31134 @subsubheading Synopsis
31135
31136 @smallexample
31137 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31138 @end smallexample
31139
31140 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31141
31142 @table @samp
31143 @item @var{type}
31144 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31145 @item @var{parameters}
31146 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31147 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31148 @end table
31149
31150 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31151 which the target program is, in the following form:
31152
31153 @smallexample
31154 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31155 args=[@var{arg list}]
31156 @end smallexample
31157
31158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31159
31160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31161
31162 @subsubheading Example
31163
31164 @smallexample
31165 (gdb)
31166 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31167 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31168 (gdb)
31169 @end smallexample
31170
31171 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31172 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31173 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31174
31175
31176 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31177 @findex -target-file-put
31178
31179 @subsubheading Synopsis
31180
31181 @smallexample
31182 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31183 @end smallexample
31184
31185 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31186 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31187
31188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31189
31190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31191
31192 @subsubheading Example
31193
31194 @smallexample
31195 (gdb)
31196 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31197 ^done
31198 (gdb)
31199 @end smallexample
31200
31201
31202 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31203 @findex -target-file-get
31204
31205 @subsubheading Synopsis
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31209 @end smallexample
31210
31211 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31212 on the host system.
31213
31214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31215
31216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31217
31218 @subsubheading Example
31219
31220 @smallexample
31221 (gdb)
31222 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31223 ^done
31224 (gdb)
31225 @end smallexample
31226
31227
31228 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31229 @findex -target-file-delete
31230
31231 @subsubheading Synopsis
31232
31233 @smallexample
31234 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31235 @end smallexample
31236
31237 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31238
31239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31240
31241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31242
31243 @subsubheading Example
31244
31245 @smallexample
31246 (gdb)
31247 -target-file-delete remotefile
31248 ^done
31249 (gdb)
31250 @end smallexample
31251
31252
31253 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31254 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31255 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31256
31257 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31258 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31259
31260 @subsubheading Synopsis
31261
31262 @smallexample
31263 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31264 @end smallexample
31265
31266 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31267 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31268 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31269
31270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31271
31272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31273
31274 @subsubheading Result
31275
31276 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31277 defined for each exception:
31278
31279 @table @samp
31280 @item name
31281 The name of the exception.
31282
31283 @item address
31284 The address of the exception.
31285
31286 @end table
31287
31288 @subsubheading Example
31289
31290 @smallexample
31291 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31292 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31293 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31294 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31295 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31296 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31297 @end smallexample
31298
31299 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31300
31301 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31302 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31303 Catchpoint Commands}.
31304
31305
31306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31307 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31308 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31309
31310 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31311 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31312 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31313 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31314
31315 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31316 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31317 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31318
31319 @subsubheading Synopsis
31320
31321 @smallexample
31322 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31323 @end smallexample
31324
31325 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31326
31327 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31328 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31329 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31330 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31331 dash.
31332
31333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31334
31335 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31336
31337 @subsubheading Result
31338
31339 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31340
31341 @table @samp
31342 @item exists
31343 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31344 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31345
31346 @end table
31347
31348 @subsubheading Example
31349
31350 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31351
31352 @smallexample
31353 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31354 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357 @noindent
31358 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31359 to the debugger:
31360
31361 @smallexample
31362 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31363 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31364 @end smallexample
31365
31366 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31367 @findex -list-features
31368 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31369
31370 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31371 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31372 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31373 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31374 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31375 startup.
31376
31377 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31378 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31379 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31380 is given below.
31381
31382 Example output:
31383
31384 @smallexample
31385 (gdb) -list-features
31386 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31387 @end smallexample
31388
31389 The current list of features is:
31390
31391 @ftable @samp
31392 @item frozen-varobjs
31393 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31394 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31395 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31396 @item pending-breakpoints
31397 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31398 command.
31399 @item python
31400 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31401 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31402 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31403 @item thread-info
31404 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31405 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31406 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31407 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31408 @item breakpoint-notifications
31409 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31410 CLI will be announced via async records.
31411 @item ada-task-info
31412 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31413 @item language-option
31414 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31415 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31416 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31417 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31418 @item undefined-command-error-code
31419 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31420 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31421 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31422 @item exec-run-start-option
31423 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31424 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31425 @end ftable
31426
31427 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31428 @findex -list-target-features
31429
31430 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31431 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31432 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31433 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31434 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31435 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31436 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31437 Example output:
31438
31439 @smallexample
31440 (gdb) -list-target-features
31441 ^done,result=["async"]
31442 @end smallexample
31443
31444 The current list of features is:
31445
31446 @table @samp
31447 @item async
31448 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31449 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31450 while the target is running.
31451
31452 @item reverse
31453 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31454 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31455
31456 @end table
31457
31458 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31459 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31460 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31461
31462 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31463
31464 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31465 @findex -gdb-exit
31466
31467 @subsubheading Synopsis
31468
31469 @smallexample
31470 -gdb-exit
31471 @end smallexample
31472
31473 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31474
31475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31476
31477 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31478
31479 @subsubheading Example
31480
31481 @smallexample
31482 (gdb)
31483 -gdb-exit
31484 ^exit
31485 @end smallexample
31486
31487
31488 @ignore
31489 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31490 @findex -exec-abort
31491
31492 @subsubheading Synopsis
31493
31494 @smallexample
31495 -exec-abort
31496 @end smallexample
31497
31498 Kill the inferior running program.
31499
31500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31501
31502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31503
31504 @subsubheading Example
31505 N.A.
31506 @end ignore
31507
31508
31509 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31510 @findex -gdb-set
31511
31512 @subsubheading Synopsis
31513
31514 @smallexample
31515 -gdb-set
31516 @end smallexample
31517
31518 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31519 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31520
31521 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31522
31523 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31524
31525 @subsubheading Example
31526
31527 @smallexample
31528 (gdb)
31529 -gdb-set $foo=3
31530 ^done
31531 (gdb)
31532 @end smallexample
31533
31534
31535 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31536 @findex -gdb-show
31537
31538 @subsubheading Synopsis
31539
31540 @smallexample
31541 -gdb-show
31542 @end smallexample
31543
31544 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31545
31546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31547
31548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31549
31550 @subsubheading Example
31551
31552 @smallexample
31553 (gdb)
31554 -gdb-show annotate
31555 ^done,value="0"
31556 (gdb)
31557 @end smallexample
31558
31559 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31560
31561
31562 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31563 @findex -gdb-version
31564
31565 @subsubheading Synopsis
31566
31567 @smallexample
31568 -gdb-version
31569 @end smallexample
31570
31571 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31572
31573 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31574
31575 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31576 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31577
31578 @subsubheading Example
31579
31580 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31581 @c box in TeX.
31582 @smallexample
31583 (gdb)
31584 -gdb-version
31585 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31586 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31587 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31588 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31589 ~ certain conditions.
31590 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31591 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31592 ~ details.
31593 ~This GDB was configured as
31594 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31595 ^done
31596 (gdb)
31597 @end smallexample
31598
31599 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31600 @findex -list-thread-groups
31601
31602 @subheading Synopsis
31603
31604 @smallexample
31605 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31606 @end smallexample
31607
31608 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31609 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31610 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31611 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31612 top-level thread groups.
31613
31614 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31615 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31616 available on the target.
31617
31618 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31619 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31620 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31621 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31622 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31623 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31624 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31625 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31626
31627 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31628 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31629 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31630 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31631 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31632 @samp{threads} field.
31633
31634 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31635 the following caveats:
31636
31637 @itemize @bullet
31638 @item
31639 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31640 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31641 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31642
31643 @item
31644 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31645 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31646 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31647 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31648 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31649 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31650
31651 @end itemize
31652
31653 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31654 have the following fields:
31655
31656 @table @code
31657 @item id
31658 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31659 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31660 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31661
31662 @item type
31663 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31664 valid type.
31665
31666 @item pid
31667 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31668 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31669
31670 @item exit-code
31671 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31672 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31673 only if the process is not running.
31674
31675 @item num_children
31676 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31677 absent for an available thread group.
31678
31679 @item threads
31680 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31681 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31682 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31683
31684 @item cores
31685 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31686 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31687 such information is not available.
31688
31689 @item executable
31690 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31691 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31692 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31693
31694 @end table
31695
31696 @subheading Example
31697
31698 @smallexample
31699 @value{GDBP}
31700 -list-thread-groups
31701 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31702 -list-thread-groups 17
31703 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31704 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31705 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31706 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31707 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31708 -list-thread-groups --available
31709 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31710 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31711 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31712 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31713 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31714 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31715 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31716 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31717 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31718 @end smallexample
31719
31720 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31721 @findex -info-os
31722
31723 @subsubheading Synopsis
31724
31725 @smallexample
31726 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31730 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31731 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31732 of data of that type.
31733
31734 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31735 system.
31736
31737 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31738
31739 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31740
31741 @subsubheading Example
31742
31743 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31744 like this:
31745
31746 @smallexample
31747 @value{GDBP}
31748 -info-os
31749 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31750 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31751 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31752 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31753 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31754 col2="Processes"@},
31755 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31756 col2="Process groups"@},
31757 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31758 col2="Threads"@},
31759 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31760 col2="File descriptors"@},
31761 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31762 col2="Sockets"@},
31763 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31764 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31765 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31766 col2="Semaphores"@},
31767 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31768 col2="Message queues"@},
31769 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31770 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31771 @value{GDBP}
31772 -info-os processes
31773 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31774 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31775 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31776 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31777 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31778 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31779 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31780 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31781 ...
31782 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31783 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31784 (gdb)
31785 @end smallexample
31786
31787 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31788 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31789 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31790 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31791 @code{info os} omits it.)
31792
31793 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31794 @findex -add-inferior
31795
31796 @subheading Synopsis
31797
31798 @smallexample
31799 -add-inferior
31800 @end smallexample
31801
31802 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31803 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31804 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31805 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31806 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31807 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31808
31809 @subheading Example
31810
31811 @smallexample
31812 @value{GDBP}
31813 -add-inferior
31814 ^done,inferior="i3"
31815 @end smallexample
31816
31817 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31818 @findex -interpreter-exec
31819
31820 @subheading Synopsis
31821
31822 @smallexample
31823 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31824 @end smallexample
31825 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31826
31827 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31828
31829 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31830
31831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31832
31833 @subheading Example
31834
31835 @smallexample
31836 (gdb)
31837 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31838 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31839 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31840 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31841 ^done
31842 (gdb)
31843 @end smallexample
31844
31845 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31846 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31847
31848 @subheading Synopsis
31849
31850 @smallexample
31851 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31852 @end smallexample
31853
31854 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31855
31856 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31857
31858 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31859
31860 @subheading Example
31861
31862 @smallexample
31863 (gdb)
31864 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31865 ^done
31866 (gdb)
31867 @end smallexample
31868
31869 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31870 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31871
31872 @subheading Synopsis
31873
31874 @smallexample
31875 -inferior-tty-show
31876 @end smallexample
31877
31878 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31879
31880 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31881
31882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31883
31884 @subheading Example
31885
31886 @smallexample
31887 (gdb)
31888 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31889 ^done
31890 (gdb)
31891 -inferior-tty-show
31892 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31893 (gdb)
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31897 @findex -enable-timings
31898
31899 @subheading Synopsis
31900
31901 @smallexample
31902 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31903 @end smallexample
31904
31905 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31906 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31907 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31908 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31909
31910 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31911
31912 No equivalent.
31913
31914 @subheading Example
31915
31916 @smallexample
31917 (gdb)
31918 -enable-timings
31919 ^done
31920 (gdb)
31921 -break-insert main
31922 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31923 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31924 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31925 times="0"@},
31926 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31927 (gdb)
31928 -enable-timings no
31929 ^done
31930 (gdb)
31931 -exec-run
31932 ^running
31933 (gdb)
31934 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31935 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31936 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31937 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31938 (gdb)
31939 @end smallexample
31940
31941 @node Annotations
31942 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31943
31944 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31945 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31946 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31947 relatively high level.
31948
31949 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31950 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31951
31952 @ignore
31953 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31954 @end ignore
31955
31956 @menu
31957 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31958 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31959 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31960 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31961 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31962 * Annotations for Running::
31963 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31964 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31965 @end menu
31966
31967 @node Annotations Overview
31968 @section What is an Annotation?
31969 @cindex annotations
31970
31971 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31972 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31973 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31974 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31975 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31976 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31977 cannot contain newline characters.
31978
31979 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31980 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31981 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31982 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31983 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31984 means those three characters as output.
31985
31986 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31987 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31988 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31989 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31990 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31991 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31992 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31993 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31994 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31995
31996 @table @code
31997 @kindex set annotate
31998 @item set annotate @var{level}
31999 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32000 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32001
32002 @item show annotate
32003 @kindex show annotate
32004 Show the current annotation level.
32005 @end table
32006
32007 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32008
32009 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32010
32011 @smallexample
32012 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32013 GNU gdb 6.0
32014 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32015 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32016 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32017 under certain conditions.
32018 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32019 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32020 for details.
32021 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32022
32023 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32024 (@value{GDBP})
32025 ^Z^Zprompt
32026 @kbd{quit}
32027
32028 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32029 $
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32033 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32034 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32035 output from @value{GDBN}.
32036
32037 @node Server Prefix
32038 @section The Server Prefix
32039 @cindex server prefix
32040
32041 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32042 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32043 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32044 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32045 a transparent manner.
32046
32047 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32048 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32049 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32050 @code{print} command.
32051
32052 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32053 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32054
32055 @node Prompting
32056 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32057
32058 @cindex annotations for prompts
32059 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32060 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32061 over, etc.
32062
32063 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32064 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32065 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32066 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32067 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32068 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32069 features the following annotations:
32070
32071 @smallexample
32072 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32073 ^Z^Zprompt
32074 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32075 @end smallexample
32076
32077 The input types are
32078
32079 @table @code
32080 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32081 @findex prompt annotation
32082 @findex post-prompt annotation
32083 @item prompt
32084 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32085
32086 @findex pre-commands annotation
32087 @findex commands annotation
32088 @findex post-commands annotation
32089 @item commands
32090 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32091 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32092
32093 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32094 @findex overload-choice annotation
32095 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32096 @item overload-choice
32097 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32098
32099 @findex pre-query annotation
32100 @findex query annotation
32101 @findex post-query annotation
32102 @item query
32103 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32104
32105 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32106 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32107 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32108 @item prompt-for-continue
32109 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32110 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32111 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32112 presence of annotations.
32113 @end table
32114
32115 @node Errors
32116 @section Errors
32117 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32118
32119 @findex quit annotation
32120 @smallexample
32121 ^Z^Zquit
32122 @end smallexample
32123
32124 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32125
32126 @findex error annotation
32127 @smallexample
32128 ^Z^Zerror
32129 @end smallexample
32130
32131 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32132
32133 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32134 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32135 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32136 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32137 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32138 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32139 to the top level.
32140
32141 @findex error-begin annotation
32142 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32143
32144 @smallexample
32145 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32146 @end smallexample
32147
32148 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32149 message.
32150
32151 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32152 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32153 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32154
32155 @node Invalidation
32156 @section Invalidation Notices
32157
32158 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32159 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32160 changed.
32161
32162 @table @code
32163 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32164 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32165
32166 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32167 have changed.
32168
32169 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32170 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32171
32172 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32173 deleted a breakpoint.
32174 @end table
32175
32176 @node Annotations for Running
32177 @section Running the Program
32178 @cindex annotations for running programs
32179
32180 @findex starting annotation
32181 @findex stopping annotation
32182 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32183 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32184
32185 @smallexample
32186 ^Z^Zstarting
32187 @end smallexample
32188
32189 is output. When the program stops,
32190
32191 @smallexample
32192 ^Z^Zstopped
32193 @end smallexample
32194
32195 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32196 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32197
32198 @table @code
32199 @findex exited annotation
32200 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32201 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32202 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32203
32204 @findex signalled annotation
32205 @findex signal-name annotation
32206 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32207 @findex signal-string annotation
32208 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32209 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32210 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32211 annotation continues:
32212
32213 @smallexample
32214 @var{intro-text}
32215 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32216 @var{name}
32217 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32218 @var{middle-text}
32219 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32220 @var{string}
32221 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32222 @var{end-text}
32223 @end smallexample
32224
32225 @noindent
32226 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32227 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32228 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32229 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32230 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32231
32232 @findex signal annotation
32233 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32234 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32235 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32236 terminated with it.
32237
32238 @findex breakpoint annotation
32239 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32240 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32241
32242 @findex watchpoint annotation
32243 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32244 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32245 @end table
32246
32247 @node Source Annotations
32248 @section Displaying Source
32249 @cindex annotations for source display
32250
32251 @findex source annotation
32252 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32253
32254 @smallexample
32255 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32256 @end smallexample
32257
32258 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32259 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32260 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32261 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32262 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32263 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32264 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32265 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32266 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32267 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32268 depend on the language).
32269
32270 @node JIT Interface
32271 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32272 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32273 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32274
32275 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32276 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32277 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32278 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32279
32280 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32281 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32282 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32283 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32284 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32285 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32286
32287 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32288 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32289 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32290 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32291 LLVM JIT.
32292
32293 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32294 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32295 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32296 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32297 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32298 out about additional code.
32299
32300 @menu
32301 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32302 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32303 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32304 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32305 @end menu
32306
32307 @node Declarations
32308 @section JIT Declarations
32309
32310 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32311 implement the interface:
32312
32313 @smallexample
32314 typedef enum
32315 @{
32316 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32317 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32318 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32319 @} jit_actions_t;
32320
32321 struct jit_code_entry
32322 @{
32323 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32324 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32325 const char *symfile_addr;
32326 uint64_t symfile_size;
32327 @};
32328
32329 struct jit_descriptor
32330 @{
32331 uint32_t version;
32332 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32333 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32334 uint32_t action_flag;
32335 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32336 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32337 @};
32338
32339 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32340 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32341
32342 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32343 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32344 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32345 @end smallexample
32346
32347 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32348 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32349 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32350
32351 @node Registering Code
32352 @section Registering Code
32353
32354 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32355
32356 @itemize @bullet
32357 @item
32358 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32359 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32360
32361 @item
32362 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32363 file.
32364
32365 @item
32366 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32367
32368 @item
32369 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32370
32371 @item
32372 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32373 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32374 @end itemize
32375
32376 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32377 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32378 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32379 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32380
32381 @node Unregistering Code
32382 @section Unregistering Code
32383
32384 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32385
32386 @itemize @bullet
32387 @item
32388 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32389
32390 @item
32391 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32392
32393 @item
32394 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32395 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32396 @end itemize
32397
32398 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32399 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32400
32401 @node Custom Debug Info
32402 @section Custom Debug Info
32403 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32404 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32405
32406 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32407 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32408 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32409 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32410 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32411 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32412 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32413 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32414 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32415
32416 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32417 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32418 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32419 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32420 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32421 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32422 compiler.
32423
32424 @menu
32425 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32426 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32427 @end menu
32428
32429 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32430 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32431 @kindex jit-reader-load
32432 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32433
32434 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32435 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32436
32437 @table @code
32438 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32439 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32440 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32441 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32442 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32443 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32444 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32445
32446 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32447 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32448 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32449 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32450 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32451
32452 @item jit-reader-unload
32453 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32454
32455 @end table
32456
32457 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32458 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32459 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32460
32461 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32462 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32463
32464 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32465 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32466 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32467 the system include directory.
32468
32469 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32470 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32471 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32472
32473 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32474 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32475
32476 @findex gdb_init_reader
32477 @smallexample
32478 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32479 @end smallexample
32480
32481 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32482
32483 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32484 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32485 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32486 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32487 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32488 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32489
32490 @smallexample
32491 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32492 @{
32493 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32494 int reader_version;
32495
32496 /* For use by the reader. */
32497 void *priv_data;
32498
32499 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32500 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32501 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32502 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32503 @};
32504 @end smallexample
32505
32506 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32507 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32508
32509 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32510 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32511 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32512 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32513 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32514 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32515 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32516 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32517 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32518 target's address space.
32519
32520 @node In-Process Agent
32521 @chapter In-Process Agent
32522 @cindex debugging agent
32523 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32524 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32525 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32526 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32527 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32528 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32529 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32530 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32531 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32532 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32533 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32534 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32535 behavior without interrupting it.
32536
32537 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32538 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32539 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32540 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32541 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32542 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32543 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32544 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32545 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32546
32547 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32548 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32549 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32550 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32551
32552 @anchor{Control Agent}
32553 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32554 debugging with the following commands:
32555
32556 @table @code
32557 @kindex set agent on
32558 @item set agent on
32559 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32560 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32561 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32562 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32563 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32564 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32565
32566 @kindex set agent off
32567 @item set agent off
32568 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32569 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32570
32571 @kindex show agent
32572 @item show agent
32573 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32574 the in-process agent.
32575 @end table
32576
32577 @menu
32578 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32579 @end menu
32580
32581 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32582 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32583 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32584
32585 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32586 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32587 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32588 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32589 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32590 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32591 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32592 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32593 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32594
32595 @menu
32596 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32597 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32598 @end menu
32599
32600 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32601 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32602 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32603
32604 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32605 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32606
32607 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32608 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32609 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32610 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32611
32612 @enumerate
32613 @item
32614 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32615 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32616 @item
32617 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32618 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32619 the other one.
32620 @end enumerate
32621
32622 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32623
32624 @enumerate
32625 @item
32626 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32627 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32628 @anchor{agent expression object}
32629 @item
32630 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32631 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32632 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32633 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32634 @item
32635 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32636 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32637
32638 @end enumerate
32639
32640 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32641 object:
32642
32643 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32644 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32645 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32646 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32647 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32648 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32649 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32650 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32651 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32652 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32653 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32654 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32655 memory address for collecting.
32656 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32657 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32658 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32659 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32660 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32661 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32662 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32663 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32664 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32665 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32666 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32667 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32668 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32669 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32670 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32671 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32672 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32673 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32674 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32675 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32676 @ref{agent expression object}
32677 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32678 @ref{agent expression object}
32679 @item actions @tab variable
32680 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32681 @end multitable
32682
32683 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32684 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32685 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32686
32687 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32688 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32689
32690 @table @samp
32691
32692 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32693 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32694 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32695 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32696 in IPA finally.
32697
32698 Replies:
32699 @table @samp
32700 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32701 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32702 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32703 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32704 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32705 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32706 @item E @var{NN}
32707 for an error
32708
32709 @end table
32710
32711 @item close
32712 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32713 is about to kill inferiors.
32714
32715 @item qTfSTM
32716 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32717 @item qTsSTM
32718 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32719 @item qTSTMat
32720 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32721 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32722 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32723
32724 Replies:
32725 @table @samp
32726 @item E @var{NN}
32727 for an error
32728 @end table
32729 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32730 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32731 @end table
32732
32733 @node GDB Bugs
32734 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32735 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32736 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32737
32738 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32739
32740 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32741 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32742 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32743 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32744
32745 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32746 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32747
32748 @menu
32749 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32750 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32751 @end menu
32752
32753 @node Bug Criteria
32754 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32755 @cindex bug criteria
32756
32757 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32758
32759 @itemize @bullet
32760 @cindex fatal signal
32761 @cindex debugger crash
32762 @cindex crash of debugger
32763 @item
32764 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32765 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32766
32767 @cindex error on valid input
32768 @item
32769 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32770 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32771 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32772
32773 @cindex invalid input
32774 @item
32775 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32776 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32777 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32778 for traditional practice''.
32779
32780 @item
32781 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32782 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32783 @end itemize
32784
32785 @node Bug Reporting
32786 @section How to Report Bugs
32787 @cindex bug reports
32788 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32789
32790 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32791 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32792 contact that organization first.
32793
32794 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32795 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32796 distribution.
32797 @c should add a web page ref...
32798
32799 @ifset BUGURL
32800 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32801 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32802 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32803 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32804 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32805 be used.
32806
32807 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32808 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32809 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32810 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32811
32812 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32813 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32814 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32815 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32816 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32817 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32818 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32819 bug reports to the mailing list.
32820 @end ifset
32821 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32822 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32823 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32824 @end ifclear
32825 @end ifset
32826
32827 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32828 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32829 fact or leave it out, state it!
32830
32831 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32832 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32833 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32834 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32835 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32836 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32837 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32838 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32839 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32840
32841 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32842 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32843 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32844 self-contained.
32845
32846 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32847 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32848 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32849 bugs properly.
32850
32851 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32852
32853 @itemize @bullet
32854 @item
32855 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32856 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32857 version}.
32858
32859 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32860 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32861
32862 @item
32863 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32864 version number.
32865
32866 @item
32867 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32868 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32869 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32870 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32871
32872 @item
32873 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32874 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32875
32876 @item
32877 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32878 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32879 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32880 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32881 those compilers.
32882
32883 @item
32884 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32885 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32886 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32887 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32888
32889 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32890 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32891
32892 @item
32893 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32894 reproduce the bug.
32895
32896 @item
32897 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32898 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32899
32900 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32901 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32902 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32903 a chance to make a mistake.
32904
32905 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32906 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32907 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32908 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32909 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32910 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32911 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32912 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32913
32914 @pindex script
32915 @cindex recording a session script
32916 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32917 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32918 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32919 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32920
32921 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32922 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32923
32924 @item
32925 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32926 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32927 it by context, not by line number.
32928
32929 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32930 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32931
32932 @end itemize
32933
32934 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32935
32936 @itemize @bullet
32937 @item
32938 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32939
32940 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32941 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32942 changes will not affect it.
32943
32944 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32945 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32946 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32947 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32948
32949 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32950 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32951 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32952 less time, and so on.
32953
32954 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32955 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32956
32957 @item
32958 A patch for the bug.
32959
32960 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32961 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32962 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32963 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32964
32965 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32966 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32967 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32968 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32969
32970 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32971 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32972 help us to understand.
32973
32974 @item
32975 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32976
32977 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32978 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32979 @end itemize
32980
32981 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32982 @c and consists of the two following files:
32983 @c rluser.texi
32984 @c hsuser.texi
32985 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32986 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32987 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32988 @include rluser.texi
32989 @include hsuser.texi
32990 @end ifclear
32991
32992 @node In Memoriam
32993 @appendix In Memoriam
32994
32995 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32996 contributors:
32997
32998 @table @code
32999 @item Fred Fish
33000 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33001 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33002 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33003
33004 @item Michael Snyder
33005 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33006 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33007 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33008 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33009 @end table
33010
33011 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33012 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33013
33014 @node Formatting Documentation
33015 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33016
33017 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33018 @cindex reference card
33019 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33020 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33021 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33022 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33023 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33024 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33025
33026 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33027 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33028
33029 @smallexample
33030 make refcard.dvi
33031 @end smallexample
33032
33033 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33034 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33035 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33036 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33037 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33038
33039 @cindex documentation
33040
33041 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33042 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33043 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33044 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33045 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33046 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33047
33048 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33049 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33050 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33051 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33052 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33053 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33054 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33055 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33056
33057 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33058 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33059 @code{makeinfo}.
33060
33061 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33062 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33063 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33064
33065 @smallexample
33066 cd gdb
33067 make gdb.info
33068 @end smallexample
33069
33070 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33071 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33072 Texinfo definitions file.
33073
33074 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33075 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33076 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33077 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33078 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33079 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33080 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33081
33082 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33083 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33084 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33085 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33086 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33087 directory.
33088
33089 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33090 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33091 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33092 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33093
33094 @smallexample
33095 make gdb.dvi
33096 @end smallexample
33097
33098 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33099
33100 @node Installing GDB
33101 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33102 @cindex installation
33103
33104 @menu
33105 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33106 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33107 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33108 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33109 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33110 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33111 @end menu
33112
33113 @node Requirements
33114 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33115 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33116
33117 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33118 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33119
33120 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33121 @table @asis
33122 @item ISO C90 compiler
33123 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33124 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33125
33126 @end table
33127
33128 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33129 @table @asis
33130 @item Expat
33131 @anchor{Expat}
33132 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33133 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33134 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33135 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33136 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33137 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33138
33139 Expat is used for:
33140
33141 @itemize @bullet
33142 @item
33143 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33144 @item
33145 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33146 @item
33147 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33148 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33149 @item
33150 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33151 @item
33152 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33153 @item
33154 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33155 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33156 @end itemize
33157
33158 @item zlib
33159 @cindex compressed debug sections
33160 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33161 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33162 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33163 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33164 information in such binaries.
33165
33166 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33167 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33168 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33169
33170 @item iconv
33171 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33172 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33173 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33174 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33175
33176 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33177 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33178 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33179 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33180
33181 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33182 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33183 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33184
33185 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33186 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33187 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33188 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33189 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33190 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33191 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33192 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33193 @end table
33194
33195 @node Running Configure
33196 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33197 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33198 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33199 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33200 build the @code{gdb} program.
33201 @iftex
33202 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33203 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33204 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33205 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33206 @end iftex
33207
33208 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33209 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33210 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33211
33212 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33213 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33214
33215 @table @code
33216 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33217 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33218
33219 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33220 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33221
33222 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33223 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33224
33225 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33226 @sc{gnu} include files
33227
33228 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33229 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33230
33231 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33232 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33233
33234 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33235 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33236
33237 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33238 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33239
33240 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33241 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33242 @end table
33243
33244 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33245 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33246 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33247
33248 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33249 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33250 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33251 argument.
33252
33253 For example:
33254
33255 @smallexample
33256 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33257 ./configure @var{host}
33258 make
33259 @end smallexample
33260
33261 @noindent
33262 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33263 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33264 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33265 correct value by examining your system.)
33266
33267 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33268 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33269 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33270 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33271
33272 @need 750
33273 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33274 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33275 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33276
33277 @smallexample
33278 sh configure @var{host}
33279 @end smallexample
33280
33281 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33282 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33283 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33284 @file{configure}
33285 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33286 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33287
33288 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33289 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33290 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33291 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33292 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33293 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33294 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33295 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33296 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33297
33298 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33299 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33300 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33301 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33302 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33303
33304 @node Separate Objdir
33305 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33306
33307 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33308 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33309 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33310 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33311 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33312 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33313 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33314 program specified there.
33315
33316 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33317 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33318 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33319 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33320 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33321 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33322
33323 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33324 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33325
33326 @smallexample
33327 @group
33328 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33329 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33330 cd ../gdb-sun4
33331 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33332 make
33333 @end group
33334 @end smallexample
33335
33336 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33337 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33338 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33339 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33340 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33341 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33342
33343 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33344 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33345 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33346 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33347 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33348
33349 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33350 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33351 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33352 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33353 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33354 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33355
33356 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33357 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33358 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33359
33360 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33361 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33362 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33363 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33364 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33365
33366 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33367 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33368 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33369 with each other.
33370
33371 @node Config Names
33372 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33373
33374 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33375 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33376 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33377 of information in the following pattern:
33378
33379 @smallexample
33380 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33381 @end smallexample
33382
33383 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33384 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33385 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33386
33387 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33388 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33389 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33390 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33391 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33392 abbreviations---for example:
33393
33394 @smallexample
33395 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33396 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33397 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33398 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33399 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33400 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33401 % sh config.sub sun4
33402 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33403 % sh config.sub sun3
33404 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33405 % sh config.sub i986v
33406 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33407 @end smallexample
33408
33409 @noindent
33410 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33411 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33412
33413 @node Configure Options
33414 @section @file{configure} Options
33415
33416 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33417 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33418 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33419 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33420
33421 @smallexample
33422 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33423 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33424 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33425 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33426 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33427 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33428 @var{host}
33429 @end smallexample
33430
33431 @noindent
33432 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33433 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33434 @samp{--}.
33435
33436 @table @code
33437 @item --help
33438 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33439
33440 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33441 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33442 @file{@var{dir}}.
33443
33444 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33445 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33446 @file{@var{dir}}.
33447
33448 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33449 @need 2000
33450 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33451 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33452 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33453 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33454 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33455 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33456 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33457 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33458 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33459 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33460 @var{dirname}.
33461
33462 @item --norecursion
33463 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33464 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33465
33466 @item --target=@var{target}
33467 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33468 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33469 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33470
33471 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33472
33473 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33474 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33475
33476 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33477 @end table
33478
33479 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33480 needed for special purposes only.
33481
33482 @node System-wide configuration
33483 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33484 @cindex system-wide init file
33485
33486 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33487 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33488 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33489
33490 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33491
33492 @table @code
33493 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33494 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33495 @var{file}.
33496 @end table
33497
33498 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33499 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33500
33501 @itemize @bullet
33502 @item
33503 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33504 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33505 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33506 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33507 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33508 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33509
33510 @item
33511 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33512 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33513 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33514 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33515 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33516 @end itemize
33517
33518 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33519 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33520 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33521 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33522 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33523 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33524 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33525 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33526 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33527 reread.
33528
33529 @menu
33530 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33531 @end menu
33532
33533 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33534 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33535 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33536
33537 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33538 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33539 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33540 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33541 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33542 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33543
33544 The following scripts are currently available:
33545 @itemize @bullet
33546
33547 @item @file{elinos.py}
33548 @pindex elinos.py
33549 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33550 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33551 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33552 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33553 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33554 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33555
33556 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33557 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33558 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33559 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33560 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33561 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33562
33563 @end itemize
33564
33565 @node Maintenance Commands
33566 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33567 @cindex maintenance commands
33568 @cindex internal commands
33569
33570 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33571 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33572 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33573 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33574 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33575
33576 @table @code
33577 @kindex maint agent
33578 @kindex maint agent-eval
33579 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33580 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33581 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33582 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33583 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33584 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33585 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33586 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33587 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33588 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33589 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33590 addition and return the sum.
33591 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33592 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33593
33594 @kindex maint agent-printf
33595 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33596 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33597 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33598 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33599 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33600
33601 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33602 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33603 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33604 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33605 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33606 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33607 is shown:
33608
33609 @table @code
33610 @item breakpoint
33611 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33612
33613 @item watchpoint
33614 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33615
33616 @item longjmp
33617 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33618 @code{longjmp} calls.
33619
33620 @item longjmp resume
33621 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33622
33623 @item until
33624 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33625
33626 @item finish
33627 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33628
33629 @item shlib events
33630 Shared library events.
33631
33632 @end table
33633
33634 @kindex maint info bfds
33635 @item maint info bfds
33636 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33637 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33638
33639 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33640 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33641 @cindex displaced stepping support
33642 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33643 @item set displaced-stepping
33644 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33645 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33646 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33647 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33648 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33649 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33650
33651 @table @code
33652 @item set displaced-stepping on
33653 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33654 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33655
33656 @item set displaced-stepping off
33657 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33658 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33659
33660 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33661 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33662 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33663 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33664 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33665 @end table
33666
33667 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33668 @item maint check-psymtabs
33669 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33670 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33671
33672 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33673 @item maint check-symtabs
33674 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33675
33676 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33677 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33678 Expand symbol tables.
33679 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33680 names matching @var{regexp}.
33681
33682 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33683 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33684 @cindex demangler crashes
33685 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33686 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33687 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33688 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33689 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33690 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33691 option to terminate the current session.
33692
33693 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33694 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33695 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33696
33697 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33698 @item maint cplus namespace
33699 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33700
33701 @kindex maint deprecate
33702 @kindex maint undeprecate
33703 @cindex deprecated commands
33704 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33705 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33706 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33707 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33708 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33709 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33710 the replacement as part of the warning.
33711
33712 @kindex maint dump-me
33713 @item maint dump-me
33714 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33715 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33716 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33717 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33718
33719 @kindex maint internal-error
33720 @kindex maint internal-warning
33721 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33722 @cindex demangler crashes
33723 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33724 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33725 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33726
33727 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33728 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33729 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33730 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33731 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33732 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33733 @value{GDBN} session.
33734
33735 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33736 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33737
33738 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33739
33740 @smallexample
33741 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33742 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33743 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33744 debugging may prove unreliable.
33745 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33746 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33747 (@value{GDBP})
33748 @end smallexample
33749
33750 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33751 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33752 @cindex demangler crashes
33753
33754 @kindex maint set internal-error
33755 @kindex maint show internal-error
33756 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33757 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33758 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33759 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33760 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33761 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33762 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33763 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33764 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33765 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33766 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33767 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33768 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33769 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33770 described in the table below.
33771
33772 @table @samp
33773 @item quit
33774 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33775 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33776
33777 @item corefile
33778 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33779 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33780 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33781 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33782 disabled.
33783 @end table
33784
33785 @kindex maint packet
33786 @item maint packet @var{text}
33787 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33788 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33789 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33790 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33791 checksum.
33792
33793 @kindex maint print architecture
33794 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33795 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33796 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33797
33798 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33799 @item maint print c-tdesc
33800 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33801 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33802 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33803
33804 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33805 @item maint print dummy-frames
33806 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33807
33808 @smallexample
33809 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33810 @dots{}
33811 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33812 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33813 58 return (a + b);
33814 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33815 @dots{}
33816 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33817 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33818 (@value{GDBP})
33819 @end smallexample
33820
33821 Takes an optional file parameter.
33822
33823 @kindex maint print registers
33824 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33825 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33826 @kindex maint print register-groups
33827 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33828 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33829 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33830 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33831 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33832 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33833 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33834
33835 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33836 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33837 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33838 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33839 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33840 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33841 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33842 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33843
33844 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33845 write the information.
33846
33847 @kindex maint print reggroups
33848 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33849 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33850 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33851 information.
33852
33853 The register groups info looks like this:
33854
33855 @smallexample
33856 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33857 Group Type
33858 general user
33859 float user
33860 all user
33861 vector user
33862 system user
33863 save internal
33864 restore internal
33865 @end smallexample
33866
33867 @kindex flushregs
33868 @item flushregs
33869 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33870
33871 @kindex maint print objfiles
33872 @cindex info for known object files
33873 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33874 Print a dump of all known object files.
33875 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33876 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33877 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33878
33879 @kindex maint print user-registers
33880 @cindex user registers
33881 @item maint print user-registers
33882 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
33883 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
33884 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
33885 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
33886 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
33887 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
33888 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
33889
33890 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33891 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33892 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33893 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33894 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33895 matching @var{regexp}.
33896 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33897 and the full path if known.
33898 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33899
33900 @kindex maint print statistics
33901 @cindex bcache statistics
33902 @item maint print statistics
33903 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33904 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33905 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33906 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33907 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33908 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33909 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33910 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33911 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33912 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33913 lengths.
33914
33915 @kindex maint print target-stack
33916 @cindex target stack description
33917 @item maint print target-stack
33918 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33919 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33920 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33921 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33922 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33923 address.
33924
33925 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33926 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33927
33928 @kindex maint print type
33929 @cindex type chain of a data type
33930 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33931 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33932 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33933 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33934 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33935 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33936
33937 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33938 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33939 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33940 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33941 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33942 information.
33943
33944 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33945 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33946 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33947 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33948 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33949 always see the disassembly form.
33950
33951 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33952
33953 @smallexample
33954 (gdb) info addr argc
33955 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33956 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33957 @end smallexample
33958
33959 For more information on these expressions, see
33960 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33961
33962 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33963 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33964 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33965 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33966 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33967
33968 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33969 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33970 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33971 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33972 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33973 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33974 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33975 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33976 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33977
33978 @kindex maint set profile
33979 @kindex maint show profile
33980 @cindex profiling GDB
33981 @item maint set profile
33982 @itemx maint show profile
33983 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33984
33985 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33986 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33987 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33988 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33989 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33990 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33991 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33992
33993 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33994 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33995
33996 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33997 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33998 @cindex hardware debug registers
33999 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34000 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34001 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34002 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34003 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34004 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34005 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34006
34007 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34008 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34009 @item maint set show-all-tib
34010 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34011 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34012 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34013 command.
34014
34015 @kindex maint set target-async
34016 @kindex maint show target-async
34017 @item maint set target-async
34018 @itemx maint show target-async
34019 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34020 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34021 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34022 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34023
34024 @kindex maint set per-command
34025 @kindex maint show per-command
34026 @item maint set per-command
34027 @itemx maint show per-command
34028 @cindex resources used by commands
34029
34030 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34031 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34032
34033 @table @code
34034 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34035 @itemx maint show per-command space
34036 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34037 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34038 took, following the command's own output.
34039 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34040 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34041
34042 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34043 @itemx maint show per-command time
34044 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34045 for each command.
34046 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34047 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34048 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34049 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34050 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34051 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34052 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34053 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34054 spent by the program been debugged.
34055 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34056 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34057
34058 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34059 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34060 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34061 for each command.
34062 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34063
34064 @enumerate a
34065 @item
34066 number of symbol tables
34067 @item
34068 number of primary symbol tables
34069 @item
34070 number of blocks in the blockvector
34071 @end enumerate
34072 @end table
34073
34074 @kindex maint space
34075 @cindex memory used by commands
34076 @item maint space @var{value}
34077 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34078 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34079
34080 @kindex maint time
34081 @cindex time of command execution
34082 @item maint time @var{value}
34083 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34084 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34085
34086 @kindex maint translate-address
34087 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34088 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34089 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34090 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34091 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34092 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34093 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34094
34095 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34096 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34097 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34098
34099 @end table
34100
34101 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34102 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34103
34104 @table @code
34105 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34106 @kindex set watchdog
34107 @cindex watchdog timer
34108 @cindex timeout for commands
34109 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34110 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34111 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34112
34113 @item show watchdog
34114 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34115 @end table
34116
34117 @node Remote Protocol
34118 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34119
34120 @menu
34121 * Overview::
34122 * Packets::
34123 * Stop Reply Packets::
34124 * General Query Packets::
34125 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34126 * Tracepoint Packets::
34127 * Host I/O Packets::
34128 * Interrupts::
34129 * Notification Packets::
34130 * Remote Non-Stop::
34131 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34132 * Examples::
34133 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34134 * Library List Format::
34135 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34136 * Memory Map Format::
34137 * Thread List Format::
34138 * Traceframe Info Format::
34139 * Branch Trace Format::
34140 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34141 @end menu
34142
34143 @node Overview
34144 @section Overview
34145
34146 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34147 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34148 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34149 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34150
34151 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34152 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34153
34154 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34155 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34156 @cindex remote serial protocol
34157 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34158 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34159 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34160 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34161 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34162
34163 @smallexample
34164 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34165 @end smallexample
34166 @noindent
34167
34168 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34169 @noindent
34170 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34171 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34172 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34173
34174 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34175 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34176
34177 @smallexample
34178 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34179 @end smallexample
34180
34181 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34182 @noindent
34183 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34184 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34185 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34186
34187 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34188 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34189 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34190 retransmission):
34191
34192 @smallexample
34193 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34194 <- @code{+}
34195 @end smallexample
34196 @noindent
34197
34198 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34199 once a connection is established.
34200 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34201
34202 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34203 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34204 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34205 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34206 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34207 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34208 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34209
34210 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34211 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34212 exceptions).
34213
34214 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34215 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34216 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34217 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34218
34219 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34220 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34221 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34222
34223 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34224 @anchor{Binary Data}
34225 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34226 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34227 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34228 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34229 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34230 binary data.
34231
34232 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34233 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34234 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34235 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34236 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34237 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34238 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34239 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34240 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34241 (described next).
34242
34243 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34244 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34245 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34246 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34247 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34248 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34249 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34250 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34251 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34252 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34253 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34254 3}} more times.
34255
34256 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34257 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34258 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34259 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34260 @samp{0*"00}.
34261
34262 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34263 error number. That number is not well defined.
34264
34265 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34266 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34267 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34268 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34269 on that response.
34270
34271 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34272 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34273 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34274 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34275 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34276 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34277
34278 @node Packets
34279 @section Packets
34280
34281 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34282 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34283 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34284 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34285
34286 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34287 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34288 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34289 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34290 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34291 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34292 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34293 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34294 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34295 @var{baz}.
34296
34297 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34298 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34299 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34300 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34301 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34302 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34303 pick any thread.
34304
34305 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34306 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34307 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34308 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34309 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34310 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34311 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34312 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34313 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34314 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34315 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34316 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34317 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34318
34319 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34320 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34321 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34322 more information.
34323
34324 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34325 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34326
34327 Here are the packet descriptions.
34328
34329 @table @samp
34330
34331 @item !
34332 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34333 @anchor{extended mode}
34334 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34335 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34336 debugged.
34337
34338 Reply:
34339 @table @samp
34340 @item OK
34341 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34342 @end table
34343
34344 @item ?
34345 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34346 @anchor{? packet}
34347 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34348 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34349 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34350
34351 Reply:
34352 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34353
34354 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34355 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34356 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34357 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34358 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34359
34360 Reply:
34361 @table @samp
34362 @item OK
34363 The arguments were set.
34364 @item E @var{NN}
34365 An error occurred.
34366 @end table
34367
34368 @item b @var{baud}
34369 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34370 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34371 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34372
34373 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34374 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34375 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34376
34377 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34378 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34379 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34380 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34381 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34382
34383 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34384 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34385 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34386 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34387
34388 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34389 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34390
34391 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34392 @anchor{bc}
34393 @item bc
34394 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34395 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34396
34397 Reply:
34398 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34399
34400 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34401 @anchor{bs}
34402 @item bs
34403 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34404 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34405
34406 Reply:
34407 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34408
34409 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34410 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34411 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34412 is omitted, resume at current address.
34413
34414 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34415 packet}.
34416
34417 Reply:
34418 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34419
34420 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34421 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34422 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34423 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34424
34425 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34426 packet}.
34427
34428 Reply:
34429 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34430
34431 @item d
34432 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34433 Toggle debug flag.
34434
34435 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34436 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34437
34438 @item D
34439 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34440 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34441 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34442 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34443 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34444
34445 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34446 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34447 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34448 big-endian hex string.
34449
34450 Reply:
34451 @table @samp
34452 @item OK
34453 for success
34454 @item E @var{NN}
34455 for an error
34456 @end table
34457
34458 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34459 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34460 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34461 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34462 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34463
34464 @item g
34465 @anchor{read registers packet}
34466 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34467 Read general registers.
34468
34469 Reply:
34470 @table @samp
34471 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34472 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34473 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34474 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34475 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34476 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34477 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34478
34479 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34480 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34481 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34482 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34483 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34484 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34485 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34486 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34487
34488 @smallexample
34489 -> @code{g}
34490 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34491 @end smallexample
34492
34493 @item E @var{NN}
34494 for an error.
34495 @end table
34496
34497 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34498 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34499 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34500 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34501
34502 Reply:
34503 @table @samp
34504 @item OK
34505 for success
34506 @item E @var{NN}
34507 for an error
34508 @end table
34509
34510 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34511 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34512 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34513 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34514 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34515 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34516 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34517 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34518 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34519
34520 Reply:
34521 @table @samp
34522 @item OK
34523 for success
34524 @item E @var{NN}
34525 for an error
34526 @end table
34527
34528 @c FIXME: JTC:
34529 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34530 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34531 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34532 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34533 @c described. For example:
34534 @c
34535 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34536 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34537 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34538 @c
34539 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34540 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34541 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34542
34543 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34544 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34545 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34546 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34547 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34548 step starting at that address.
34549
34550 @item I
34551 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34552 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34553 step packet}.
34554
34555 @item k
34556 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34557 Kill request.
34558
34559 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34560
34561 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34562 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34563
34564 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34565
34566 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34567 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34568 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34569
34570 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34571 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34572 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34573
34574 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34575 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34576 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34577 (@pxref{? packet}).
34578
34579 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34580 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34581 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34582 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34583
34584 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34585 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34586 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34587 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34588 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34589 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34590 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34591 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34592
34593 Reply:
34594 @table @samp
34595 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34596 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34597 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34598 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34599 @item E @var{NN}
34600 @var{NN} is errno
34601 @end table
34602
34603 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34604 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34605 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34606 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34607 hexadecimal number.
34608
34609 Reply:
34610 @table @samp
34611 @item OK
34612 for success
34613 @item E @var{NN}
34614 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34615 written).
34616 @end table
34617
34618 @item p @var{n}
34619 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34620 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34621 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34622 register value is encoded.
34623
34624 Reply:
34625 @table @samp
34626 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34627 the register's value
34628 @item E @var{NN}
34629 for an error
34630 @item @w{}
34631 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34632 @end table
34633
34634 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34635 @anchor{write register packet}
34636 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34637 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34638 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34639 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34640
34641 Reply:
34642 @table @samp
34643 @item OK
34644 for success
34645 @item E @var{NN}
34646 for an error
34647 @end table
34648
34649 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34650 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34651 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34652 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34653 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34654 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34655
34656 @item r
34657 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34658 Reset the entire system.
34659
34660 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34661
34662 @item R @var{XX}
34663 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34664 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34665 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34666
34667 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34668
34669 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34670 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34671 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34672 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34673
34674 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34675 packet}.
34676
34677 Reply:
34678 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34679
34680 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34681 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34682 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34683 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34684 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34685
34686 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34687 packet}.
34688
34689 Reply:
34690 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34691
34692 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34693 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34694 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34695 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34696 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34697
34698 @item T @var{thread-id}
34699 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34700 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34701
34702 Reply:
34703 @table @samp
34704 @item OK
34705 thread is still alive
34706 @item E @var{NN}
34707 thread is dead
34708 @end table
34709
34710 @item v
34711 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34712 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34713
34714 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34715 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34716 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34717 The process ID is a
34718 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34719 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34720 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34721
34722 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34723 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34724 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34725 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34726 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34727 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34728 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34729 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34730
34731 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34732
34733 Reply:
34734 @table @samp
34735 @item E @var{nn}
34736 for an error
34737 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34738 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34739 @item OK
34740 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34741 @end table
34742
34743 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34744 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34745 @anchor{vCont packet}
34746 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34747 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34748 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34749 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34750 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34751 Specifying multiple
34752 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34753 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34754
34755 Currently supported actions are:
34756
34757 @table @samp
34758 @item c
34759 Continue.
34760 @item C @var{sig}
34761 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34762 @item s
34763 Step.
34764 @item S @var{sig}
34765 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34766 @item t
34767 Stop.
34768 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34769 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34770 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34771 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34772 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34773 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34774
34775 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34776 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34777 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34778 jumps to @var{start}).
34779
34780 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34781 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34782 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34783
34784 @end table
34785
34786 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34787 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34788 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34789
34790 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34791 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34792 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34793 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34794 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34795 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34796 as an implementation detail.
34797
34798 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34799 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34800 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34801 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34802 @var{thread-id}.
34803
34804 Reply:
34805 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34806
34807 @item vCont?
34808 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34809 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34810
34811 Reply:
34812 @table @samp
34813 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34814 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34815 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34816 @item @w{}
34817 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34818 @end table
34819
34820 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34821 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34822 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34823 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34824
34825 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34826 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34827 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34828 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34829 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34830 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34831 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34832 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34833 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34834 packet is received.
34835
34836 Reply:
34837 @table @samp
34838 @item OK
34839 for success
34840 @item E @var{NN}
34841 for an error
34842 @end table
34843
34844 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34845 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34846 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34847 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34848 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34849 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34850 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34851 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34852 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34853 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34854 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34855 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34856
34857
34858 Reply:
34859 @table @samp
34860 @item OK
34861 for success
34862 @item E.memtype
34863 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34864 @item E @var{NN}
34865 for an error
34866 @end table
34867
34868 @item vFlashDone
34869 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34870 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34871 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34872 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34873 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34874 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34875 request is completed.
34876
34877 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34878 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34879 @anchor{vKill packet}
34880 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34881 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34882 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34883 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34884
34885 Reply:
34886 @table @samp
34887 @item E @var{nn}
34888 for an error
34889 @item OK
34890 for success
34891 @end table
34892
34893 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34894 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34895 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34896 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34897 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34898 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34899 state.
34900
34901 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34902
34903 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34904
34905 Reply:
34906 @table @samp
34907 @item E @var{nn}
34908 for an error
34909 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34910 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34911 @end table
34912
34913 @item vStopped
34914 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34915 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34916
34917 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34918 @anchor{X packet}
34919 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34920 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34921 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34922 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34923
34924 Reply:
34925 @table @samp
34926 @item OK
34927 for success
34928 @item E @var{NN}
34929 for an error
34930 @end table
34931
34932 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34933 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34934 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34935 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34936 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34937 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34938 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34939
34940 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34941 separately.
34942
34943 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34944 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34945 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34946 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34947 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34948 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34949
34950 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34951 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34952 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34953 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34954 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34955 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34956
34957 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34958 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34959 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34960 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34961 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34962 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34963 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34964 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34965 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34966 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34967
34968 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34969 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34970
34971 @table @samp
34972
34973 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34974 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34975 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34976
34977 @end table
34978
34979 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34980 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34981 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34982 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34983 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34984 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34985 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34986
34987 @table @samp
34988
34989 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34990 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34991 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34992
34993 @end table
34994
34995 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34996
34997 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34998 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34999 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35000 target, is not defined.}
35001
35002 Reply:
35003 @table @samp
35004 @item OK
35005 success
35006 @item @w{}
35007 not supported
35008 @item E @var{NN}
35009 for an error
35010 @end table
35011
35012 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35013 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35014 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35015 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35016 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35017 address @var{addr}.
35018
35019 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35020 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35021 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35022
35023 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35024 movement.}
35025
35026 Reply:
35027 @table @samp
35028 @item OK
35029 success
35030 @item @w{}
35031 not supported
35032 @item E @var{NN}
35033 for an error
35034 @end table
35035
35036 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35037 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35038 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35039 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35040 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35041 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35042
35043 Reply:
35044 @table @samp
35045 @item OK
35046 success
35047 @item @w{}
35048 not supported
35049 @item E @var{NN}
35050 for an error
35051 @end table
35052
35053 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35054 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35055 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35056 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35057 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35058 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35059
35060 Reply:
35061 @table @samp
35062 @item OK
35063 success
35064 @item @w{}
35065 not supported
35066 @item E @var{NN}
35067 for an error
35068 @end table
35069
35070 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35071 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35072 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35073 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35074 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35075 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35076
35077 Reply:
35078 @table @samp
35079 @item OK
35080 success
35081 @item @w{}
35082 not supported
35083 @item E @var{NN}
35084 for an error
35085 @end table
35086
35087 @end table
35088
35089 @node Stop Reply Packets
35090 @section Stop Reply Packets
35091 @cindex stop reply packets
35092
35093 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35094 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35095 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35096 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35097 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35098 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35099 @value{GDBN} source code.
35100
35101 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35102 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35103 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35104 components.
35105
35106 @table @samp
35107
35108 @item S @var{AA}
35109 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35110 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35111 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35112
35113 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35114 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35115 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35116 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35117 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35118 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35119 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35120 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35121
35122 @itemize @bullet
35123 @item
35124 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35125 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35126 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35127 two-digit hex number.
35128
35129 @item
35130 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35131 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35132
35133 @item
35134 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35135 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35136
35137 @item
35138 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35139 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35140 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35141 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35142
35143 @item
35144 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35145 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35146 future.
35147 @end itemize
35148
35149 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35150
35151 @table @samp
35152 @item watch
35153 @itemx rwatch
35154 @itemx awatch
35155 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35156 hex.
35157
35158 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35159 @item library
35160 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35161 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35162 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35163
35164 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35165 @item replaylog
35166 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35167 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35168 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35169 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35170 for more information.
35171 @end table
35172
35173 @item W @var{AA}
35174 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35175 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35176 applicable to certain targets.
35177
35178 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35179 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35180 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35181 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35182
35183 @item X @var{AA}
35184 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35185 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35186
35187 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35188 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35189 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35190 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35191
35192 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35193 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35194 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35195 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35196 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35197
35198 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35199 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35200 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35201 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35202 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35203 system calls.
35204
35205 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35206 this very system call.
35207
35208 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35209 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35210 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35211 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35212 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35213 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35214
35215 @end table
35216
35217 @node General Query Packets
35218 @section General Query Packets
35219 @cindex remote query requests
35220
35221 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35222 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35223 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35224 sending information to and from the stub.
35225
35226 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35227 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35228 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35229 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35230 conventions:
35231
35232 @itemize @bullet
35233 @item
35234 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35235 @item
35236 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35237 letter.
35238 @item
35239 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35240 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35241 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35242 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35243 @end itemize
35244
35245 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35246 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35247 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35248 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35249 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35250 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35251 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35252 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35253 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35254 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35255 packet.}.
35256
35257 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35258 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35259 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35260 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35261 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35262
35263 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35264
35265 @table @samp
35266
35267 @item QAgent:1
35268 @itemx QAgent:0
35269 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35270 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35271
35272 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35273 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35274 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35275 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35276 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35277 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35278 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35279 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35280 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35281 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35282 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35283
35284 @item qC
35285 @cindex current thread, remote request
35286 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35287 Return the current thread ID.
35288
35289 Reply:
35290 @table @samp
35291 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35292 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35293 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35294 @item @r{(anything else)}
35295 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35296 @end table
35297
35298 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35299 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35300 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35301 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35302 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35303 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35304 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35305 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35306
35307 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35308 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35309 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35310 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35311 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35312 detect trailing zeros.
35313
35314 Reply:
35315 @table @samp
35316 @item E @var{NN}
35317 An error (such as memory fault)
35318 @item C @var{crc32}
35319 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35320 @end table
35321
35322 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35323 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35324 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35325 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35326 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35327 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35328 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35329 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35330 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35331 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35332 randomization.
35333
35334 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35335
35336 Reply:
35337 @table @samp
35338 @item OK
35339 The request succeeded.
35340
35341 @item E @var{nn}
35342 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35343
35344 @item @w{}
35345 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35346 by the stub.
35347 @end table
35348
35349 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35350 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35351 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35352 address space randomization.
35353
35354 @item qfThreadInfo
35355 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35356 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35357 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35358 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35359 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35360 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35361 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35362 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35363 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35364 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35365
35366 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35367
35368 Reply:
35369 @table @samp
35370 @item m @var{thread-id}
35371 A single thread ID
35372 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35373 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35374 @item l
35375 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35376 @end table
35377
35378 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35379 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35380 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35381 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35382 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35383 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35384 fields.
35385
35386 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35387 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35388 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35389 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35390 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35391
35392 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35393 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35394 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35395 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35396 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35397
35398 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35399 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35400
35401 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35402 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35403 information associated with the variable.)
35404
35405 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35406 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35407 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35408 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35409 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35410 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35411
35412 Reply:
35413 @table @samp
35414 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35415 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35416 local storage requested.
35417
35418 @item E @var{nn}
35419 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35420
35421 @item @w{}
35422 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35423 @end table
35424
35425 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35426 @cindex get thread information block address
35427 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35428 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35429
35430 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35431
35432 Reply:
35433 @table @samp
35434 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35435 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35436 thread information block.
35437
35438 @item E @var{nn}
35439 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35440 address could not be retrieved.
35441
35442 @item @w{}
35443 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35444 @end table
35445
35446 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35447 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35448 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35449 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35450 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35451 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35452 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35453
35454 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35455
35456 Reply:
35457 @table @samp
35458 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35459 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35460 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35461 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35462 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35463 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35464 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35465 @end table
35466
35467 @item qOffsets
35468 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35469 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35470 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35471 image.
35472
35473 Reply:
35474 @table @samp
35475 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35476 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35477 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35478 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35479 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35480 segments by the supplied offsets.
35481
35482 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35483 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35484 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35485
35486 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35487 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35488 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35489 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35490 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35491 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35492 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35493 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35494 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35495 @end table
35496
35497 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35498 @cindex thread information, remote request
35499 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35500 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35501 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35502 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35503
35504 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35505 (see below).
35506
35507 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35508
35509 @item QNonStop:1
35510 @itemx QNonStop:0
35511 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35512 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35513 @anchor{QNonStop}
35514 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35515 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35516
35517 Reply:
35518 @table @samp
35519 @item OK
35520 The request succeeded.
35521
35522 @item E @var{nn}
35523 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35524
35525 @item @w{}
35526 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35527 the stub.
35528 @end table
35529
35530 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35531 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35532 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35533 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35534
35535 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35536 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35537 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35538 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35539 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35540 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35541 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35542 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35543 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35544 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35545 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35546 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35547 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35548
35549 Reply:
35550 @table @samp
35551 @item OK
35552 The request succeeded.
35553
35554 @item E @var{nn}
35555 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35556
35557 @item @w{}
35558 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35559 the stub.
35560 @end table
35561
35562 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35563 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35564 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35565 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35566
35567 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35568 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35569 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35570 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35571 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35572 Others should be silently discarded.
35573
35574 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35575 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35576 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35577 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35578 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35579 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35580 signals.
35581
35582 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35583 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35584
35585 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35586 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35587 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35588 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35589 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35590
35591 Reply:
35592 @table @samp
35593 @item OK
35594 The request succeeded.
35595
35596 @item E @var{nn}
35597 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35598
35599 @item @w{}
35600 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35601 by the stub.
35602 @end table
35603
35604 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35605 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35606 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35607 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35608
35609 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35610 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35611 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35612 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35613 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35614 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35615 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35616 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35617 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35618
35619 Reply:
35620 @table @samp
35621 @item OK
35622 A command response with no output.
35623 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35624 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35625 @item E @var{NN}
35626 Indicate a badly formed request.
35627 @item @w{}
35628 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35629 @end table
35630
35631 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35632 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35633 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35634 packets.)
35635
35636 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35637 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35638 @ifnotinfo
35639 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35640 @end ifnotinfo
35641 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35642 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35643 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35644 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35645 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35646
35647 Reply:
35648 @table @samp
35649 @item 0
35650 The pattern was not found.
35651 @item 1,address
35652 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35653 @item E @var{NN}
35654 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35655 @item @w{}
35656 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35657 @end table
35658
35659 @item QStartNoAckMode
35660 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35661 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35662 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35663 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35664
35665 Reply:
35666 @table @samp
35667 @item OK
35668 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35669 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35670 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35671 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35672 @item @w{}
35673 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35674 @end table
35675
35676 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35677 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35678 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35679 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35680 @anchor{qSupported}
35681 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35682 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35683 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35684 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35685 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35686 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35687 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35688 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35689 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35690 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35691 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35692 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35693 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35694 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35695
35696 Reply:
35697 @table @samp
35698 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35699 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35700 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35701 possible forms).
35702 @item @w{}
35703 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35704 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35705 @end table
35706
35707 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35708 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35709 are:
35710
35711 @table @samp
35712 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35713 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35714 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35715 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35716 @item @var{name}+
35717 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35718 need an associated value.
35719 @item @var{name}-
35720 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35721 @item @var{name}?
35722 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35723 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35724 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35725 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35726 @end table
35727
35728 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35729 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35730 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35731 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35732 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35733
35734 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35735 are defined:
35736
35737 @table @samp
35738 @item multiprocess
35739 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35740 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35741 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35742 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35743 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35744
35745 @item xmlRegisters
35746 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35747 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35748 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35749 description.
35750
35751 @item qRelocInsn
35752 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35753 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35754 instruction reply packet}).
35755 @end table
35756
35757 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35758 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35759 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35760 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35761 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35762 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35763 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35764 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35765 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35766 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35767 all the features it supports.
35768
35769 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35770 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35771
35772 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35773 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35774 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35775 form response.
35776
35777 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35778 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35779 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35780 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35781
35782 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35783 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35784 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35785 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35786 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35787
35788 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35789
35790 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35791 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35792 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35793 @item Feature Name
35794 @tab Value Required
35795 @tab Default
35796 @tab Probe Allowed
35797
35798 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35799 @tab Yes
35800 @tab @samp{-}
35801 @tab No
35802
35803 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35804 @tab No
35805 @tab @samp{-}
35806 @tab Yes
35807
35808 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35809 @tab No
35810 @tab @samp{-}
35811 @tab Yes
35812
35813 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
35814 @tab No
35815 @tab @samp{-}
35816 @tab Yes
35817
35818 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35819 @tab No
35820 @tab @samp{-}
35821 @tab Yes
35822
35823 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35824 @tab No
35825 @tab @samp{-}
35826 @tab Yes
35827
35828 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35829 @tab No
35830 @tab @samp{-}
35831 @tab Yes
35832
35833 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35834 @tab No
35835 @tab @samp{-}
35836 @tab No
35837
35838 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35839 @tab No
35840 @tab @samp{-}
35841 @tab Yes
35842
35843 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35844 @tab No
35845 @tab @samp{-}
35846 @tab Yes
35847
35848 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35849 @tab No
35850 @tab @samp{-}
35851 @tab Yes
35852
35853 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35854 @tab No
35855 @tab @samp{-}
35856 @tab Yes
35857
35858 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35859 @tab No
35860 @tab @samp{-}
35861 @tab Yes
35862
35863 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35864 @tab No
35865 @tab @samp{-}
35866 @tab Yes
35867
35868 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35869 @tab No
35870 @tab @samp{-}
35871 @tab Yes
35872
35873 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35874 @tab No
35875 @tab @samp{-}
35876 @tab Yes
35877
35878 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35879 @tab No
35880 @tab @samp{-}
35881 @tab Yes
35882
35883 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35884 @tab No
35885 @tab @samp{-}
35886 @tab Yes
35887
35888 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35889 @tab Yes
35890 @tab @samp{-}
35891 @tab Yes
35892
35893 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35894 @tab Yes
35895 @tab @samp{-}
35896 @tab Yes
35897
35898 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
35899 @tab Yes
35900 @tab @samp{-}
35901 @tab Yes
35902
35903 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35904 @tab No
35905 @tab @samp{-}
35906 @tab Yes
35907
35908 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35909 @tab No
35910 @tab @samp{-}
35911 @tab Yes
35912
35913 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35914 @tab No
35915 @tab @samp{-}
35916 @tab Yes
35917
35918 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35919 @tab No
35920 @tab @samp{-}
35921 @tab No
35922
35923 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35924 @tab No
35925 @tab @samp{-}
35926 @tab No
35927
35928 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35929 @tab No
35930 @tab @samp{-}
35931 @tab No
35932
35933 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35934 @tab No
35935 @tab @samp{-}
35936 @tab No
35937
35938 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35939 @tab No
35940 @tab @samp{-}
35941 @tab No
35942
35943 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35944 @tab No
35945 @tab @samp{-}
35946 @tab No
35947
35948 @item @samp{QAgent}
35949 @tab No
35950 @tab @samp{-}
35951 @tab No
35952
35953 @item @samp{QAllow}
35954 @tab No
35955 @tab @samp{-}
35956 @tab No
35957
35958 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35959 @tab No
35960 @tab @samp{-}
35961 @tab No
35962
35963 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35964 @tab No
35965 @tab @samp{-}
35966 @tab No
35967
35968 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35969 @tab No
35970 @tab @samp{-}
35971 @tab No
35972
35973 @item @samp{tracenz}
35974 @tab No
35975 @tab @samp{-}
35976 @tab No
35977
35978 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35979 @tab No
35980 @tab @samp{-}
35981 @tab No
35982
35983 @end multitable
35984
35985 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35986
35987 @table @samp
35988 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35989 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35990 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35991 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35992 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35993 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35994 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35995 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35996 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35997 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35998
35999 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36000 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36001 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36002
36003 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36004 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36005 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36006
36007 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36008 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36009 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36010
36011 @item qXfer:features:read
36012 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36013 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36014
36015 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36016 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36017 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36018
36019 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36020 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36021 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36022
36023 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36024 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36025 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36026 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36027
36028 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36029 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36030 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36031
36032 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36033 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36034 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36035
36036 @item qXfer:spu:read
36037 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36038 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36039
36040 @item qXfer:spu:write
36041 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36042 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36043
36044 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36045 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36046 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36047
36048 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36049 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36050 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36051
36052 @item qXfer:threads:read
36053 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36054 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36055
36056 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36057 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36058 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36059
36060 @item qXfer:uib:read
36061 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36062 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36063
36064 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36065 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36066 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36067
36068 @item QNonStop
36069 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36070 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36071
36072 @item QPassSignals
36073 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36074 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36075
36076 @item QStartNoAckMode
36077 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36078 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36079
36080 @item multiprocess
36081 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36082 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36083 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36084 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36085 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36086 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36087 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36088 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36089 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36090 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36091 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36092
36093 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36094 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36095 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36096
36097 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36098 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36099 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36100 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36101
36102 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36103 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36104 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36105
36106 @item ReverseContinue
36107 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36108 (@pxref{bc}).
36109
36110 @item ReverseStep
36111 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36112 (@pxref{bs}).
36113
36114 @item TracepointSource
36115 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36116 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36117
36118 @item QAgent
36119 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36120
36121 @item QAllow
36122 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36123
36124 @item QDisableRandomization
36125 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36126
36127 @item StaticTracepoint
36128 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36129 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36130
36131 @item InstallInTrace
36132 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36133 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36134
36135 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36136 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36137 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36138 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36139
36140 @item QTBuffer:size
36141 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36142 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36143
36144 @item tracenz
36145 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36146 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36147 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36148
36149 @item BreakpointCommands
36150 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36151 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36152 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36153
36154 @item Qbtrace:off
36155 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36156
36157 @item Qbtrace:bts
36158 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36159
36160 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36161 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36162
36163 @end table
36164
36165 @item qSymbol::
36166 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36167 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36168 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36169 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36170
36171 Reply:
36172 @table @samp
36173 @item OK
36174 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36175 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36176 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36177 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36178 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36179 below.
36180 @end table
36181
36182 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36183 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36184
36185 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36186 target has previously requested.
36187
36188 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36189 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36190 will be empty.
36191
36192 Reply:
36193 @table @samp
36194 @item OK
36195 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36196 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36197 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36198 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36199 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36200 @end table
36201
36202 @item qTBuffer
36203 @itemx QTBuffer
36204 @itemx QTDisconnected
36205 @itemx QTDP
36206 @itemx QTDPsrc
36207 @itemx QTDV
36208 @itemx qTfP
36209 @itemx qTfV
36210 @itemx QTFrame
36211 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36212
36213 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36214
36215 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36216 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36217 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36218 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36219 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36220 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36221 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36222 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36223 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36224 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36225 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36226
36227 Reply:
36228 @table @samp
36229 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36230 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36231 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36232 the thread's attributes.
36233 @end table
36234
36235 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36236 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36237 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36238 packets.)
36239
36240 @item QTNotes
36241 @itemx qTP
36242 @itemx QTSave
36243 @itemx qTsP
36244 @itemx qTsV
36245 @itemx QTStart
36246 @itemx QTStop
36247 @itemx QTEnable
36248 @itemx QTDisable
36249 @itemx QTinit
36250 @itemx QTro
36251 @itemx qTStatus
36252 @itemx qTV
36253 @itemx qTfSTM
36254 @itemx qTsSTM
36255 @itemx qTSTMat
36256 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36257
36258 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36259 @cindex read special object, remote request
36260 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36261 @anchor{qXfer read}
36262 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36263 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36264 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36265 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36266 additional details about what data to access.
36267
36268 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36269 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36270 formats, listed below.
36271
36272 @table @samp
36273 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36274 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36275 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36276 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36277
36278 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36279 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36280
36281 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36282 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36283
36284 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36285 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36286 packet may have one of the following values:
36287
36288 @table @code
36289 @item all
36290 Returns all available branch trace.
36291
36292 @item new
36293 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36294 the last read request.
36295
36296 @item delta
36297 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36298 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36299 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36300 used to stitch traces together.
36301
36302 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36303 @end table
36304
36305 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36306 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36307
36308 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36309 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36310
36311 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36312 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36313
36314 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36315 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36316
36317 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36318 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36319 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36320 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36321 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36322
36323 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36324 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36325
36326 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36327 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36328 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36329 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36330 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36331
36332 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36333 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36334 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36335
36336 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36337 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36338
36339 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36340 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36341 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36342 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36343 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36344 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36345 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36346 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36347
36348 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36349 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36350
36351 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36352 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36353
36354 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36355 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36356 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36357 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36358
36359 @table @code
36360 @item start=@var{address}
36361 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36362 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36363 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36364 chosen as the starting point.
36365
36366 @item prev=@var{address}
36367 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36368 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36369 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36370 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36371 exists prior to the starting point.
36372
36373 @end table
36374
36375 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36376 ignored.
36377
36378 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36379 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36380 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36381 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36382 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36383
36384 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36385 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36386
36387 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36388 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36389
36390 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36391 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36392 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36393 Action Lists}.
36394
36395 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36396 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36397 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36398
36399 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36400 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36401 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36402 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36403 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36404
36405 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36406 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36407 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36408
36409 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36410 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36411 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36412 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36413 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36414 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36415 in that context to be accessed.
36416
36417 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36418 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36419 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36420
36421 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36422 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36423 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36424 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36425 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36426
36427 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36428 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36429
36430 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36431 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36432
36433 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36434 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36435 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36436
36437 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36438 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36439
36440 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36441 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36442
36443 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36444 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36445
36446 This packet is not probed by default.
36447
36448 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36449 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36450 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36451 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36452 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36453
36454 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36455 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36456
36457 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36458 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36459 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36460 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36461
36462 @end table
36463
36464 Reply:
36465 @table @samp
36466 @item m @var{data}
36467 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36468 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36469 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36470 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36471 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36472 request.
36473
36474 @item l @var{data}
36475 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36476 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36477 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36478
36479 @item l
36480 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36481 There is no more data to be read.
36482
36483 @item E00
36484 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36485
36486 @item E @var{nn}
36487 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36488 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36489
36490 @item @w{}
36491 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36492 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36493 @end table
36494
36495 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36496 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36497 @anchor{qXfer write}
36498 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36499 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36500 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36501 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36502 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36503 to access.
36504
36505 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36506 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36507 formats, listed below.
36508
36509 @table @samp
36510 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36511 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36512 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36513 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36514 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36515
36516 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36517 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36518 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36519
36520 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36521 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36522 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36523 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36524 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36525 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36526 in that context to be accessed.
36527
36528 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36529 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36530 @end table
36531
36532 Reply:
36533 @table @samp
36534 @item @var{nn}
36535 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36536 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36537
36538 @item E00
36539 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36540
36541 @item E @var{nn}
36542 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36543 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36544
36545 @item @w{}
36546 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36547 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36548 @end table
36549
36550 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36551 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36552 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36553 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36554 must respond with an empty packet.
36555
36556 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36557 @cindex query attached, remote request
36558 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36559 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36560 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36561 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36562 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36563 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36564 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36565
36566 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36567 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36568 the @code{quit} command.
36569
36570 Reply:
36571 @table @samp
36572 @item 1
36573 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36574 @item 0
36575 The remote server created a new process.
36576 @item E @var{NN}
36577 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36578 @end table
36579
36580 @item Qbtrace:bts
36581 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36582
36583 Reply:
36584 @table @samp
36585 @item OK
36586 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36587 @item E.errtext
36588 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36589 @end table
36590
36591 @item Qbtrace:off
36592 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36593
36594 Reply:
36595 @table @samp
36596 @item OK
36597 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36598 @item E.errtext
36599 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36600 @end table
36601
36602 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
36603 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
36604 btrace recording method in bts format.
36605
36606 Reply:
36607 @table @samp
36608 @item OK
36609 The ring buffer size has been set.
36610 @item E.errtext
36611 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36612 @end table
36613
36614 @end table
36615
36616 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36617 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36618
36619 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36620 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36621 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36622
36623 @menu
36624 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36625 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36626 @end menu
36627
36628 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36629 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36630
36631 @menu
36632 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36633 @end menu
36634
36635 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36636 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36637 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36638
36639 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36640
36641 @table @r
36642
36643 @item 2
36644 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36645
36646 @item 3
36647 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36648
36649 @item 4
36650 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36651
36652 @end table
36653
36654 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36655 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36656
36657 @menu
36658 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36659 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36660 @end menu
36661
36662 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36663 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36664 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36665
36666 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36667 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36668 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36669 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36670 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36671 most-significant -- least-significant.
36672
36673 @table @r
36674
36675 @item MIPS32
36676 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36677 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36678 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36679
36680 @item MIPS64
36681 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36682 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36683 as @code{MIPS32}.
36684
36685 @end table
36686
36687 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36688 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36689 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36690
36691 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36692
36693 @table @r
36694
36695 @item 2
36696 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36697
36698 @item 3
36699 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36700
36701 @item 4
36702 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36703
36704 @item 5
36705 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36706
36707 @end table
36708
36709 @node Tracepoint Packets
36710 @section Tracepoint Packets
36711 @cindex tracepoint packets
36712 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36713
36714 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36715 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36716
36717 @table @samp
36718
36719 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36720 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36721 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36722 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36723 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36724 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36725 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36726 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36727 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36728 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36729 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36730 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36731 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36732 actions.
36733
36734 Replies:
36735 @table @samp
36736 @item OK
36737 The packet was understood and carried out.
36738 @item qRelocInsn
36739 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36740 @item @w{}
36741 The packet was not recognized.
36742 @end table
36743
36744 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36745 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36746 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36747 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36748 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36749 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36750 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36751
36752 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36753 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36754 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36755 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36756 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36757 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36758 tracepoint actions.
36759
36760 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36761 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36762 following forms:
36763
36764 @table @samp
36765
36766 @item R @var{mask}
36767 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36768 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36769 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36770 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36771 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36772
36773 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36774 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36775 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36776 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36777 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36778 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36779 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36780
36781 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36782 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36783 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36784 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36785 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36786 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36787 packet).
36788
36789 @end table
36790
36791 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36792 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36793 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36794 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36795 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36796 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36797 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36798 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36799
36800 Replies:
36801 @table @samp
36802 @item OK
36803 The packet was understood and carried out.
36804 @item qRelocInsn
36805 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36806 @item @w{}
36807 The packet was not recognized.
36808 @end table
36809
36810 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36811 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36812 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36813 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36814 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36815 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36816 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36817 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36818
36819 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36820 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36821 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36822 fit in a single packet.
36823 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36824 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36825
36826 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36827 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36828 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36829 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36830
36831 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36832 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36833 query packets.
36834
36835 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36836 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36837 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36838 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36839 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36840 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36841 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36842 be found.
36843
36844 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
36845 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36846 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36847 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36848 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36849 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36850 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36851 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36852 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
36853 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
36854 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
36855 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
36856 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
36857 variable.
36858
36859 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36860 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36861 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36862 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36863 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36864
36865 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36866 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36867 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36868 one of the following forms:
36869
36870 @table @samp
36871 @item F @var{f}
36872 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36873 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36874 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36875
36876 @item T @var{t}
36877 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36878 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36879
36880 @end table
36881
36882 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36883 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36884 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36885 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36886
36887 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36888 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36889 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36890 is a hexadecimal number.
36891
36892 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36893 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36894 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36895 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36896 numbers.
36897
36898 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36899 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36900 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36901
36902 @item qTMinFTPILen
36903 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36904 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36905 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36906 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36907 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36908 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36909 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36910 arrange for that.
36911
36912 Replies:
36913
36914 @table @samp
36915 @item 0
36916 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36917 @item @var{length}
36918 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36919 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36920 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36921 regardless of size.
36922 @item E
36923 An error has occurred.
36924 @item @w{}
36925 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36926 @end table
36927
36928 @item QTStart
36929 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36930 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36931 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36932 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36933 instruction reply packet}).
36934
36935 @item QTStop
36936 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36937 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36938
36939 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36940 @anchor{QTEnable}
36941 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36942 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36943 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36944 of data from it will resume.
36945
36946 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36947 @anchor{QTDisable}
36948 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36949 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36950 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36951 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36952
36953 @item QTinit
36954 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36955 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36956
36957 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36958 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36959 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36960 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36961 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36962
36963 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36964 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36965 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36966 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36967
36968 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36969 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36970 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36971 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36972 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36973 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36974
36975 @item qTStatus
36976 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36977 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36978
36979 The reply has the form:
36980
36981 @table @samp
36982
36983 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36984 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36985 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36986 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36987
36988 @end table
36989
36990 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36991 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36992
36993 @table @samp
36994
36995 @item tnotrun:0
36996 No trace has been run yet.
36997
36998 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36999 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37000 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37001 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37002 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37003
37004 @item tfull:0
37005 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37006
37007 @item tdisconnected:0
37008 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37009
37010 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37011 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37012
37013 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37014 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37015 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37016 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37017 is hex encoded.
37018
37019 @item tunknown:0
37020 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37021
37022 @end table
37023
37024 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37025 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37026 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37027 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37028 trace.
37029
37030 @table @samp
37031
37032 @item tframes:@var{n}
37033 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37034
37035 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37036 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37037 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37038
37039 @item tsize:@var{n}
37040 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37041
37042 @item tfree:@var{n}
37043 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37044
37045 @item circular:@var{n}
37046 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37047 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37048 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37049 and may fill up.
37050
37051 @item disconn:@var{n}
37052 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37053 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37054 that the trace run will stop.
37055
37056 @end table
37057
37058 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37059 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37060 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37061 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37062 address @var{addr}.
37063
37064 Replies:
37065 @table @samp
37066 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37067 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37068 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37069 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37070 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37071
37072 @end table
37073
37074 @item qTV:@var{var}
37075 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37076 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37077 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37078
37079 Replies:
37080 @table @samp
37081 @item V@var{value}
37082 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37083 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37084 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37085 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37086 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37087 program is running.
37088
37089 @item U
37090 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37091 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37092 was not collected.
37093 @end table
37094
37095 @item qTfP
37096 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37097 @itemx qTsP
37098 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37099 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37100 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37101 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37102 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37103 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37104
37105 @item qTfV
37106 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37107 @itemx qTsV
37108 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37109 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37110 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37111 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37112 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37113 trace state variables.
37114
37115 @item qTfSTM
37116 @itemx qTsSTM
37117 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37118 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37119 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37120 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37121 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37122 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37123 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37124 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37125
37126 Reply:
37127 @table @samp
37128 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37129 A single marker
37130 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37131 a comma-separated list of markers
37132 @item l
37133 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37134 @item E @var{nn}
37135 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37136 @item @w{}
37137 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37138 stub.
37139 @end table
37140
37141 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37142 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37143
37144 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37145 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37146 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37147 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37148 @dfn{last}).
37149
37150 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37151 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37152 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37153 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37154 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37155 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37156 tracepoint markers.
37157
37158 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37159 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37160 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37161 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37162 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37163 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37164
37165 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37166 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37167 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37168 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37169 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37170 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37171 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37172 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37173 available.
37174
37175 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37176 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37177 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37178
37179 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37180 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37181 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37182 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37183 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37184 use whatever size it prefers.
37185
37186 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37187 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37188 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37189 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37190 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37191
37192 @end table
37193
37194 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37195 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37196 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37197 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37198 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37199 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37200 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37201 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37202 it had executed in the original location.
37203
37204 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37205 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37206 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37207 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37208 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37209 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37210 format of the request is:
37211
37212 @table @samp
37213 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37214
37215 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37216 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37217 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37218 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37219 memory starting at @var{to}.
37220 @end table
37221
37222 Replies:
37223 @table @samp
37224 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37225 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37226 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37227 @item E @var{NN}
37228 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37229 relocating the instruction.
37230 @end table
37231
37232 @node Host I/O Packets
37233 @section Host I/O Packets
37234 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37235 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37236
37237 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37238 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37239 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37240 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37241 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37242 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37243 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37244 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37245 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37246 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37247
37248 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37249 its arguments. They have this format:
37250
37251 @table @samp
37252
37253 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37254 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37255 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37256 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37257 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37258 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37259 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37260 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37261 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37262
37263 @end table
37264
37265 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37266
37267 @table @samp
37268
37269 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37270 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37271 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37272 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37273 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37274 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37275 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37276 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37277 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37278 @var{attachment}.
37279
37280 @item @w{}
37281 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37282
37283 @end table
37284
37285 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37286
37287 @table @samp
37288 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37289 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37290 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37291 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37292 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37293 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37294 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37295
37296 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37297 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37298 -1 if an error occurs.
37299
37300 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37301 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37302 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37303 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37304 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37305 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37306 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37307 @var{count} was zero.
37308
37309 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37310 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37311 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37312 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37313 some characters were escaped.
37314
37315 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37316 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37317 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37318 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37319 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37320 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37321 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37322 error occurred.
37323
37324 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37325 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37326 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37327
37328 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37329 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37330 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37331
37332 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37333 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37334 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37335 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37336 some characters were escaped.
37337
37338 @end table
37339
37340 @node Interrupts
37341 @section Interrupts
37342 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37343
37344 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37345 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37346 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37347 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37348
37349 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37350 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37351 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37352 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37353 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37354
37355 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37356 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37357 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37358 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37359 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37360 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37361 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37362 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37363
37364 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37365 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37366 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37367
37368 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
37369 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
37370 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
37371 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
37372 currently-executing threads and processes.
37373 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
37374 running program, it should send one of the stop
37375 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
37376 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
37377 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
37378 Interrupts received while the
37379 program is stopped are discarded.
37380
37381 @node Notification Packets
37382 @section Notification Packets
37383 @cindex notification packets
37384 @cindex packets, notification
37385
37386 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
37387 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
37388 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
37389 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
37390 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
37391 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
37392 is not a problem.
37393
37394 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
37395 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
37396 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
37397 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
37398 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
37399 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
37400 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
37401
37402 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
37403 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
37404
37405 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
37406 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
37407 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
37408 not they understand it.
37409
37410 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
37411 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
37412 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
37413 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
37414 recipients.
37415
37416 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
37417 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
37418 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37419 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37420 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37421
37422 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37423 @table @samp
37424 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37425 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37426 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37427 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37428 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37429 @item @var{ack}
37430 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37431 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37432 @end table
37433
37434 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37435 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37436
37437 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37438 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37439 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37440 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37441 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37442 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37443 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37444 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37445 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37446 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37447
37448 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37449 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37450 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37451 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37452 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37453 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37454
37455 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37456 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37457 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37458 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37459 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37460
37461 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37462 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37463 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37464 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37465 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37466 normally.
37467
37468 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37469 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37470 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37471 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37472 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37473 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37474 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37475 the process shall be repeated.
37476
37477 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37478 following example:
37479 @smallexample
37480 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37481 @code{...}
37482 -> @code{vStopped}
37483 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37484 -> @code{vStopped}
37485 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37486 -> @code{vStopped}
37487 <- @code{OK}
37488 @end smallexample
37489
37490 The following notifications are defined:
37491 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37492
37493 @item Notification
37494 @tab Ack
37495 @tab Event
37496 @tab Description
37497
37498 @item Stop
37499 @tab vStopped
37500 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37501 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37502 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37503 @value{GDBN}.
37504 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37505
37506 @end multitable
37507
37508 @node Remote Non-Stop
37509 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37510
37511 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37512 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37513 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37514 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37515
37516 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37517 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37518 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37519 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37520 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37521 probe the target state after a mode change.
37522
37523 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37524 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37525 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37526 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37527 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37528 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37529 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37530 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37531 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37532 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37533 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37534
37535 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37536 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37537 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37538 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37539 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37540 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37541 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37542 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37543 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37544 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37545 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37546 @samp{OK}.
37547
37548 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37549 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37550
37551 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37552 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37553 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37554 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37555 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37556 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37557 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37558
37559 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37560 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37561 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37562 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37563 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37564
37565 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37566 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37567 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37568 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37569
37570 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37571 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37572 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37573 @pxref{qSupported}.
37574 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37575 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37576 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37577 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37578 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37579 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37580 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37581
37582 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37583 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37584 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37585 connection.
37586 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37587 new connection is established,
37588 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37589 for the current connection, once disabled.
37590
37591 @node Examples
37592 @section Examples
37593
37594 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37595 does not get any direct output:
37596
37597 @smallexample
37598 -> @code{R00}
37599 <- @code{+}
37600 @emph{target restarts}
37601 -> @code{?}
37602 <- @code{+}
37603 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37604 -> @code{+}
37605 @end smallexample
37606
37607 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37608
37609 @smallexample
37610 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37611 <- @code{+}
37612 -> @code{s}
37613 <- @code{+}
37614 @emph{time passes}
37615 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37616 -> @code{+}
37617 -> @code{g}
37618 <- @code{+}
37619 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37620 -> @code{+}
37621 @end smallexample
37622
37623 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37624 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37625 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37626
37627 @menu
37628 * File-I/O Overview::
37629 * Protocol Basics::
37630 * The F Request Packet::
37631 * The F Reply Packet::
37632 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37633 * Console I/O::
37634 * List of Supported Calls::
37635 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37636 * Constants::
37637 * File-I/O Examples::
37638 @end menu
37639
37640 @node File-I/O Overview
37641 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37642 @cindex file-i/o overview
37643
37644 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37645 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37646 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37647 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37648 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37649 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37650
37651 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37652 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37653 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37654 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37655 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37656
37657 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37658 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37659 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37660 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37661 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37662 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37663 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37664
37665 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37666 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37667 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37668 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37669 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37670
37671 @smallexample
37672 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37673 <- target requests 'system call X'
37674 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37675 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37676 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37677 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37678 @end smallexample
37679
37680 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37681 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37682 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37683 system are not supported by this protocol.
37684
37685 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37686
37687 @node Protocol Basics
37688 @subsection Protocol Basics
37689 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37690
37691 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37692 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37693 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37694 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37695 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37696 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37697 to call the appropriate host system call:
37698
37699 @itemize @bullet
37700 @item
37701 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37702
37703 @item
37704 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37705 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37706 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37707 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37708
37709 @end itemize
37710
37711 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37712
37713 @itemize @bullet
37714 @item
37715 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37716 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37717 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37718 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37719 packet.
37720
37721 @item
37722 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37723 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37724
37725 @item
37726 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37727
37728 @item
37729 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37730
37731 @item
37732 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37733 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37734 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37735 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37736 packet.
37737
37738 @end itemize
37739
37740 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37741 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37742
37743 @itemize @bullet
37744 @item
37745 Return value.
37746
37747 @item
37748 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37749
37750 @item
37751 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37752
37753 @end itemize
37754
37755 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37756 the latest continue or step action.
37757
37758 @node The F Request Packet
37759 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37760 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37761 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37762
37763 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37764
37765 @table @samp
37766 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37767
37768 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37769 This is just the name of the function.
37770
37771 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37772 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37773 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37774 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37775 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37776 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37777 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37778
37779 @end table
37780
37781
37782
37783 @node The F Reply Packet
37784 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37785 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37786 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37787
37788 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37789
37790 @table @samp
37791
37792 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37793
37794 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37795
37796 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37797 representation.
37798 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37799
37800 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37801 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37802 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37803
37804 @smallexample
37805 F0,0,C
37806 @end smallexample
37807
37808 @noindent
37809 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37810
37811 @smallexample
37812 F-1,4,C
37813 @end smallexample
37814
37815 @noindent
37816 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37817
37818 @end table
37819
37820
37821 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37822 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37823 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37824
37825 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37826 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37827 the target should behave as if it had
37828 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37829 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37830 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37831 packet.
37832
37833 It's important for the target to know in which
37834 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37835
37836 @itemize @bullet
37837 @item
37838 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37839
37840 @item
37841 The system call on the host has been finished.
37842
37843 @end itemize
37844
37845 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37846 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37847 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37848 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37849 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37850 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37851
37852 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37853 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37854 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37855 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37856 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37857 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37858 or the full action has been completed.
37859
37860 @node Console I/O
37861 @subsection Console I/O
37862 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37863
37864 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37865 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37866 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37867 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37868 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37869 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37870 conditions is met:
37871
37872 @itemize @bullet
37873 @item
37874 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37875 @code{read}
37876 system call is treated as finished.
37877
37878 @item
37879 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37880 newline.
37881
37882 @item
37883 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37884 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37885
37886 @end itemize
37887
37888 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37889 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37890 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37891 is stopped at the user's request.
37892
37893
37894 @node List of Supported Calls
37895 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37896 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37897
37898 @menu
37899 * open::
37900 * close::
37901 * read::
37902 * write::
37903 * lseek::
37904 * rename::
37905 * unlink::
37906 * stat/fstat::
37907 * gettimeofday::
37908 * isatty::
37909 * system::
37910 @end menu
37911
37912 @node open
37913 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37914 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37915
37916 @table @asis
37917 @item Synopsis:
37918 @smallexample
37919 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37920 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37921 @end smallexample
37922
37923 @item Request:
37924 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37925
37926 @noindent
37927 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37928
37929 @table @code
37930 @item O_CREAT
37931 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37932 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37933 are concerned.
37934
37935 @item O_EXCL
37936 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37937 an error and open() fails.
37938
37939 @item O_TRUNC
37940 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37941 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37942 truncated to zero length.
37943
37944 @item O_APPEND
37945 The file is opened in append mode.
37946
37947 @item O_RDONLY
37948 The file is opened for reading only.
37949
37950 @item O_WRONLY
37951 The file is opened for writing only.
37952
37953 @item O_RDWR
37954 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37955 @end table
37956
37957 @noindent
37958 Other bits are silently ignored.
37959
37960
37961 @noindent
37962 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37963
37964 @table @code
37965 @item S_IRUSR
37966 User has read permission.
37967
37968 @item S_IWUSR
37969 User has write permission.
37970
37971 @item S_IRGRP
37972 Group has read permission.
37973
37974 @item S_IWGRP
37975 Group has write permission.
37976
37977 @item S_IROTH
37978 Others have read permission.
37979
37980 @item S_IWOTH
37981 Others have write permission.
37982 @end table
37983
37984 @noindent
37985 Other bits are silently ignored.
37986
37987
37988 @item Return value:
37989 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37990 occurred.
37991
37992 @item Errors:
37993
37994 @table @code
37995 @item EEXIST
37996 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37997
37998 @item EISDIR
37999 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38000
38001 @item EACCES
38002 The requested access is not allowed.
38003
38004 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38005 @var{pathname} was too long.
38006
38007 @item ENOENT
38008 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38009
38010 @item ENODEV
38011 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38012
38013 @item EROFS
38014 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38015 write access was requested.
38016
38017 @item EFAULT
38018 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38019
38020 @item ENOSPC
38021 No space on device to create the file.
38022
38023 @item EMFILE
38024 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38025
38026 @item ENFILE
38027 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38028 has been reached.
38029
38030 @item EINTR
38031 The call was interrupted by the user.
38032 @end table
38033
38034 @end table
38035
38036 @node close
38037 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38038 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38039
38040 @table @asis
38041 @item Synopsis:
38042 @smallexample
38043 int close(int fd);
38044 @end smallexample
38045
38046 @item Request:
38047 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38048
38049 @item Return value:
38050 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38051
38052 @item Errors:
38053
38054 @table @code
38055 @item EBADF
38056 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38057
38058 @item EINTR
38059 The call was interrupted by the user.
38060 @end table
38061
38062 @end table
38063
38064 @node read
38065 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38066 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38067
38068 @table @asis
38069 @item Synopsis:
38070 @smallexample
38071 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38072 @end smallexample
38073
38074 @item Request:
38075 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38076
38077 @item Return value:
38078 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38079 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38080 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38081
38082 @item Errors:
38083
38084 @table @code
38085 @item EBADF
38086 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38087 reading.
38088
38089 @item EFAULT
38090 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38091
38092 @item EINTR
38093 The call was interrupted by the user.
38094 @end table
38095
38096 @end table
38097
38098 @node write
38099 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38100 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38101
38102 @table @asis
38103 @item Synopsis:
38104 @smallexample
38105 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38106 @end smallexample
38107
38108 @item Request:
38109 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38110
38111 @item Return value:
38112 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38113 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38114 is returned.
38115
38116 @item Errors:
38117
38118 @table @code
38119 @item EBADF
38120 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38121 writing.
38122
38123 @item EFAULT
38124 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38125
38126 @item EFBIG
38127 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38128 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38129
38130 @item ENOSPC
38131 No space on device to write the data.
38132
38133 @item EINTR
38134 The call was interrupted by the user.
38135 @end table
38136
38137 @end table
38138
38139 @node lseek
38140 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38141 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38142
38143 @table @asis
38144 @item Synopsis:
38145 @smallexample
38146 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38147 @end smallexample
38148
38149 @item Request:
38150 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38151
38152 @var{flag} is one of:
38153
38154 @table @code
38155 @item SEEK_SET
38156 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38157
38158 @item SEEK_CUR
38159 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38160 bytes.
38161
38162 @item SEEK_END
38163 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38164 bytes.
38165 @end table
38166
38167 @item Return value:
38168 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38169 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38170 value of -1 is returned.
38171
38172 @item Errors:
38173
38174 @table @code
38175 @item EBADF
38176 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38177
38178 @item ESPIPE
38179 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38180
38181 @item EINVAL
38182 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38183
38184 @item EINTR
38185 The call was interrupted by the user.
38186 @end table
38187
38188 @end table
38189
38190 @node rename
38191 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38192 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38193
38194 @table @asis
38195 @item Synopsis:
38196 @smallexample
38197 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38198 @end smallexample
38199
38200 @item Request:
38201 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38202
38203 @item Return value:
38204 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38205
38206 @item Errors:
38207
38208 @table @code
38209 @item EISDIR
38210 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38211 directory.
38212
38213 @item EEXIST
38214 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38215
38216 @item EBUSY
38217 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38218 process.
38219
38220 @item EINVAL
38221 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38222 of itself.
38223
38224 @item ENOTDIR
38225 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38226 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38227 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38228
38229 @item EFAULT
38230 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38231
38232 @item EACCES
38233 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38234
38235 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38236
38237 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38238
38239 @item ENOENT
38240 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38241
38242 @item EROFS
38243 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38244
38245 @item ENOSPC
38246 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38247 directory entry.
38248
38249 @item EINTR
38250 The call was interrupted by the user.
38251 @end table
38252
38253 @end table
38254
38255 @node unlink
38256 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38257 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38258
38259 @table @asis
38260 @item Synopsis:
38261 @smallexample
38262 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38263 @end smallexample
38264
38265 @item Request:
38266 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38267
38268 @item Return value:
38269 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38270
38271 @item Errors:
38272
38273 @table @code
38274 @item EACCES
38275 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38276
38277 @item EPERM
38278 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38279
38280 @item EBUSY
38281 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38282 being used by another process.
38283
38284 @item EFAULT
38285 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38286
38287 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38288 @var{pathname} was too long.
38289
38290 @item ENOENT
38291 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38292
38293 @item ENOTDIR
38294 A component of the path is not a directory.
38295
38296 @item EROFS
38297 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38298
38299 @item EINTR
38300 The call was interrupted by the user.
38301 @end table
38302
38303 @end table
38304
38305 @node stat/fstat
38306 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38307 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38308 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38309
38310 @table @asis
38311 @item Synopsis:
38312 @smallexample
38313 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38314 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38315 @end smallexample
38316
38317 @item Request:
38318 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38319 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38320
38321 @item Return value:
38322 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38323
38324 @item Errors:
38325
38326 @table @code
38327 @item EBADF
38328 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38329
38330 @item ENOENT
38331 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38332 path is an empty string.
38333
38334 @item ENOTDIR
38335 A component of the path is not a directory.
38336
38337 @item EFAULT
38338 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38339
38340 @item EACCES
38341 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38342
38343 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38344 @var{pathname} was too long.
38345
38346 @item EINTR
38347 The call was interrupted by the user.
38348 @end table
38349
38350 @end table
38351
38352 @node gettimeofday
38353 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
38354 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
38355
38356 @table @asis
38357 @item Synopsis:
38358 @smallexample
38359 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
38360 @end smallexample
38361
38362 @item Request:
38363 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
38364
38365 @item Return value:
38366 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
38367
38368 @item Errors:
38369
38370 @table @code
38371 @item EINVAL
38372 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
38373
38374 @item EFAULT
38375 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38376 @end table
38377
38378 @end table
38379
38380 @node isatty
38381 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
38382 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
38383
38384 @table @asis
38385 @item Synopsis:
38386 @smallexample
38387 int isatty(int fd);
38388 @end smallexample
38389
38390 @item Request:
38391 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
38392
38393 @item Return value:
38394 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
38395
38396 @item Errors:
38397
38398 @table @code
38399 @item EINTR
38400 The call was interrupted by the user.
38401 @end table
38402
38403 @end table
38404
38405 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
38406 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
38407 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
38408 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
38409 needed.
38410
38411
38412 @node system
38413 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
38414 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
38415
38416 @table @asis
38417 @item Synopsis:
38418 @smallexample
38419 int system(const char *command);
38420 @end smallexample
38421
38422 @item Request:
38423 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38424
38425 @item Return value:
38426 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38427 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38428 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38429 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38430 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38431 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38432 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38433
38434 @item Errors:
38435
38436 @table @code
38437 @item EINTR
38438 The call was interrupted by the user.
38439 @end table
38440
38441 @end table
38442
38443 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38444 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38445 the host is simplified before it's returned
38446 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38447 is discarded, and the return value consists
38448 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38449
38450 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38451 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38452 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38453
38454 @table @code
38455 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38456 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38457 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38458 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38459
38460 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38461 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38462 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38463 protocol.
38464 @end table
38465
38466 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38467 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38468 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38469
38470 @menu
38471 * Integral Datatypes::
38472 * Pointer Values::
38473 * Memory Transfer::
38474 * struct stat::
38475 * struct timeval::
38476 @end menu
38477
38478 @node Integral Datatypes
38479 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38480 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38481
38482 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38483 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38484 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38485
38486 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38487 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38488
38489 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38490
38491 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38492 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38493
38494 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38495
38496 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38497 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38498 byte order.
38499
38500 @node Pointer Values
38501 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38502 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38503
38504 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38505 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38506 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38507 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38508
38509 @smallexample
38510 @code{1aaf/12}
38511 @end smallexample
38512
38513 @noindent
38514 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38515 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38516 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38517 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38518
38519 @smallexample
38520 @code{123456/d}
38521 @end smallexample
38522
38523 @node Memory Transfer
38524 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38525 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38526
38527 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38528 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38529 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38530 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38531 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38532 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38533 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38534
38535
38536 @node struct stat
38537 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38538 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38539
38540 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38541 is defined as follows:
38542
38543 @smallexample
38544 struct stat @{
38545 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38546 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38547 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38548 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38549 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38550 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38551 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38552 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38553 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38554 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38555 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38556 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38557 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38558 @};
38559 @end smallexample
38560
38561 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38562 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38563 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38564
38565 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38566 range of values.
38567
38568 @table @code
38569
38570 @item st_dev
38571 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38572
38573 @item st_ino
38574 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38575
38576 @item st_mode
38577 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38578 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38579
38580 @item st_uid
38581 @itemx st_gid
38582 @itemx st_rdev
38583 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38584
38585 @item st_atime
38586 @itemx st_mtime
38587 @itemx st_ctime
38588 These values have a host and file system dependent
38589 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38590 support exact timing values.
38591 @end table
38592
38593 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38594 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38595 continuing.
38596
38597 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38598 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38599 get truncated on the target.
38600
38601 @node struct timeval
38602 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38603 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38604
38605 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38606 is defined as follows:
38607
38608 @smallexample
38609 struct timeval @{
38610 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38611 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38612 @};
38613 @end smallexample
38614
38615 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38616 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38617 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38618
38619 @node Constants
38620 @subsection Constants
38621 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38622
38623 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38624 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38625 values before and after the call as needed.
38626
38627 @menu
38628 * Open Flags::
38629 * mode_t Values::
38630 * Errno Values::
38631 * Lseek Flags::
38632 * Limits::
38633 @end menu
38634
38635 @node Open Flags
38636 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38637 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38638
38639 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38640
38641 @smallexample
38642 O_RDONLY 0x0
38643 O_WRONLY 0x1
38644 O_RDWR 0x2
38645 O_APPEND 0x8
38646 O_CREAT 0x200
38647 O_TRUNC 0x400
38648 O_EXCL 0x800
38649 @end smallexample
38650
38651 @node mode_t Values
38652 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38653 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38654
38655 All values are given in octal representation.
38656
38657 @smallexample
38658 S_IFREG 0100000
38659 S_IFDIR 040000
38660 S_IRUSR 0400
38661 S_IWUSR 0200
38662 S_IXUSR 0100
38663 S_IRGRP 040
38664 S_IWGRP 020
38665 S_IXGRP 010
38666 S_IROTH 04
38667 S_IWOTH 02
38668 S_IXOTH 01
38669 @end smallexample
38670
38671 @node Errno Values
38672 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38673 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38674
38675 All values are given in decimal representation.
38676
38677 @smallexample
38678 EPERM 1
38679 ENOENT 2
38680 EINTR 4
38681 EBADF 9
38682 EACCES 13
38683 EFAULT 14
38684 EBUSY 16
38685 EEXIST 17
38686 ENODEV 19
38687 ENOTDIR 20
38688 EISDIR 21
38689 EINVAL 22
38690 ENFILE 23
38691 EMFILE 24
38692 EFBIG 27
38693 ENOSPC 28
38694 ESPIPE 29
38695 EROFS 30
38696 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38697 EUNKNOWN 9999
38698 @end smallexample
38699
38700 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38701 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38702
38703 @node Lseek Flags
38704 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38705 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38706
38707 @smallexample
38708 SEEK_SET 0
38709 SEEK_CUR 1
38710 SEEK_END 2
38711 @end smallexample
38712
38713 @node Limits
38714 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38715 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38716
38717 All values are given in decimal representation.
38718
38719 @smallexample
38720 INT_MIN -2147483648
38721 INT_MAX 2147483647
38722 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38723 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38724 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38725 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38726 @end smallexample
38727
38728 @node File-I/O Examples
38729 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38730 @cindex file-i/o examples
38731
38732 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38733 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38734
38735 @smallexample
38736 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38737 @emph{request memory read from target}
38738 -> @code{m1234,6}
38739 <- XXXXXX
38740 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38741 -> @code{F6}
38742 @end smallexample
38743
38744 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38745 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38746
38747 @smallexample
38748 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38749 @emph{request memory write to target}
38750 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38751 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38752 -> @code{F6}
38753 @end smallexample
38754
38755 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38756 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38757
38758 @smallexample
38759 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38760 -> @code{F-1,9}
38761 @end smallexample
38762
38763 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38764 host is called:
38765
38766 @smallexample
38767 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38768 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38769 <- @code{T02}
38770 @end smallexample
38771
38772 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38773 host is called:
38774
38775 @smallexample
38776 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38777 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38778 <- @code{T02}
38779 @end smallexample
38780
38781 @node Library List Format
38782 @section Library List Format
38783 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38784
38785 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38786 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38787 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38788 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38789 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38790 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38791 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38792 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38793 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38794 are loaded.
38795
38796 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38797 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38798 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38799 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38800
38801 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38802 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38803 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38804 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38805 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38806 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38807
38808 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38809 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38810
38811 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38812 offset, looks like this:
38813
38814 @smallexample
38815 <library-list>
38816 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38817 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38818 </library>
38819 </library-list>
38820 @end smallexample
38821
38822 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38823 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38824
38825 @smallexample
38826 <library-list>
38827 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38828 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38829 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38830 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38831 </library>
38832 </library-list>
38833 @end smallexample
38834
38835 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38836
38837 @smallexample
38838 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38839 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38840 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38841 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38842 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38843 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38844 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38845 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38846 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38847 @end smallexample
38848
38849 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38850 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38851 section for each library.
38852
38853 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38854 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38855 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38856
38857 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38858 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38859 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38860 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38861
38862 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38863 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38864 target, the following parameters are reported:
38865
38866 @itemize @minus
38867 @item
38868 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38869 @code{struct link_map}.
38870 @item
38871 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38872 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38873 @item
38874 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38875 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38876 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38877 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38878 @item
38879 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38880 @end itemize
38881
38882 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38883 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38884 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38885
38886 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38887 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38888
38889 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38890 looks like this:
38891
38892 @smallexample
38893 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38894 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38895 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38896 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38897 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38898 </library-list-svr>
38899 @end smallexample
38900
38901 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38902
38903 @smallexample
38904 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38905 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38906 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38907 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38908 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38909 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38910 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38911 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38912 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38913 @end smallexample
38914
38915 @node Memory Map Format
38916 @section Memory Map Format
38917 @cindex memory map format
38918
38919 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38920 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38921 memory map.
38922
38923 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38924 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38925 lists memory regions.
38926
38927 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38928 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38929
38930 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38931
38932 @smallexample
38933 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38934 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38935 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38936 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38937 <memory-map>
38938 region...
38939 </memory-map>
38940 @end smallexample
38941
38942 Each region can be either:
38943
38944 @itemize
38945
38946 @item
38947 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38948 bytes from there:
38949
38950 @smallexample
38951 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38952 @end smallexample
38953
38954
38955 @item
38956 A region of read-only memory:
38957
38958 @smallexample
38959 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38960 @end smallexample
38961
38962
38963 @item
38964 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38965 bytes in length:
38966
38967 @smallexample
38968 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38969 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38970 </memory>
38971 @end smallexample
38972
38973 @end itemize
38974
38975 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38976 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38977 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38978
38979 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38980
38981 @smallexample
38982 <!-- ................................................... -->
38983 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38984 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38985 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38986 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38987 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38988 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38989 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38990 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38991 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38992 and its type, or device. -->
38993 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38994 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38995 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38996 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38997 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38998 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38999 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39000 @end smallexample
39001
39002 @node Thread List Format
39003 @section Thread List Format
39004 @cindex thread list format
39005
39006 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39007 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39008 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39009 the following structure:
39010
39011 @smallexample
39012 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39013 <threads>
39014 <thread id="id" core="0">
39015 ... description ...
39016 </thread>
39017 </threads>
39018 @end smallexample
39019
39020 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39021 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39022 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39023 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39024 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39025
39026 @node Traceframe Info Format
39027 @section Traceframe Info Format
39028 @cindex traceframe info format
39029
39030 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39031 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39032 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39033 collected in a traceframe.
39034
39035 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39036 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39037
39038 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39039 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39040
39041 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39042
39043 @smallexample
39044 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39045 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39046 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39047 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39048 <traceframe-info>
39049 block...
39050 </traceframe-info>
39051 @end smallexample
39052
39053 Each traceframe block can be either:
39054
39055 @itemize
39056
39057 @item
39058 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39059 @var{length} bytes from there:
39060
39061 @smallexample
39062 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39063 @end smallexample
39064
39065 @item
39066 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39067 collected:
39068
39069 @smallexample
39070 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39071 @end smallexample
39072
39073 @end itemize
39074
39075 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39076
39077 @smallexample
39078 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39079 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39080
39081 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39082 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39083 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39084 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39085 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39086 @end smallexample
39087
39088 @node Branch Trace Format
39089 @section Branch Trace Format
39090 @cindex branch trace format
39091
39092 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39093 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39094 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39095 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39096
39097 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39098 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39099
39100 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39101 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39102
39103 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39104
39105 @smallexample
39106 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39107 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39108 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39109 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39110 <btrace>
39111 block...
39112 </btrace>
39113 @end smallexample
39114
39115 @itemize
39116
39117 @item
39118 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39119 and ending at @var{end}:
39120
39121 @smallexample
39122 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39123 @end smallexample
39124
39125 @end itemize
39126
39127 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39128
39129 @smallexample
39130 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
39131 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39132
39133 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39134 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39135 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39136 @end smallexample
39137
39138 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39139 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39140 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39141
39142 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39143 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39144 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39145
39146 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39147 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39148
39149 @table @code
39150 @item bts
39151 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39152 @table @code
39153 @item size
39154 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39155 @end table
39156 @end table
39157
39158 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39159 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39160
39161 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39162
39163 @smallexample
39164 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?)>
39165 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39166
39167 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39168 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39169 @end smallexample
39170
39171 @include agentexpr.texi
39172
39173 @node Target Descriptions
39174 @appendix Target Descriptions
39175 @cindex target descriptions
39176
39177 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39178 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39179 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39180 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39181 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39182 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39183 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39184
39185 @itemize @bullet
39186 @item
39187 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39188 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39189 @item
39190 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39191 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39192 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39193 @item
39194 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39195 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39196 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39197 @end itemize
39198
39199 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39200 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39201 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39202 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39203 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39204
39205 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39206 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39207
39208 @menu
39209 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39210 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39211 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39212 descriptions.
39213 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39214 @end menu
39215
39216 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39217 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39218
39219 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39220 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39221 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39222 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39223 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39224 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39225 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39226 Format}.
39227
39228 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39229 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39230 specify a file are:
39231
39232 @table @code
39233 @cindex set tdesc filename
39234 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39235 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39236
39237 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39238 @item unset tdesc filename
39239 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39240 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39241
39242 @cindex show tdesc filename
39243 @item show tdesc filename
39244 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39245 @end table
39246
39247
39248 @node Target Description Format
39249 @section Target Description Format
39250 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39251
39252 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39253 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39254 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39255 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39256 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39257 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39258 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39259
39260 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39261 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39262 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39263 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39264 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39265
39266 Here is a simple target description:
39267
39268 @smallexample
39269 <target version="1.0">
39270 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39271 </target>
39272 @end smallexample
39273
39274 @noindent
39275 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39276 the x86-64 architecture.
39277
39278 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39279 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39280 are explained further below.
39281
39282 @smallexample
39283 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39284 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39285 <target version="1.0">
39286 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39287 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39288 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39289 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39290 </target>
39291 @end smallexample
39292
39293 @noindent
39294 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39295 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39296 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39297 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39298 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39299 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39300 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39301 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39302 the version mismatch.
39303
39304 @subsection Inclusion
39305 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39306 @cindex XInclude
39307 @ifnotinfo
39308 @cindex <xi:include>
39309 @end ifnotinfo
39310
39311 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39312 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39313 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39314 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39315 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39316
39317 @smallexample
39318 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39319 @end smallexample
39320
39321 @noindent
39322 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39323 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39324 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39325 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39326 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39327 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39328 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39329 original description.
39330
39331 @subsection Architecture
39332 @cindex <architecture>
39333
39334 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39335
39336 @smallexample
39337 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39338 @end smallexample
39339
39340 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39341 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39342
39343 @subsection OS ABI
39344 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39345
39346 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39347 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39348
39349 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39350
39351 @smallexample
39352 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39353 @end smallexample
39354
39355 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
39356 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
39357
39358 @subsection Compatible Architecture
39359 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
39360
39361 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39362 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39363
39364 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
39365
39366 @smallexample
39367 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
39368 @end smallexample
39369
39370 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39371 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39372
39373 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
39374 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
39375 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
39376 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
39377 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
39378 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
39379 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
39380
39381 @smallexample
39382 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
39383 <compatible>spu</compatible>
39384 @end smallexample
39385
39386 @subsection Features
39387 @cindex <feature>
39388
39389 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
39390 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
39391 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
39392 has this form:
39393
39394 @smallexample
39395 <feature name="@var{name}">
39396 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
39397 @var{reg}@dots{}
39398 </feature>
39399 @end smallexample
39400
39401 @noindent
39402 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
39403 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
39404 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
39405 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
39406
39407 @subsection Types
39408
39409 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
39410 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
39411 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
39412 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
39413 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
39414
39415 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
39416 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
39417 Types must be defined before they are used.
39418
39419 @cindex <vector>
39420 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
39421 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
39422 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
39423 @var{count}:
39424
39425 @smallexample
39426 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
39427 @end smallexample
39428
39429 @cindex <union>
39430 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
39431 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
39432 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
39433 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
39434
39435 @smallexample
39436 <union id="@var{id}">
39437 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39438 @dots{}
39439 </union>
39440 @end smallexample
39441
39442 @cindex <struct>
39443 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
39444 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
39445 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
39446 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
39447 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
39448 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
39449 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
39450 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
39451
39452 @smallexample
39453 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39454 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39455 @dots{}
39456 </struct>
39457 @end smallexample
39458
39459 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39460 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39461
39462 @smallexample
39463 <struct id="@var{id}">
39464 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39465 @dots{}
39466 </struct>
39467 @end smallexample
39468
39469 @cindex <flags>
39470 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39471 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39472 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39473 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39474 are supported.
39475
39476 @smallexample
39477 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39478 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39479 @dots{}
39480 </flags>
39481 @end smallexample
39482
39483 @subsection Registers
39484 @cindex <reg>
39485
39486 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39487
39488 @smallexample
39489 <reg name="@var{name}"
39490 bitsize="@var{size}"
39491 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39492 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39493 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39494 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39495 @end smallexample
39496
39497 @noindent
39498 The components are as follows:
39499
39500 @table @var
39501
39502 @item name
39503 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39504
39505 @item bitsize
39506 The register's size, in bits.
39507
39508 @item regnum
39509 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39510 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39511 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39512 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39513 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39514 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39515 in order of increasing register number.
39516
39517 @item save-restore
39518 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39519 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39520 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39521 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39522 ABI.
39523
39524 @item type
39525 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39526 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39527 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39528 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39529 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39530 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39531
39532 @item group
39533 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39534 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39535 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39536 in @code{info registers}.
39537
39538 @end table
39539
39540 @node Predefined Target Types
39541 @section Predefined Target Types
39542 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39543
39544 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39545 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39546 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39547 types. The currently supported types are:
39548
39549 @table @code
39550
39551 @item int8
39552 @itemx int16
39553 @itemx int32
39554 @itemx int64
39555 @itemx int128
39556 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39557
39558 @item uint8
39559 @itemx uint16
39560 @itemx uint32
39561 @itemx uint64
39562 @itemx uint128
39563 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39564
39565 @item code_ptr
39566 @itemx data_ptr
39567 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39568 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39569 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39570 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39571 may be marked as data pointers.
39572
39573 @item ieee_single
39574 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39575
39576 @item ieee_double
39577 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39578
39579 @item arm_fpa_ext
39580 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39581
39582 @item i387_ext
39583 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39584
39585 @item i386_eflags
39586 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39587
39588 @item i386_mxcsr
39589 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39590
39591 @end table
39592
39593 @node Standard Target Features
39594 @section Standard Target Features
39595 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39596
39597 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39598 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39599 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39600 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39601 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39602 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39603 can recognize them.
39604
39605 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39606 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39607 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39608 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39609 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39610 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39611 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39612 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39613
39614 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39615 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39616 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39617
39618 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39619 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39620 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39621 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39622
39623 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39624 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39625 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39626
39627 @menu
39628 * AArch64 Features::
39629 * ARM Features::
39630 * i386 Features::
39631 * MicroBlaze Features::
39632 * MIPS Features::
39633 * M68K Features::
39634 * Nios II Features::
39635 * PowerPC Features::
39636 * S/390 and System z Features::
39637 * TIC6x Features::
39638 @end menu
39639
39640
39641 @node AArch64 Features
39642 @subsection AArch64 Features
39643 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39644
39645 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39646 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39647 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39648
39649 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39650 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39651 and @samp{fpcr}.
39652
39653 @node ARM Features
39654 @subsection ARM Features
39655 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39656
39657 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39658 ARM targets.
39659 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39660 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39661
39662 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39663 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39664 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39665 and @samp{xpsr}.
39666
39667 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39668 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39669
39670 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39671 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39672 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39673 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39674
39675 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39676 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39677 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39678 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39679 halves of the double-precision registers.
39680
39681 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39682 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39683 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39684 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39685 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39686 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39687
39688 @node i386 Features
39689 @subsection i386 Features
39690 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39691
39692 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39693 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39694
39695 @itemize @minus
39696 @item
39697 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39698 @item
39699 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39700 @item
39701 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39702 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39703 @item
39704 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39705 @item
39706 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39707 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39708 @end itemize
39709
39710 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39711
39712 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39713 describe registers:
39714
39715 @itemize @minus
39716 @item
39717 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39718 @item
39719 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39720 @item
39721 @samp{mxcsr}
39722 @end itemize
39723
39724 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39725 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39726 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39727
39728 @itemize @minus
39729 @item
39730 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39731 @item
39732 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39733 @end itemize
39734
39735 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39736 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39737
39738 @itemize @minus
39739 @item
39740 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39741 @item
39742 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39743 @end itemize
39744
39745 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39746 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39747
39748 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39749 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39750 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39751
39752 @itemize @minus
39753 @item
39754 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39755 @end itemize
39756
39757 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39758
39759 @itemize @minus
39760 @item
39761 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39762 @end itemize
39763
39764 It should
39765 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39766
39767 @itemize @minus
39768 @item
39769 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39770 @item
39771 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39772 @end itemize
39773
39774 It should
39775 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39776
39777 @itemize @minus
39778 @item
39779 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39780 @end itemize
39781
39782 @node MicroBlaze Features
39783 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
39784 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
39785
39786 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
39787 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39788 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
39789 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
39790 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
39791
39792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
39793 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
39794
39795 @node MIPS Features
39796 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39797 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39798
39799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39800 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39801 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39802 on the target.
39803
39804 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39805 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39806 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39807
39808 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39809 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39810 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39811 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39812
39813 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39814 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39815 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39816 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39817
39818 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39819 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39820 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39821
39822 @node M68K Features
39823 @subsection M68K Features
39824 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39825
39826 @table @code
39827 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39828 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39829 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39830 One of those features must be always present.
39831 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39832 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39833 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39834 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39835
39836 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39837 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39838 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39839 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39840 @end table
39841
39842 @node Nios II Features
39843 @subsection Nios II Features
39844 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39845
39846 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39847 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39848 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39849 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39850 @samp{mpuacc}).
39851
39852 @node PowerPC Features
39853 @subsection PowerPC Features
39854 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39855
39856 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39857 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39858 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39859 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39860
39861 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39862 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39863
39864 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39865 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39866 and @samp{vrsave}.
39867
39868 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39869 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39870 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39871 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39872 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39873 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39874
39875 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39876 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39877 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39878 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39879 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39880 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39881 user.
39882
39883 @node S/390 and System z Features
39884 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39885 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39886 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39887
39888 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39889 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39890 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39891 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39892 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39893 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39894 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39895 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39896 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39897
39898 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39899 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39900 @samp{fpc}.
39901
39902 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39903 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39904
39905 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39906 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39907 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39908 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39909 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39910 32-bit wide.
39911
39912 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39913 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39914 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39915
39916 @node TIC6x Features
39917 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39918 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39919 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39920 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39921 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39922 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39923
39924 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39925 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39926 through @samp{B31}.
39927
39928 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39929 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39930
39931 @node Operating System Information
39932 @appendix Operating System Information
39933 @cindex operating system information
39934
39935 @menu
39936 * Process list::
39937 @end menu
39938
39939 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39940 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39941 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39942 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39943 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39944 on a different aspect of target.
39945
39946 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39947 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39948 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39949 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39950
39951 @node Process list
39952 @appendixsection Process list
39953 @cindex operating system information, process list
39954
39955 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39956 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39957 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39958 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39959
39960 An example document is:
39961
39962 @smallexample
39963 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39964 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39965 <osdata type="processes">
39966 <item>
39967 <column name="pid">1</column>
39968 <column name="user">root</column>
39969 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39970 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39971 </item>
39972 </osdata>
39973 @end smallexample
39974
39975 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39976 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39977 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39978 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39979 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39980 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39981 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39982
39983 @node Trace File Format
39984 @appendix Trace File Format
39985 @cindex trace file format
39986
39987 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39988 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39989
39990 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39991 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39992 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39993 in the future.
39994
39995 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39996 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39997 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39998 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39999 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40000 of this section.
40001
40002 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40003
40004 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40005 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40006 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40007 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40008 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40009 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40010 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40011 endianness.
40012
40013 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40014
40015 @table @code
40016 @item R @var{bytes}
40017 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40018 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40019 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40020 hexadecimal encoding.
40021
40022 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40023 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40024 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40025 @var{length} bytes.
40026
40027 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40028 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40029 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40030
40031 @end table
40032
40033 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40034 of blocks.
40035
40036 @node Index Section Format
40037 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40038 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40039 @cindex index section format
40040
40041 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40042 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40043 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40044 description.
40045
40046 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40047 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40048 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40049 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40050 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40051 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40052
40053 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40054
40055 @enumerate
40056 @item
40057 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40058 unless otherwise noted:
40059
40060 @enumerate
40061 @item
40062 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40063 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40064 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40065 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40066 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40067 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40068 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40069
40070 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40071 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40072 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40073 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40074
40075 @item
40076 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40077
40078 @item
40079 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40080 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40081 to the next offset.
40082
40083 @item
40084 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40085
40086 @item
40087 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40088
40089 @item
40090 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40091 @end enumerate
40092
40093 @item
40094 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40095 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40096 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40097 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40098 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40099 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40100 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40101 CU indices.
40102
40103 @item
40104 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40105 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40106 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40107 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40108
40109 @item
40110 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40111 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40112
40113 @enumerate
40114 @item
40115 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40116
40117 @item
40118 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40119 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40120
40121 @item
40122 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40123 @end enumerate
40124
40125 @item
40126 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40127 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40128
40129 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40130 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40131 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40132 constant pool.
40133
40134 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40135 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40136 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40137
40138 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40139 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40140 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40141 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40142 index version:
40143
40144 @table @asis
40145 @item Version 4
40146 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40147
40148 @item Versions 5 to 7
40149 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40150 @end table
40151
40152 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40153
40154 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40155 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40156 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40157 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40158 collision.
40159
40160 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40161 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40162 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40163 the code.
40164
40165 @item
40166 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40167 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40168 strings.
40169
40170 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40171 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40172 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40173 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40174 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40175 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40176
40177 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40178 @end enumerate
40179
40180 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40181 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40182 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40183
40184 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40185 (bit 0 = LSB):
40186
40187 @table @asis
40188
40189 @item Bits 0-23
40190 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40191 @item Bits 24-27
40192 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40193 @item Bits 28-30
40194 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40195
40196 @table @asis
40197 @item 0
40198 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40199 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40200 with previous versions of the index.
40201 @item 1
40202 The symbol is a type.
40203 @item 2
40204 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40205 @item 3
40206 The symbol is a function.
40207 @item 4
40208 Any other kind of symbol.
40209 @item 5,6,7
40210 These values are reserved.
40211 @end table
40212
40213 @item Bit 31
40214 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40215
40216 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40217 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40218 @value{GDBN} sources.
40219
40220 @end table
40221
40222 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40223 global/static attributes in the index.
40224
40225 @smallexample
40226 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40227 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40228 switch (die->tag)
40229 @{
40230 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40231 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40232 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40233 kind = TYPE;
40234 is_static = 1;
40235 break;
40236 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40237 kind = VARIABLE;
40238 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40239 break;
40240 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40241 kind = FUNCTION;
40242 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40243 break;
40244 case DW_TAG_constant:
40245 kind = VARIABLE;
40246 is_static = ! is_external;
40247 break;
40248 case DW_TAG_variable:
40249 kind = VARIABLE;
40250 is_static = ! is_external;
40251 break;
40252 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40253 kind = TYPE;
40254 is_static = 0;
40255 break;
40256 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40257 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40258 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40259 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40260 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40261 kind = TYPE;
40262 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40263 break;
40264 default:
40265 assert (0);
40266 @}
40267 @end smallexample
40268
40269 @node Man Pages
40270 @appendix Manual pages
40271 @cindex Man pages
40272
40273 @menu
40274 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40275 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40276 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40277 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40278 @end menu
40279
40280 @node gdb man
40281 @heading gdb man
40282
40283 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40284
40285 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40286 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40287 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40288 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40289 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40290 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40291 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40292 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40293 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40294 @c man end
40295
40296 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40297 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40298 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40299 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40300
40301 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40302 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40303
40304 @itemize @bullet
40305 @item
40306 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40307
40308 @item
40309 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40310
40311 @item
40312 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40313
40314 @item
40315 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40316 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40317 @end itemize
40318
40319 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40320 Modula-2.
40321
40322 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
40323 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
40324 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
40325 by using the command @code{help}.
40326
40327 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
40328 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
40329 executable program as the argument:
40330
40331 @smallexample
40332 gdb program
40333 @end smallexample
40334
40335 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
40336
40337 @smallexample
40338 gdb program core
40339 @end smallexample
40340
40341 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
40342 to debug a running process:
40343
40344 @smallexample
40345 gdb program 1234
40346 gdb -p 1234
40347 @end smallexample
40348
40349 @noindent
40350 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
40351 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
40352 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
40353
40354 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
40355
40356 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
40357 @table @env
40358 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
40359 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
40360
40361 @item run [@var{arglist}]
40362 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
40363
40364 @item bt
40365 Backtrace: display the program stack.
40366
40367 @item print @var{expr}
40368 Display the value of an expression.
40369
40370 @item c
40371 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
40372
40373 @item next
40374 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
40375 function calls in the line.
40376
40377 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40378 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
40379
40380 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40381 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
40382
40383 @item step
40384 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
40385 function calls in the line.
40386
40387 @item help [@var{name}]
40388 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
40389 about using @value{GDBN}.
40390
40391 @item quit
40392 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
40393 @end table
40394
40395 @ifset man
40396 For full details on @value{GDBN},
40397 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40398 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
40399 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
40400 @end ifset
40401 @c man end
40402
40403 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
40404 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
40405 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
40406 encountered with no
40407 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
40408 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
40409 Many options have
40410 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
40411 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
40412 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
40413 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
40414 more usual convention.)
40415
40416 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
40417 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
40418 option is used.
40419
40420 @table @env
40421 @item -help
40422 @itemx -h
40423 List all options, with brief explanations.
40424
40425 @item -symbols=@var{file}
40426 @itemx -s @var{file}
40427 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
40428
40429 @item -write
40430 Enable writing into executable and core files.
40431
40432 @item -exec=@var{file}
40433 @itemx -e @var{file}
40434 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
40435 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
40436 dump.
40437
40438 @item -se=@var{file}
40439 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
40440 file.
40441
40442 @item -core=@var{file}
40443 @itemx -c @var{file}
40444 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
40445
40446 @item -command=@var{file}
40447 @itemx -x @var{file}
40448 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
40449
40450 @item -ex @var{command}
40451 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40452
40453 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40454 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40455 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40456
40457 @item -nh
40458 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40459
40460 @item -nx
40461 @itemx -n
40462 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40463
40464 @item -quiet
40465 @itemx -q
40466 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40467 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40468
40469 @item -batch
40470 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40471 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40472 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40473 commands in the command files.
40474
40475 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40476 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40477 more useful, the message
40478
40479 @smallexample
40480 Program exited normally.
40481 @end smallexample
40482
40483 @noindent
40484 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40485 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40486
40487 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40488 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40489 instead of the current directory.
40490
40491 @item -fullname
40492 @itemx -f
40493 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40494 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40495 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40496 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40497 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40498 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40499 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40500 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40501
40502 @item -b @var{bps}
40503 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40504 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40505
40506 @item -tty=@var{device}
40507 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40508 @end table
40509 @c man end
40510
40511 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40512 @ifset man
40513 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40514 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40515 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40516
40517 @smallexample
40518 info gdb
40519 @end smallexample
40520
40521 @noindent
40522 should give you access to the complete manual.
40523
40524 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40525 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40526 @end ifset
40527 @c man end
40528
40529 @node gdbserver man
40530 @heading gdbserver man
40531
40532 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40533 @format
40534 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40535 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40536
40537 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40538
40539 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40540 @c man end
40541 @end format
40542
40543 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40544 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40545 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40546
40547 @ifclear man
40548 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40549 @end ifclear
40550 @ifset man
40551 Usage (server (target) side):
40552 @end ifset
40553
40554 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40555 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40556 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40557 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40558
40559 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40560 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40561 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40562
40563 @smallexample
40564 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40565 @end smallexample
40566
40567 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40568
40569 @smallexample
40570 @ifset man
40571 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40572 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40573 @end ifset
40574 @ifclear man
40575 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40576 @end ifclear
40577 @end smallexample
40578
40579 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40580 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40581 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40582
40583 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40584
40585 @smallexample
40586 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40587 @end smallexample
40588
40589 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40590 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40591 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40592 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40593 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40594 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40595 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40596 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40597 print an error message and exit.
40598
40599 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40600 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40601
40602 @smallexample
40603 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40604 @end smallexample
40605
40606 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40607 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40608
40609 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40610 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40611 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40612 the program you want to debug.
40613
40614 @smallexample
40615 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40616 @end smallexample
40617
40618 @ifclear man
40619 @subheading Usage (host side)
40620 @end ifclear
40621 @ifset man
40622 Usage (host side):
40623 @end ifset
40624
40625 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40626 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40627 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40628 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40629 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40630 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40631 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40632 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40633 descriptor. For example:
40634
40635 @smallexample
40636 @ifset man
40637 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40638 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40639 @end ifset
40640 @ifclear man
40641 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40642 @end ifclear
40643 @end smallexample
40644
40645 @noindent
40646 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40647
40648 @smallexample
40649 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40650 @end smallexample
40651
40652 @noindent
40653 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40654 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40655 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40656 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40657 `Connection refused'.
40658
40659 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40660 described in
40661 @ifset man
40662 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40663 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40664 @end ifset
40665 @ifclear man
40666 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40667 @end ifclear
40668 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40669
40670 @smallexample
40671 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40672 @end smallexample
40673
40674 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40675 case.
40676 @c man end
40677
40678 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40679 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40680
40681 @itemize @bullet
40682
40683 @item
40684 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40685
40686 @smallexample
40687 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40688 @end smallexample
40689
40690 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40691 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40692 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40693 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40694 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40695 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40696 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40697
40698 @item
40699 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40700 program:
40701
40702 @smallexample
40703 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40704 @end smallexample
40705
40706 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40707 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40708 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40709 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40710
40711 @item
40712 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40713
40714 @smallexample
40715 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40716 @end smallexample
40717
40718 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40719 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40720 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40721 debug several processes in the same session.
40722 @end itemize
40723
40724 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40725
40726 @table @env
40727
40728 @item --help
40729 List all options, with brief explanations.
40730
40731 @item --version
40732 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40733
40734 @item --attach
40735 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40736
40737 @smallexample
40738 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40739 @end smallexample
40740
40741 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40742 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40743
40744 @item --multi
40745 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40746 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40747 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40748 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40749
40750 @smallexample
40751 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40752 @end smallexample
40753
40754 @item --debug
40755 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40756 process.
40757 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40758 the developers.
40759
40760 @item --remote-debug
40761 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40762 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40763 the developers.
40764
40765 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40766 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40767 of debugging output.
40768 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40769
40770 @item --wrapper
40771 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40772 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40773 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40774 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40775
40776 @item --once
40777 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40778 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40779 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40780 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40781
40782 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40783
40784 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40785 @c QDisableRandomization.
40786
40787 @end table
40788 @c man end
40789
40790 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40791 @ifset man
40792 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40793 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40794 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40795
40796 @smallexample
40797 info gdb
40798 @end smallexample
40799
40800 should give you access to the complete manual.
40801
40802 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40803 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40804 @end ifset
40805 @c man end
40806
40807 @node gcore man
40808 @heading gcore
40809
40810 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40811
40812 @format
40813 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40814 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40815 @c man end
40816 @end format
40817
40818 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40819 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40820 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40821 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40822 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40823 running without any change.
40824 @c man end
40825
40826 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40827 @table @env
40828 @item -o @var{filename}
40829 The optional argument
40830 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40831 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40832 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40833 @end table
40834 @c man end
40835
40836 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40837 @ifset man
40838 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40839 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40840 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40841
40842 @smallexample
40843 info gdb
40844 @end smallexample
40845
40846 @noindent
40847 should give you access to the complete manual.
40848
40849 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40850 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40851 @end ifset
40852 @c man end
40853
40854 @node gdbinit man
40855 @heading gdbinit
40856
40857 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40858
40859 @format
40860 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40861 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40862 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40863 @end ifset
40864
40865 ~/.gdbinit
40866
40867 ./.gdbinit
40868 @c man end
40869 @end format
40870
40871 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40872 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40873 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40874 described in
40875 @ifset man
40876 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40877 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40878 @end ifset
40879 @ifclear man
40880 @ref{Sequences}.
40881 @end ifclear
40882
40883 Please read more in
40884 @ifset man
40885 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40886 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40887 @end ifset
40888 @ifclear man
40889 @ref{Startup}.
40890 @end ifclear
40891
40892 @table @env
40893 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40894 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40895 @end ifset
40896 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40897 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40898 @end ifclear
40899 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40900 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40901 See more in
40902 @ifset man
40903 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40904 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40905 @end ifset
40906 @ifclear man
40907 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40908 @end ifclear
40909
40910 @item ~/.gdbinit
40911 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40912 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40913
40914 @item ./.gdbinit
40915 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40916 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40917 See more in
40918 @ifset man
40919 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40920 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40921 @end ifset
40922 @ifclear man
40923 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40924 @end ifclear
40925 @end table
40926 @c man end
40927
40928 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40929 @ifset man
40930 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40931
40932 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40933 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40934 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40935
40936 @smallexample
40937 info gdb
40938 @end smallexample
40939
40940 should give you access to the complete manual.
40941
40942 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40943 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40944 @end ifset
40945 @c man end
40946
40947 @include gpl.texi
40948
40949 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40950 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40951 @include fdl.texi
40952
40953 @node Concept Index
40954 @unnumbered Concept Index
40955
40956 @printindex cp
40957
40958 @node Command and Variable Index
40959 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40960
40961 @printindex fn
40962
40963 @tex
40964 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40965 % meantime:
40966 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40967 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40968 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40969 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40970 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40971 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40972 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40973 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40974 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40975 \page\colophon
40976 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40977 @end tex
40978
40979 @bye
This page took 0.84498 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.